View
0
Download
0
Category
Preview:
Citation preview
An examination of the critical resources and Internet
capabilities for leveraging global performance in international
entrepreneurial firms.
A thesis submitted to Queensland University of Technology in fulfilment of the
requirements for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy 2014 by
Charmaine Glavas
BBus (IntBus) (First Class Hons)
BBus (IntBus/Mktg)
DipBus (IntBus)
School of Advertising, Marketing and Public Relations
QUT Business School, Queensland University of Technology
ii
SUPERVISORS
Principal Supervisor
Dr. Shane Mathews, Queensland University of Technology Business School, Advertising,
Marketing and Public Relations
Associate Supervisor
Professor Rebekah Russell-Bennett, Queensland University of Technology Business
School, Advertising, Marketing and Public Relations
iii
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
Undertaking this thesis has truly been a challenging but also life changing experience. I
would like to take this opportunity to thank the people who have supported and
encouraged me throughout this journey.
Firstly, I would like to acknowledge the significant contributions of my primary
supervisor, Dr Shane Mathews. Shane, I am very fortunate to have worked with you, such
a focused, knowledgeable and motivated researcher. Your guidance and unwavering
support throughout my PhD has allowed me to overcome many obstacles. Thank you for
your tireless support in mentoring me, and for always pushing me to achieve greater. I
look forward to our continued working relationship as colleagues. Secondly, I would also
like to sincerely thank my associate supervisor, Professor Rebekah Russell-Bennett.
Rebekah, thank you for always being approachable and for your time spent in assisting
me to complete my thesis. Thank you for your feedback and advice, and especially for
your support. I am lucky to have had such a great mentor in you.
I would also like to express my gratitude and appreciation to the PhD panel members,
Professor Boris Kabanoff and Dr Gary Mortimer. Thank you for your patience in not only
reading but also the drafting of valuable feedback to assist in the final version of this
thesis. I would also like to sincerely acknowledge the participants in this research for their
collaboration and expertise.
The PhD is for the most part a selfish journey, so a special thank you to my friends for
your understanding. Thank you especially to my dear friends Ms Bree Devin and Mrs
Sally Hourigan for your support and friendship. I would like to sincerely thank my mum
and dad for their unwavering support. Thank you for your encouragement, especially
during the most trying times. Finally, I would like to say thank you to my partner, Mr
Heath Taylor, for your support and encouragement, for always making me laugh and
encouraging me to keep going.
QUT Verified Signature
v
GLOSSARY OF KEY TERMS
IBE* International business experience
IE International entrepreneurship
IEO* International entrepreneurial orientation
IEOR* International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
IIMC* Internet, international marketing capabilities
IMP* International market performance
IVNC* International virtual network capabilities
RBV Resource-based view
SMEs Small and medium sized enterprises
TRIV* Technology-related international vision
Note. *The key glossary terms noted here are utlised only from Chapter Six onwards, where quantitative
codes require the use of minimal labels.
vi
ABSTRACT
The Internet is a critical resource for a new generation of small and medium sized
enterprise. Specifically, the Internet is important for small entrepreneurial firms in
pursuing international opportunities through increased digital integration. As such, the
Internet has been identified as a key enabler of international entrepreneurship (IE)
(Reuber & Fischer, 2011). By facilitating international business for many entrepreneurial
SMEs, the Internet has the ability to increase the quality and speed of communications
(Prasad, Ramamurthy & Naidu, 2001; Gabrielsson & Manek Kirpalani, 2004), lower
transaction costs (Lohrke, Franklin & Frownfelter- Lohrke, 2006), and facilitate the
development of international networks (Morgan-Thomas, 2009). Despite the increasing
numbers of entrepreneurial firms utilising the Internet to pursue international business
(Reuber & Fischer, 2011), the literature has paid limited attention to firms operating in an
Internet environment.
When firms extend their international activities, they often accumulate resources and
capabilities to improve their international performance. Although the resource-based
view has previously been applied to studies investigating the Internet’s impact on IE,
most research (e.g. Loane, 2006; Mostafa, Wheeler & Jones, 2006) only identifies the
conceptual links between the application of the Internet and the factors that may influence
firm performance. As such, no one model examines the specific links between resources,
Internet capabilities and international performance. Therefore, this research examines the
link between the international performance of firms and their Internet-related capabilities
through the lens of a resource and capabilities approach as recently suggested by Glavas
and Mathews (2014a). To investigate the phenomenon of the Internet’s impact on
international firm performance, a two-study approach was adopted to investigate two
research questions: (RQ1) ‘What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international
marketing capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international performance?’
and (RQ2a), ‘What is the relative influence of firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities on international performance?’ Research studies
also identify the international entrepreneur as a potential catalyst for driving Internet-
vii
generated internationalisation (Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006), but neglect the
entrepreneur’s role in exploiting resources and capabilities for international performance.
Therefore, research question (RQ2b) seeks to investigate: ‘How do international
entrepreneurs leverage Internet, international marketing capabilities for international
performance?’
In Study One, twelve international entrepreneurial firms engaged in international business
activity were investigated using case study methodology. The findings from Study One
indicate that international entrepreneurial orientation is a critical element for firms in
identifying new international opportunities, and for leveraging capabilities for
international performance. This key finding supports Wiklund and Shepherd’s (2005)
suggestion that resources are relevant for enacting entrepreneurial orientation, and that the
strength of a firm’s performance relies on the resources of the firm.
In Study Two, a quantitative confirmatory approach was utilised to test the inter-
relationships identified in the model of ‘Capabilities in IE’. Modelling of the data
revealed a mediated model, indicating that resources (international entrepreneurial
orientation) can, in combination with other capabilities (international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition and Internet, international marketing capabilities) predict how
international performance is achieved.
The research findings extend the literature by firstly examining the influence of Internet
capabilities on IE. Secondly, the findings provide an understanding of how Internet
capabilities can be characterised, and how they influence international performance.
Thirdly, the findings highlight the positive influence of the international entrepreneur in
exploiting resources and Internet capabilities. For practitioners, this thesis provides
managers with a strategy tool that can be utilised to reconfigure existing resources and
capabilities, and that also identifies the levels of international innovativeness required for
international performance. The thesis also highlights the need for international
entrepreneurs to recruit employees with an international entrepreneurial orientation.
viii
KEY WORDS
Internet, international marketing capabilities, international entrepreneurship, resource-
based view, small and medium sized firms.
ix
PUBLICATIONS
Journal articles
Glavas, C, R., Mathews, S. (2014). How international entrepreneurial characteristics influence Internet
capabilities for the international business processes of the firm? International Business Review, 1(23), 228-
245.
Glavas, C, R., Pike, S., and Mathews, S. (2014). Internet-enabled tourism entrepreneurs. International
entrepreneurial values elicited through repertory test and laddering analysis. International Journal of
Tourism Research, 1(16), 44-55.
Conference papers
Glavas, C, R., Pike, S., & Mathews, S. (2012). ‘International entrepreneurship for SME business growth: A
resource and dynamic capability view of the firm. An Internet context.’ Track: Innovation, knowledge
management and entrepreneurship for international business growth. Academy of International Business
(AIB) Southeast Asia Regional Conference Xiamen, China.
Glavas, C, R., & Mathews, S. (2011). ‘Internet-enabled international entrepreneurs: An investigation of the
inter-relationships between firm resources, dynamic capabilities and international market performance.’
Track: Innovation and Entrepreneurship. Australia and New Zealand Marketing Academy Conference
(ANZMAC) Perth, Australia.
Glavas, C, R., Pike, S., & Mathews, S. (2011). ‘International entrepreneurial values elicited through
repertory test and laddering analysis: An SME, Internet-enabled tourism perspective.’ Track: Innovation,
knowledge management and entrepreneurship for international business growth. Academy of International
Business (AIB) Southeast Asia Regional Conference Taipei, Taiwan.
Glavas, C, R., Pike, S., & Mathews, S. (2011). ‘International entrepreneurial values elicited through
repertory test and laddering analysis: An SME, Internet-enabled tourism perspective.’ Track 11: SMEs,
Entrepreneurship and Born Globals. Academy of International Business (AIB) Conference Nagoya, Japan.
Book sections:
Glavas, C. (2013). Strategies for international marketing: ‘Establishing international networks: The
internationalisation of Calleija Jewellers and their partnership with the exclusive Aston Martin’, case study
in Fletcher, R & Crawford, H., International Marketing: An Asia-Pacific perspective (6th
edition), Pearson
Education Australia, 664-667.
Glavas, C. (2013). International marketing implementation: ‘The sweet aroma of success. Modification of
products for new markets: The case of TORQ by Di Bella Coffee’, case study in Fletcher, R & Crawford,
H., International Marketing: An Asia-Pacific perspective (6th
edition), Pearson Education Australia, 680-
x
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ........................................................................................................................... iii
STATEMENT OF ORIGINAL AUTHORSHIP ............................................................................................ iv
GLOSSARY OF KEY TERMS ...................................................................................................................... v
ABSTRACT ................................................................................................................................................... vi
KEY WORDS .............................................................................................................................................. viii
PUBLICATIONS ........................................................................................................................................... ix
TABLE OF CONTENTS ................................................................................................................................ x
LIST OF APPENDICES .............................................................................................................................. xiv
LIST OF FIGURES ....................................................................................................................................... xv
LIST OF TABLES ....................................................................................................................................... xvi
CHAPTER ONE: INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 1
1.1 Introduction ........................................................................................................................................... 1
1.2 The importance of the field of international entrepreneurship .............................................................. 3
1.3 Australian SMEs in an Internet context ................................................................................................ 4
1.4 Theoretical frameworks ........................................................................................................................ 6
1.4.1 Framework one: Entrepreneurship – International entrepreneurial orientation ............................. 6
1.4.2 Framework two: Resource-based view of the firm ........................................................................ 8
1.5 Research problem ................................................................................................................................. 9
1.6 Research gaps and questions ............................................................................................................... 10
1.7 Methodology ....................................................................................................................................... 12
1.7.1 Study One: Qualitative multiple case studies to address RQ1 ..................................................... 13
1.7.2 Study Two: Quantitative questionnaire to address RQ2a and RQ2b ........................................... 14
1.8 Research contributions ........................................................................................................................ 16
1.8.1 Theoretical contributions ............................................................................................................. 16
1.8.2 Managerial contributions ............................................................................................................. 19
1.9 Outline of the thesis ............................................................................................................................ 20
1.10 Key definitions .................................................................................................................................. 23
1.11 Delimitations ..................................................................................................................................... 25
1.12 Conclusion ........................................................................................................................................ 26
CHAPTER TWO: LITERATURE REVIEW ............................................................................................... 27
2.1 Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... 27
2.2 The field of international entrepreneurship ......................................................................................... 28
2.3 International entrepreneurship in an Internet context ......................................................................... 29
2.3.1 Internet, international marketing capabilities .............................................................................. 30
2.3.2 The Internet and internationalisation theory ................................................................................ 34
xi
2.4 Framework one: International entrepreneurial orientation .................................................................. 35
2.4.1 International entrepreneurial orientation and performance .......................................................... 40
2.5 Framework two: Resource and capability view of the firm ................................................................ 42
2.5.1 Resource-based view of the firm ................................................................................................. 42
2.5.2 Dynamic capability view of the firm ........................................................................................... 45
2.5.3 International entrepreneurial firm-level resources and capabilities ............................................. 50
2.6 Summary of research gaps and questions ........................................................................................... 53
2.7 Proposed conceptual model ................................................................................................................ 57
2.8 Conclusion .......................................................................................................................................... 58
CHAPTER THREE: QUALITATIVE METHODOLOGY: STUDY ONE .................................................. 59
3.1 Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... 59
3.2 Philosophical approach ....................................................................................................................... 62
3.3 Level of analysis ................................................................................................................................. 65
3.4 Unit of data collection ......................................................................................................................... 65
3.5 Study One: Multiple case study methodology .................................................................................... 66
3.5.1 Selection strategy ......................................................................................................................... 68
3.5.2 Data sources ................................................................................................................................ 69
3.5.3 Sampling procedure and data collection ...................................................................................... 71
3.5.4 Interview protocol ....................................................................................................................... 72
3.5.5 Data analysis procedures ............................................................................................................. 73
3.5.6 Coding procedures ....................................................................................................................... 75
3.6 Criteria for evaluating the quality of case studies ............................................................................... 81
3.6.1 Construct validity ........................................................................................................................ 82
3.6.2 Internal validity ........................................................................................................................... 82
3.6.3 External validity .......................................................................................................................... 82
3.6.4 Reliability .................................................................................................................................... 83
3.7 Ethical considerations ......................................................................................................................... 83
3.8 Conclusion .......................................................................................................................................... 84
CHAPTER FOUR: FINDINGS OF QUALITATIVE STUDY ONE ........................................................... 85
4.1 Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... 85
4.2 Within-case analysis ........................................................................................................................... 86
4.2.1 CASE Gs001 ............................................................................................................................... 88
4.2.2 CASE Gs002 ............................................................................................................................... 88
4.2.3 CASE Gs003 ............................................................................................................................... 89
4.2.4 CASE Gm004 .............................................................................................................................. 89
4.2.5 CASE Gm005 .............................................................................................................................. 90
4.2.6 CASE Gm006 .............................................................................................................................. 91
4.2.7 CASE Ss007 ................................................................................................................................ 92
xii
4.2.8 CASE Ss008 ................................................................................................................................ 92
4.2.9 CASE Ss009 ................................................................................................................................ 93
4.2.10 CASE Sm010............................................................................................................................. 94
4.2.11 CASE Sm011............................................................................................................................. 94
4.2.12 CASE Sm012............................................................................................................................. 95
4.3.1 Firm-level resource 1: International technology-related innovation ............................................ 97
4.3.2 Firm-level resource 2: International technology-related proactiveness ..................................... 106
4.3.3 Firm-level resource 3: International technology-related risk-taking propensity ........................ 112
4.3.4 Firm-level resource 4: Technology-related international vision ................................................ 116
4.3.5 Firm-level resource 5: International business experience .......................................................... 123
4.3.6 Capability 1: Internet, international marketing capabilities ....................................................... 129
4.3.7 Capability 2: International virtual network capabilities ............................................................. 139
4.4 Evaluation of Chapter Four ............................................................................................................... 147
4.5 Conclusion ........................................................................................................................................ 151
CHAPTER FIVE: HYPOTHESES AND THEORETICAL MODEL DEVELOPMENT .......................... 152
5.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................... 152
5.2 Cross case evaluation: Hypotheses and model development ............................................................ 153
5.2.1 International entrepreneurial orientation ................................................................................... 154
5.2.2 Technology-related international vision .................................................................................... 155
5.2.3 International business experience .............................................................................................. 157
5.2.4 Internet, international marketing capabilities ............................................................................ 158
5.2.5 International virtual networking capabilities ............................................................................. 159
5.2.6 International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition ............................................................... 160
5.3 Full hypothesised model ................................................................................................................... 161
5.4 Factor variable labels for measurement ............................................................................................ 162
5.4.1 International entrepreneurial orientation: (Factor 1) .................................................................. 162
5.4.2 Technology-related international vision: (Factor 2) .................................................................. 163
5.4.3 International business experience: (Factor 3) ............................................................................ 164
5.4.4 Internet, international marketing capabilities: (Factor 4) .......................................................... 164
5.4.5 International virtual networking capabilities: (Factor 5) ........................................................... 165
5.4.6 International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition: (Factor 6) ............................................. 166
5.4.7 International market performance: (Factor 7) ............................................................................ 166
5.5 Measures and excepted relationships ................................................................................................ 167
5.6 Conclusion ........................................................................................................................................ 169
CHAPTER SIX: QUANTITATIVE METHODOLOGY: STUDY TWO .................................................. 170
6.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................... 170
6.2 Quantitative research design ............................................................................................................. 171
6.2.1 Population and study sample ..................................................................................................... 171
xiii
6.2.2 Unit of analysis .......................................................................................................................... 174
6.2.3 Selection of key informants ....................................................................................................... 174
6.2.4 Instrument development ............................................................................................................ 175
6.2.5 Pre-test of questionnaire ............................................................................................................ 175
6.2.6 Data collection procedure .......................................................................................................... 176
6.2.7 Evaluation of reliability and validity ......................................................................................... 181
6.2.8 Non-response bias ..................................................................................................................... 183
6.2.9 Common method variance ......................................................................................................... 186
6.3 Exploratory factor analysis (EFA) .................................................................................................... 187
6.4 Structural equation modelling ........................................................................................................... 192
6.5 Conclusion ........................................................................................................................................ 193
CHAPTER SEVEN: RESULTS OF QUANTITATIVE STUDY TWO..................................................... 194
7.1 Introduction ........................................................................................................................................... 194
7.2 Initial examination of the data .......................................................................................................... 195
7.2.1 Profile of responding firms ........................................................................................................ 195
7.2.2 Missing data .............................................................................................................................. 200
7.2.3 Normality of the data ................................................................................................................. 200
7.2.4 Data outliers defined by Mahalanobis Distance (D2) Test ......................................................... 201
7.3 Measurement model .......................................................................................................................... 201
7.3.1 Confirmatory factor analysis (CFA) .......................................................................................... 202
7.3.2 Measurement model evaluation ................................................................................................. 208
7.4 Full structural model ......................................................................................................................... 211
7.5 Hypotheses evaluation ...................................................................................................................... 221
7.6 Conclusion ........................................................................................................................................ 227
CHAPTER EIGHT: DISCUSSION AND CONCLUSION ........................................................................ 228
8.1 Introduction ....................................................................................................................................... 228
8.2 Overall findings ................................................................................................................................ 230
8.3 The positive influence of firm-level resources and capabilities on performance .............................. 232
8.3.1 The key role of Internet, international marketing capabilities on performance ......................... 232
8.3.2 The key role of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition on performance ............ 234
8.4 The key role of international entrepreneurial orientation in firm performance ................................. 236
8.5 Contributions to international entrepreneurship theory .................................................................... 239
8.6 Managerial contributions .................................................................................................................. 245
8.7 Limitations and directions for future research .................................................................................. 247
8.8 Summary ........................................................................................................................................... 250
REFERENCE LIST .................................................................................................................................... 252
APPENDIX ................................................................................................................................................. 277
xiv
LIST OF APPENDICES
Appendix 1. Interview Protocol .................................................................................................................. 278
Appendix 2. Questionnaire .......................................................................................................................... 284
Appendix 3. Expert reviews for the pre-testing of the questionnaire .......................................................... 292
Appendix 4. Recruitment Email for qualitative interviews ......................................................................... 293
Appendix 5. Profile of respondent firm’s international market behaviour .................................................. 294
Appendix 6. Telephone script for qualitative interviews ............................................................................ 295
Appendix 7. Descriptive statistics- Skewness and Kurtosis ........................................................................ 296
Appendix 8. Mahalanobis Distance (D2) test .............................................................................................. 297
Appendix 9. Assessment of the reliability and validity of the structural model - complete ........................ 297
Appendix 10. Standardised indirect effects for mediation .......................................................................... 298
Appendix 11. Standardised direct effects for mediation ............................................................................. 299
Appendix 12. Comparison of standardised regression weights: Correlated Marker Technique.................. 300
Appendix 13. Implied (for all variables) Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model) ........................ 302
Appendix 14. Implied (for all variables) Correlations (Group number 1 - Default model) ......................... 303
Appendix 15. Implied Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model) ..................................................... 304
Appendix 16. Implied Correlations (Group number 1 - Default model) ..................................................... 305
Appendix 17. Residual Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model) ................................................... 306
Appendix 18. Standardised Residual Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model) .............................. 307
xv
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter One ....................................................................................... 2
Figure 1.2 Theoretical frameworks in this research ........................................................................................ 6
Figure 1.3 Research design ........................................................................................................................... 13
Figure 2.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Two ..................................................................................... 27
Figure 2.2 Categorisation of Internet, international marketing capability integration................................... 32
Figure 2.3 Conceptualisation of international entrepreneurial orientation .................................................... 37
Figure 2.4 Proposed conceptual model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities ............................. 57
Figure 3.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Three ................................................................................... 61
Figure 3.2 Representation of expected literal and theoretical replications .................................................... 75
Figure 3.3 Diagrammatic representation of the stages undertaken to code case study inquiry data .............. 76
Figure 4.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Four .................................................................................... 85
Figure 4.2 International technology-related innovation and international markets ..................................... 105
Figure 4.3 International technology-related proactiveness and international markets ................................ 111
Figure 4.4 Relationship between the Internet and perceived risk reduction ................................................ 116
Figure 4.5 Representation of the findings of technology-related international vision ................................ 122
Figure 4.6 International business experience, opportunity recognition and international outcomes ........... 128
Figure 4.7 Internet, international marketing capabilities of the firm and internationalisation .................... 138
Figure 4.8 Components of international virtual network capabilities ......................................................... 144
Figure 4.9 Proposed conceptual model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities ........................... 150
Figure 5.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Five ................................................................................... 152
Figure 5.2 Hypothesised model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities ...................................... 162
Figure 6.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Six ..................................................................................... 170
Figure 7.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Seven ................................................................................ 194
Figure 7.2 Model 1: Measurement model for factorial validity .................................................................. 210
Figure 7.3 Model 2: Full structural model of ‘Capabilities in IE’ ............................................................... 214
Figure 7.4 Mediation of direct and indirect relationships ........................................................................... 217
Figure 7.5 Final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’: Significant, non-significant and new pathways ................. 225
Figure 7.6 Final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’ ............................................................................................ 226
Figure 8.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Eight ................................................................................. 229
xvi
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1.1 Overview of the research program ................................................................................................ 15
Table 1.2 Outline of the thesis ...................................................................................................................... 20
Table 1.3 Definitions ..................................................................................................................................... 23
Table 2.1 Summary of literature on international entrepreneurship in an Internet context ........................... 33
Table 2.2 Evaluation of seminal Internet and international entrepreneurship papers .................................... 56
Table 3.1 Research methods: International entrepreneurship in an Internet context ..................................... 60
Table 3.2 Basic beliefs of alternative inquiry paradigms .............................................................................. 63
Table 3.3 Types of design in case study inquiry ........................................................................................... 69
Table 3.4 Corresponding research questions relevant to the interview protocol ........................................... 73
Table 3.5 The a priori code manual .............................................................................................................. 77
Table 4.1 Participant demographic data file .................................................................................................. 87
Table 4.2 Cross-case analysis, with corresponding research and protocol questions .................................... 97
Table 4.3 Levels of international technology-related innovation .................................................................. 99
Table 4.4 Supporting quotations for international technology-related innovation ...................................... 102
Table 4.5 Levels of international technology-related proactiveness ........................................................... 107
Table 4.6 Supporting quotations for firms anticipating future online needs ............................................... 109
Table 4.7 Levels of international technology-related risk-taking propensity .............................................. 113
Table 4.8 Levels of technology-related international vision ....................................................................... 118
Table 4.9 Levels of international business experience ................................................................................ 124
Table 4.10 Internet usage and Internet, international marketing capabilities .............................................. 131
Table 4.11 Supporting quotations for the use of email and websites .......................................................... 133
Table 4.12 Levels of international virtual network capabilities .................................................................. 140
Table 4.13 Research Issues: Analytic importance resources and capabilities ............................................. 146
Table 5.1 Research questions and variable identification and hypotheses .................................................. 153
Table 5.2 Summary of measures ................................................................................................................. 168
Table 6.1 Sample selection pool from the Austrade database ..................................................................... 172
Table 6.2 Questionnaire construct specification ......................................................................................... 177
Table 6.3 Items and scale anchors for international business experience ................................................... 180
Table 6.4 Postcode characteristics of the survey responses ........................................................................ 184
Table 6.5 Representative industry proportions ............................................................................................ 184
Table 6.6 Significance two-tail test for non-response bias .......................................................................... 185
Table 6.7 Reliability and internal consistency tests .................................................................................... 189
Table 6.8 EFA measurement model ............................................................................................................ 191
Table 7.1 Profile of respondent firm’s including size and location ............................................................. 195
Table 7.2 Percentage of respondents per main state compared with ABS statistics.................................... 196
xvii
Table 7.3 Demographic profile of international entrepreneur’s demographics ........................................... 197
Table 7.4 Profile of respondents’ international experience ......................................................................... 198
Table 7.5 Internet usage summary .............................................................................................................. 199
Table 7.6 Model fit indicators ..................................................................................................................... 203
Table 7.7 Summary of initial CFA findings ................................................................................................ 207
Table 7.8 Summary of measurement model fit ........................................................................................... 208
Table 7.9 Summary of model fit for the full structural model..................................................................... 212
Table 7.10 Assessment of reliability and validity of the structural model .................................................. 213
Table 7.11 Summary of the results of the Chi-square difference tests ........................................................ 215
Table 7.12 Summary of model fit for the full structural model employing bootstrap procedure ................ 217
Table 7.13 Summary of the indirect effects ................................................................................................ 218
Table 7.14 Product characteristics marker variable item specification ....................................................... 220
Table 7.15 Evaluated hypothesised relationship table................................................................................. 223
Table 7.16 Standardised regression weights ............................................................................................... 224
Table 8.1 Summary of key findings from Study One and Study Two ........................................................ 232
Table 8.2 Summary of findings: Internet, international marketing capabilities .......................................... 233
Table 8.3 Summary of findings: International virtual networking capabilities ........................................... 234
Table 8.4 Summary of findings: International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition ............................. 236
Table 8.5 Summary of findings: International entrepreneurial orientation ................................................. 239
Table 8.6 Essential and desirable resources and capabilities for practice ................................................... 246
1
CHAPTER ONE: INTRODUCTION
1.1 Introduction
It is widely recognised that the Internet has been one of the most important tools for
modern-day international business (see, Petersen, Welch & Liesch, 2002; Loane,
McNaughton & Bell, 2004; Mathews & Healy, 2007). For example, the Internet has
enabled international firms to improve the efficiency of international market transactions
(Prasad et al., 2001; Gabielsson & Manek Kirpalani, 2004; Loane et al., 2004), improve
the speed and quality of communications (Reuber & Fischer, 2011), and assist in the
development and strengthening of international network relationships (Petersen et al.,
2002; Morgan-Thomas, 2009; Overby & Servais, 2005). In particular, the Internet has
played a valuable role in providing small to medium sized enterprises (SMEs) new ways
to conduct international business through faster access to market and competitor
information (Mathews & Healy, 2007). Subsequently, SMEs now have a greater ability to
take advantage of international opportunities (Mathews, Healy & Wickramasekera, 2012).
Despite the increased research interest of the Internet’s impact on firm
internationalisation, there is limited empirical evidence examining the relationship
between the Internet and a firm’s international performance (Prange & Verdier, 2011). To
date, the majority of research (see, Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mostafa et al., 2006),
identifies links between the Internet and the factors that may influence international
performance, although no one model holistically examines the specific factors which lead
to performance outcomes. With the exception of a small number of studies (Morgan-
Thomas & Bridgewater, 2004; Loane 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer,
2011), researchers have paid limited attention to the influence of Internet on the
international entrepreneurial performance of firms. As a consequence, recent research
(see, Reuber & Fischer, 2011; Glavas & Mathews, 2014a) suggests the need to investigate
the firm’s international performance through the lens of the resource-based view (RBV)
and capability view of the firm.
2
Chapter One commences with a discussion of the research background, including the
importance of the field of international entrepreneurship (IE) and the use of the Internet
within Australian SMEs. The key theoretical frameworks are discussed, followed by the
research problem. The research gaps and questions are then identified. A two-study
approach to address the research questions is then outlined, followed by the research
contributions and overall outline of the thesis. The key definitions utilised throughout this
thesis are provided, followed by the delimitations of the research. A diagrammatic
overview of Chapter One can be seen in Figure 1.1.
Figure 1.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter One
Introduction (1.1)
Research problem (1.5)
Research contributions (1.8)
Theoretical frameworks (1.4)
Outline of the thesis (1.9)
Key definitions (1.10)
Delimitations (1.11)
Conclusion (1.12)
Methodology (1.7)
The importance of the field of international entrepreneurship (1.2)
Australian SMEs in an Internet context (1.3)
Research gaps and questions (1.6)
3
1.2 The importance of the field of international entrepreneurship
IE can be defined as the “discovery, enactment, evaluation, and exploitation of
opportunities across national borders to create future goods and services” (Oviatt &
McDougall, 2005, p. 540). The IE literature states that advances in information and
communication technologies have been identified as enablers of IE, by decreasing costs
and thus making internationalisation more feasible for the resource-constrained firm
(Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). The emergence of IE as a
distinct field of research has led researchers to look specifically at the individual
entrepreneur in the international business field (Knight, 2001; Zahra, Korri & Yu, 2005;
Reuber & Fischer, 2011). The importance of the IE field has also been signalled by the
appearance of ‘special issues’ on IE in academic journals such as Entrepreneurship
Theory and Practice (1996), Academy of Management Review (2000), and the Journal of
International Entrepreneurship (2006).
More recently, there has been a growing emphasis placed on the increasingly active role
played by international entrepreneurs in the internationalisation of the firm (Bell,
McNaughton, Young & Crick, 2003; Welch, 2004; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005; Loane,
2006). This interest reflects the fact that the decision-making power in SMEs and the
impetus for firm internationalisation often lies with the international entrepreneur, as
opposed to the management team, which is responsible for decision making in larger
multi-national firms (Bhuian, Menguc & Bell, 2005). In SMEs the owner and/or the
international entrepreneurial founder is likely to be working at the front line of the firm,
and is most likely to possess the decision-making power for firm internationalisation
decisions. The literature also highlights that international market performance outcomes
can be optimised when the firm is internationally market-oriented and entrepreneurial
(Bhuian, et al., 2005). For example, Frishammar and Andersson (2010) argue that there is
a positive relationship between IE and international business outcomes, such as number
of international markets and percentage of total sales as international revenue and profit.
As a result of the positive relationship between IE and international market performance
outcomes, scholars have proposed that a significant shift in IE research is warranted
through an examination of how international entrepreneurial firms recognise and achieve
4
international market performance outcomes (Zahra et al., 2005). Given that international
entrepreneurial firms who operate in an Internet environment are the primary sources for
investigation in this thesis, Australian SMEs operating in an Internet context are
discussed next.
1.3 Australian SMEs in an Internet context
Research has suggested that the Internet has become an increasingly important tool for
internationally focused businesses (Petersen et al., 2002; Arenius, Sasi & Gabrielsson,
2006; Mathews & Healy, 2007; Etemad, Wilkinson & Dana, 2010). The Internet
facilitates the development of international business by enabling access to new
international markets (Petersen et al., 2002). Further, researchers in IE have found that the
Internet influences the behaviour of SMEs in a number of areas, such as the ability to
identify and evaluate international competition and develop new international networks
through exploitation of international opportunities (Loane & Bell, 2006). Information and
communication technologies have been identified as enablers of IE, through improved
efficiency and speed of communication, the flow of international market knowledge and
decreased overall start-up costs for firms (Prasad et al., 2001, Gabrielsson & Manek
Kirpalani, 2004). As a consequence, the Internet has given rise to the increased
internationalisation of SMEs.
Successful tourism-based SMEs such as ANZCRO have successfully leveraged the use of
the Internet to augment product offerings through streamlining of communications to take
advantage of opportunities in international markets. Other companies include Skype
which provide digital services such as the online telephone business, or eBay which offer
services solely via an Internet platform (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). Other companies such
as wotif.com provide conventional services but conduct all business transactions and
communication via the Internet, enabling the firm to pursue international opportunities
much quicker than firms without an online presence.
The Internet economy is essential to Australia’s productivity and global competitiveness
(Department of Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy, 2011). While an
increasing number of Australian businesses are using the Internet for international
5
business activity, key statistics indicate that only a relatively small share of businesses are
taking advantage of the Internet for international business operations (Department of
Innovation, Industry, Science and Research, 2011). Although the proportion of
Australian businesses with Internet access rose to 91.2% in 2011 (Department of
Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy, 2012), less than half of Australian
businesses have an online Internet presence, such as a website. Firms utilising the Internet
are more productive and add value to the business at a higher rate than those businesses
without an Internet presence (ABS, 2010).
Australian Government statistics indicate that a relatively small number of businesses
continue to obtain the benefits of a rapidly increasing online customer spend and the
international opportunities that an Internet platform offers (Department of Broadband,
Communications and the Digital Economy, 2013). Australian businesses with an online
presence received online orders worth an estimated $237 billion in 2011-2012 (ABS,
2013). In terms of consumer Internet usage the Oceania/Australian region accounted for
approximately 24.3 million Internet users in 2012 (Internet World Statistics, 2012). The
relatively high proportion of Internet use within the Australian region indicates the
increased potential for firms to exploit the opportunities that an Internet environment
offers.
On a global scale, there are more than 2.4 billion Internet users worldwide (Internet
World Statistics, 2012). With more than one billion Internet users in the Asian region,
there is evidence to suggest that Asia is the largest and fastest growing market in the
world for services delivered by the Internet (Internet World Statistics, 2012). The
European region has the second highest number of Internet users worldwide with just
over 518.5 million, with North America accounting for 273.8 million Internet users
worldwide (Internet World Statistics, 2012). The proliferation of Internet markets has
enabled many SMEs to become international. Further, the key statistics presented here
translate to millions of businesses that have, via the Internet, the potential to pursue IE in
an international market environment (Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
6
1.4 Theoretical frameworks
This research is informed by two key theoretical frameworks; IE and the resource-based
view of the firm. In this thesis, these two key theoretical frameworks, as seen in Figure
1.2, are applied to the investigation of international entrepreneurial firms, situated in the
context of an Internet environment.
Figure 1.2 Theoretical frameworks in this research
Note. This thesis draws from two key theoretical frameworks. Firstly, International entrepreneurial
orientation where the focus lies with the individual entrepreneur and secondly, the resource-based view
which constitutes a firm level focus.
1.4.1 Framework one: Entrepreneurship – International entrepreneurial orientation
Entrepreneurship research is dominated by micro-level analysis, predominantly utilising
the ‘individual’ or the ‘firm’ as the primary level of analysis (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005;
Davidsson & Wiklund, 2007). During the last decade, however, the number of research
papers employing both the ‘individual’ and ‘firm’ as a collective level of analysis has
risen, accounting for 11.1% of the total number of entrepreneurship studies. Davidsson
and Wiklund (2007) have suggested that the tendency for ‘individual and firm’ level
studies is a positive sign that individual behaviour is systematically related to firm-level
behaviour and outcomes rather than just describing individuals who run businesses.
Further, the author’s highlight that trying to explain firm outcomes solely by individual
behaviour is not a wise strategy (Davidsson & Wiklund, 2007). As such, this thesis draws
from the both the ‘individual’ level, drawing an entrepreneurial orientation, and the ‘firm’
level by utilisation of the RBV.
Framework one:
Entrepreneurship
- International
entrepreneurial
orientation
Framework two:
Resource-based
view of the firm
7
Entrepreneurial orientation has played an important role in the development of
entrepreneurship research (Slevin & Terjesen, 2011). Entrepreneurial orientation has been
used to refer to the strategy-making processes of firms engaged in entrepreneurial activity
(Lumpkin & Dess, 2001). Scholars have suggested that entrepreneurial orientation can be
meaningfully extended into the field of IE as a way of examining and explaining the
cross-border internationalisation of firms, as either a firm-level or an individual-level
construct (Knight, 2001; Jantunen Puumalainen, Saarenketo and Kylaheiko, 2005;
Mostafa et al., 2006). An international entrepreneurial orientation is a multi-dimensional
concept reflecting the firm’s overall proactiveness and aggressiveness in its pursuit of
international markets (Knight, 2001). International entrepreneurial orientation involves
taking advantage of international market offerings and risks in international environments
and being more proactive than competitors in relation to new international business
opportunities (Covin & Slevin, 1991; Jantunen et al., 2005; Wang, 2008).
To survive and to be continually successful in international markets, firms particularly
SMEs, need to engage in internationalisation behaviour (Slevin & Terjesen, 2011). An
international entrepreneurial orientation can also enable firms to identify and exploit these
internationalisation opportunities. The concept of international entrepreneurial orientation
incorporates three dimensions that reflect the firm’s propensity to engage in international
business in innovative, proactive and risk-taking ways in order to achieve the firm’s
competitive and internationally oriented goals (Knight, 2001). Firstly, international
innovativeness refers to a firm’s tendency to enter into experimentation, support new
international ideas and depart from established practices (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996; Miller,
1983; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2004). The international innovative dimension also refers to
the development or enhancement of products and services, such as new administrative
techniques and/or technologies for improving the international organisational operations
of the firm (Knight, 2001).
Secondly, international proactiveness involves aggressive positioning relative to
competitors with an emphasis on the execution and ongoing tasks in pursuit of the firm’s
international market objectives (Knight, 2001). It has also been suggested that with a
‘forward-looking’ perspective, proactive firms have the desire to be pioneers, thereby
8
capitalising on new and existing international business opportunities (Wiklund &
Shepherd, 2005). Thirdly, international risk-taking propensity denotes the willingness of
the international entrepreneur to make investments and commit resources to projects that
have uncertain outcomes or unusually high profits and/or losses (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996;
Lee, Kyungmook & Pennings, 2001; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). Overall, it can be said
that an international entrepreneurial orientation is a fundamental resource contributing
strongly to the firm’s international market performance.
1.4.2 Framework two: Resource-based view of the firm
While a number of theoretical frameworks have been developed and advanced over the
past decade to explain international firm performance, one of the predominant
perspectives has been the RBV (Wernerfelt, 1984; Barney, 1986, 1991). Seminal work by
Wernerfelt (1984) and Barney (1986, 1991) has provided the foundation for studies in the
RBV stream. The RBV is an influential theoretical framework developed to comprehend
how competitive advantage within firms is attained and how this advantage can be
sustained (Penrose, 1959; Nelson & Winter, 1982; Barney, 1986; Wernerfelt, 1984;
Barney, 1991). Researchers in international business often utilise the RBV to identify
how firms achieve and sustain international market performance.
Business performance is a firm’s reason for existence. In the absence of sustainable,
satisfactory performance outcomes, the firm will not survive; hence, performance is the
single more important dimension of the firm’s overall operations (Knight, 2001).
Researchers agree that international market performance includes both financial and non-
financial performance indicators (see, Murphy, Taylor & Hill, 1996; Wiklund &
Shepherd, 2005). More recently, researchers have expanded on the RBV literature to
include a capabilities approach, which attempts to explain how firms achieve performance
in markets that are characterised by rapid change (Eisenhardt & Martin, 2000; Makadok,
2001). In this regard, Teece and Pisano (1994) proposed the dynamic capability view to
include changing markets.
Dynamic capabilities are the responses to the need for change required to identify new
international opportunities (Easterby- Smith, Lyles & Peteraf, 2009). These key changes
9
can involve the allocation of resources and operations. This changing nature and
allocation of resources is a crucial component of the capability view (Easterby- Smith et
al., 2009). That is, a firm’s international performance is contingent firstly on a portfolio of
capabilities, and secondly, the firm’s potential to reconfigure, diversify and deploy
capabilities for international market performance (Prange & Verdier, 2011). Research
also suggests that when firms extend their international activities, they often accumulate
resources to improve their international performance (Barney, 1986, 2001).
Referred to in the literature as being ‘sticky’, firm-level resources are unique because they
cannot be readily assembled through markets (Teece, 1982), nor can they be brought or
sold. RBV theories suggest that firms with valuable, rare, inimitable, and non-
substitutable resources have the potential to achieve superior international market
performance (Barney, 1991). Firm-level resources are inputs into the firm’s production
process or strategy (Barney, 1991; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2003), and have been
considered as ‘bundles’ of tangible and intangible assets, including a firm’s management
skills, its organisational processes, and the information and knowledge the firm possesses.
RBV implies that differential endowment of firm-level resources is an important
determinant of strategy and international performance (Knight, 2001). That is,
collectively, firm-level resources can contribute to the creation of a unique resource
bundle, which can assist the firm in achieving superior international market performance.
1.5 Research problem
Although the importance of the Internet for international business activity has been
identified in the international business literature (Hamill, 1997; Aspelund & Moen, 2004;
Loane, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2007), the IE literature has paid limited attention to this
phenomenon. In recent years, the practice of IE in an Internet environment has developed
well ahead of the advancement of theory. As such, much of the research into IE in an
Internet environment remains at a conceptual level with a lack of empirical validation.
Despite the number of small entrepreneurial business that are currently utilising the
Internet to pursue international market performance, the IE literature has paid limited
attention to the specific link between Internet capabilities and the firm’s international
market performance outcomes (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). In particular, there has been
10
very little empirical research aimed at uncovering ‘bundles’ of firm-level resources and
Internet capabilities that characterise international entrepreneurial SMEs (Lewin &
Massini, 2003). To date, most research identifies links between the Internet and the
factors that may influence the international market performance of the firm, yet no one
model examines the specific links between Internet capabilities and international market
performance. Therefore, ambiguity exists in defining the Internet capabilities required for
firm performance. As such, the key research gaps within the literature will be discussed
next in relation to the research questions.
1.6 Research gaps and questions
To address the research problem, three research gaps have been identified, with three
corresponding research questions. Firstly, research has suggested that international
entrepreneurial firm-level resources and Internet capabilities are critical variables for the
successful pursuit of international opportunities (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). The literature
states that international market performance can be optimised when the firm is
internationally market-orientated and entrepreneurial. In order for firms to seize the
international opportunities that an Internet environment presents, international
entrepreneurial firms must first reconfigure their existing resource base to identify the
firm-level resources and Internet capabilities that could lead to the formulation of new
international market opportunities. Although, the RBV approach has previously been
applied to international business studies, limited research identifies the specific ‘bundle’
of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities that characterise firms operating in an
Internet environment. Further, limited research attempts to explain how Internet
capabilities in conjunction with firm-level resources influence the international market
performance of the firm. As such, research question one (RQ1) has been established:
RQ1: What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international
performance?
Secondly, the Internet has been highlighted as a strategic resource that may help firms
achieve operational efficiency and functionality when operating internationally (Li & Ye,
11
1999). More importantly, Reuber and Fischer (2011) found that entrepreneurial resources
such as Internet capabilities are a critical variable for the successful pursuit of
international marketing opportunities. However, the extent to which Internet capabilities
can contribute to the international business performance outcomes of the firm remains
unclear (Celuch & Murphy, 2010). Moreover, the link between international
entrepreneurial firm-level resources, Internet capabilities and the international market
performance of firms operating in Internet environments is still not well understood
(Mostafa et al., 2006, Mathews & Healy, 2007; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). Furthermore,
research concerning SME internationalisation has been criticised in the entrepreneurship
literature due to the lack of consideration paid to IE in an Internet environment (Mostafa
et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
Despite the increasing numbers of businesses that are already using the Internet to pursue
international business, and the latent potential for such activity from rising Internet
adoption levels, the IE literature has paid limited attention to this phenomenon (Reuber &
Fischer, 2011). In summary, research suggests that the limited extent to which IE scholars
have studied the utilisation of the Internet is not reflective of the significance of its use by
the growing number of international entrepreneurs (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). As such, it
is believed that an essential step in moving the field of IE forward is the incorporation of
Internet phenomena into the current understanding of how firms are achieving
international market performance (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). More recently, Wilden,
Gudergan, Neilsen and Lings (2013) suggested that research exploring capabilities will
benefit from modelling the mediation effects of capabilities, such as technology-related
capabilities with performance of the firm. As such, sub-research question (RQ2a) was
developed:
RQ2a: What is the relative influence of firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities on international performance?
Thirdly, research studies identify the international entrepreneur as an important and
potential catalyst for driving Internet-generated internationalisation (Davis et al., 2000;
Loane et al., 2004; Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006).
Predominantly, research highlights the positive impact of the Internet on the firm, but
12
neglects the significant influence of the decision-maker, or the international
entrepreneur’s role in exploiting firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing
capabilities for performance. With the exception of a small number of studies (Mostafa et
al., 2006; Liao et al., 2009; Reuber & Fischer, 2011), researchers to date have paid
limited attention to the role of the international entrepreneur in influencing the
international market performance of firms in an Internet environment. Therefore, this key
gap in the literature leads to the second sub-research question (RQ2b):
RQ2b: How do international entrepreneurs leverage Internet, international
marketing capabilities for international performance?
In summary, this research seeks to address the gaps in the literature by investigating how
firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing capabilities influence the
international market performance of the firm. Understanding these key firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities will assist in providing some insight into how the
Internet is influencing the internationalisation of firms. To investigate the research
questions, a mixed-method approach was adopted.
1.7 Methodology
This research is underpinned by a multi-method, two-study approach. A mixed method
approach was deemed appropriate for identifying new theoretical constructs, while
attempting to achieve verification in a relatively nascent research area (Eisenhardt, 1989,
Poon & Swatman, 1997; Perry, 1998b; Marshall & Rossman, 2006; Reuber & Fischer,
2011). Multi-method approaches, as seen in this thesis, typically involve the use of
qualitative and quantitative methodologies (Creswell, 2003; Marshall & Rossman, 2006).
The multi-method research design of this thesis can be seen in Figure 1.3, where Study
One utilises qualitative multiple case study methodology to address RQ1 and, Study Two
utilises a quantitative questionnaire to address RQ2a and RQ2b.
13
Figure 1.3 Research design
1.7.1 Study One: Qualitative multiple case studies to address RQ1
In Study One, multiple case study methodology was utilised to address RQ1. Study One
employed in-depth case study interviews, with a non-probability purposive sampling
strategy to construct a theoretical platform of firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities. A total of 12 in-depth, structured 90-minute to two-hour case interviews were
conducted with founding international entrepreneurs to yield rich insights into the
understanding of the types of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities at play in
international entrepreneurial firms. As a consequence of the qualitative analysis, a
theoretical model of ‘Capabilities in IE’ was developed for testing in Study Two. It was
determined that Study Two would empirically test all firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities identified in Study One, expect international business experience.
Reuber and Fischer (1999) acknowledge that many factors will impact a firm’s
performance, and that business experience is not necessarily the strongest of the factors.
International business experience is most often identified in more generic/traditional
models of internationalisation. Initial EFA and reliability analysis techniques were
employed to measure the suitability of international business experience in the theoretical
model. The Chronbach Alpha and Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin analysis indicates unacceptable
reliability levels; therefore international business experience was identified as a non-
critical component of the theoretical model and is not empirically tested in Study Two.
The model of ‘Capabilities in IE’ included six constructs for testing: resources include;
(international entrepreneurial orientation and technology-related international vision),
and three capabilities (international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition,
Theoretical
framework
Research issues
founded from
the literature
Study One: Multiple case studies
(RQ1)
Case study analysis
Revised theoretical framework
Formulation of hypothesis
Study Two: Questionnaire
(RQ2) and (RQ2b)
Structural equation model
Discussion of findings
Adjusted
theoretical
framework
Re-iterative
process
EFA and CFA
14
international virtual network capabilities and Internet, international marketing
capabilities). The model also utilised international market performance as the dependent
outcome.
1.7.2 Study Two: Quantitative questionnaire to address RQ2a and RQ2b
Study Two, which addresses RQ2a and RQ2b, employed a 15-minute web-based
questionnaire comprising measures adapted from pre-validated measurement scales. The
purpose of Study Two was to test the relationships in the proposed model of ‘Capabilities
in IE’. The measures were adapted to reflect more appropriate items for the specified
context of an Internet environment and tested with a pilot sample of n=100, through an
exploratory factor analysis (EFA), and reliability analysis utilising IBM SPSS 19
software. The measures were then subject to a large-scale, web-based questionnaire with
a final sample of n=208. The measures in the final sample were subject to an EFA, a
confirmatory factor analysis (CFA), and structural equation model (SEM) techniques,
utilising IMB SPSS 19 and IBM SPSS AMOS 21. By confirming or disconfirming the
constructs in the initial qualitative Study One, a quantitative modelling process gave
statistical verification to the constructs identified, as well as confirming generalisability of
the findings (Eisenhardt, 1989). Further, the multivariate SEM approach allowed the
researcher to develop theory through identification of direct and indirect relationships in a
holistic manner (Bagozzi, 1994). Scholars have suggested that SEM provides a high level
of complexity of analysis as compared with more traditional means of multivariate
analysis. An overview of the research program can be seen in Table 1.1.
15
Table 1.1 Overview of the research program
Research gaps Corresponding research
question Study
Objectives of the
research Research methods Data analysis procedures
Research gap one: Limited understanding
of how resources and
Internet capabilities
influence international
performance.
RQ1: What are the firm-
level resources and
Internet, international
marketing capabilities of
firms, and how do they
influence international
performance?
Study
One
(i) To identify the firm-
level resources and
Internet capabilities
influencing
international market
performance.
(ii) To develop a
proposed conceptual
model of firm-level
resources and Internet
capabilities.
Qualitative method
- In-depth
structured
interviews for
case study
methodology.
- (n=12 cases).
Case study analysis
- Analytic
generalisability
achieved through
replication logic,
which provides
support for theory
development.
- Manual coding
techniques.
Research gap two:
(i) Limited empirical
evidence of the inter-
relationship between
resources, Internet
capabilities and
international
performance.
Research gap three:
(ii) Lack of
understanding of how
the international
entrepreneur
influences firm
performance in an
Internet environment.
RQ 2a: What is the
relative influence of firm-
level resources and
Internet, international
marketing capabilities on
international
performance?
RQ2b: How do
international
entrepreneurs leverage
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
for international
performance?
Study
Two
(i) To examine the
relative impact of firm-
level resources and
Internet capabilities on
performance.
(ii) To understand the
role of the international
entrepreneur in
leveraging Internet
marketing capabilities
for performance.
Quantitative method
- Questionnaire.
- Initial validation
sample (n=100).
- Final sample
(n=208).
Questionnaire analysis
- Exploratory factor
analysis (EFA) utilising
IBM SPSS 19.
- Confirmatory factor
analysis (CFA) utilising
IBM SPSS 19.
- Structural equation
modelling utilising IBM
SPSS AMOS 21.
16
1.8 Research contributions
This thesis makes three important contributions to theory and three managerial
contributions. The theoretical contributions will be discussed first.
1.8.1 Theoretical contributions
The theoretical contributions to be discussed are (i) the advancement of theory derived
from the practice of IE, (ii) the empirical validation of resources and capabilities in IE,
(iii) identification of the key Internet capabilities required for international performance
and, (iv) risk perceptions associated with the Internet and implications for
internationalisation process theory.
(i) The advancement of theory derived from the practice of international entrepreneurship
The practice of IE has in recent years has proceeded well ahead of the advancement of
theory, and, as a consequence IE theory remains fragmented and devoid of a unifying
theoretical direction (Coombs, Sadrieh & Annavarjula, 2009; Zahra & George, 2002;
Peiris, Akoorie & Sinha, 2012). At a macro level, the diversity of approaches found in the
IE literature suggests that a unifying and clear methodological direction is currently
remote (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As such, a core contribution of this thesis lies in the
ability of the research to direct attention back to the importance of the development of
theory for the field of IE. Further, this thesis identifies that two commonly used
approaches to understanding international entrepreneurial firms are now outdated. First,
studies examining IE from an RBV perspective without consideration of capabilities do
not provide an accurate understanding of the how resources, and more specifically
capabilities, are influencing the firm’s international strategy. Second, the findings suggest
that performance is contingent upon the integration of an aggregation of capabilities,
beyond just the singular perspective that has plagued recent studies in IE (e.g. Wiklund &
Shepherd, 2003; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mostafa et al., 2006; Mathews & Zander,
2007).
17
(ii) The empirical validation of resources and capabilities in international
entrepreneurship
Empirical research in IE examining the resource and capability development of firms
remains largely at a conceptual level. As a consequence, there is a lack of empirical
validation of the specific variables affecting the international market performance of the
firm. The majority of the research in the emerging IE field is also characterised by studies
focusing on quantitative analysis, and as a result, complex processes in building theory
for the deployment of resources and capabilities is not being captured, unless at a narrow
level (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As such, a quantitative approach dominates IE (Coviello
& Jones, 2004; Coviello & McAuley, 1999), with the bulk of data emphasising inferential
statistics and hypothesis testing. Qualitative approaches to IE are fewer in number, which
is a weakness in a field concerned with behaviour and value-creating processes
(McDougal & Oviatt, 2000). Because IE remains at a relatively nascent stage, a number
of researchers (e.g. Knight, 2001; Zahra & George, 2002; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005)
have argued that employing both qualitative and quantitative methodologies will ensure
that research contributions in IE move away from basic conceptualisation to identifying
new theories and statistical validation of constructs. Furthermore, this thesis has
addressed this call for mixed method research contributions by employing both
qualitative and quantitative methods.
(iii) Identification of the key Internet capabilities required for international performance
With the exception of a small number of studies (e.g. Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Loane et
al., 2004; Loane 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Morgan, 2012; Reuber & Fischer, 2011),
researchers to date have paid limited attention to the relationship between IE and the firm-
level resources and capabilities required for firms in achieving international market
performance. To date, most research (e.g. Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mostafa et al., 2006)
identifies the potential for links between resources and capabilities and performance
outcomes. However, no one model examines the specific firm-level resources and
capabilities that may affect the performance outcomes of firms operating in an Internet
environment. This research addresses this gap by providing scholars with an
understanding of the firm-level resources and capabilities required for firms operating in
18
an Internet environment, beyond just viewing resources from a singular viewpoint.
Although the literature states that a firm-level resources and capability bundle can have a
positive effect on international market performance, these assertions have not yet been
clearly empirically tested.
Confirmation and modelling of the mediation effects in the model also indicate an explicit
link between firm-level resources and Internet capabilities. These key research findings
support the work of Eisenhardt and Martin (2000) and Winter (2003), who argue that
capabilities do not influence a firm’s performance directly, but rather indirectly through a
mediating variable, such as international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. As
such, the research findings extend the literature in two important ways. First, the research
findings contribute to the existing literature in examining the role of firm-level resources
and the capabilities of international entrepreneurial firms operating in an Internet
environment. Second, the results provide support for the contribution of capabilities in
improving the firm’s international market performance as predicted by Teece (2007).
(iv) Risk perceptions associated with the Internet and implications for
internationalisation process theory
The findings of this research indicate that while the Internet has had an impact on
reducing risk in internationalisation, it has now created a perception in which
international entrepreneurial managers now view internationalisation as a low-risk
business practice. This is because the Internet has negated the traditional barriers faced by
firms in the internationalisation process. It has been suggested that the Internet can also
assist in reducing the perceived risk associated with strategic decisions in the
internationalisation of the firm, considering that the internationalisation processes of the
firm are often complex with a high degree of risk in failure (Mathews & Healy, 2007).
The findings indicate that Internet, international marketing capabilities have had a
positive effect on lowering the perceived risk in internationalisation and negate key risk
factors such as high uncertainty and costs, low information and knowledge and the
presence of psychic distance factors.
19
1.8.2 Managerial contributions
This thesis provides three managerial contributions that are beneficial to international
entrepreneurial firms: (i) identification of a strategy tool to reconfigure existing resources
and capabilities, (ii) identification of the levels of innovation required for international
performance, and (iii) identification of the need to recruit employees with an international
entrepreneurial orientation.
(i) Identification of a strategy tool to reconfigure existing resources and capabilities
The research findings indicate a number of variables influencing the international market
performance of the firm. International entrepreneurial managers can use these key
capabilities as tools to reconfigure the existing resource base to achieve performance. The
essential firm-level resources required for firms to achieve performance in international
markets are international entrepreneurial orientation and international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition. The findings of the research indicate that these two components
of a firm’s resource base are critical for international business strategy. Similarly,
Internet, international marketing capabilities are also critical firm-level capabilities.
‘Desirable’, but not essential to the firm’s progression in international markets,
technology-related international vision and international virtual network capabilities are
not critical components for international market success.
(ii) Identification of the levels of innovation required for international performance
While the final model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities shows that a
number of variables are required for firms to achieve optimal performance outcomes,
innovation is one of the most important resources for an internationally focused business.
For instance, the research findings show a clear relationship between the acceptance and
application of the Internet and the development of new products to increase customer
value in Internet environments. Because the Internet has become increasingly
competitive, firms need to ensure they are more innovative in an online environment. The
research findings show that firms can become more innovative through developing new
products, opening new markets, and strategic use of the Internet to achieve successful
20
international outcomes. Firms that place a greater emphasis on innovation will stand to
achieve better financial performance outcomes.
(iii) Identification of the need to recruit employees with an international entrepreneurial
orientation
In an increasingly globalised world where the Internet plays an important role in fostering
international business, there are incentives to rely on technology for all aspects of
business. The findings of the current research show that while the Internet has been one of
the most important tools for internationally focused businesses in recent times (Petersen
et al., 2002; Loane, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2008; Mathews et al., 2012), the ‘human’
component of IE remains at the forefront. This research shows that while capabilities,
such as Internet, international marketing capabilities are important for the firm’s
progression in international markets, firm-level resources such as the international
entrepreneurial orientation play a substantial role in the international performance
outcomes of the firm. As such, international entrepreneurs should consider recruiting
people who exhibit innovative behaviours, those who are forward-looking and proactive,
and those who are willing to take risks in an international business environment.
1.9 Outline of the thesis
This thesis was written in accordance with Perry’s (1998a) overview of a structured
approach for presenting a thesis. The following thesis structure identifies eight chapters
for this research. The eight chapters included in this research are presented in Table 1.2,
followed by a brief description of the individual chapters.
Table 1.2 Outline of the thesis
Chapters included in this research
Chapter One Introduction
Chapter Two Literature review
Chapter Three Qualitative methodology – Study One
Chapter Four Findings of qualitative Study One
Chapter Five Theoretical model and hypotheses
21
Chapters included in this research
Chapter Six Quantitative methodology – Study Two
Chapter Seven Results of quantitative Study Two
Chapter Eight Discussion and conclusion
Chapter One of this thesis provides an introduction to the research by highlighting in brief
the background to the research, an evaluation of the research problem and research
questions, and an overview of the data collection methods. Within this chapter the key
terms and definitions utilised in the study are also presented along with the delimitation
parameters for research investigation.
Chapter Two provides a detailed discussion of the literature pertinent to the identified
research problem. Although limited research has attempted to examine the Internet’s
impact on small firm internationalisation, scholars have not yet thoroughly explored the
internationalisation process of firms who operate in an Internet environment. Despite the
increasing number of SMEs using the Internet to pursue and exploit international
opportunities, limited attention has been paid to this phenomenon (Reuber & Fischer,
2011). To address this gap in the international business literature, two research questions
were developed and a number of theoretical constructs in the literature were identified to
assist in answering the research questions. The proposed theoretical model developed
from the literature review is also presented in Chapter Two.
Chapter Three provides a detailed discussion of the case study methodology used for
investigation in Study One. This research methodology is thoroughly investigated to
ascertain the appropriateness of the methods used in Study One. The justification for a
qualitative approach to Study One is also presented, along with the data collection and
analysis procedures. This section of the thesis also outlines the philosophical
underpinnings in Study One and gives consideration to the ethics procedures taken in this
research.
Chapter Four provides an analytical review of the findings from the data collected from
12 information-rich international entrepreneurial firms. The findings of the 12 case
studies are presented with reference to key firm-level resources and Internet capabilities
22
identified as influencing the firm’s international market performance. A proposed
conceptual model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities in an Internet context is
also presented. This conceptual model was utilised to generate a series of hypothesis for
statistical testing in Study Two.
Chapter Five presents the proposed model of firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities, while addressing the constructs for statistical testing in Study Two. This
conceptual model identifies the hypothesised relationships between the identified
constructs of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities in an Internet context. This
section of the chapter provides a description of the measures utilised in Study Two and a
justification for the hypothesised relationships. Chapter Five further presents the full
hypothesised model of ‘Capabilities in IE’.
Chapter Six discusses the quantitative methodology for Study Two. In this chapter the use
of quantitative methods is evaluated and justified. Validity and reliability issues are taken
into consideration, along with the justification for using a structural equation modelling
approach. The ability to evaluate both manifest and latent variables with multiple-item
constructs in a simultaneous modelling process highlights the strength of utilising SEM.
SEM also allows for identification of complex interrelations, which were identified in this
study.
Chapter Seven analyses the normality of the data, reliability and measurement models as
well as the use of a EFA and CFA. Structural models including the fully saturated model,
competing and final models, are presented and discussed. This chapter also further
provides an evaluation of the model fit relevant to the inter-relationships between firm-
level resources, Internet capabilities, and international market performance. The models
are assessed for reliability and validity and for model fit and rigour using normed Chi-
squared, Tucker Lewis Index (TLI), Comparative Fit Index (CFI), Standardised Root
Mean Residual (SRMR), and Root Mean Squared Error Approximate (RMSEA). The
competing models are also assessed using a Bootstrap test for rigour and robustness.
Chapter Eight provides a discussion of the key findings of the overall research
investigation by drawing upon the findings from Study One and Study Two. The
23
theoretical and practical contributions are discussed, as are the limitations of the research.
Suggestions for future research are presented, which not only seek to overcome the
existing limitations, but also to expand the current scope of understanding in IE. The
holistic model extends the current understanding of IE by providing empirical evidence
and addressing the three identified gaps within the literature pertaining to the inter-
relationship between firm-level resources and Internet capabilities and the international
market performance.
1.10 Key definitions
The definitions of key terms utilised in this thesis are presented in Table 1.3, followed by
a discussion of the delimitations of the research.
Table 1.3 Definitions
Key terms & Abbreviation Definition
Capabilities The literature characterises capabilities as complicated routines and
processes embedded in firms (Eisenhardt & Martin, 2000).
Firm-level resources Referred to in the literature as being ‘sticky’, firm-level resources are
unique because they cannot be readily assembled through markets
(Teece, 1982), nor can they be brought or sold. Firm-level resources
have been considered as ‘bundles’ of tangible and intangible assets,
including a firm’s management skills, its organisational processes and
routines, and the information and knowledge the firm possesses (Barney,
2001). That is, collectively, these core resources contribute to the
creation of a unique resource bundle. The term ‘firm-level’ is used to
delimit to resources at the firm level.
International business
experience
Abbreviation: IBE
International business experience related to the Internet and international
markets plays an important role in garnering firm-level resources for
internationalisation via the Internet (Reuber & Fischer, 1997). The
Internet can expedite the internationalisation process, by allowing firms
to collect, analyse and evaluate information and knowledge at a much
faster pace (Loane & Bell, 2002). Likewise, international business
experience in international markets can assist firms to internationalise
more efficiently and effectively.
International entrepreneurship
Abbreviation: IE
International entrepreneurship is “the discovery, enactment, evaluation,
and exploitation of opportunities across national borders to create future
goods and services” (Oviatt & McDougall, 2005, p. 540).
Internet environments An Internet environment is an online platform that connects businesses
through a gateway of interconnected networks. Firms that operate in an
Internet environment with an online presence may engage in activities
that include website presence, online sales transactions and online
communications. It is important to highlight that a website presence does
not automatically imply that a business is instantly international, because
the firm may not be currently pursuing an international activity or have
the desire to be international in nature.
24
Key terms & Abbreviation Definition
International entrepreneurial
orientation
Abbreviation: IEO
International entrepreneurial orientation reflects the firm’s overall
international innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-seeking propensities
in its pursuit of international markets (Knight, 2001). The construct has
been used in the literature at both an individual and firm level (Knight &
Cavusgil, 2004).
Internet internationalisation
Internationalisation is a synonym for “the geographical expansion of
economic activities over a national country’s boarder” (Ruzzier, Hisrich
& Antoncic, 2006, p. 477). Internet internationalisation refers to the
firm’s expansion across national borders via technologies such as the
Internet (Loane, 2006).
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
Abbreviation: IIMC
The literature suggests that Internet, international marketing capabilities
are an important and unique firm resource (Loane, 2006; Etemad et al.,
2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). Internet, international marketing
capabilities are defined as the ‘engagement of routines, prior and
emergent knowledge, analytic processes, and simple rules to turn
information technology into customer value’ (Zhu & Kraemer, 2002, p.
278).
International virtual network
capabilities
Abbreviation: IVNC
Developing a international virtual network capability can enhance the
firm’s progression (Loane, 2006) and successful pursuit of international
opportunities in Internet markets, just one component of a firm’s
resource bundle that builds towards successful internationalisation via
Internet platforms. An international virtual network capability involves
developing virtual networks with suppliers, distributors, industry-specific
client competitors, customers and industry-relevant authorities.
International entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition
Abbreviation: IEOR
International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is the ability to
recognise a good idea and transform it into an international business
concept that adds value and generates international revenues (Lumpkin
& Lichtenstein, 2005).
International market
performance
Abbreviation: IMP
Performance is a firm’s reason for existence (Knight, 2001). In the
absence of sustainable, satisfactory performance outcomes, the firm will
not survive; hence, performance is the single more important dimension
of its overall operations (Knight, 2001). Validated measures of
international firm performance include, but are not limited to, number of
international markets, percentage of total sales as international revenue
and profit, export sales growth and export profitability (Cavusgil & Zou,
1994; Lu & Beamish, 2001; Mostafa et al., 2006; Mathews et al., 2012). Resource-based view
Abbreviation: RBV
The resource-based view of the firm is an influential theoretical
framework developed to comprehend how competitive advantage within
firms is attained and how this advantage can be sustained (Penrose,
1959; Nelson & Winter, 1982; Barney, 1986; Wernerfelt, 1984; Teece,
1986, Barney, 1991). Wernerfelt (1984) argues that by specifying a
resource profile a firm can identify the minimum resource requirements
necessary for growth.
Small and medium sized
enterprise
Abbreviation: SME
Small- and medium-sized enterprises are classified as firms employing
between 1 and 200 people. Small firms employ between 1 and 19, and
medium-sized firms between 20 and 200 (ABS, 2012).
Technology-related
international vision
Abbreviation: TRIV
The international vision of the entrepreneur has also been found to be a
principal factor in the internationalisation of SMEs (Johnson, 2004). For
instance, small, high technology mediated firms are often driven to be
international at or near inception, and often engage in early
internationalisation activities in order to maintain competitiveness
(Johnson, 2004; Loane & Bell, 2006). Derived from international vision,
technology-related international vision is the entrepreneur’s drive and
willingness to achieve international outcomes via the Internet.
25
1.11 Delimitations
The research sample in this thesis was firstly limited to international entrepreneurs. The
selection of key informants was conducted in accordance with Huber and Power’s (1985)
guidelines in determining the appropriateness of informants, such as international
entrepreneurs or owner/founders. International entrepreneurs were pre-screened to ensure
that they were the owner/founder of the firm and were central to key decision-making
processes. Pre-screening questions to differentiate entrepreneurs from non-entrepreneurs
were also included and both stages of data collection. This research is also limited to the
investigation of Australian goods and service firms only. Australia’s annual export value
of goods and services combined is approximately US$217 billion in 2009-10 (Austrade,
2011). A study published by the Australian Department of Industry, Innovation, Science,
Research and Tertiary Education (2012) also suggests that over half a million Australians
are involved in early stage entrepreneurial activity at any point in time. Considering the
entrepreneurial nature of this thesis, investigation of key informants from the Australian
region was deemed appropriate.
The findings in this research are drawn only from SMEs employing between 1 and 200
people (ABS, 2012). SMEs make a significant contribution to the Australian economy,
accounting for 99.7% of jobs, employing more than 70.5% of the private sector in
Australia (Australian Government: Department of Innovation, Industry, Science and
Research, 2011). These statistics represent the importance of SMEs to Australia’s
economic prosperity. A contextual factor, which constitutes a boundary condition
restricting the generalisability of the findings presented, is the context of the Internet.
Although the research sample consisted of firms that were actively operating in an
Internet environment, firms’ Internet use ranged from limited to extensive. Because
markets are becoming increasingly global in nature (Reuber & Fischer, 2011),
investigation of how international entrepreneurial firms were pursuing international
market performance in an Internet environment was essential.
26
1.12 Conclusion
This chapter has provided an overview of this thesis. The chapter has outlined the
research background and discussed the two key theoretical frameworks underpinning the
thesis. The research problem is discussed with reference to the key gaps identified from
the literature. The research questions developed to address the gaps in the literature were
also discussed. The mixed-method approach for data collection and analysis was also
outlined. This chapter also addressed the research contributions, and provided an
overview of the structure of the thesis. The key definitions and limitations of the research
are also addressed. Next, Chapter Two provides a comprehensive review and critique of
the literature related to IE and the resource-based view of the firm. The literature review
forms the basis for the research investigation, while highlighting the research gaps and
explaining the derivation of the research questions.
27
CHAPTER TWO: LITERATURE REVIEW
2.1 Introduction
The following literature review provides an in-depth understanding into the field of IE,
situated within the context of an Internet environment. The literature review begins with a
discussion of the foundations of IE with reference to the changing nature of entrepreneurs
who operate within an Internet environment. A review and discussion of the key role of
the international entrepreneur and the influence of international entrepreneurial
orientation will also be provided. This discussion is then followed by a review of the
resource-based and capability view of the firm. The summary of research gaps and
questions is also provided, followed by the proposed conceptual model. Concluding
comments for Chapter Two are also provided. A diagrammatic overview of Chapter Two
can be seen in Figure 2.1.
Figure 2.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Two
Introduction (2.1)
The field of international entrepreneurship (2.2)
International entrepreneurship in an Internet context (2.3)
Summary of research gaps and questions (2.6)
Proposed conceptual model (2.7)
Conclusion (2.8)
Framework one: International entrepreneurial orientation (2.4)
Framework two: Resource and capability view of the firm (2.5)
28
2.2 The field of international entrepreneurship
According to Zahra and George (2002) the term ‘international entrepreneurship’(IE) first
appeared in a manuscript by Morrow (1988), who concluded that with technological
advances and increasing global competition, entrepreneurs in the United States are
challenged to become increasingly ‘international’ in their outlook. This seminal article by
Morrow (1988) laid the conceptual foundation for further studies examining the
international nature of previously domestic-based firms, which now need to engage in
international business activity. This close theoretical link between the convergence of
entrepreneurship and international business has given rise to the field of IE (Hisrich,
Honig-Haftel, McDougall & Oviatt, 1995; McDougall & Oviatt, 2000; Zahra & George,
2002; Zahra et al., 2005). Reflective of the multidisciplinary nature of both
entrepreneurship and international business, IE draws upon theories and frameworks from
a broad range of academic fields such as management, entrepreneurship, international
business, economics, sociology and marketing to explore the complex phenomenon of IE
(Hisrich et al., 1996; McDougall & Oviatt, 2000; Zahra & George, 2002; Oviatt &
McDougall, 2005; Gamboa & Brouthers, 2008).
International business scholars Wright and Ricks (1994) argue that IE is a newly
emerging research field, consisting of (i) the study of entrepreneurial behaviour across
multiple countries and cultures, and (ii) the study of firms that are entrepreneurial and
engage in business activity across national borders. This definition of IE is said to have
‘set the scene’ for IE research (Zahra & George, 2002). While these two key foci have
remained over the last decade, the definition of IE is still a matter of continuing debate
(Oviatt & McDougall, 2005). Despite the efforts and progress made towards defining IE,
the field remains in nascent form (Zahra & George, 2002), with some scholars claiming
that IE research is fragmented, inconsistent and lacking in a unifying theoretical direction
(Jones, Coviello & Tang, 2011).
This thesis draws on a widely utilised and commonly cited definition as ‘the discovery,
enactment, evaluation, and exploitation of opportunities – across national borders – to
create future goods and services’ (Oviatt & McDougall, 2005, p. 540). The phrase ‘across
national borders’ highlights the particular importance of firms, groups and individuals
29
who discover, enact, evaluate and exploit international opportunity (Oviatt & McDougall,
2005). This definition is consistent with the definition of entrepreneurship as ‘the
processes of discovery, evaluation, and exploitation of opportunities’ (Shane &
Venkataraman, p. 218). These key definitions highlight the importance of opportunity
identification as well as the increasing importance of international entrepreneurs
themselves, their behaviour and the circumstances in which they are embedded (Shane &
Venkataraman, 2000).
International entrepreneurs, whether in new or established firms, take considerable risks
as they pursue opportunities in international markets (Zahra & George, 2002; Zahra et al.,
2005). Given that IE is about opportunity identification in international markets,
understanding how entrepreneurs make decisions to identify and exploit new international
market opportunities is necessary to the development of the field (Shane &
Venkataraman, 2000; Zahra et al., 2005). As such, understanding the factors that lead to
variations in international market performance has been identified as an important but
under-researched topic in IE (Abouzeedan & Busler, 2004; Zucchella, 2007; Jantunen,
Puumalainen, Saarenketo & Kylaheiko, 2005; Zahra et al., 2005; Frishammer &
Andersson, 2010). Given this finding, this research focuses on the firm’s successful
pursuit of international opportunities in the context of an Internet environment.
2.3 International entrepreneurship in an Internet context
The number of research articles examining the relationship between the Internet and
firms’ internationalisation has risen due to the influence of increasing Internet integration
in SMEs (e.g. Poon & Swatman, 1997; Poon & Jevons, 1997; Haynes, Becherer &
Helms, 1998; Dholakia & Kshetri, 2004; Loane & Bell, 2006; Bell & Loane, 2010;
Celuch & Murphy, 2010). The Internet as a medium for international trade has also been
championed as the most significant advancement in global strategy (Lynch & Beck, 2001;
Melawar & Stead, 2002). Research highlights, for example, that advances in information
and communication technologies, such as the Internet, are enablers of IE (Reuber &
Fischer, 2011). By increasing the quality and speed of communications and transactions,
and decreasing costs, such advances have made internationalisation more feasible for the
resource-constrained SME (Mathews & Zander, 2007; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005). The
30
Internet has the capacity not only to significantly increase the efficiency of market
transactions, but also to enhance the learning process about international markets through
faster and more extensive access to relevant information (Petersen et al., 2002; Morgan-
Thomas & Bridgewater, 2004; Mathews & Healy, 2008). The explosive growth and low
cost of the Internet has enabled firms, particularly SMEs, to connect with people and
locations all over the world, further strengthening international business relationships
(Loane, 2006; Ruzzier et al., 2006). Many scholars have seen the Internet’s influence and
ability to facilitate international market expansion as the basis for a new paradigm in
international business studies (Hamill & Gregory, 1997; Samiee, 1998; Prasad et al.,
2001; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006; Mathews & Healy,
2007, 2008).
Previous research has highlighted that the Internet can also act as a conduit for many of
the international activities between the customer and the firm (Mathews & Healy, 2007).
For example, Aspelund and Moen (2004) argue that the Internet can fundamentally
reduce communication barriers that often occur for geographically dispersed
organisations. Long-term use of the Internet creates the opportunity for cross-border
information flows and transactions, while evoking faster foreign market expansion of
firms (Quelch & Klein, 1996; Petersen et al., 2002; Aspelund & Moen, 2004). Further,
research suggests that the Internet is a powerful tool, which in most cases can be used to
assist firms in overcoming physical and managerial barriers to internationalisation
(Sinkovics & Bell, 2006). This is especially true for SMEs given their widely recognised
human and financial resource constraints (Samiee, 1998; Lituchy & Rail, 2000; Arenius
et al., 2006; Sinkovics & Penz, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006).
2.3.1 Internet, international marketing capabilities
Previously identified in the literature as ‘online technological capabilities’, Internet,
international marketing capabilities are defined as the ‘engagement of routines, prior and
emergent knowledge, analytic processes, and simple rules to turn information technology
into customer value’ (Zhu & Kraemer, 2002, p. 278). Internet, international marketing
capabilities make reference to the online technological capabilities of the firm. Much of
the literature in international business and marketing (see, Quelch & Klein, 1996; Poon &
31
Swatman, 1997; Poon & Jevons, 1997; Samiee, 1998; Prasad et al., 2001; Petersen et al.,
2002; Quan, 2008) focuses on the Internet's potential to facilitate SMEs to develop their
international activities and improve performance by reducing the challenges associated
with internationalisation. However, there is also growing evidence (Hamill, 1997; Poon &
Swatman, 1997; Poon & Jevons, 1997; Morgan-Thomas & Bridgewater, 2004; Moen,
Masden & Aspelund, 2008; Reuber & Fischer, 2011) to suggest that many firms are
embracing Internet technologies from inception, or near after, to realise international
outcomes. This finding suggests that the Internet can be employed not only as a tool to
improve international market performance, but also as a core capability underpinning the
firm's overall international strategy (Loane et al., 2004).
Research suggests that Internet, international marketing capabilities are an important and
unique firm resource for SMEs (Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006; Raymond &
Bergeron, 2008; Etemad et al., 2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). More than the Internet
itself, it has been suggested that the sustainability of a firm’s competitive advantage in the
international marketplace arising from technology, lies in the firm’s ability to re-
configure and leverage technology in rapidly changing digital environments (Zhu &
Kraemer, 2002; Teece, 2007; Liao et al., 2009). For instance, Morgan-Thomas and
Bridgewater (2004) found that the businesses making larger financial and human resource
investments in Internet technologies were more successful in conducting business with
online export channels.
The quality of a firm’s Internet technology has also been found to be associated with
lowered online customer switching (Chen & Hitt, 2002), strengthened and improved
online international customer relationships (Loane, 2006), increased online market
performance, speedier recognition of international opportunities (Aspelund & Moen,
2004), and overall increased international market performance (Mostafa et al., 2006; Bell
& Loane, 2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). As such, Internet, international marketing
capabilities better enable firms to identify, pursue and exploit internationalisation
opportunities. This is because the success of a firm in international markets relies heavily
on the capacity of the firm to change and adapt to new Internet technology developments
32
(Buttriss & Wilkinson, 2003). A categorisation of Internet, international marketing
capability integration within the firm can be seen in Figure 2.2.
Figure 2.2 Categorisation of Internet, international marketing capability integration
Note. Integrated MM = Integrated market management. Exchange of data includes exchange of data with
suppliers and customers. Source: Glavas, Pike and Mathews (2014b). Adapted from * Aspelund and Moen
(2004) and ^ Gibbs and Kraemer (2004).
Scholars have argued that a mere Internet presence, while it implies instant
internationalisation from a technological perspective, is limited, because the successful
deployment of a virtual presence is restrained by the functional and organisational
capabilities of the firm (Kotha et al., 2001; Loane, 2006). That is, a website presence does
not automatically assume that a business is instantly international. Instead, to survive and
grow in highly competitive Internet business environments, firms have to search beyond
their current resource base (Liao et al., 2009). There have also been suggestions that
Internet environments render seemingly unsustainable competitive advantages and
international outcomes obsolete (Liao et al., 2009). Instead, superior international market
performance arises from the firm’s ability to constantly rejuvenate Internet processes.
Although the literature highlights the potential impact of the Internet on performance
outcomes, limited studies accurately identify the specific inter-relationships within
STAGE TWO
MODERATE levels of integration
STAGE THREE
STAGE ONE
Communication*
Advertising ^
Integrated MM*
Online purchasing ^
Market research ^
Online sales channel ^
After sales service ^
Website application*
Exchange of data ^
LOW levels of integration
HIGH levels of integration
33
international business processes (Mathews et al., 2012). Recent research has suggested
that superior international market performance in Internet environments may arise from
the Internet marketing capabilities a firm possesses (Reuber & Fischer, 2011; Glavas &
Mathews, 2014a). Research also indicates that the link between IE, Internet, international
marketing capabilities and the performance of the firm in international markets is still not
well understood (Mostafa et al., 2006, Liao et al., 2009, Reuber & Fischer, 2011). For
example, the three studies summarised in Table 2.1 identify links between the Internet
and the factors that may influence performance, yet no model identifies the specific
resources or Internet capabilities required to optimise a firm’s international market
performance.
Table 2.1 Summary of literature on international entrepreneurship in an Internet
context
Research paper Mostafa, Wheeler & Jones
(2006)
Liao, Kickul & Ma
(2009)
Reuber & Fischer
(2011)
Methodology Quantitative
Descriptive statistics Quantitative
Structural equation model Conceptual
Analysis of literature
Theoretical
framework
- International
entrepreneurship.
- Resources.
- Innovation-based
entrepreneurship.
- Dynamic capability
view.
- Primarily based on a
review of the
literature
Key findings - The results show that
increased
entrepreneurial
orientation leads to
greater Internet
commitment.
- Firm’s resource stock
and integrative
capabilities affect the
firm’s innovation.
- Single resources
influence
performance.
- Identifies a number of
Internet-related firm-
level resources related
to the pursuit of
international
opportunities.
Key limitation - Vague description of
resources that are
related to the firm’s
performance.
- Investigates resources
from a singular view
and is vague in
analysis.
- Provides a directional
literature review,
although the paper is
conceptual in nature.
Although some research studies attempt to provide insight into IE in an Internet
environment, the research area is still evolving, warranting greater exploration (Arenius et
al., 2006; Loane, 2006; Sinkovics & Bell, 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Etemad et al., 2010;
Reuber & Fischer, 2011). Researchers have suggested that there is also a need for further
research in IE studies to identify the specific influence of Internet, international marketing
capabilities on the international performance of the firm from an IE perspective (Mostafa
et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
34
2.3.2 The Internet and internationalisation theory
Internationalisation theories were developed to explain why firms, particularly large
multi-national corporations, choose to operate beyond their domestic home market
(Johanson & Weidersheim-Paul, 1975; Johanson & Vahlne, 1977). The underlying basic
assumption in the literature is that the internationalisation processes of the firm are
associated with a number of distinct steps following from commitment decisions of the
firm (Johanson & Weidersheim-Paul, 1975; Johanson & Vahlne, 1977). Early
conceptualisations suggest that internationalisation involves a series of stages in which
firms gradually increase their international market commitment by building experience
(Johanson & Vahlne, 2003). For this reason, mainstream theory on firm
internationalisation has largely rested on ‘process’ view arguments. For example, the
Uppsala model of internationalisation, associated with the work of Johanson and
Weidersheim-Paul (1975) and Johanson and Vahlne (1977), sees internationalisation as a
process in which learning about international operations and commitment to international
business are coupled.
Traditional internationalisation process theories, such as the Uppsala internationalisation
model, have been widely criticised in the literature for not accounting for firms which do
not engage in a stepwise, incremental progression to international markets. For example,
in a study of rapidly internationalising entrepreneurial Internet firms from Canada,
Ireland, Australia and New Zealand, Loane (2006) found limited support for the stages
models of internationalisation. The vast majority of case firms interviewed in this study
displayed non-incremental Internet adoption with limited evidence supporting the
incremental international market progression of firms (Loane, 2006). Instead, numerous
scholars agree that many firms become international and seek out international market
advantages from the outset (e.g. Petersen et al., 2002; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Arenius
et al., 2006; Loane, 2006, Loane & Bell, 2006; Mathews & Zander, 2007; Gabrielsson &
Pelkonen, 2008). Referred to in the literature as ‘born global firms’ (Moen & Servais,
1997), ‘accelerated internationalising firms’ (Mathews & Zander, 2007), ‘global start-
ups’ (Oviatt & McDougall, 1995), ‘born internationals’ (Gabrielsson & Pelkonen, 2008),
and ‘international new ventures’ (McDougall, Shane & Oviatt, 1994; Oviatt &
35
McDougall, 1994; Wakkee, 2006; Oviatt & McDougall, 1997), these firms most often
engage in international business activity from or near the business’s inception.
Mainstream internationalisation theory has been criticised in the literature for assuming
that firms become international only after a long period from their time of establishment
(Etemad & Wright, 1999; Lu & Beamish, 2001; Andersson, Gabrielsson & Wictor,
2004). Scholars have suggested that process models of internationalisation also focus too
narrowly at the firm level (McDougall et al., 1994), rather than investigating the influence
of the individual or owner/founder on the internationalisation of the firm. Although
internationalisation theory has not been utilised extensively in earlier empirical IE studies,
McDougall and Oviatt (2003) have questioned the adequacy of the theory in explaining
IE phenomena, calling for new and diversified theoretical perspectives.
More recent conceptualisations of internationalisation (see, Petersen et al., 2002;
Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Arenius et al., 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2008) have suggested
that the process of firm internationalisation is also influenced by other key activities of
the firm – for example, integration of the Internet into business strategy, the capacity of
the firm to engage in international network behaviour (Poon & Jevons, 1997; Lee et al.,
2001; Welch, 2004; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006; Wakkee, 2006), and internal firm-
specific managerial factors (Cavusgil & Nevin, 1981; Begley & Boyd, 1987; Hutchinson
et al., 2006). As such, these key studies confirm that traditional internationalisation
theories are now challenged when firms operating in an Internet environment are taken
into consideration.
2.4 Framework one: International entrepreneurial orientation
Entrepreneurial orientation refers to a firm’s strategic orientation in seizing
entrepreneurial aspects of decision-making styles and practices (Wiklund & Shepherd,
2005), while also reflecting how a firm operates (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996). Three decades
since its conceptualisation, entrepreneurial orientation is a central component of
entrepreneurship and strategy research (Slevin & Terjesen, 2011), with seminal
contributions by Miller (1983), Miller and Friesen (1982), Covin and Slevin (1989, 1991),
and Lumpkin and Dess (1996). Entrepreneurial orientation refers to a firm’s strategic
36
orientation, encapsulating specific entrepreneurial components of decision-making styles,
methods, and practices (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). Miller (1983) suggests that an
entrepreneurial firm is one that ‘engages in product market innovation, undertakes
somewhat risky ventures, and is first to come up with proactive innovations, beating
competitors to the punch’ (p. 771). More recently, the entrepreneurial orientation concept
has been advanced by Knight (2001) who suggested that entrepreneurial orientation can
extend to international market environments.
In a study of international manufacturing SMEs, Knight (2001) discovered that specific
SME international success factors, such as the international orientation of the
entrepreneur, contribute strongly to the international performance of the firm. Given this
finding, Knight (2001) proposes specific international success factors such as
‘international innovativeness’, ‘international proactiveness’ and ‘international risk-taking
propensity’ in international markets as reflecting an ‘international entrepreneurial
orientation’. International entrepreneurial orientation is a multi-dimensional concept
(Covin & Slevin, 1991), utilised as both an individual and firm-level construct, reflecting
the firm’s overall proactiveness and aggressiveness in its pursuit of international market
opportunities (Knight, 2001).
International entrepreneurial orientation involves seizing international market offerings
by taking risks to be more proactive than competitors to gain new international market
opportunities (Covin & Slevin, 1991; Jantunen et al., 2005; Wang, 2008). The concept of
international entrepreneurial orientation, as illustrated in Figure 2.3, incorporates the three
dimensions as proposed by Knight (2001) and Knight and Cavusgil (2004), reflecting the
firm’s propensity to engage in international innovative, proactive and risk-seeking
propensities to achieve the firm’s competitive and internationally oriented goals.
37
Figure 2.3 Conceptualisation of international entrepreneurial orientation
Source: Knight (2001) and Knight and Cavusgil (2004).
(i) International innovativeness
Scholars have suggested that innovativeness includes supporting new ideas,
experimentation, and creative processes by departing from established practices and
technologies (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996). The international innovativeness dimension of
international entrepreneurial orientation reflects a firm’s tendency to ‘pursue creative or
novel solutions to challenges confronting the firm, including the development or
enhancement of products and services, as well as new administrative techniques and
technologies for performing organisational functions’ (Knight, 2001, p. 160). Some
research has argued that for an innovative activity to be considered entrepreneurial, it
should involve the search for new relations between existing resources and products in a
way that expands the firm’s resources in an international context (Ripollés-Meliá,
Menguzzato-Boulard & Sánchez-Peinado, 2007).
Firms often engage in international innovative behaviour in order to achieve competitive
and internationally oriented goals, such as successful firm internationalisation. Examples
of international innovativeness in an Internet environment include new product
development in an online context and opening of new markets via the Internet. From a
conceptual standpoint, research describes international innovativeness as an antecedent to
internationalisation (Knight, 2001: Ripollés-Meliá et al., 2007), successful international
outcomes (Jantunen et al., 2005; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2003; Mostafa et al., 2006), and
technology adoption (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004; Wang, 2008).
International entrepreneurial orientation
(i) International innovativeness
(ii) International proactiveness
(iii) International risk-taking propensity
38
Research also suggests that an entrepreneurial orientation gives rise to innovative
processes and practices intended to maximise organisational success in new markets
(Lumpkin & Dess, 1996). As a result of the increasing number of firms using the Internet
to pursue international markets, it is expected that standardised use of the Internet will no
longer be sufficient for international market performance. Instead, firms are often forced
to become innovative to take advantage of online international market opportunities.
Therefore, increased levels of technological and/or product market innovation can also be
used by the firm to pursue new opportunities (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005).
Research further suggests that entrepreneurship, innovation and internationalisation are
becoming increasingly intertwined and that innovativeness is imperative for the flexible
and proactive management of business activities in a complex and dynamic globalising
world (Onetti, Zucchella, Jones & McDougall-Covin, 2012). Therefore, it is expected that
firms operating in an online environment will be forced to develop new international
innovations in order to remain competitive in dynamic Internet environments.
(ii) International proactiveness
The international proactiveness dimension of international entrepreneurial orientation
refers to the aggressive positioning of the firm relative to competitors with an emphasis
on the execution of ongoing tasks in pursuit of the firm’s international market objectives
(Knight, 2001). Scholars agree that proactiveness encompasses a ‘forward-looking’
perspective whereby firms encompass the desire to be pioneers (Miller, 1983; Lumpkin &
Dess, 1996; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005; Ripollés- Meliá et al., 2007; Wang, 2008).
Wiklund and Shepherd (2005) suggest that with a forward-looking perspective, proactive
firms have the aspiration to be pioneers in their field, doing so by capitalising on
emerging international market opportunities. The literature states that firms engaged
proactively in international business activities in an Internet environment are more likely
to achieve gains beyond financial outcomes (Loane, 2006), including first-mover
advantages in anticipation of future demand (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996; Mostafa et al.,
2006). Research also highlights that a proactive international approach enhances the
international entrepreneur’s ability to anticipate the future needs of the firm and to
39
achieve performance outcomes by pursuing new international market prospects (Knight &
Cavusgil 2004; Jantunen et al., 2005).
International technology-related proactiveness refers to an opportunity-seeking, forward-
looking perspective where firms actively seek out international market opportunities,
while anticipating the future international market and technological needs of the firm.
With the explosive growth of the Internet in the international business environment, there
has been limited research that examines the proactive behaviour of firms in highly
complex, dynamic Internet environments. Such research may provide an understanding of
how international entrepreneurial firms are leveraging the Internet for the international
business processes of the firm.
(iii) International risk-taking propensity
The international risk-taking dimension of international entrepreneurial orientation is
associated with the planning and implementation of projects that entail significant
chances of financial loss (Miller & Friesen 1984; Knight, 2001). The risk-taking
dimension also denotes the willingness of the international entrepreneur to make
investments and commit resources to projects that have uncertain outcomes or unusually
high profits and/or losses (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996; Knight, 2001; Lee, Kyungmook &
Pennings, 2001), and to break away from previously established practices and venture
into the unknown (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005).
The existing literature in entrepreneurship (e.g. Lumpkin & Dess, 1996, 2001; Wiklund &
Shepherd, 2005; Moreno & Casillas, 2008) and in IE (e.g. Jantunen et al., 2005; Oviatt &
McDougall, 2005; Mostafa et al., 2006; Ripollés-Meliá et al., 2007) assumes that
entrepreneurial orientation and a firm’s international business processes (such as firm
internationalisation) are positively related to the firm’s entrepreneurial orientation,
including risk-taking propensities. For example, in a study of SME exporting firms,
Mostafa et al., (2006) found that that those managers with high entrepreneurial orientation
are innovative, proactive and risk-seeking, and, as a consequence were more likely to
exploit opportunities provided by Internet capabilities, thus showing a higher level of
commitment to the Internet and firm internationalisation. As such, it is assumed that
40
international risk-taking propensity will be important for the firm’s development of
Internet capabilities for international business. International technology-related risk-
taking propensity refers specifically to the risk, uncertainty and volatility experienced by
firms in making international business-related decisions in Internet environments. For the
purpose of this study, risk is delimited to technological and firm internationalisation risk
factors only.
2.4.1 International entrepreneurial orientation and performance
With reference to the individual dimensions of entrepreneurial orientation, research
suggests that each dimension of entrepreneurial orientation can have a positive influence
on the successful performance of the firm (Zahra & Garvis, 2000; Knight, 2001; Wiklund
& Shepherd, 2005; Mostafa et al., 2006; Wang 2008). Similarly, international
entrepreneurial orientation has been found to have a positive influence on a firm’s
international performance (see, Knight 2001, Jantunen et al., 2005; Ripollés- Meliá et al.,
2007; Kuivalainen, Sundqvist & Servais, 2007). A review of the literature in IE suggests
that firms developing an international entrepreneurial orientation perceive new
international market opportunities more quickly, outperform competitors, and improve
the international market performance of the firm (Knight, 2001; Jantunen et al., 2005;
Mostafa et al., 2006; Ripollés- Meliá et al., 2007; Slevin & Terjesen, 2011).
A sustainable international performance may also provide firms with an incoming stream
of resources, often used to channel back into the firm’s ongoing international business
(Knight, 2001; Frishammar & Andersson, 2010). For instance, case study research
conducted by Knight (2001) revealed that an international entrepreneurial orientation is a
fundamental ‘corporate posture’, contributing strongly to the international performance of
SMEs. However, in the absence of sustainable performance outcomes, the firm will not
survive; hence, performance is the single most important dimension of the firm’s overall
operations (Knight, 2001).
In a study of 808 Swedish SME business managers, Wiklund and Shepherd (2005)
identified that entrepreneurial orientation dimensions (i.e. proactiveness, innovativeness
and risk-seeking propensity) positively influence the firm’s knowledge-based resources
41
and performance. Similarly, Zahra and Garvis (2000) acquired data from 98 firms based
in the United States and identified those entrepreneurial activities positively influencing
the international profitability of the firm. The authors of the US-based study concluded
that entrepreneurship moderates the relationship between unstable operating
environments and successful market performance (Zahra & Garvis, 2000). Similar
findings were also identified by Jantunen et al. (2005), who argue that the technological
capabilities of a firm offer sustainable competitive advantages in rapidly changing
markets, as an international entrepreneurial orientation supports opportunity recognition
in new international markets.
Contrary to the findings of Zahra and Garvis (2000) and Wiklund and Shepherd (2005),
Lee, Kyungmook and Pennings (2001) identified only weak evidence of a positive
relationship between entrepreneurial orientation and performance. The study utilised data
from 137 Korean technological start-up firms, to identify that it takes in excess of two
years for entrepreneurial orientation to enhance firm performance. However,
generalisability of these findings to other country-specific markets and non-technological
firms is questionable. Although the relationship between international entrepreneurial
orientation and performance remains inconsistent, an overwhelming majority of scholars
(e.g. Knight, 2001; Jantunen et al., 2005; Ripollés- Meliá et al., 2007; Moreno & Casillas,
2008; Wang, 2008; Slevin & Terjesen, 2011) indicate that international entrepreneurial
orientation can positively influence international market performance.
Research also suggests that international performance can be difficult to operationalise
and measure as it is vastly different from organisational effectiveness and firm growth
(Dimitratos, Lioukas & Carter, 2004; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). Various scholars (e.g.
Murphy et al., 1996; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005) agree that international performance
should be measured through at least two different dimensions of performance, preferably
including both financial and non-financial performance indicators (Wiklund & Shepherd,
2005).
Understanding the motivation to internationalise can reveal how entrepreneurs define
their international arena and how they go about building their international markets
(Zahra et al., 2005; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). Research suggests that an international
42
entrepreneur’s resources are a crucial determinant in developing a firm’s international
strategy and ongoing international performance (Mostafa et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer,
2011). While a number of theoretical frameworks have been developed and advanced
over the past decade to explain international firm performance, one predominant
perspective utlised in the international business literature has been the RBV (Wernerfelt,
1984; Barney, 1986, 1991).
The RBV implies that differential endowment of firm resources is an important
determinant of strategy and international performance (Knight, 2001). Resources include
capabilities, information, knowledge and technology. The most critical are those
resources such as firm specific capabilities which cannot be brought or sold and which are
difficult to imitate. Resources are often utilised by the firm to enable the implementation
of strategies that improve the firm’s international effectiveness and efficiency, and for
SMEs to acquire differential advantage in international markets where possible (Knight,
2001; Wernerfelt, 1984). Knight (2001) suggested that the RBV view rests on two key
assumptions: ‘(i) Firms within any given industry are heterogeneous with regard to the
resources they control and (ii) resources are not perfectly mobile across firms and hence,
heterogeneity tends to be long-lasting’ (p. 158). As such, RBV theory helps to explain
how possession of superior managerial orientations, strategic approaches, and other such
factors can serve as important advantages in the international activities of SMEs.
2.5 Framework two: Resource and capability view of the firm
The second theoretical framework this thesis draws from is the RBV of the firm.
Recently, RBV has been extended to include the dynamic capabilities approach (Teece et
al., 1997), which is the firm’s ability to achieve performance in markets characterised by
rapid change (Teece, 2007). As such, the RBV of the firm will be discussed, followed by
the dynamic capability view of the firm.
2.5.1 Resource-based view of the firm
Edith Penrose (1959) was one of the first scholars to identify the importance of resources
for a firm’s international growth. In 1959, Penrose argued that a firm’s growth, both
43
internally and externally (globally), is due to the manner in which the firm’s resources are
employed. She began by arguing that a firm is a ‘collection of productive resources’
(Penrose, 1959, p. 24), and continued by suggesting that resources will only contribute to
a firm’s competitive global position to the extent that they are exploited. Penrose (1959,
p. 136) argued that ‘a firm with resources available for expansion over and above those
required to maintain its position… may well find that opportunities for expansion into
new areas look more promising than further expansion into existing areas’. This resource
explanation by Penrose (1959) has laid the conceptual foundation of how certain firms,
which have achieved local market success, look to exploit international opportunities
beyond those that exist domestically. While a number of theoretical frameworks have
been developed and advanced over the past decade to explain international firm
performance, one of the predominant perspectives has been the RBV (Wernerfelt, 1984;
Barney, 1986, 1991). Seminal work produced by Wernerfelt (1984) and Barney (1986,
1991) has provided the foundation for studies in the RBV stream. These foundation RBV
studies will be discussed further.
Firm-level resources are at the core of the RBV. The RBV is an influential theoretical
framework developed to comprehend how competitive advantage within firms is attained
and how this advantage can be sustained (Penrose, 1959; Nelson & Winter, 1982; Barney,
1986; Wernerfelt, 1984; Teece, 1986, Barney, 1991). Wernerfelt (1984) explored the
usefulness of analysing firms from a resource rather than a product perspective.
Wernerfelt states that ‘for the firm, resources and products are two sides of the same coin’
(1984, p. 171), and further argues that by specifying a resource profile a firm can identify
the minimum resource requirements necessary for growth. Wernerfelt (1984) identified
resources as important antecedents for product development and ultimately firm
performance. Building on the foundation provided by Wernerfelt (1984), Barney (1991)
provided what has been argued as the ‘most detailed and formalised depiction’ (Priem &
Butler, 2001) of business-level RBV.
To a large extent most of the empirical research on the RBV has relied on Barney (1991)
or further extensions of his seminal work. According to Barney (1986, 1991), sustained
competitive advantage and superior international market performance are derived from
44
the resources and capabilities a firm possesses, which are valuable, rare, difficult to
imitate and non-substitutable (Barney 1991; Barney, Wright & Ketchen, 2001; Barney,
2001). Barney (1991) argues that two key assumptions are essential to the RBV: Firstly,
that firm-level resources are distributed heterogeneously across firms, and secondly, that
productive resources cannot be transferred from firm to firm (Barney, 1991; Priem &
Butler, 2001). Referred to in the literature as being ‘sticky’, firm-level resources are
unique because they cannot be readily assembled through markets, nor can they be
brought or sold (Teece, 1982). These firm-level resources and capabilities have been
considered as ‘bundles’ of tangible and intangible assets, including a firm’s management
skills, its organisational processes and routines, and the information and knowledge the
firm possesses (Barney, 2001). That is, collectively, these core firm-level resources
contribute to the creation of a unique resource bundle.
The findings of Wernerfelt (1984) and Barney (1991) are fundamentally similar in that
both argue that unique value-creating resources will generate a sustainable competitive
advantage to the extent that no competitor has the ability to utilise the same type of
resource, either through acquisition or imitation. From this value-creating resource
perspective, firms are perceived to be heterogeneous with respect to their resources
(Barney, 1991) and capabilities (Teece et al., 1997). That is, firms possess unique firm-
level resources and capabilities that are different from every other firm, albeit in the same
operating environment or different industry sector. These firm capabilities, competencies
and routines are characterised by firm resources, which in turn can lead to superior
domestic and international performance, particularly for firms operating in highly
competitive and complex environments (Teece et al., 1997).
It has been argued in the literature that the accumulation of valuable firm-level resources
is not enough to support a firm’s sustainable competitive advantage, especially for firms
operating in fast-changing dynamic environments (Griffith & Harvey, 2001; Wu, 2006;
Augier & Teece, 2007; Teece, 2007; Døving & Gooderham, 2008; Makadok, 2001;
Ambrosini & Bowman, 2009). Instead, a firm must also possess capabilities so as to
continually adapt, integrate, reconfigure and redeploy its resources and capabilities to
exploit the opportunities of complex changing environments (Teece & Pisano, 1994;
45
Teece et al., 1997; Augier & Teece, 2007, Teece, 2007). In this regard, the dynamic
capability view of the firm will be discussed.
2.5.2 Dynamic capability view of the firm
It has been argued that the accumulation of valuable resources is not enough to support a
firm’s sustainable competitive advantage (Teece et al., 1997), especially for firms that
operate in fast-changing dynamic Internet environments. For instance, small international
entrepreneurial firms most often cannot afford to make costly mistakes in wrongful
resource commitments, but instead have to be highly alert, flexible and adaptive (Liao et
al., 2009). Research suggests that a firm must also possess capabilities so as to
continually adapt, integrate, reconfigure and redeploy resources and capabilities to exploit
the opportunities of changing environments (Teece et al., 1997; Vogel & Güttel, 2013). In
this regard, Teece and Pisano (1994) proposed the dynamic capability view to include
dynamic markets. This means that firms can ultimately re-deploy resources and
capabilities to respond to changing market circumstances in environments characterised
by rapid and unpredictable change. This is particularly important for small firms as their
inherent flexibility enhances the ability of the firm to transform ideas into business
activities that support the business’s international performance strategies (Weerawardena,
Mort, Liesch, & Knight, 2007; Lewin & Massini, 2003; Wu, 2006; Liao et al., 2009).
The dynamic capability view is an extension, or subset of the RBV. The dynamic
capability view typically involves a firm’s long-term commitment to specialised resources
in dynamic and rapidly changing environments, such as those markets characterised by
high technology-mediated change (Winter, 2003; Vogel & Güttel, 2013). Elements of the
dynamic capabilities approach can be found in the work of Penrose (1959), Nelson &
Winter (1982), Barney (1986, 1991) and Teece (1986, 1997). The literature characterises
dynamic capabilities as complicated routines and processes embedded in firms (Teece,
1997). More precisely, Makadok (2001, p. 398) defines dynamic capabilities as a ‘special
type of resource, specifically organizationally embedded, non-transferable, firm-specific
resources whose purpose is to improve the productivity of other resources possessed by
the firm’. Because the dynamic capabilities framework is still in nascent form (Easterby-
Smith et al., 2009), and the notion of the capabilities has been applied to different
46
research streams, terminological confusion and inconsistencies about what constitutes a
dynamic capability and how they can be captured remain. And despite the growing
number of international business studies employing a dynamic capability approach, the
search for enhanced and continued understanding around the topic continues to be of
importance (Wang & Ahmed, 2007). Terminological confusion within the framework
exists, and as a result the literature features mixed use dynamic capabilities at both firm
and industry specific levels, leading to a unified topic area (Wang & Ahmed, 2007). For
instance, the literature states that there are inherent commonalities between the firms and
their use of dynamic capabilities, although identification of these ‘commonalities’
between capability deployment are not present within the current body of knowledge.
Research suggests that capabilities are responses to the need for change required to
identify new international opportunities (Easterby-Smith et al., 2009). These changes can
involve the transformation of organisational processes, as well as the allocation of
resources and operations. This changing nature and allocation of resources is a crucial
component of the dynamic capability view (Easterby- Smith et al., 2009). That is, a firm’s
international performance is contingent firstly on a portfolio of capabilities, and secondly,
on the firm’s potential to reconfigure, diversify and deploy the capabilities for
international market entry (Prange & Verdier, 2011). In a study of 120 entrepreneurs of
Internet-based organisations, Liao et al., (2009) examined the innovative, dynamic
capabilities of firms drawing from the RBV and dynamic capabilities. Consistent with the
dynamic capability perspective, Liao et al., (2009) differentiate between a firm’s resource
stock and its dynamic capability. Described as an integrative capability, Liao et al.,
(2009) suggest the term ‘integrative capability’ to describe a firm’s capability in
configuring and reconfiguring its resource stock and deploying and redeploying resources
to capture and exploit the opportunities established by changing market environments.
More recently, Teece (2007), reflecting on the work of Teece et al., (1997) delineates
between the two main characteristics of the varying components of the dynamic
capability view. The external-oriented view comprises characteristics that include
sensing, detecting, filtering and identifying market opportunities (Liao et al., 2009). The
internal view primarily deals with seising, capitalising, and exploiting opportunities
47
through ‘intra-firm’ structures, procedures, designs and incentives (Liao at al., 2009).
That is, the firm is strategically placed to identify international market opportunities –
externally – and well-positioned to exploit these opportunities by establishing internal
procedures to capitalise on opportunity identification. Opportunity-recognising
capabilities have been argued to be associated with the dimensions of managerial
processes, information and networks through which external information and knowledge
can be identified and utilised within the firm (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004; Sher & Lee,
2004, Liao et al., 2009). These external capabilities are especially important for
technology-based firms and their international market performance, given the changing
nature of the Internet environment.
Dynamic capabilities can be differentiated from operational-level capabilities or zero-
level capabilities, which are exercised at the stationary level and permit the firm to ‘make
a living’ (Winter, 2003). These operational-level capabilities enable the use of activities
on an ongoing basis using more or less the same techniques to support existing products
and services for customers (Helfat & Winter, 2011). Winter (2003) defines operational
capabilities as ‘a high level routine (or collection of routines) that, together with its
implementing input flows, confers upon an organizations a set of decision options for
producing significant outputs of a significant type.’ There is a broad consensus in the
literature that dynamic capabilities are concerned with ‘change’ and therefore differ from
‘operational’ level capabilities (Winter, 2003).
The literature highlights that dynamic capabilities also govern the rate of change of
operational-level capabilities (Collis, 1994; Winter, 2003). Winter (2003) also refers to
operational-level capabilities as the ‘how we earn a living now’ capabilities. Without the
presence of such capabilities it would be difficult for the firm to make a profit or invest in
inputs to that would see the creation of new business. The literature suggests that further
research into examining the relationship between capabilities and the firm’s superior
international market performance is warranted (Freeman, Styles & Lawley, 2012). The
ability to generate superior customer value through marketing-related processes has long
been suggested as a critical factor in contributing to the firm’s international market
performance (Day, 1994). As such, Internet, international marketing capabilities can be
48
framed within the capability framework (Knudsen & Madsen, 2002; Ray, Barney &
Muhanna, 2004; Ray, Muhanna & Barney, 2005). This research therefore situated within
a capability framework which can be distinguished from the dynamic capability view of
the firm.
Superior international market performance is argued to be an outcome of the firm’s
entrepreneurial and managerial knowledge (Penrose, 1959). Although capabilities may
not be sufficient to guarantee international market performance enhancement, Internet,
international marketing capabilities are a necessary factor for enhanced international
market performance (Sher & Lee, 2004). This statement is of particular importance for
internationally focused SMEs, which often operate in fast-changing environments.
International marketing capabilities allow SMEs to respond and adapt flexibly and in a
timely manner to change and environmental uncertainties (Sher & Lee, 2004). This
flexibility of SMEs enhances the ability to transform processes into business activities
that support the international market performance of the firm (Lewin & Massini, 2003).
Research also argues that the internationalisation of entrepreneurship is increasingly
facilitated through the use of the Internet (Etemad et al., 2010).
It has been suggested that the overall success of an SME in international markets relies
heavily on the capacity of the firm to change and adapt to new developments such as
Internet-related applications, and embed these developments in the social and technical
infrastructures of the firm (Buttriss & Wilkinson, 2003). The exploitation of the Internet’s
capabilities is essential for any business activity or firm that intends to expand
internationally. Accordingly, while a mere Internet presence implies instant
internationalisation from a technological perspective; this is limited because the
successful deployment of a virtual presence is restrained by the functional and
organisational capabilities of the firm (Kotha et al., 2001). That is, a website presence
does not automatically assume a business is instantly international. Instead, to survive and
grow in highly competitive Internet business environments, firms have to search beyond
their current resource base (Liao et al., 2009). Simply redeploying the firm’s current
resources in dynamic fast-changing Internet environments will not suffice for business
performance.
49
The literature states that accumulating valuable resources is not enough to support
international market performance (Teece et al., 1997; Vogel & Güttel, 2013). In this
regard, the RBV and capability view of the firm will have will have important
implications for international entrepreneurial SMEs by allowing firms, firstly, to identify
their resource base, and, secondly, to leverage the firm’s resources capabilities to
effectively reconfigure, renew and redeploy competencies to improve international
market performance. This is because Internet environments render seemingly sustainable
competitive advantages and international performance obsolete (Liao et al., 2009).
Instead, research shows that superior international market performance arises from a
firm’s capacity to constantly rejuvenate and redeploy the firm’s resource capabilities.
In addition, there has been limited empirical research (see, Mostafa et al., 2006; Wu,
2006; Liao et al., 2009) aimed at uncovering ‘bundles’ of capabilities that characterise
firms, and the explicit link between the possession of a firm resources, Internet
capabilities and international performance. As such, this research gives way to examining
the internationalisation process of firms through the lens of a firm’s resources and
capabilities perspective. This is because when firms extend their international activities,
they often accumulate resource capabilities to improve their international performance.
Drawing on the RBV (Barney, 1986, 1991, 2001; Barney et al., 2001) and the capability
view of the firm (Winter, 2003), this research will aim to make an important contribution
by extending the RBV and capabilities to the IE literature, by empirically examining the
relationship between firm-level resources and Internet capabilities and international
market performance. Research also indicates that a firm’s ability to recognise and exploit
international opportunities is dependent on the internal resources of the firm (Reuber &
Fischer, 1997; Priem & Butler, 2001; Chen, Zou & Wang, 2009; Frishammar &
Andersson, 2010; Bell & Loane, 2010; Prange & Verdier, 2011). The following section
examines the firm-level resources that have been highlighted in the IE literature as being
important factors that may positively influence the international market performance of
the firm.
50
2.5.3 International entrepreneurial firm-level resources and capabilities
The IE literature identifies a number of international entrepreneurial firm-level resources
and capabilities expected to be related to the firm’s international market performance,
including: (i) technology-related international vision; (ii) international business
experience and capabilities; and (iii) international virtual networking capabilities. These
firm-level resources and capabilities will be discussed further below.
(i) Technology-related international vision
Research suggests that an entrepreneur’s international vision is essential for the firm’s
progression into international markets (Tesar & Tarleton, 1982; Aspelund & Moen, 2004;
Johnson, 2004, Andersson & Evangelista, 2006). Described as playing an important role
in the development of international strategies for small business (Andersson &
Evangelista, 2006), the international vision of the entrepreneur has been found to be a
principal factor in the internationalisation of SMEs (Johnson, 2004). For instance,
research suggests that small, high technology-mediated firms are often driven by vision to
be international at or near inception, and often engage in early internationalisation
activities in order to maintain competitiveness, be successful and grow (Johnson, 2004;
Loane & Bell, 2006).
An important component of business-seeking international market expansion and
performance, an international entrepreneur’s vision enables the firm to seek out new
international opportunities aggressively (Autio, Sapienza & Almeida, 2000; Nummela,
Sapienza & Almeida, 2004). For example, Aspelund and Moen (2004) found that small
technology-intensive firms with an international vision and a focus on the customer in
international markets are better able to create competitive advantages internationally. The
SME study by Aspelund and Moen (2004) highlights that the international vision of
management, combined with the use of the Internet, facilitated the niche international
strategies and competitive advantage of small Norwegian exporting firms. Although this
seminal study only validates a single international entrepreneurial cognitive attribute, its
findings highlight the importance of IE within Internet marketing research.
51
Research (Oviatt & McDougall, 1994; Autio et al., 2000; Aspelund & Moen, 2004;
Andersson & Evangelista, 2006) suggests that in many instances it is the manager’s drive
and international vision that facilitates international market expansion, enabling firms to
seek out new business opportunities. However, studies examining the influence of the
international entrepreneurs’ vision in the pursuit of international market performance in
an Internet context are limited in scope and detail (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Johnson,
2004; Mostafa et al., 2006). In this regard, further research examining international vision
from an IE perspective in an Internet context is warranted.
(ii) International business experience
The international business literature highlights that prior international business experience
of the entrepreneur may influence the international market performance of the firm (Dyer
& Handler, 1994; Loane & Bell, 2002; Fischer & Reuber, 2003; Hutchinson et al., 2006;
Wang, 2008). Research suggests that international experience can have an important
effect upon entrepreneurial firms, particularly on the initial decision to expand and the
continuation of the firm’s international strategy (Dyer & Handler, 1994; Loane & Bell,
2002; Fischer & Reuber, 2003; Hutchinson et al., 2006; Wang, 2008). According to
Westhead, Wright and Ucbasaran (2001), entrepreneurial firms with diverse management
know-how and international experience may be able to undertake more promising
competitive strategies and opportunities in international markets, more so than larger
sized competitors.
Knowledge, as embedded in the international entrepreneur from previous experience
(Reuber & Fischer, 1997), also plays an important role in the garnering of firm resources
for internationalisation. Two kinds of international experience relate to the ownership of
previous firms. They include previous experience in an entrepreneurial firm and
participation in previous business start-ups, or start-up experience (Dyke, Fischer &
Reuber, 1992; Busenitz, West, Shepherd, Nelson, Chandler & Zacharakis, 2003). An
additional source of experience lies with the entrepreneur’s family (Loane & Bell, 2002).
Individuals who have observed family members managing businesses are more likely to
start businesses of their own (Hisrich & Brush, 1984). Although international business
52
experience of the manager is widely recognised as a vital asset for firms (Dyer &
Handler, 1994; Reuber & Fischer, 1997; Westhead et al., 2001; Loane & Bell, 2002;
Chetty & Campbell-Hunt, 2004; Andersson & Evangelista, 2006; Schwens & Kabst,
2009), studies examining the international experience of managers in an Internet context
are limited (see, Poon & Swatman, 1997). As such, the link between the prior
international experience of international entrepreneurs and the international performance
of firms in an Internet context has not yet been established.
(iii) International virtual networking capabilities
Network theory depicts markets as a web of relationships among a number of players,
encompassing customers, suppliers, distributors, competitors and private and public
support agencies (Coviello & Munro, 1995; Oviatt & McDougall, 1995; Etemad, 2001;
Loane, 2006). International entrepreneurial firms seeking to internationalise can leverage
and take advantage of these network players. Numerous scholars (see, Coviello & Munro,
1995; Oviatt & McDougall, 1995; Poon & Jevons, 1997; Hite & Hesterly, 2001; Lee et
al., 2001; Coviello & Cox, 2007; Rothaermel, 2007) have suggested that network
relationships play an important part in internationalisation, particularly allowing firms to
overcome resource constraints. Case study research further suggests that firms with
extensive international networks internationalise quicker and more successfully than
established firms (Oviatt & McDougall, 1995; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006).
The value of international networks as an integral part of the explanation of international
entrepreneurial success is also acknowledged in the literature (Coviello & Munro, 1995;
Dimitratos & Plakoyiannaki, 2003; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006; Loane, 2006; Loane &
Bell, 2006). For instance, drawing from IE theory, Mort and Weerawardena (2006) found
that international networking capabilities enable exploitation of international market
opportunities. For instance, Andersson and Wictor (2003) identified that the international
entrepreneurs they studied all had a vision for their strategy to be enacted globally, and
that all had extensive international experience, either in business, as students or through
informal ties. It is also widely suggested that the Internet has provided entrepreneurial
SMEs with new ways to conduct and develop international business, communicate ideas,
and exchange information (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Bell & Loane, 2010).
53
The literature suggests that international networks in an Internet context are an important
and unique firm resource (Loane, 2006; Etemad et al., 2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
The Internet has also been found to be associated with increased international business
outcomes, allowing firms to identify new international market opportunities through
integration of international networks via the Internet (Mostafa et al., 2006; Bell & Loane,
2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). Further, the Internet has also been found to play a pivotal
role in the creation of international relationships and is a mechanism for the creation of
international growth opportunities in SMEs (Mathews & Healy, 2008). As such, it can be
said that international networks remain an important part of any international firm
operating in a complex Internet environments. Although the Internet has been found to
play a pivotal role in the creation of international relationships and is a mechanism for the
creation of international growth opportunities in SMEs (Mathews & Healy, 2008), the
role of the international entrepreneurial decision-maker in the development of
international virtual networks for leveraging opportunities in internationalisation remains
unclear (Mort & Weerawardena, 2006). That is, the explicit link between international
virtual network capabilities and international market performance outcomes remains
vague.
2.6 Summary of research gaps and questions
To summarise, three gaps in existing research have been identified from the literature
review. In this section, the key research gaps are briefly discussed, and the subsequent
research questions are presented. Firstly, the literature states that international market
performance can be optimised when the firm is internationally market-orientated and
entrepreneurial. In order for firms to seize the international opportunities that a dynamic
Internet environment presents, international entrepreneurial firms must first identify the
firm-level resources and Internet capabilities that could lead to international market
performance. Further, limited research attempts to explain how Internet capabilities in
conjunction with firm-level resources influence the international market performance of
the firm. As such, research question one (RQ1) has been established:
54
RQ1: What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international
performance?
Secondly, it is evident that an essential step in moving the field of IE forward is the
incorporation of Internet phenomena into the current understanding of how firms are
achieving international market performance outcomes. More recently, Wilden, Gudergan,
Neilsen and Lings (2013) suggest that research exploring capabilities will benefit from
modelling the mediation effects of capabilities. As such, sub-research question (RQ2a)
was developed:
RQ2a: What is the relative influence of firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities on international performance?
Thirdly, research highlights the positive impact of the Internet on the firm, but neglects
the significant influence of the international entrepreneur’s role in exploiting firm-level
resources and Internet, international marketing capabilities for firm performance. As
such, the second sub-research question (RQ2b) has been established:
RQ2b: How do international entrepreneurs leverage Internet, international
marketing capabilities for international performance?
Overall, an evaluation of seminal papers contributing to the understanding of IE in an
Internet environment, as shown in Table 2.2, indicates that only 13.8% of IE research
papers published in the past decade (from a sample of IE papers) explored IE from an
Internet perspective. Predominantly, research highlights the positive impact of the
Internet on the firm, yet research papers that investigate the Internet and IE combined are
limited. As such, Table 2.2 shows that with the exception of a small number of studies
(see, Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Loane et al 2004; Loane 2006; Mostafa et al, 2006;
Reuber & Fischer, 2011), researchers to date have paid limited attention to the
relationship between IE and Internet capabilities for the international business outcomes
of the firm; despite research suggesting that the Internet is one of the most important tools
55
for an internationally focused business (e.g. Petersen et al., 2002; Mostafa et al., 2006;
Mathews & Healy, 2007).
Traditional internationalisation theories (see, Johanson & Vahlne, 1977; Cavusgil, 1984)
have for decades concentrated on analysing internationalisation as a process over time,
where firms gradually increase their international market commitment. A review of IE
papers from an Internet perspective indicates that incremental internationalisation process
theories are now out-dated in explaining differential results of a firm’s international
performance (Sapienza, Autio, George & Zahra, 2006). For example, in the past decade
the sample of papers published indicates that only 13.8% of research papers incorporated
incremental process theories into their research. Instead, scholars now analysing the
internationalisation process of firms through, for example, the resource and capabilities
perspective (Stray, Bridgewater & Murray, 2001; Moen & Servais, 2002; Fischer &
Reuber, 2003; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005; Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
While a number of theoretical frameworks have been developed and advanced over the
past decade to explain international firm performance, one predominant perspective
utlised in the international business literature has been the RBV (Wernerfelt, 1984;
Barney, 1986, 1991). The RBV of the firm is an influential theoretical framework
developed to comprehend how competitive advantage within firms is attained and how
this advantage can be sustained (Nelson & Winter, 1982; Barney, 1986; Wernerfelt, 1984;
Teece, 1986, Barney, 1991). This research draws from the RBV of the firm as a
theoretical underpinning to explain how firms achieve international firm performance.
56
Table 2.2 Evaluation of seminal Internet and international entrepreneurship papers
Author/s & publication date Approach Firm Focus Industry IIE IE RBV DCV Internationalisation
1. Hamill, 1997 Conceptual SMEs Software, education, telecommunications & manufacturing I
2. Poon & Swatman, 1997 Empirical SMEs Services industry I
3. Lituchy & Rail, 2000 Empirical SMEs Hospitality industry I
4. Knight, 2001 Empirical SMEs Electronic and electrical equipment and textile mill products I
5. Stray, Bridgewater & Murray, 2001 Empirical SMEs Technology-based firms I
6. Moen Servais, 2002 Empirical SMEs Goods and service firms I
7. Bell, McNaughton, Young & Crick, 2003 Empirical SMEs Goods and service firms I
8. Buttriss & Wilkinson, 2003 Conceptual SMEs Goods and service firms I
9. Fischer & Reuber, 2003 Empirical SMEs Exporting good and service firms I
10. Katz, Safranski & Khan, 2003 Empirical SMEs Software-based firms I
11. Wright & Dana, 2003 Conceptual SMEs Goods and service firms I
12. Aspelund & Moen, 2004 Empirical SMEs High-tech information technology firms I
13. Bell, Crick & Young, 2004 Empirical SMEs Manufacturing firms I
14. Dholakia & Kshetri, 2004 Empirical SMEs Goods and service firms I I
15. Johnson, 2004 Empirical SMEs High-technology international start-ups I I I
16. Loane, McNaughton & Bell, 2004 Empirical SMEs Consultancy, software & service online I
17. Bhuian, Menguc & Bell, 2005 Empirical SMEs CEOs of hospitals I I
18. Oviatt & McDougall, 2004 Conceptual SMEs No industry focus I
19. Oviatt & McDougall, 2005 Conceptual SMEs No industry focus I
20. Prashantham, 2005 Conceptual SMEs No industry focus I
21. Ramsey & Ibbotson, 2005 Empirical SMEs Service sector firms I
22. Arenius, Sasi & Gabrielsson, 2006 Empirical SMEs Manufacturing firms I I
23. Loane, 2006 Empirical SMEs Goods and services firms I I
24. Mostafa, Wheeler & Jones, 2006 Empirical SMEs Manufacturing SME exporters I I I
25. Nieto & Fernandez, 2006 Empirical SMEs Manufacturing firms I
26. Sinkovics & Bell, 2006 Empirical SMEs Goods and service firms I
27. Sinkovics & Penz, 2006 Empirical SMEs Goods and service firms I
28. Styles & Seymour, 2006 Conceptual SMEs No industry focus I
29. Weerawardena, Mort, Liesch & Knight, 2007 Conceptual SMEs Born-global I I I
30. Forsgren & Hagström, 2007 Empirical No firm focus Internet-related firms I
31. Mathews & Zander, 2007 Empirical No firm focus No industry focus I
32. Gabrielsson & Pelkonen, 2008 Empirical No firm focus Internet consultancy firms I
33. Liao, Kickul & Ma, 2009 Empirical No firm focus Internet-related firms I I I
34. Etemad, Wilkinson & Dana, 2010 Conceptual No firm focus Internet-based firms I
35. Reuber & Fischer, 2011 Conceptual No firm focus No firm focus I I
36. Prange & Verdier, 2011 Conceptual No firm focus No industry I I
Aggregate concentration of research 5/36 21/36 17/36 2/36 5/36
Note. IIE= Internet and International entrepreneurship combined, IE= International entrepreneurship, RBV= Resource-based view of the firm, DCV= Dynamic capability view of the
firm.
57
2.7 Proposed conceptual model
Drawing on the RBV of the firm, this research will make an important contribution by
exploring the international entrepreneurial firm-level resources and Internet capabilities
that are expected to be related to the firm’s pursuit of international market performance.
The research gaps highlighted in the literature review are addressed by the development
of a conceptual model illustrated in Figure 2.4. Based on the IE literature, Figure 2.4
shows three firm-level resources are expected to be positivity related to a firm’s
successful international market performance: international entrepreneurial orientation,
technology-related international vision and international business experience. The
Internet capabilities in the model include; Internet, international marketing capabilities
and international virtual network capabilities. The proposed theoretical model will be
utilised as the basis for research investigation in Study One.
Figure 2.4 Proposed conceptual model of firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities
Note. The conceptual model shows mediation through ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities. It is
expected that mediated relationships will be observed in relation to resources and capabilities through
Internet, international marketing capabilities.
Resources
International
entrepreneurial
orientation
Technology-related
International vision
International business
experience
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
International virtual
network capabilities
International market
performance outcomes
Capabilities
58
2.8 Conclusion
Chapter Two has presented a synthesis of the literature pertaining to IE and the resource-
based view of the firm. Specifically, this chapter has discussed the influence of the
Internet on IE and introduced the capability view of the firm. In particular, the chapter has
discussed international entrepreneurial orientation, including international innovativeness,
international proactiveness and the international risk-taking propensities of entrepreneurs.
This chapter has also addressed the literature related to technology-related international
vision, international business experience, Internet, international marketing capabilities,
and international virtual network capabilities. An evaluation of the literature has
identified three key gaps that provide opportunities for further research investigation.
Subsequently, three research questions were developed to assist in filling the research
gaps. In the following chapter, the methodology for Study One will be discussed.
59
CHAPTER THREE: QUALITATIVE METHODOLOGY: STUDY ONE
3.1 Introduction
Chapter Three provides a detailed discussion of the qualitative methods and procedures
for gathering and analysing data in Study One. The aim of Study One is to address
research question one (RQ1); ‘What are the firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international
performance?’ The purpose of Study One is to identify the firm-level resources and
Internet capabilities expected to be related to the firm’s international market performance,
through the utilisation of multiple case study methodology.
The findings of the data presented in Table 3.1 indicate the research methods adopted by
seminal scholars investigating IE in an Internet environment from the period of 1997 to
2011. The findings in Table 3.1 indicate that multiple case study research is lacking
within IE, contributing to only 19.4% out of a possible 41.6% of qualitative studies. This
is unexpected given that it has been suggested that the multiple case study methodology is
suitable for the development of new theory (Eisenhardt, 1989). Scholars have also
suggested that existing research models are limited in capturing the specific firm-level
resources and capabilities required for a firm’s internationalisation in an Internet
environment (Knight, 2001; Mostafa et al., 2006). Only a proportion of research in IE
employs a mixed method research design (16.6%). Because IE in an Internet context
remains at a relatively nascent stage, scholars have argued that employing both qualitative
and quantitative methodologies will help research contributions in IE to move away from
basic conceptualisations to identify new theories and statistical validation of constructs
(Knight, 2001; Zahra & George, 2002; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005).
60
Table 3.1 Research methods: International entrepreneurship in an Internet context
Methodology
Author/s & publication date
Mix
ed-m
eth
od
ap
pro
ach
Co
nce
ptu
ali
sati
on
pa
per
Qu
an
tita
tiv
e
met
ho
do
log
ies
Qu
ali
tati
ve
met
ho
do
log
ies
Inte
rvie
ws
Ca
se s
tud
y i
nq
uir
y
1. Hamill, 1997
2. Poon & Swatman, 1997
3. Lituchy & Rail, 2000
4. Knight, 2001
5. Stray, Bridgewater & Murray, 2001
6. Moen Servais, 2002
7. Bell, McNaughton, Young & Crick, 2003
8. Buttriss & Wilkinson, 2003
9. Fischer & Reuber, 2003
10. Katz, Safranski & Khan, 2003
11. Wright & Dana, 2003
12. Aspelund & Moen, 2004
13. Bell, Crick & Young, 2004
14. Dholakia & Kshetri, 2004
15. Johnson, 2004
16. Loane, McNaughton & Bell, 2004
17. Bhuian, Menguc & Bell, 2005
18. Oviatt & McDougall, 2004
19. Oviatt & McDougall, 2005
20. Ramsey & Ibbotson, 2005
21. Prashantham, 2005
22. Arenius, Sasi & Gabrielsson, 2006 *
23. Loane, 2006
24. Mostafa, Wheeler & Jones, 2006
25. Nieto & Fernandez, 2006
26. Sinkovics & Bell, 2006
27. Sinkovics & Penz, 2006
28. Styles & Seymour, 2006
29. Weerawardena, Mort, Liesch & Knight, 2007
30. Forsgren & Hagström, 2007
31. Mathews & Zander, 2007
32. Gabrielsson & Pelkonen, 2008
33. Liao, Kickul & Ma, 2009
34. Etemad, Wilkinson & Dana, 2010
35. Reuber & Fischer, 2011
36. Prange & Verdier, 2011
Aggregate choice of methodology 6/36 13/36 14/36 15/36 10/36 7/36
Proportions: (I) CONCEPTUALISATION,
(II) QUANTITATIVE, (III) QUALITATIVE METHODOLOGIES 16.6%
36.1% (I)
38.8% (II)
41.6% (III)
27.7% 19.4%
Note. * Single embedded case
61
Chapter Three commences by considering the philosophical approach upon which the
research is founded. Further concepts addressed in this chapter include the unit of data
analysis, unit of data collection, selection strategy, data sources, sampling procedure and
data collection, data analysis procedures, coding procedures, the criteria for evaluating the
quality of case study inquiry by construct validity, internal validity, external validity and
reliability. Ethical considerations are also discussed and concluding comments provided
for Chapter Three. A diagrammatic overview of Chapter Three can be seen in Figure 3.1.
Figure 3.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Three
Introduction (3.1)
Selection strategy (3.5.1) Data sources (3.5.2)
Level of analysis (3.3)
Unit of data collection (3.4)
Criteria for evaluating the quality of case study inquiry (3.6)
Sampling procedure and data collection (3.5.3)
Data analysis procedures (3.5.4) Coding procedures (3.5.5)
Construct validity (3.6.1) Internal validity (3.6.2) External validity (3.6.3) Reliability (3.6.4)
Ethical considerations (3.7)
Philosophical approach (3.2)
Conclusion (3.8)
Study One: Multiple case study methodology (3.5)
62
3.2 Philosophical approach
A research paradigm is defined as a ‘set of beliefs that guide action’ (Guba, 1990, p. 17).
All researchers work within a specific research paradigm, where a paradigm is a set of
linked assumptions about the reality that is shared by those investigating the world
(Deshpande, 1983). Scholars often reflect on their philosophy of science through
examination of their ontological, epistemological and methodological assumptions or
premises in relation to research paradigms, thus applying research methods consistent
with their assumptions (Guba, 1990). Briefly, a research paradigm addresses four areas:
ethics, ontology, epistemology and methodology (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011).
Ethics asks, “How will I be a moral person in the world?” (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011).
Eriksson and Kovalainen (2008) argue that ethical principles govern all research
activities, including the way research is conducted and reported. Addressing the issue of
ethics also adds to the credibility of the research study (Eriksson & Kovalainen, 2008).
Ontology raises basic questions about the nature of the reality and the nature of the
human being in the world (Guba, 1990) – for instance, about the existence of
relationships between people, society and the world as a whole. Epistemology is the
relationship between the inquirer and the known, or the researcher and the reality (Denzin
& Lincoln, 1994). That is, epistemology defines how knowledge can be produced and
argued for (Eriksson & Kovalainen, 2008). Finally, methodology focuses on the best
means for acquiring knowledge about the world (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994).
This research adopts Denzin and Lincoln’s (1994) notion that the basic beliefs of
alternative inquiry paradigms exist along a continuum, and consist of positivism,
postpositivism, critical theory and constructivism. A summary of the basic beliefs
systems as proposed by Denzin and Lincoln (1994) can be seen in Table 3.1. These basic
belief systems will be discussed next, followed by a justification of the paradigm adopted
in this thesis.
63
Table 3.2 Basic beliefs of alternative inquiry paradigms
Item Positivism Postpositivism Critical theory Constructivism
Ontology Naive realism;
“real” reality but
apprehendable
Also known as
critical realism;
‘real’ reality but
only imperfectly
and
probabilistically
apprehendable
Historical realism.
Virtual reality
shaped by social,
political, cultural,
economic, ethnic,
and gender
values;
crystallised over
time
Relativism/
intepretivism.
Local and
specific
constructed
realities
Epistemology Dualist/
objectivist;
findings are true
Modified dualist/
objectivist: critical
tradition/
community;
findings are
probably true
Transactional/
subjectivist;
value-mediated
findings
Transactional/
subjectivist;
created findings
Methodology Experimental/
manipulative;
verification of
hypothesis;
chiefly
quantitative
methods
Modified
experimental/
manipulative;
critical multiplism;
falsification of
hypothesis; may
include qualitative
methods
Dialogic/
dialectical
Hermeneutical/
dialectical
Source: Guba and Lincoln (1994, p. 109).
The research paradigms can be viewed as falling along a continuum ranging from precise
design principles at one end, to evolving less structured directives at the other (Denzin &
Lincoln, 2011). The first paradigm to be explored is that of positivism. Positivism is a
philosophical position that has generally rejected qualitative research as a scientific
method (Kvale, 1996). Positivism assumes that research measures independent facts
about a particular apprehensible reality and is therefore generally used in quantitative
studies involving hypothesis testing (Guba & Lincoln, 1994). Quantitative methodologies
are most commonly used in positivism-framed studies and for this reason adopting a
positivist approach was deemed unsuitable for exploring the phenomenon of the
Internet’s impact on IE. To elicit information on the firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities, a mixed method research design was deemed appropriate to ensure the
richness of data extracted from key informants.
The postpositivism research paradigm, which is the paradigmatic approach adopted in this
research, is a rejection or modification of numerous core beliefs of positivism
64
(Onwuegbuzie, Johnson & Collins, 2009). The postpositivism paradigm relies on multiple
methods as a way of capturing as much of reality as possible, while emphasising the
discovery and verification of theories (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011). Based on this view, the
postpositivism paradigm extends beyond relativism, but retains the idea of objective truth
(Denzin & Lincoln, 1994). The postpositivism paradigm is based on the reality that
human knowledge is not based upon unchangeable foundations but rather conjectures,
which can change over time (Denzin & Lincoln, 20011).
Scholars within the postpositivism paradigm believe that there is an independent reality
that can be studied, but they also assert that theory can be imperfect and, therefore can be
modified (Onwuegbuzie et al., 2009). Postpositivism researchers also assert that, as a
result of their experiences and worldviews, people are partially biased in their objective
perceptions of reality (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994; Onwuegbuzie et al., 2009). For example,
this research draws on the perceptions of international entrepreneurs about the role of the
Internet in a firm’s internationalisation. Although researchers within the postpositivism
paradigm utilise quantitative research methods, they also employ qualitative methods to
assist the researcher in developing quantitative instruments (Onwuegbuzie et al., 2009).
Critical theory has been seen as an antipositivist movement in the social sciences (Denzin
& Lincoln, 1994). Critical theorists oppose logical positivist, relativist, and anti-
foundational epistemologies (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011). Critical theory involves a
historical realism which sees reality as shaped by social, economic, political, cultural and
ethnic factors that have been reified into a series of structures that are now taken as ‘real’
(Guba & Lincoln, 1994). The critical theory approach is not well suited for the purpose of
this research as although it employs mixed-method approaches, assumptions are
subjective to the researcher and are grounded in a value-dependent social and historical
understanding (Guba & Lincoln, 1994).
Constructivism aims to understand the complex world of lived experience from the view
of those who live it (Guba & Lincoln, 1994). Denzin and Lincoln (2011) suggest that
constructivism realities are apprehendable as multiple, elusive psychological
constructions that are socially and experimentally based. The constructivism paradigm is
utilised most commonly by researchers engaging in qualitative data collection, where the
65
researcher seeks to understand the social world as perceived by others (Malhotra et al.,
2006). This approach requires interpretivist researchers to focus on the intrinsic details of
individual cases under investigation (Malhotra et al., 2006). The constructivism paradigm
was regarded as being unsuitable for this study because it suggests that the realities are
apprehendable in the form of multiple, intangible mental constructions that are socially
and experimentally based (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011).
3.3 Level of analysis
The objective of this research study was to investigate and explore the firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities that are expected to be related to the firm’s
international market performance. For the purpose of the research, international
entrepreneurs from Australian SMEs were selected, from which eight cases were
constructed based on in-depth interviews with owner/founders. This research adopted the
level of analysis used by Loane (2006) who conducted interviews with key decision-
makers in SMEs, which in most cases was a member of the founding team, for a firm-
level analysis of the role of the Internet in the internationalisation of SMEs. Research
papers in international business have argued that the international entrepreneur can be
seen as the single representative of the firm in relation to internal decision-making
processes (Jantunen et al., 2005; Loane, 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006). As such, interviews
were conducted at the individual level with international entrepreneurs.
3.4 Unit of data collection
The unit of data collection in this study is the individual international entrepreneur.
Although data was collected by use of interviews conducted with international
entrepreneurs, case study questions were relevant to both the international entrepreneur,
and the firm as a collective. It was deemed appropriate to investigate firm-level resources
and Internet capabilities at an individual level first, rather than at a collective level, as
decision-making power within SMEs is generally concentrated in the hands of one or a
very few people (Reid, 1981). This is because owner/founders are generally the principal
force behind the initiation, development, sustenance and success of SME
internationalisation (Chetty & Hamilton, 1993; Hutchinson et al., 2006). Research also
66
states that the decision of a firm to pursue international markets is dependent not only on
the availability of technology, but also the international orientation of management
(Loane et al., 2004). More recent research, for example, highlights a shift in the IE
literature through the application of capability perspectives, such as the understanding of
the firm-level resources and capabilities, which may lead to an increased understanding of
how many SMEs are recognising and exploiting new international market opportunities
(Mostafa et al., 2006; Zahra et al., 2005). As such, it is important to reiterate that the
findings in this research are relevant for both the individual international entrepreneur and
the firm as a collective.
3.5 Study One: Multiple case study methodology
The primary method for data collection in Study One was the multiple case study
methodology. The most frequently encountered definition of case study methodology
considers:
A case study is an empirical inquiry that;
i. investigates a contemporary phenomenon in depth and within its
real-life context, especially when,
ii. the boundaries between phenomenon and context are not clearly
evident. Case studies can include, and even be limited to
quantitative evidence, however are primarily qualitative in nature.
(Yin, 2009, p. 18)
The purpose of Study One was to identify the firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities expected to influence the international market performance of the firm.
Research has suggested that multiple case study inquiry is an all-encompassing logical
research method with a unique strength of dealing with a full variety of evidence, such as
documents, artefacts, observations and interviews (Yin, 1981; Eisenhardt, 1989). The use
of various sources of evidence, such as interview transcripts, print media and web
documents, allowed the investigator to address a broader range of behavioural issues
aimed at corroborating the same fact or phenomenon (Patton, 1990). Case study
67
methodology has evolved into a well-accepted and widely utilised research method in the
marketing and international business fields, particularly in the areas of Internet
international marketing. For example, researchers have recently used case study
methodology to analyse the Internet’s impact on firm internationalisation (Loane, 2006;
Mathews & Healy, 2007, 2008). Mathews and Healy (2007), for example, used case
analysis to explore the influence of the Internet on international market penetration and
development from the strategic perspective of the firm.
Case study research can include either a single embedded case or multiple case studies
(Yin, 1981). This research utilised multiple case studies to aid in providing a holistic
perspective on the identified research problem and to assist in exploring and defining the
IE constructs. It has been suggested that multiple case studies allow for greater
understanding in the IE domain (Zahra & Dess, 2001; Wright & Dana, 2003; Nummela &
Welch, 2006; Hohenthal, Eriksson & Lindbergh, 2006) and more specifically for the
investigation of the Internet’s impact on the international entrepreneurial firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities for international market performance. To this extent,
case study methodology was deemed appropriate for answering the ‘how’ and ‘why’
questions being proposed in this thesis (Yin, 2009). As opposed to a single case with an
individual firm, the objective of this study is to assist in building a better understanding of
theory through multiple case studies to guide data collection and analysis.
Case studies can be distinguished from other research methods. For instance, an
experiment deliberately takes away from the full complexity of a phenomenon, attending
to a limited number of variables in a controlled environment (Yin, 2009). A history deals
with the inter-relationships between the phenomenon and the research context, but usually
deals with non-contemporary events (Eisenhardt & Graebner, 2007). A questionnaire, by
comparison, attempts to deal with a phenomenon and context, although the ability to
investigate context is limited (Mason, 2006; Yin, 2009). In this research, it is necessary to
firstly explore the phenomenon of the Internet’s impact on IE before identified concepts
can be verified through a quantitative questionnaire.
Although case studies are a distinctive form of empirical inquiry, researchers have
continued to highlight the drawbacks of the methodology. Firstly, the greatest concern for
68
scholars has been over the lack of rigour in case study methodology (Yin, 2009). This is
primarily due to researchers’ inability to conduct valid and rigorous cases that follow
systematic procedures and are free from biased views influencing the direction of the
research, or its findings (Eisenhardt & Graebner, 2007; Yin, 2009). However, bias can
also enter into other research methods, for example, experiments or in designing
questionnaires. In this research, academic and peer-reviewed case study research
publications were utilised to ensure the case design was rigorous and free from critical
errors. Secondly, a common concern among research investigators is that case studies
provide little basis for scientific generalisation (Mason, 2006; Marshall & Rossman,
2006; Yin, 2009). This argument commonly relates to those case studies which rely solely
on a single embedded case. However, this research is based on the use of multiple case
studies.
3.5.1 Selection strategy
The sample in Study One of the research study was recruited through the use of a
purposive sampling strategy in which the researcher selects participants who can
‘purposefully inform an understanding of the research problem and central phenomenon
in the study’ (Creswell, 2003, p. 125). The power of purposive sampling lies in selecting
information-rich cases for in-depth analysis related to the phenomenon under
investigation (Patton, 1990). This statement implies that the choice of data sources is
driven predominately by the conceptual questions, not through a concern about the
representiveness of the data (Miles & Huberman, 1984). Purposive sampling is generally
intended to facilitate a process whereby the research generates and tests a theory based on
the analysis of the research data through inductive reasoning (Mason, 2002).
A purposive sampling strategy can be justified given the aim of Study One to investigate
the relatively unexplained phenomenon of the unique firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities influencing the firm’s international market performance. Briefly, to limit
desirability bias and ensure that international entrepreneurs were being interviewed in
terms of their job description, each participant had to meet two considerations. Firstly,
the international entrepreneur must be the owner and founder of the SME. That is,
questions regarding the international entrepreneur’s role within the firm were also asked.
69
Secondly, international entrepreneurs had to fulfil a screening process used to evaluate
only international entrepreneurial individuals demonstrating innovative, proactive and
risk-taking behaviours (Mostafa et al., 2006; Wang, 2008). This screening process
identified the international entrepreneurs from non-international entrepreneurs.
3.5.2 Data sources
In terms of the number of the cases for analysis, Perry (1998b) argues that there are no
precise guides to the number of cases that should be included. The literature also rarely
specifies how many cases should be developed. Eisenhardt (1989) recommends that cases
should be added until theoretical saturation is reached. Although there is no specified
number of cases that should be in a case study inquiry (Patton, 1990), a number of authors
advocate that there should be no less than four cases in any given case study research
design (Perry, 1998b; Eisenhardt, 2002). Selection of fewer than four cases can lead to
issues for the researcher in trying to generate credibility in the development of theory
(Perry, 1998b). Given these recommendations, the use of 12 cases across the Australian
goods and services sectors was considered appropriate. The careful selection of cases
within the goods and service sectors ensured the research met the criterion of literal
replication; predicting similar results within industries was ensured, and, contrasting
results across industries for robustness to satisfy validity through theoretical replication
(Yin, 2009). Multiple cases also assist in generating analytic generalisability (Yin, 1994,
2009). The multiple case study design of Study One is illustrated in Figure 3.3.
Table 3.3 Types of design in case study inquiry
Single-case designs Multiple-case designs
Type 1 Type 3
Type 2
Type 4
Source: Yin (1994, p 39).
Holistic (single unit of
analysis)
Embedded (multiple
units of analysis)
70
Central to the purposive sampling strategy, this research maintains a cross-sectorial focus
including sources from the Australian goods and services sectors. The Australian
economy is dominated by its service sector, representing 68% of Australian GDP
(Austrade, 2011) and rising to a record worth of $A53.3 billion in 2008-09 (Austrade,
2011). Service-oriented firms account for more than three-quarters of the economy’s
output and four out of every five jobs in Australia (Austrade, 2011).
Service-oriented firms were sourced from the professional business services, tourism and
information communication technology services. This is because the later three trade
service commodities rank in Australia’s top 25 export service firms (Austrade, 2011). For
example, professional business service firms were worth $A3.2 billion in real gross
revenue in 2011 (ABS, 2012). The tourism industry in Australia is also an important
factor contributor to the economic wellbeing of the country (Standing & Vasudavan,
2000). Tourism is one of Australia’s largest exporter of services. In 2010-2011, tourism
contributed $A23.7 billion to Australia’s export earnings, or 8% of total export earnings
for all goods and services (Department of Resources, Energy and Tourism, 2012).
Tourism’s total contribution to Australia’s GDP in 2010-2011 was $A73.3 billion, or
5.2% Australia’s total economy. In addition, the industry employed 907,100 people,
representing 7.9% of Australia’s total employment. Along with education, tourism is
Australia’s leading services exporter (Department of Resources, Energy and Tourism,
2012).
Consumer goods firms trading in manufacturing of textiles, food products and jewellery
were also selected for this research. These goods and services industries have been
selected for this research as they represent five out of the top nine Australian export
industries. The total value of goods and services exported from Australia in 2009-10 was
US$217 billion in 2009-10 (Austrade, 2011). A total of six SMEs were included in the
sample from the Australian export goods sector. The sample also consisted of an
additional six SMEs from the Australian export services sector.
71
3.5.3 Sampling procedure and data collection
The primary method of data collection in Study One was structured in-depth interviews.
Interviews are often the most important part of acquiring case study information and are
critical to the overall success of the research design (Mason, 2006; Malhotra, 2008). The
structured in-depth interviews took place in a single setting, lasting on average 90-
minutes to two-hours. The interviewer asked the international entrepreneurs questions
relating to their international innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-seeking propensities.
Further questions relating to technology-related international vision and international
business experience, Internet, international marketing capabilities, and international
network capabilities were also discussed. Essentially, the structured in-depth interview
process involved two considerations: (i) to follow the line of inquiry as reflected in the
case study protocol, and (ii) to ask the participant conversational questions in an unbiased
manner, which serves the needs of the line of inquiry posed in this thesis (Mason, 2006;
Marshall & Rossman, 2006; Malhotra, 2008; Yin, 2009).
The interviews with international entrepreneurs were also recorded with an audiotape
device to ensure a more accurate record of the interview rather than that provided by
observer notes alone. Both observer notes and recordings of the in-depth interviews
allowed for accurate recall of data. An Internet search to locate secondary data relevant to
the focal firm was also conducted. Documents that were of use to the case studies
included articles appearing in mass print media, industry publications and brochures,
email correspondence and website data. The abundance of material on the Internet meant
the interviewer had to use personal judgement while maintaining a strong sense of the
case study inquiry, acquiring only the most pertinent information relevant to the research
questions.
To improve the reliability of organising and documenting data, a case study database was
also established. This practice allows other investigators to review the evidence and draw
independent conclusions directly, rather than being limited to written case study reports
(Marshall & Rossman, 2006). Case study notes formed the basis of the case study
database and were stored in a manner that allowed other investigators to retrieve notes
efficiently. Although the process of transferring case study information into a database
72
requires excessive amounts of time in re-writing and making editorial changes to notes,
the process is essential in establishing readily retrievable documents for later perusal
(Yin, 2009). Through the development of a case study database, the principle of
maintaining a chain of evidence to increase the reliability of information is evident (Yin,
1994). In summary, this research has maintained credibility by satisfying the three key
principles of data collection identified by Yin (2009): (i) the use of multiple sources of
evidence, (ii) establishment of a case study database, and (iii) maintaining a chain of
evidence.
3.5.4 Interview protocol
The interview protocol utilised in this research assisted the researcher by focusing the
discussion with the respondent to issues pertaining to the research area (Perry, 1998b).
The questions included in the interview protocol are of particular importance to the
creditability of the research. The interview protocol utilised in Study One can be found in
Appendix 1, and is evaluated in this section of the thesis. It is important to highlight that
each of the open-ended questions in the interview protocol was derived from a literature
review and focused on exploring key research theories, such as IE and the RBV and the
capability view of the firm. The open-ended questions also allowed for unpredicted or
unexpected responses (Yin, 2009). Further, it has been argued that an interview protocol
allows for increased reliability and creditability in data collection (Perry, 1998b;
Malhotra, 2008). The interview protocol for this research is outlined below.
Part A of the interview protocol was the introduction to thank participants for their
contributions to this research. This section of the interview protocol was used to briefly
describe to participants why they were selected as appropriate informants for the research.
Part B describes the research aim and the expected outcomes of the research study. This
section of the interview protocol gives participants important information pertaining to
the research. Part C was used to explain the process of the interview, including
information relevant to the ethical issues and the research institution in which the research
is being conducted. The purpose of Part D of the interview protocol was to obtain general
business information and participant details. These questions at the start of the interview
invited participants to describe their business and give general background information on
73
their firm. Part E used probing questions to draw on the prior experiences and knowledge
of the international entrepreneur in order to explore their international entrepreneurial
orientation. Questions in this section were developed to capture the international
entrepreneur’s level of innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-taking propensity in
international business decision making.
Probing questions in Part F were used to explore the technology-related international
vision of the international entrepreneur. Part G used probing questions related to the
international business experience of entrepreneurs, including the previous industries they
have worked in. Part H seeks to explore the Internet, international marketing capabilities
of firms and the extent to which Internet integration is embedded within the business. Part
I used probing questions to explore the international networks of international
entrepreneurs. Part J used probing questions to evaluate the international market
performance of the firm, including all export markets in which they were operating.
These protocol questions and corresponding questions in the interview protocol are
illustrated in Table 3.4.
Table 3.4 Corresponding research questions relevant to the interview protocol
Research questions Protocol
section
Corresponding
question
Research focus
Questions: 1- 5 (PART D) are opening questions & Questions: 32- 33 (PART K) are closing questions
RQ 1: What are the firm-level
resources and Internet,
international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do
they influence international
performance?
PART E: Qs: 6, 7, 8, 9 International entrepreneurial
orientation as a firm-level resource
PART F: Qs: 10, 11, 12, 13 Technology-related international
vision as a firm-level resource
PART G: Qs 14, 15, 16, 17,
18, 19
Experiential international business
experience as a firm-level resource
PART H: Qs: 20, 21, 22 Internet, international marketing
capabilities
PART I: Qs: 23, 24, 25, 26 International virtual network
capabilities
PART J Qs: 27, 28, 29, 30,
31
International market outcomes and
performance of the firm
3.5.5 Data analysis procedures
Data analysis ‘is a matter of giving meaning to first impressions as well as final
compilations’ (Stake, 1995, p. 71), and involves examining, categorising, tabulating, or
otherwise recombining evidence to elicit empirically based conclusions (Yin, 2009).
74
According to Yin (1994), acquiring case study evidence is one of the least developed and
most difficult aspects of conducting case studies. This is because investigators commonly
embark upon the case study methodology without firstly determining how the evidence
will be analysed (Marshall & Rossman, 2006). To avoid the common mistakes which can
stall data analysis in the analytic stage of the research design, the investigator became
well versed with all aspects of case study analysis procedures prior to coding the data.
The data analysis of cases included both within-case and cross-case analysis procedures
(Yin, 1994). By analysing the data at two points the researcher was able to examine and
extrapolate information key to solving the research problem.
Within-case and cross-case analysis
The purpose of within-case analysis was to become familiar with each individual case
through detailed examination of case study data (Perry, 1998b). The process of
conducting a within-case analysis allowed the researcher to become familiar with each
individual case through a descriptive and comprehensive case write-up (Perry, 1998b;
Eisenhardt, 2002). As such, the multiple cases in this research were viewed individually
before cross case-analysis took place. Cross-case analysis or pattern matching is a logic
comparing empirically based patterns with predicted ones (Yin, 2009). It is suggested that
where the patterns coincide, the results will assist in strengthening the study’s internal
validity (Patton, 1990). A cross-case analysis was conducted after the within-case
analysis, forcing the investigator to look beyond initial assumptions and consider all rival
explanations.
The data analysis of cases included both within-case and cross-case analysis (Yin, 1992).
As previously mentioned, this study incorporates both literal replications (predictions of
similar results) and theoretical replications (predicting contrasting results for predicted
reasons) (Yin, 1992; Mason, 2006). For example, predicted similar results, as shown in
Figure 3.2, are expected in cases Gs001 through to Gs003: goods-oriented small-sized
firms; cases Gm004 through to Gm006: goods-oriented medium-sized firms; cases Ss007
through to Ss009: service-oriented small-sized firms, and cases Sm010 through to Sm012:
service-oriented medium-sized firms.
75
Predicted contrasting results, as seen in Figure 3.2, are expected between the goods and
services industries and between small- and medium-sized firms. These case replications
aid in providing analytical generalisability and offer strong support for theory
development. The analytic strategy for data analysis in this study relied on the research
questions for guidance. This process ensured that all evidence was treated fairly (Yin,
2009), meaning that compelling analytic conclusions were established. As the research
questions have shaped the data collection plan, data analysis will be conducted through
the examination of case inquiry data and the research question. That is, the research
questions will assist in organising the case study and defining explanations to be
examined. A detailed discussion of the coding process, including the identification of
data-driven and theory-driven codes will be discussed in the next section.
Figure 3.2 Representation of expected literal and theoretical replications
Note. Homogenous firms within industries – Expected literal replications. Heterogeneity between industries
and firms – Expected theoretical replications. G= Goods-oriented firm, S= Service-orientated firm, s=
Small sized firm < 100 employees: TYPE A FIRMS, m= Medium sized firm > 100 employees: TYPE B
FIRMS.
3.5.6 Coding procedures
Data analysis involves what is commonly termed coding, that is, taking raw data and
raising it to a conceptual level (Strauss & Corbin, 2008). This involves reviewing and
synthesising transcribed documents to differentiate between parts, making reflections
Goods-oriented
firms
Case Gs001
Case Gm005
Case Gs002
Case Gm006
Case Gs003
Case Ss008
Service-oriented
firms
Case Ss007
Case Gm004
Case Ss009
Case Sm010
Case Sm011
Case Sm012
TY
PE
A F
IRM
S
TY
PE
B F
IRM
S
TY
PE
A F
IRM
S
TY
PE
B F
IRM
S
76
about the inter-relationships within the information (Miles & Huberman, 1984). The
coding process is further characterised by the operations through which data are broken
down, conceptualised, and put back together in new ways (Strauss & Corbin, 1990).
Consistent with key authors in the IE domain, this research draws on the coding
procedures conceptualised by Fereday and Muir-Cochrane (2008) and Strauss and Corbin
(1990). The method of analysis chosen for this research was a hybrid approach of
qualitative methods, incorporating both the deductive a priori template of codes approach
as outlined by Miller and Crabtree (1999), and the data-driven inductive approach of
Boyatzis (1998). This approach was appropriate in allowing the beliefs of social
phenomenology to be integral to the process of deductive analysis while allowing for
themes to emerge from the data using inductive coding (Fereday & Muir-Cochrane 2008).
Figure 3.3 offers a diagrammatic representation of the stages undertaken to code the case
study inquiry data.
Figure 3.3 Diagrammatic representation of the stages undertaken to code case study
inquiry data
STAGE 3: Summarising data and identifying the initial themes
STAGE 4: Applying the template of codes and additional coding
STAGE 5: Connecting the codes and identifying the themes
STAGE 6: Corroborating and legitimating coded themes
STAGE 1: Developing the code manual
STAGE 2: Testing the reliability of the codes
Open coding
The process of
breaking down and
conceptualizing data
Axial coding
A set of procedures to
put data back together
in new ways
Selective coding
Developing core
categories and
validating relationships
Source: Fereday and Muir-Cochrane (2008) further adapted from Boyatzis (1998) and Miller and
Crabtree (1999). Open, Axial and Selective coding sourced from Strauss and Corbin (1990).
77
Development of the code manual
The establishment of a code manual for this research was imperative, because it served as
a data management tool for systematising groups of similar or related text assisting in the
interpretation of the data (Miller & Crabtree, 1999). For this research, the template of
codes was developed a priori, based on the theoretical research questions (Fereday &
Muir-Cochrane, 2008), as shown in Table 3.5. The proposed conceptual model discussed
in Chapter Two of this thesis identified six constructs that informed the development of
the code manual: international entrepreneurial orientation, technology-related
international vision, international business experience, Internet, international marketing
capabilities, international network capabilities and international market performance. It is
also important to highlight that while the establishment of the code manual initially
commenced with these six categories, each theme was then broken down into numerous
codes. In this research the codes were written with reference to Boyatzis (1998) and
identified by the code label, the definition concerning the code, and a description of how
to identify the theme. The a priori code manual is presented in Table 3.5.
Table 3.5 The a priori code manual
Code 01
Core Theme: International entrepreneurial orientation
Label International innovativeness
Definition International innovativeness refers to a firm’s tendency to enter into experimentation,
support new international ideas and depart from established practices (Lumpkin &
Dess, 1996; Miller, 1983; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005).
Description The development or enhancement of products and services, such as new administrative
techniques and/or technologies for improving the international organisational
operations of the firm (Knight, 2001).
Code 02
Core Theme: International entrepreneurial orientation
Label International proactiveness
Definition International proactiveness relates to aggressive positioning relative to competitors
with an emphasis on the execution and ongoing tasks in pursuit of the firm’s
international market objectives (Knight, 2001).
Description The international entrepreneur’s ability to anticipate future needs of the firm and gain a
competitive advantage by pursuing new international market prospects.
Code 03
Core Theme: International entrepreneurial orientation
Label International risk-seeking propensity
Definition International risk-seeking propensity denotes the willingness of the international
entrepreneur to make investments and commit resources to projects that have uncertain
outcomes or unusually high profits and/or losses (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996; Lee et al.,
2001; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005).
Description The international entrepreneur’s ability to commit financial and human resources to
78
support new risky international projects. This can also include borrowing heavily and
venturing into the relatively unknown (Lumpkin & Dess, 1996).
Code 04
Core Theme: Technology-related international vision
Label International vision (Also referred to in text as international motivation and mission)
Definition An international or global vision of founders consistently seeks to procure the best
resources, including human and financial, to support the overseas operations of the firm
(Johnson, 2004; Loane, 2006). These international entrepreneurs envision international
opportunities and capitalise on them by taking advantage of new international market
opportunities through Internet platforms.
Description International entrepreneurs with a strong international vision will emphasise the
importance of exporting with employees as well as emphasising the development of
export-related resources (Aspelund & Moen, 2004). International entrepreneurs also
regard the world as their market.
Code 05
Core Theme: International business experience
Label International business experience
Definition The international business experience of the international entrepreneur refers to the
exposure of the manager to international markets, business experience and firm
internationalisation behaviours (Reuber & Fischer, 1997).
Description Any business experience that is internationally related. That is, any prior international
business experience working in the current firm or related and supporting industries or
firms.
Code 06
Core theme: International business experience
Label Qualifications (Also referred to in text as diplomas, degrees and certificates)
Definition Qualifications are those attributes that are possessed by a person that indicate the
individual is qualified to complete the task at hand.
Description Qualifications refer to any formal qualifications the international entrepreneur has
attained prior to establishment of the firm. Formal qualifications must be completed at
the time of the interview for the qualification to be classified complete.
Code 07
Core theme: International business experience
Label Internet experience
Definition Internet experience refers to any prior experience the international entrepreneur has
with the use of technology such as the Internet in a business environment.
Description Prior experience with Internet applications can include, but is not limited to:
developing and/or maintaining the firm’s official website, using the Internet for
international market management, market research, contacting overseas customers and
suppliers, identifying overseas competitors, markets and potential business partners,
exchange of operational data with suppliers and/or customers, online purchasing, after
sales support, recruiting personnel, or dealing with international public authorities.
Code 08
Core Theme: Internet, international marketing capabilities
Label Internet integration
Definition Internet integration refers to the extent to which Internet technologies are embedded in
the international business operations within the firm.
Description Internet integration can include any of the following items, but is not limited to:
developing and/or maintaining the firm’s official website, using the Internet for
international market management, market research, contacting overseas customers and
suppliers, identifying overseas competitors, markets and potential business partners,
exchange of operational data with suppliers and/or customers, online purchasing, after
sales support, recruiting personnel, or dealing with international public authorities.
Code 09
Core theme: International network capabilities
Label International networks (Also referred to in text as business relationships, ties)
79
Definition International business networks are the business relationships a firm secures, generally
consisting of a collection of close-knit secure business groups, where the focal
organisation is embedded (Elfring & Hulsink, 2003; Loane, 2006).
Description International business networks refer to the international entrepreneur’s formal
business-related relations with banks, trade partners, direct competitors, suppliers and
distributors, Government agencies and authorities.
Code 10
Core theme: International market performance
Label International performance(Also referred to in text as growth, international success
and exporting profitability)
Definition Performance is a firm’s reason for existence (Knight, 2001). In the absence of
sustainable, satisfactory performance outcomes, the firm will not survive; hence,
performance is the most important dimension of its overall operations (Knight, 2001).
Description The financial and non-financial indicators to measure the international success of the
firm. These indicators can include, but are not limited to: the total proportion of sales as
international revenue and profit, export sales growth, export profitability, the number
of years to firm has been exporting, the number of markets the firm is currently vested
in and the number of international investments.
All of the interview transcripts were analysed separately and summarised according to the
six identified themes. The transcripts were then summarised separately by outlining the
key points made by participants in response to questions asked by the interviewer. These
questions formed the framework of the interviews. The interview protocol included such
questions as:
Do you use the Internet to attract customers in overseas markets? If so, what types of technologies
do you use?
Are you likely to make investments in new international projects that are risky? If so, will the use
of the Internet play a role?
Do you intend to target any country markets within the next two years? Which markets and why?
Do you aspire to increase the number of your current international customer database? If so, will
the Internet play a role in increasing the number of international customers?
Do you have previous international business experience? If so, can you tell me about your
previous experience?
Does your firm place a strong emphasis on technological leadership? If so, why is this important?
Has the Internet impacted on the development and maintenance of your international network
relationships? If so, can you please explain why?
Can you please tell me the number of countries/ markets your firm currently exports to?
The coding process also consisted of five key stages: (i) the reliability of the codes, (ii)
summarising data and identifying the initial themes, (iii) applying the template of codes
and additional coding, (iv) connecting the codes and identifying the themes, and (v)
corroborating and legitimating coded themes. These key coding stages will be discussed
next.
80
(i) The reliability of the codes
Determining the applicability of the code to the raw information is a necessary step in the
data analysis process (Boyatzis, 1998). Three interviews transcripts and web documents
from the Australian goods and services sector were selected as pre-test pieces (Fereday &
Muir-Cochrane, 2008). Drawing from the coding process of the documents using a priori
codes, the researcher invited three selected co-researchers to code the transcripts and
documents. The results were compared and contrasted and minimal adjustments to the a
priori code template were required (Fereday & Muir-Cochrane, 2008).
(ii) Summarising data and identifying the initial themes
The process of summarising and identifying initial themes occurred through listening to,
and reading of the raw data. This process was adopted for each interview transcript and
for related and supporting evidence, such as web documents and print media. In essence,
this open coding technique began by analysing the first interview transcript with a line-
by-line analysis (Strauss & Corbin, 1990). This process involved the close examination of
the text, mainly phrase by phrase but sometimes by single words. The next phase included
coding sentences and paragraphs (Strauss & Corbin, 1990). The researcher was
essentially looking for the major idea brought about in each sentence or paragraph. Each
core idea, for example technology-related international vision, was given a name, and
then a more detailed analysis on that concept was conducted. In some cases each core
idea or theme consisted of several codes relating to the one label. For example,
‘international market performance’ (core theme), consisted of multiple codes stemming
from the core theme: for example, ‘international performance’ (code), ‘international
growth’ (code), and ‘international exporting’ (code). The initial names for concepts were
written on the interview transcripts and web documents.
(iii) Applying the template of codes and additional coding
The purpose of applying a template of codes to the text was to identify meaningful units
of text. Using the template analytic technique (Miller & Crabtree, 1999), the codes from
the code manual were applied to the interview transcripts and firm documents. Analysis
81
of the codes at this stage was guided, but not confined to the preliminary codes (Fereday
& Muir-Cochrane, 2008). During the coding process additional inductive codes were
found describing new themes emerging from the text.
(iv) Connecting the codes and identifying the themes
The process of connecting the codes is primarily concerned with discovering themes and
patterns in the data (Miller & Crabtree, 1999). At this stage of the coding process,
similarities and differences among case study interviews emerged. The process of
connecting the codes and identifying themes across the data clustered under headings that
directly relate to the research questions (Fereday & Muir-Cochrane, 2008).
(v) Corroborating and legitimating coded themes
The final stage in the coding process is corroborating and legitimating coded themes
(Fereday & Muir-Cochrane, 2008). Corroborating is a term used to describe the process
of confirming the findings (Miller & Crabtree, 1999). Before the researcher embarked on
the final coding process, the previous coding stages were scrutinised to ensure that the
clustered themes and codes were representative of the initial data analysis and a priori
codes (Fereday & Muir-Cochrane, 2008). In this study it is important to highlight that the
interaction of text, codes and themes involved several iterations before the analysis
proceeded to an interpretive phase, in which the units were connected into an explanatory
framework. The themes were then further clustered and assigned to succinct phrases to
describe the meaning that underpinned the theme.
3.6 Criteria for evaluating the quality of case studies
Yin’s (1994, 2009) criteria for judging qualitative research design and the quality of case
study research include four tests: construct validity, internal validity, external validity and
reliability. Each of these criteria are discussed below.
82
3.6.1 Construct validity
Construct validity is the first and most challenging aspect of case study design (Yin,
2009). This is because researchers often fail to develop sufficiently an operational set of
measures framing the research design. As previously mentioned, maintaining a chain of
evidence, the use of multiple sources, and the establishment of a case study database
(Marshall & Rossman, 2006; Yin, 2009) increase the reliability of information presented.
These techniques are also necessary in allowing external observers to follow the deviation
of any evidence from the initial research questions to the final case study conclusions.
3.6.2 Internal validity
The second criterion for evaluating research quality is internal validity (Eisenhardt, 2002;
Yin, 2009). Internal validity is mainly a concern in explanatory case studies, where the
researcher attempts to verify that true and correct relationships have been established
(Yin, 1994). If the investigator incorrectly assumes a causal relationship that is false or
untrue, the research design has failed to deal with some threat to internal validity, and
therefore the constructed theory will be flawed (Yin, 1994). Because this research is
exploratory in nature, casual statements are not developed, and therefore internal validity
is not an immediate issue. Instead, this research is concerned with developing theory from
multiple research fields, including IE and the RBV of the firm to elicit knowledge and
understanding of subjective meanings and interpretations of social phenomena (Marshall
& Rossman, 2006).
3.6.3 External validity
The third test of quality in Study One is external validity, which deals with the issue of
generalisability and whether the findings of the case study are applicable beyond the
immediate case to the external environment (Yin, 2009). Various authors (Yin, 1994;
Mason, 2006; Marshall & Rossman, 2006) have argued that typically single cases offer a
poor basis of generalising, whereas multiple case studies include tactics of replication
logic, thus strengthening the design and conclusions drawn. Unlike questionnaire
research, multiple case study methodology relies on analytic generalisation where the
83
investigator strives to generalise the findings of the case study to some border theory
(Mason, 2006); in this thesis the boarder theory is IE in an Internet context.
Generalisability in case study methodology is achieved through replication logic. As
previously mentioned, this study incorporates both literal replications (predictions of
similar results) and theoretical replications (predicting contrasting results for predicted
reasons) (Yin, 1994; Mason, 2006). That is, all cases within industries will be
homogenous and cases across industries will be heterogeneous. These case replications
aid in providing analytical generalisability and strong support for theory development.
3.6.4 Reliability
The final measure of quality in social research is the study’s reliability (Yin, 1994). The
reliability of the research is measured by the dependability of the findings (Gummesson,
2000). That is, all questions from the interview protocol are used to focus the study
around the research questions (Gummesson, 2000). The process of ensuring reliability in
the research design therefore means that in similar circumstances, the same results and
conclusions would be drawn by another researcher. It has also been suggested that a point
of data redundancy is required to draw out all pertinent issues from research participants
(Gummesson, 2004). That is, redundant constructs are identified at the point of
redundancy, that is, the point at which more cases would yield little or no better
understanding (Gummesson, 2004). This research addresses the issue of reliability by
establishing an interview protocol for the in-depth interviews and by developing a case
study database as described previously.
3.7 Ethical considerations
Prior to the research being conducted an application was lodged with the Queensland
University of Technology Human Research Ethics Committee for low-risk research
involving human participants. The research being undertaken was in accordance with the
Australian Government’s National Statement on Ethical Conduct in Human Research and
the human research ethics requirements of Queensland University of Technology. The
following discussion identifies the ethical issues raised prior to the research investigation.
84
i. Codes and consent: Participants involved in this research were asked at the
commencement of the interviews to sign research consent forms. By signing the
consent forms, participants indicated that they had read and understood the
information document regarding this study, agreed to participate, and understood
that their confidentiality would be maintained and no identifying information
released. Further, participants understood that they were free to withdraw from the
interview at any time, without comment or penalty.
ii. Confidentiality and anonymity of participants: By signing the consent forms prior
to the initiation of the study, participants’ rights were protected. All comments and
responses made within the interview were anonymous and treated with
confidentiality. The names of the participants were not required in any of the
responses, meaning the participant remained anonymous for the entire period of
the interview, and information contained within these recordings was kept
confidential. The audio recordings from the interviews were also not used for any
purpose other than the study itself. Also, this research did not involve the
gathering of personal or sensitive information about or from individuals.
3.8 Conclusion
In Chapter Three, the paradigmatic approach and ideological foundation for Study One
was discussed. A mixed-method postpositivist approach was adopted in this study, given
that research within IE lacks mixed-method approaches (Zahra & George, 2000).
Specifically, this chapter outlined the methodology for Study One, which employs
multiple case study methodology. Multiple case studies were deemed as an appropriate
method for data collection as the technique best addresses ‘how’ and ‘why’ research
questions, such as research question one being posed in Study One. In this chapter the
unit of analysis and unit of data collection were discussed. The overall research design for
Study One was also addressed. The validity and reliability of case studies were also
discussed. This chapter also addressed the ethical considerations of this research. The
analysis of the data collected from Study One will be discussed in Chapter Four.
85
CHAPTER FOUR: FINDINGS OF QUALITATIVE STUDY ONE
4.1 Introduction
As discussed in Chapter Three, the most suitable methodology chosen as the primary
method for research investigation in Study One was in-depth case study interviews. The
analysis and presentation of the data in Chapter Four was founded on in-depth interviews
conducted with 12 international entrepreneurs, who are owner/founders of individual
international entrepreneurial firms. The industries represented in Study One were
professional business services, tourism, information communication technology services
and consumer goods firms trading in manufacturing of textiles, food products and
jewellery. The techniques of the within-case and cross-case analysis assisted in the
examination and analysis of research question one (Yin, 1994; Perry, 1998b). A
diagrammatic overview of Chapter Four can be seen in Figure 4.1.
Figure 4.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Four
Introduction (4.1)
Within-case analysis (4.2)
Cross-case analysis of research question one (4.3)
Firm-level resource 1 (4.3.1) Firm-level resource 2 (4.3.2) Firm-level resource 3 (4.3.3)
Firm-level resource 4 (4.3.4) Firm-level resource 5 (4.3.5) Firm-level resource 6 (4.3.6)
Dynamic capability 1 (4.4.1) Dynamic capability 2 (4.4.2)
Conclusion (4.6)
Cross-case analysis of research question two (4.4)
Evaluation of Chapter Four (4.5)
86
4.2 Within-case analysis
The within-case analysis involved the detailed examination of each single case
represented in Study One. A within-case analysis involves the detailed write-up for each
firm (Eisenhardt, 1989), often built around pure descriptions central to the generation of
insight (Pettigrew, 1990). Through a succinct case write-up the researcher firstly
formalised each case study, as presented in Table 4.1, as individual entities presented for
examination. The within-case analysis also allowed the researcher to begin to identify the
unique patterns of each case before cross-case examination (Eisenhardt, 1989).
The individual within-case analyses were examined in accordance with a number of
categories including: job role of the entrepreneur, age, gender, country of birth,
education, number of employees, number of outlets, year of establishment, product
orientation, regional focus of the firm, first export market, customer type, turnover per
annum, proportion of sales as revenue coming from international customers, and a brief
description of the firm’s business, as shown in Table 4.1. It is important to note that
information presented in Table 4.1 and in the within-case and cross-case analysis has
been altered slightly, in accordance with ethics procedures so as to protect the rights of
the international entrepreneurs and businesses under investigation in this research. As
such, names of the individual international entrepreneur and the firm are not identified. It
is important to note that these omissions have not changed the research in any way that
would influence the quality of the data presented or the subsequent interpretation and
findings. The participant demographic data file accompanying the case studies in Study
One are presented in Table 4.1, followed by the within-case analysis of each case.
87
Table 4.1 Participant demographic data file
Case
#
Job Role of
interviewee
Age Gender Country
of birth
Education # of
staff/ # of
outlets
Year
established
Product
orientation
Regional
Focus
Customer
Type
Turnover
p.a.
Proportion of
international sales
Description of the firm
CASE
Gs001
Founder &
CEO 40 Female Australia
Technical
College 2/1 1989 Goods Heath
AU/TW/
CN /HK/NZ/
*US
# B-to-C
B-to-B
< $1
million
25% Moderately
international
CASE Gs001 provides a number of wellbeing services to improve people’s
health, wellbeing and productivity.
CASE
Gs002
Founder &
Managing
Director
61 Male Australia No formal
qualifications 11/1 1984
Goods
Manufacturing
AU/NZ/*AE
/FJ
# B-to-B
B-to-C
< $1
million
45% Moderately
international
CASE Gs002’s wholesale business provides Australia’s finest textiles for
luxury apartments and accommodation.
CASE
Gs003
Founder &
Manager
67 Female Australia Technical
College 6/2 1986
Goods
Jewellery
AU/NZ/*
US B-to-C
< $1
million
35% Moderately
international
CASE Gs003 is one of Australia’s oldest jewellery businesses and specialises in the
sale of rare and exquisite gemstones.
CASE
Gm004
Founder &
Managing
Director
52 Male Australia Technical
College 26/4 1985
Goods
Jewellery
AU/AE/*
UK /CN/RU
#B-to-C
B-to-B
$10
million +
75%
Highly international
CASE Gm004 travels the world to provide
unique and quality diamonds to customers that are rare.
CASE
Gm005
Founder & Managing
Director
36 Male Australia University
Degree 75/5 2002
Goods
Hospitality
AU/*CN/
IN
# B-to-C
B-to-B
$20
million +
5%
Primarily domestic
CASE Gm005 is a small size coffee roasting company that supplies signature
blended coffee and coffee machines as well as maintenance.
CASE
Gm006
Founder &
Managing
Director
36 Male Lebanon University
Degree 18/3 2002
Goods
Manufacturing
AU/CN/*
UK B-to-B
$5
million +
85%
Highly international
CASE Gm006 provides services from
labelling of corporate uniforms, promotional merchandise and consultancy
CASE
Ss007
Founder & Managing
Director
62 Female Australia Technical
College 7/1 1990
Services
Marketing AU/*NZ
# B-to-C
B-to-B
< $1
million
2%
Primarily domestic
CASE Ss007 provides financial services
including insurance to customers as well as a range of marketing services.
CASE
Ss008
Founder & Managing
Director
41 Male Australia University
Degree 3/1 2009
Services Finance
AU/*NZ B-to-C < $1
million
1%
Primarily
domestic
CASE Ss008 is an independent Australian
organisation providing property buyers and
developers access to no deposit finance.
CASE
Ss009
Founder &
Managing
Director
34 Female Australia University
Degree 7/2 2000
Services
Software
AU/*US/
CAUK
/HK
B-to-B < $1
million
25%
Moderately
international
CASE Ss009 provides jewellery software
management systems to businesses,
allowing firms to manage their stores.
CASE
Sm010
Founder &
Managing director
62 Male New
Zealand No formal
qualifications 92/5 1996
Services Tourism
AU/*NZ/
*US
/ UK
# B-to-B B-to-C
$2 million +
95%
Highly
international
CASE Sm010 is one of Australia’s leading
and most comprehensive independent
travel export firms to New Zealand.
CASE
Sm011
Founder &
Manager
52 Male Australia Technical College
42/1 1994 Services
Manufacturing AU/*NZ B-to-B
< $1 million
10%
Primarily
domestic
CASE Sm011 is an Australian wholesale
soft drink distributor providing a large
range of soft drinks for restaurants.
CASE
Sm012
Co-founder
& Manager
50 Male Australia Technical College
200/ 273
1989 Services
Hospitality
AU/*NZ/
TH
/NC/CN
B-to-C $15
million +
40%
Moderately
international
CASE Sm012 is a café that has expanded
to multiple countries with preeminent
international growth.
Note. All firms are private, wholly-owned Australian businesses. * First export market and # denotes the primary customer type/ orientation. G= Goods-oriented firm, S= Service-orientated firm, s=
Small sized firm, m= Medium sized firm. Country codes: AE= United Arab Emirates, AU= Australia, CA= Canada, CN= People’s Republic of China, FJ= Fiji, IN= India, NC= New Caledonia, NZ=
New Zealand, RU= Russian Federation, TH= Thailand, TW= Taiwan, UK= United Kingdom, US= United States.
88
Outline of international entrepreneurship case studies
4.2.1 CASE Gs001
Heath & Wellbeing Services Firm
CASE Gs001 provides a number of health and wellbeing services. The female founder
and CEO of CASE Gs001 initially started the business in 1989. The international
entrepreneur of CASE Gs001 speaks to corporations throughout Australia, New Zealand,
the United States and South-East Asia, sharing practical real-life strategies that help
people to improve their health, wellbeing and productivity by finding balance in their
lives. Primarily an online business the firm is moderately international with 25% (see
Table 4.1) of business revenue coming from international customers. The business
exports services globally to Taiwan, China, Hong Kong, New Zealand and the United
States. Primarily a business-to-consumer orientation, the business also deals with other
service-based companies. With extensive networks in the health and wellbeing industry
CASE Gs001 has grown quickly, primarily through the use of Internet technologies.
CASE Gs001’s intensity of Internet use, ranges from email and website applications to
marketing and advertising, market research and as a direct sales channel.
4.2.2 CASE Gs002
Wholesale Luxury Textiles Company
Established in 1984, CASE Gm005 is a wholesale luxury bed linen and furnishing fabric
company. Over the past 10 years the business has grown to become a market leader in
providing some of the finest luxury fabrics available with a major emphasis placed on
providing the widest range of locally produced, quality bedding products. Products in
high demand include Australia's leading luxurious feather bed toppers, hotel blankets,
microfiber quilts, bathrobes and other quality textiles for the hotel bedroom and
bathroom. With primarily a business-to-business orientation, and experiencing strong
growth in the wholesale market and high demand of products for residential demand,
CASE Gm005 now supplies products to consumers for residential purposes, although the
bulk of its revenue comes from wholesale business contracts. As a small company, CASE
Gm005 has extended its international market penetration though the extensive use of
89
formal business networks, international trade shows and forums. With no formal
qualifications, the male entrepreneurial founder has turned the business from a small-
sized firm into an international company serving multiple countries. The business
produces Australian-made products and ships to multiple markets including New
Zealand, Fiji, and the United Arab Emirates, via an extensive network of bulk freight
forwarders. The international entrepreneur has extensive industry and international
experience working in the textiles industry. This previous experience has enabled the
business to excel in business within the manufacturing industry.
4.2.3 CASE Gs003
Jewellery and Designer Homewares Retail Business
Established in 1986, CASE Gs003 sells fine designer homewares, specialty gifts and
exquisite jewellery from a retail boutique outlet. A moderately international small
company, CASE Gs003 exports to the New Zealand and United Sates market, with just
six employees and two retail outlets. Originating as a primarily domestic-based business,
CASE Gs003 is expanding with a newly established business in the United States market.
The entrepreneur of CASE Gs003’s favours distinctly Australian gems and has earned
international recognition. With primarily a business-to-consumer orientation, the business
relies on traditional networking relationships including the supply chain to coordinate
business in the United States market. Therefore, growth in CASE Gs003 is generated
minimally through Internet integration, but primarily through more traditional methods of
networking. International market growth was the result of demand created through
website applications and word of mouth. A ‘moderately international’ firm, CASE Gs003
receives around 35% of its revenue from an international customer database; however,
relationship-based networks and agents in the United States market ensure future
international market expansion.
4.2.4 CASE Gm004
Jewellery Firm
Recognised for their rare and exotic gemstones, CASE Gm004 was established in 1985.
With a childhood passion for gold and precious stones, the international entrepreneur of
CASE Gm004 was inspired initially by a jewellery television commercial. CASE Gm004
90
has brought his vision of owning and managing a jewellery store to reality. The passion
and motivation exhibited by CASE Gm004 is second to none, with the business now
extending its reach globally. Exporting to markets such as the United Arab Emirates, the
United Kingdom, China and Russia, CASE Gm004 has spawned international market
growth through the use of the Internet and traditional networking relationships.
Guaranteeing secure international delivery with a 30-day international refund policy,
CASE Gm004 has created a secure online environment enabling customers to place
orders 24 hours a day, seven days a week.
Although the Internet generates around 25% of new business, the Internet still remains of
limited use in countries where customers require close personal interaction such as the
United Arab Emirates and Russia. The firm uses online support systems to maintain
customer relationships and to generate consumer interest in new markets. CASE Gm004
has also invested large amounts of revenue in developing and maintaining a strong
presence in the online community. As such, customers can view designs online and make
enquires about products instantly via the Internet. Primarily, international trade shows
were used to access new international customers; however the owner/founder highlights
that the use of traditional networks in the jewellery industry remains important. This is
because many firms within the jewellery industry remain in established, tight network
relationships. CASE Gm004 is a highly international firm, as seen in Table 4.1, with a
little over 75% of total revenue coming from international customers.
4.2.5 CASE Gm005
Wholesale Coffee Roasting Company
Conceived as an Australian wholesale coffee roasting company, CASE Gs002 is fast
becoming a household name by supplying over 11 signature blends of coffee, a range of
coffee machines and a number of services, including maintenance and training. CASE
Gs002 supplies more than 1000 cafés in Australia and more than 1.4 million cups of
CASE Gs002’s coffee are sold each week. A passion for coffee and a keen
entrepreneurial spirit led the founder of CASE Gs002 to establish a coffee-roasting
operation in 2002. Over the last eight years, CASE Gs002 has proceeded to thrive and
expand Australia-wide with roasting houses in major cities, including Brisbane,
91
Melbourne, Sydney and Adelaide. This unprecedented growth has spanned distribution
into the Chinese market and soon into the Indian market. While the international
component of CASE Gs002 is only 5%, the firm turns over a staggering $20 million
annually.
Dedicated to building relationships and inspiring passion in those around him, the founder
and chief executive officer of CASE Gs002 has successfully established a comprehensive
business consisting of wholesale, retail, and online sales, and service. CASE Gs002
primarily has a business-to-business customer orientation, although the firm has now
tailored some of its coffee products to be sold exclusively through the Internet. Further,
digitalisation within CASE Gs002 is being used to support the international aspirations of
the company through the recent development of an online store selling direct to
wholesalers and consumers. Growth is being generated through traditional networks,
word of mouth and the application of the Internet. For example, CASE Gs002 highlighted
that the company’s official website, online sales, online advertising and marketing, online
after sales and support, online purchasing and email use remain of high importance to the
firm.
4.2.6 CASE Gm006
Corporate & Promotional Goods Company
CASE Gm006 provides services in the fields of marketing, promotional products, and
corporate and safety clothing. More than 30 of the world’s 100 leading brands are
included in the portfolio of CASE Gm006. Clients are serviced globally on a daily basis
via a series of dedicated, sophisticated web stores, all designed and hosted by CASE
Gm006. CASE Gm006 is located in Sydney, with regional offices in Melbourne and
London, with shipments coming from the East Asia office and warehouse in Shanghai
and China. The entrepreneur of case Gm006 has limited international experience in terms
of working with overseas companies. However, with formal qualifications including a
business degree, the young owner/founder of CASE Gm006 has managed to grow the
business quickly: within three years of establishment, the company was featured on
BRW’s 2011 Australian 100 fast starters. With 18 employees and three outlets, this
business-to-business firm has achieved exceptional international market penetration.
92
Servicing the domestic Australian market, China and the United Kingdom, CASE Gm006
is a highly international company with approximately 85% of the businesses revenue
coming from international customers. The company relies heavily on international
networks and uses the Internet to develop and maintain international relations. The
company also has a high level of Internet integration with a increased use of email and
online advertising and marketing, market research, sales, and communications and relying
heavily an online supply chain management solutions, guaranteeing delivery in full and
on time. In summary, the company uses the Internet as a mechanism to facilitate
international business as well as to generate new international market growth.
4.2.7 CASE Ss007
Financial Insurance Services Company
CASE Ss007 is a small marketing and financial services firm established in 1990. The
marketing services side of the business provides strategic marketing consultancy services
as well as marketing resources to help, consult and coach small business. Primarily a
domestic-based business, CASE Ss007 has some clients in the New Zealand market, with
approximately only 2% of revenue coming from this market. The company has around 70
employees with only one outlet. The proportion of international revenue extends from the
financial services side of the business, which provides fully-integrated financial solutions
for clients. The owner/founder of CASE Ss007 is an innovative business owner who has
transformed business processes to suit the needs of a changing digital environment. This
includes integrating Internet technology, with which the entrepreneur was previously not
familiar. Internet integration in CASE Ss007 extends from website applications to email
and supply chain management. CASE Ss007 highlights the importance of traditional
relationship-based networks as the primary source for business growth domestically.
4.2.8 CASE Ss008
No-Deposit Finance Company
CASE Ss008 is an independent Australian organisation established in 2009. The business
provides property buyers, finance brokers, real estate agents, builders, developers and
other affiliates access to no-deposit finance solutions. Essentially the business provides
interest-free personal loan facilities. Based on the Gold Coast, CASE 008 was formed
93
through a collaboration of businesses operating in the areas of property development,
credit systems, building products and financial services in response to the Global
Financial Crisis. The primary vision of CASE Ss008 was to create an integrated property
and finance company, which would provide buyers and sellers with an affordable and
more efficient way to buy and sell property. CASE Ss008 originally offered services only
to the Gold Coast and Brisbane markets, but through increased interest and demand the
firm now offers its services nation-wide, despite only working from one outlet with only
three employees. High levels of innovation were noted in CASE Ss008 as the business is
consistently searching for new and innovative ways to assist buyers in investing in their
key development projects. With only 1% international market penetration, as seen in
Table 4.1, CASE Ss008 has a vision to extend the business concept into the neighboring
New Zealand market. The owner/founder of CASE Ss008 has extensive experience of
working in internationally focused firms and has formal links with financial brokers and
lenders. Overall, this Australian-born entrepreneur envisions business growth to almost
double over the next decade.
4.2.9 CASE Ss009
Jewellery Software Management Company
CASE Ss009 is a small technology-based firm that provides leading software for retail
jewellery stores. The business produces easy plug-in and play software designed to
manage all aspects of a jeweller’s business. The business management system controls
the accounting, customer relationship management, marketing, payroll, sales, wholesaler
management and web integration of the firm. As a business-to-business operator, CASE
Ss009 has been predominantly operating in the domestic market; however international
recognition for their software products has enabled CASE Ss009 to internationalise early
from inception. Founded in 2000, CASE Ss009 has international customers in the United
States, Canada, the United Kingdom and Hong Kong, with approximately 25% of
international revenue coming from an international customer database. A moderately
international firm, the business is still in its infancy, however international demand is
increasing.
94
4.2.10 CASE Sm010
Independent New Zealand Travel Company
CASE Sm010 is one of Australia’s leading and most comprehensive independent travel
export firms to New Zealand. This travel-exporting firm boasts the largest and most
comprehensive selection of New Zealand travel products. The founder of this
internationally focused company indicated that living in New Zealand, the United States
and the United Kingdom for more than more five years had helped to motivate the
decision to expand the business abroad via the Internet. Although the company is based
on the in Australia, the business also has five support offices, including; Gold Coast,
Perth, Christchurch, Seattle and the United Kingdom. The firm has a business-to-
customer orientation, primarily catering for couples, first-time travels and families
seeking a unique travel experience to New Zealand. The international component of the
total business revenue is 95%, meaning that the business has a highly international
orientation. It is also important to note that as a wholesaler, 100% of the business comes
from the travel agent. In terms of technologies integration within the firm, CASE
Sm010’s intensity of Internet use, ranges from email and website applications to
marketing and advertising and developing the firm’s own online self-operational
booking/reservation system. As a direct result of software development, the business has
generated new international market growth across Asia, the South Pacific and Europe.
The Internet has allowed CASE Sm010 to specifically build customer itineraries for
clients through a simple point and click system, which allows customers to view and print
quotes and invoices and to create custom reservations on the software system. A growth
rate of 1300% in the last 15 years indicates a prosperous future for CASE Sm010.
4.2.11 CASE Sm011
Wholesale Beverage Firm
CASE Sm011 is a small Australian wholesale soft drink distributor established in 1994. A
goods-based business with a business-to-business orientation, CASE Sm011 has grown to
become one of the most reputable and reliable beverage distribution companies in the
market. Employing 30 people, the company has one warehouse located in South
Brisbane, allowing quick access to customers north and south of the city. The company
95
also has several supporting agents throughout Australia, and relies heavily on traditional
network relationships to maintain business growth. CASE Sm011 has a primarily
domestic-based business operation with only 10% of revenue coming from the New
Zealand market. The firm aims to grow international business throughout the New
Zealand market, due to the low psychic distance barriers presented in this market. The
business relies on portable hand-held scanning equipment to control inventory stocks.
CASE Sm011 indicates minimal use of the Internet for website advertising and email
functions only.
4.2.12 CASE Sm012
Restaurant & Food Services Company
Case Sm012 is one of Australia’s largest home-grown chain of retail cafés. From the
development of its single retail outlet in 1989, CASE Sm012 has established itself as an
iconic household name. Originally starting as a small domestic-based entrepreneurial
business to meet the untapped demand of the Australian market, the business has now
expanded globally with retail outlets in Australia, New Zealand, Thailand, New
Caledonia and China. The international entrepreneur of CASE Sm012 has placed a strong
emphasis on being a family-grown business, one that has grown exponentially and has
become a much-loved brand that is focused on contributing to the Australian community.
With around 200 employees and 273 retail outlets, CASE Sm012 is reaching new heights
in brand awareness, advocacy and sales through their franchise operations.
CASE Sm012’s vision to be the ‘global leader’ in providing good retail food and coffee is
coupled with the company’s core values. One of these core values is continual
improvement, coupled with actively promoting innovative practice in all business
activities. With approximately 40% of revenue coming from international customers, this
moderately international company envisions that international market growth will expand
by at least 30% over the next five years. The business also relies on substantial integration
of the Internet into point-of-sale systems to allow the business to track inventory across
all stores, track and record profit and loss margins, determine top selling items, and
record employee information. CASE Sm012 also highlights the importance of Internet
use for marketing, website advertising, blogging and for social media purposes.
96
4.3 Cross-case analysis of research question one
Coupled with the within-case analysis is a cross-case search for patterns (Eisenhardt,
1989), which gives the research a higher degree of analytical complexity and encourages
the investigator to look beyond the initial interpretations of the data (Perry, 1998b).
Cross-case synthesis is performed to ensure robustness in the data presented, ultimately
giving the results greater meaning, due to the strengthening of data findings across the
multiple cases presented (Perry, 1998b; Yin, 2009). Cross-case analysis also improves the
likelihood of accurate and reliable theory development, through capturing novel findings
that may exist in the data (Eisenhardt, 1989). The frequency and emphasis of the
statements presented can also be used to justify patterns or themes emergent from the
data, and also to identify the similarities and differences between cases which will inform
theory development (Patton, 1990; Yin, 2009).
Initial examination of case study evidence in the form of in-depth interviews, website
data, and promotional materials revealed a large amount of information accumulated. To
ensure the coding process was rigorous, analytical coding techniques were utilised to
manage the data (Strauss & Corbin, 1998; Fereday & Muir-Cochrane 2008). A line-by-
line, phrase-by-phrase coding process was used to break down data into individual pieces
of evidence so as to label and categorise data effectively (Strauss & Corbin, 1998). The
systematic classification process involved analysing text according to research question
one. Research question one can be seen in Table 4.2, which also shows the protocol
section, corresponding question in the interview guide and the research focus. Following
Table 4.2, the data will be examined in accordance with research question one.
97
Table 4.2 Cross-case analysis, with corresponding research and protocol questions
Research question Protocol
section
Corresponding
question
Research focus
Questions 1-5 (PART D) are opening questions & Questions 32-33 (PART K) are closing questions
RQ 1: What are the firm-level
resources and Internet,
international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do
they influence international
performance?
PART E: Qs: 6, 7, 8, 9 International entrepreneurial
orientation as a firm-level resource
PART F: Qs: 10, 11, 12, 13 Technology-related international
vision as a firm-level resource
PART G: Qs: 14, 15, 16, 17,
18, 19
International business experience
as a firm-level resource
PART H: Qs: 20, 21, 22 Internet, international marketing
capabilities
PART I: Qs: 23, 24, 25, 26 International virtual network
capabilities
PART J Qs: 27, 28, 29, 30,
31
International market outcomes and
performance of the firm
Research question one
RQ 1: What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international
performance?
Research question one incorporates five firm-level a-priori resource constructs: Firm-
level resource 1: International technology-related innovation: Firm-level resource 2:
International technology-related proactiveness, Firm-level resource 3: International
technology-related risk-taking propensity; Firm-level resource 4: Technology-related
international vision; and Firm-level resource 5: International business experience.
Research question one also incorporates two capabilities: Capability 1: Internet,
international marketing capabilities and; Capability 2: International virtual network
capabilities.
4.3.1 Firm-level resource 1: International technology-related innovation
The first concept to be addressed was international technology-related innovation. All
firms were asked to identify: (i) something different or new the business had done in the
past year to do with their international customers, and (ii) if it was important for the firm
to be continually innovative with Internet technologies. The questions in relation to
international technology-related innovation can be seen in Appendix 1.
98
Seven firms (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), as shown in
column (A) of Table 4.3, viewed innovation to be ‘very strongly important’. Two firms
(Gs001, Gs003) indicated ‘strong importance’, while a further three firms, (Gs002, Ss007,
Sm011) indicated ‘moderate importance’. Eight firms (Gs001, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011) signified the ability to establish new products in an online
space, as seen in column (B). Re-producing existing products in a new way, as seen in
column (C), was evident in six firms (Gs002, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010). Six
firms (Gs001, Gm004, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011) introduced new methods of
production in online environments, as shown in column (D).
Opening new markets enabled by the Internet was seen in eight firms (Gs00, Gs003,
Gs004, Gm005, Ss008, Sm101, Ss009, Sm012), as shown in column (E). Developing new
organisational structures in an online space column (F), and implementation of untried
Internet technologies previously not used in the firm column (G), was evident in only two
firms (Ss009, Sm010). Use of the Internet to achieve successful international outcomes
was seen in nine firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010,
Ss009, Sm012), as shown in column (H). Six firms, (Gs001, Gs003, Gm005, Ss009,
Sm010Sm012), as shown in column (I), engaged in experimentation with the Internet in
internationalisation activities. The level of innovation, as seen in column (J), shows very
high levels in two firms (Ss009, Sm010); high levels in two firms (see, Gs001, Gm004);
moderate levels in six firms (Gs003, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm011, Sm012); and low
levels in a further two firms (Gs002, Ss007).
99
Table 4.3 Levels of international technology-related innovation
Type of innovation explicit in firm processes in an Internet-
based environment
A B C D E F G H I J
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f
inn
ovat
ion
New
pro
du
ct d
evel
op
men
t in
an o
nli
ne
env
iro
nm
ent
Re-
pro
duci
ng a
n e
xis
ting
onli
ne
pro
duct
in a
new
way
Intr
odu
cing
new
met
hod
s o
f
pro
duct
ion
in
an
on
line
spac
e
Op
enin
g n
ew m
ark
ets
enab
led
by t
he
Inte
rnet
Dev
elopin
g n
ew o
rgan
isat
ion
al
stru
ctu
res
in a
n o
nli
ne
spac
e
Imp
lem
enti
ng
un
trie
d I
nte
rnet
tech
nolo
gie
s p
rev
iou
sly
no
t
use
d
Usi
ng
the
Inte
rnet
to
ach
ieve
inte
rnat
ional
ou
tco
mes
Exp
erim
enta
tion
of
the
Inte
rnet
in f
irm
inte
rnat
ional
izat
ion
acti
vit
ies
Descriptive comment Level of
innovation
Case
Gs001 SI - - -
Online booking and payments systems.
High
Case
Gs002 MI - - - - -
Everything done in-house.
Overhauled textile market. Low
Case
Gs003 SI - - - - -
Searches for new products
to remain competitive. Moderate
Case
Gm004 VSI - - - -
Continually innovative in
relationship networking to secure global markets.
High
Case
Gm005 VSI - - - - -
The epitome of an
innovative firm. Essential to all business practice.
Moderate
Case
Gm006 VSI - - - - -
Global infrastructure
mindset, with a low-
overhead operation. Moderate
Case
Ss007 MI - - - - - - -
Introduced new insurance
plans for existing clients. Low
Case
Ss008 VSI - - -
Developed a new
organisational structure and a new product never
before seen on the market.
Moderate
Case
Ss009 VSI
Runs a virtually cost-less
business. Very High
Case
Sm010 VSI
Developed a booking
engine to complement the
business structure
domestically and globally.
Very High
Case
Sm011 MI - - - - - -
Uses technology for stock
inventory but is not
continually innovative. Moderate
Case
Sm012 VSI - - - - - -
Spawned into multiple
markets by replication of a
successful firm structure. Moderate
Aggregate 8/12 6/12 6/12 8/12 2/12 2/12 9/12 6/12
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, tick represents
‘use’, dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates very high levels of international
technology-related innovation.
100
Evaluation of international technology-related innovation
Three key findings from the data in relation to how international technology-related
innovation influences firm performance have been identified: (1) new product
development in an online environment, (2) opening of new markets enabled by the
Internet, (3) use of the Internet to achieve successful international outcomes, and (4)
technology-related innovation and markets of similarity. These key findings are discussed
below.
(1) New product development in an online environment
Firms in this research indicated that the ability to establish new ideas and products in an
online space was one of the top priorities of the firm. This is particularly evident in eight
of the cases (Gs001, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011). Use of the
Internet in non-traditional niche retail spaces has also assisted small international
entrepreneurial firms in promoting products and services for international markets. For
example, one quote included in Table 4.4 conceptualises the use of the Internet to reach
niche markets in Russia. Case Gm004 (jeweller), exporter of pink diamonds said;
‘...there’s a negative perception about Australian jewels. People come to us because of
our pink diamonds – we create uniqueness. People know the exquisite nature of these
diamonds because of the Internet, even in Russia. We are now the largest exporter [of
pink diamonds] from Western Australia’. Similarly, Case Ss009 (plug-and-play software)
and Sm010 (NZ travel provider) are highly innovative pure.com firms which have
established products and services purely for the virtual market. The two international
entrepreneurial cases also show a clear relationship between the acceptance and
application of the Internet and the development of new products to increase customer
value in Internet environments.
(2) Opening of new markets enabled by the Internet
Eight out of the 12 cases (Gs00, Gs003, Gs004, Gm005, Ss008, Sm101, Ss009, Sm012)
indicated that Internet-enabled opening of new markets was perceived to be important for
the international development of the firm. For example, Case Gm005 (coffee roasting
business) states that the business has used the Internet to secure business opportunities in
101
the Chinese market and is looking to grow the business into India within the year: ‘We
are a people-based company foremost. But we adapt technology where we need it, where
appropriate.’ ‘Our website is now one of the largest in the country. And we are making
investments in Chinese market and Indian market later this year…’ Similarly, Case
Sm012 (food and beverage provider) explains how the business has received global
attention, via the Internet from many countries including Egypt; ‘The Internet has made
brands small become recognised globally. The Internet has made the world a smaller
place; everyone is knowledge hungry... We have global expressions of interest including
Egypt, from someone who hasn’t even been to Australia.’
(3) Use of the Internet to achieve international performance outcomes
The use of the Internet to achieve successful international outcomes was evident in nine
out of 12 cases (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010, Ss009,
Sm012). For example, one quote from Table 4.4 shows that Case Ss009 (plug-and-play
software) was built initially to become global in nature; ‘We built the business from the
outset to be international… From the outset we wanted to be jewellery specific and totally
online, that’s our point of difference so we’ll go worldwide.’ Similarly, the owner/founder
of Case Sm010 (NZ travel provider), as seen in Table 4.4, speaks of the business’s
international scope, stating that international business has grown exponentially: ‘...we
have added Pacific Islands, the UK and US to our customer base.’ ‘The business has
increased by 1300% over the last 15 years; we are defiantly looking at more international
market growth.’ The cases demonstrating ‘very high’ levels of innovation display this
innovation through development and enhancement of online products and services, such
as the new customer relationship management systems in Case Sm010, and technologies
for improving the international organisational operations of the firm in Case Ss009.
The data and quotes from interviews supporting the three opportunity-seeking constructs
– New product development in an online environment (PD), Opening new markets
enabled by the Internet (NM), and the use of the Internet to achieve international
performance outcomes (PO) – are shown in Table 4.4.
102
Table 4.4 Supporting quotations for international technology-related innovation
Case
code
New product development (PD) Opening new Internet markets (NM) International performance outcomes
(PO)
Case
Gs001
PD: New skincare product development. ‘In fact I’ve got 300 kilos worth of skincare products going to
Taiwan today and I’ve got two cartons of books going to South Korea today.’
NM: ‘All of my business is on the Internet. And in fact I’ve been sitting here creating new web links. Another
website landing page.’
PO: ‘...about a quarter of our business in international. 25%. Mostly from the North American market and
all from our investments into net technology to achieve international growth.’
Case
Gs002
PD: ‘A huge product for us is the feather and down bed topper... It’s 40% down and in Australia they sort of
think if they put any more than 10% (down) it’s absolutely super luxurious – a new product never before seen
in the Australian market... I mean you get imitations.’
PO: ‘We export to New Zealand and other countries like Abu Dhabi, Dubai and Fiji are all customers from
the Internet. The Internet is important but the only way to, you know, do business with hotels and these sorts
of people (in the UAE) was really to be knocking on doors...’ ‘But no doubt yes the Internet is important for
our company to move forward and go internationally.’
Case
Gs003
NM: ‘We place a strong importance on using the Internet to reach in particular our US clients... Also those
customers in the NZ market.’
PO: ‘The business is mainly domestic although I envision the US component of our global customer database
to increase by at least 25% in the next five years, and the Internet will truly make this process easier.’
Case
Gm004
PD: ‘...there’s maybe a negative perception about Australian jewels. But people come to us because of our
pink diamonds, they are number one – people want something different and we can create that uniqueness
they desire.’ ‘People know about the exquisite nature of these diamonds because of the Internet. We have the
largest exporter (of pink diamonds) in Western Australia.’
NM: ‘...our computer software and stock systems are all Internet based. If we didn’t have the Internet we
wouldn’t be here. We have been able to use the Internet to overcome culture barriers in the United Arab
Emirates and in Russia, primarily because they don’t speak English.’
PO: ‘We’ve just signed a contract with one of the biggest most iconic/ prestigious carmakers in the world...
We have just singed a contact with the world.’ ‘We are not looking at anymore standalone stores, but stores
within the car dealership (previously mentioned).’
Case
Gm005
NM: ‘We are a people-based company foremost. But we adapt technology where we need it, where
appropriate.’ ‘Our website is now one of the largest in the country. And we are making investments in
Chinese market and Indian market later this year…’
PO: Participant is asked why go to China and India? ‘They are the fastest growing economies… I’m not going
to Italy where there’s already people drinking coffee… Instead I’m going to a new market where Starbucks is
paving the way and I can go in and show them how to do it better...’
Case
Gm006
PD: ‘We are pretty much the only company in this industry that has an industry magazine.’ ‘It’s in print
publication. Call it old fashioned but it works.’ ‘…so we’ve got a highly competitive field of mums and dads,
backyard operators, but we are innovative by having an industry-first magazine and our online payment
platforms and delivery process are second to none in relation to what our competitors offer our clients.’
PO: ‘The UK market is a big market for us. We haven’t really hit the ground running there. It’s been very
turbulent. ‘Europe interests us; Australia is very close to Europe in terms of business philosophies and
structure, so we hope to be there in a few years....’
Case
Ss007 ‘Indicates no PD, NM or GO’
Case
Ss008
PD: ‘There are two key words for any entrepreneur in my opinion. The first one is innovation, the second,
being able to innovate.’ ‘…I developed this latest business based on the fact that the market had changed. We
created a boutique sales incentive for buyers to help buyers. It is simply a 10 year, interest-free loan.’ ‘We are
only just starting to maximise the Internet side of the equation…’
NM: ‘We are tapping into the NZ market through the Internet also through using our pre-established
networks…’
PO: ‘We have interest expressed by countries like Vietnam, but we remain primarily domestic for now.’
Case
Ss009
PD: ‘We created a ‘plug-and-play’ software program in 2000 because we recognised a need in the industry
and also identified that the Internet could actually deliver a web-based solution that could be brought or sold
anywhere in the world…’
103
NM: ‘We thought by default the US would be our biggest markets…’ ‘The US has a lot of competition, there
was like 30 other jewellery specific software providers. The US also is not the US, its 50 different states and
they all see themselves individually. ’ ‘For us the UK and Hong Kong market has been most fruitful.’
PO: ‘We built the business from the outset to be international…’ ‘From the outset we wanted to be jewellery
specific and totally online, that’s our point of difference so we’ll go worldwide…’
Case
Sm010
PD: ‘The vision was to always have an extensive distribution system of travel agents across Australia.... ‘The
thing is we are selling NZ travel to customers from highly trained and knowledgeable staff.’ ‘Being the largest
seller of NZ travel we have alerted our products to suit our clients’ needs,’ ‘…we bought it [ski business]
because we felt we could operate it efficiently and in actual fact it’s helped us more than anything else
because it’s added extra bookings when we needed them. With downturns we always run very lean. We don’t
have any extra staff. It’s important in my opinion to have new innovative business…’
NM: ‘The vision is that if we could get it going here [Aus], we could expand globally and become a
significant seller of NZ as a wholesaler.’ ‘Necessity is the mother of invention. I was getting really annoyed as
many Internet guys [competitors] were killing us with price. So we decided to be fully web operational, now
we can target any market we like, specifically the UK and the US.’
PO: ‘...we have added Pacific Islands, the UK and US to our customer base...’ ‘The business has increased by
1300% over the last 15 years; we are defiantly looking at more international market growth.’
Case
Sm011
PD: ‘Most people in our business don’t have time for the Internet. They rely on someone walking through the
door and selling stuff to them. That’s what makes us different because we had developed online stock and
ordering systems, this serves the NZ market well.’
Case
Sm012
NM: ‘The Internet, Wi-Fi, Facebook have made the ability of any brand to be recognised globally. The
Internet has made the world a much smaller place, everyone is knowledge hungry... this is great for us, now
we have global expressions of interest- including: Egypt of all places, from someone who hasn’t even been to
Australia.
PO: ‘We believe that our business model would work excellently in Bahrain. Dubai is another one, Abu
Dhabi is fantastic.’ ‘We will continue to become more reliant on the Internet to make our company more well-
known.’
(4) Technology-related innovation and markets of similarity
A key finding derived from the data and captured in Table 4.1 and 4.3 is that a total of 10
firms out of the 12 interviewed in this research (Gs001-US, Gs003-US, Gm004- UK,
Gm006- UK, Ss007- NZ, Ss008- NZ, Ss009- US, Sm010- NZ/ UK, Sm011- NZ, Sm012-
NZ), first internationalised to markets of similarity, as denoted by the country code
represented in Table 4.1. That is, the findings suggest that firms will tend to select those
countries most similar to the home country. Of the ten firms, one case (GS001) displayed
‘low’ levels on innovation; five firms indicated ‘moderate’ levels (Gs003, Gm006, Ss008,
Sm011, Sm012), two firms displayed ‘high’ levels (Gs001, Gm004), and a further two
firms indicated ‘very high’ levels of innovation (Ss009, Sm010). It is important to note
that the elements in this research are delimited to language, culture and legal regulations
only. Two firms initially internationalised to markets of dissimilarity (Gs002 – UAE,
Gm005 – CHN), and Table 4.3 indicates that these firms displayed ‘low’ and ‘moderate’
levels of innovation respectively. This finding suggests that international technology-
related innovation seems to matter more in firms exporting to markets that share similar
104
characteristics to that of the home market. For example, one quote from Case Gm005
(coffee roasting business) confirms that the company first exported to the Chinese market:
‘we are making investments in the Chinese and Indian market later this year.’ The
participant was asked, ‘why go to China and India?’: ‘They are the fastest growing
economies… I’m not going to Italy where there’s already people drinking coffee…
Instead I’m going to a new market where Starbucks is paving the way and I can go in and
show them how to do it better.’ This statement suggests that while markets of
dissimilarity can offer abundance of opportunity, technology-based innovation matters
less is high-context/dissimilar markets.
Types of innovation not identified
It was predicted that reproducing an existing online product in a new way, introducing
new methods of production in an online space, developing new organisational structures
in an online space, implementing untried Internet technologies previously not used, and
experimenting with the Internet in firm internationalisation activities would be identified
as important aspects of innovation. Table 4.3 indicates that these types of innovation are
not essential components required for firms operating in an online environment. Those
firms indicating low levels of innovation recognised the importance of the Internet at a
general business level, but also realised that they lacked an appreciation of the Internet in
creating new innovative ways to achieve international outcomes. These firms also noted
that they found Internet use complex and costly to implement, most likely due to the
turbulent and highly saturated competitive environments in which these small
international entrepreneurial firms compete.
Overall discussion: International technology-related innovation
Overall, it was found that: (1) new product development, (2) opening of new Internet-
enabled markets, (3) use of the Internet to achieve international outcomes, and (4)
technology-related innovation and markets of similarity are important aspects of
international innovation in SMEs. Firms that engage in innovative behaviour
encompassing these key aspects of innovation stand to achieve international gain. The
findings from the data, as presented in Figure 4.2, suggest that international technology-
105
related innovation influences the perception of international market outcomes. The
findings also indicate that innovation seems to matter more in markets of similarity,
where key elements such as language, culture and legal regulations are comparable to the
home operating market. The previous assertion argues that innovation processes are more
important in Internet environments and are critical to the firm’s successful pursuit of
international markets.
Figure 4.2 International technology-related innovation and international markets
(i) New product development in an online space
(ii) Opening of new Internet-enabled
markets
(iii) Use of the Internet to achieve
international outcomes
Development of innovation in
an online context Successful pursuit of
international opportunity
seeking and market
performance in Internet
markets
Number of international
export markets increases
Proportion of revenue coming
from international customers
increases
+
+
+
106
4.3.2 Firm-level resource 2: International technology-related proactiveness
The second concept to be addressed is international technology-related proactiveness. All
firms were asked: (i) whether the firm used Internet technology to attract and attain
customers in international markets, (ii) where the manager envisioned the business to be
in five years’ time, and (iii) if strategies were put into place to anticipate the future
market needs to secure new international opportunities. The questions in relation to
international technology-related proactiveness can be seen in Appendix 1.
Nine cases (Gs001, Gs002, Gs004, Gs005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010, Sm011, Sm012) as
shown in column (A) of Table 4.5, viewed international technology-related proactiveness
to be ‘very strongly important’. One firm (Gs003) indicated ‘strong importance’, while a
further two firms (see, Ss007, Sm011) indicated ‘moderate importance’. Four firms
(Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010) signified that the firm created first-mover advantages in
an online space, as shown in column (B). Capitalising on new product innovations to
create opportunity online was noted in five firms (Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010), as seen in column (C). Three firms (Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), as seen in column
(D), indicated that the firm was more proactive than competitors towards new online
marketplace opportunities. Maintaining a forward-looking perspective was also
mentioned by 10 firms in this research (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), as seen in column (E). Proactiveness in international
opportunity seeking in Internet-mediated environments was highlighted in five firms
(Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010), as noted in column (F). Anticipating the future
online needs of the firm as seen in column (G) was identified in 11 firms (Gs001, Gs002,
GS003, Gs004, Gs005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012).
The level of proactiveness, as shown in column (H), indicates very high levels of
proactiveness in four firms (Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010); high levels in one firm
(Sm012), moderate levels in three firms (Gs002, Gm004, Ss008), and low levels in a
further four firms (Gs001, Gs003, Ss007, and Sm011).
107
Table 4.5 Levels of international technology-related proactiveness
Type of proactiveness explicit in firm processes in an
Internet-based environment
A B C D E F G H
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f
pro
acti
ven
ess
Cre
ates
fir
st-m
over
adv
anta
ges
in a
n o
nli
ne
spac
e
Cap
ital
ises
on
new
pro
duct
inn
ovat
ion
s to
cre
ate
oppo
rtu
nit
y o
nli
ne
Mo
re p
roac
tive
than
com
pet
ito
rs t
ow
ard
s new
onli
ne
mar
ket
pla
ce o
pp
ort
un
itie
s
Mai
nta
ins
a ‘f
orw
ard
-loo
kin
g’
per
spec
tiv
e
Pro
acti
ve
in i
nte
rnat
ional
oppo
rtu
nit
y s
eek
ing
in
In
tern
et-
med
iate
d e
nv
iro
nm
ents
An
tici
pat
es t
he
futu
re o
nli
ne
nee
ds
of
the
firm
Descriptive comment
Level of international
proactiveness
behaviour
Case
Gs001 VSI - - - -
Self-driven and proactive about
travelling the world and bringing new
ideas to life across multiple international markets simultaneously.
Low
Reactive
Case
Gs002 VSI - - - -
National brand that has taken heed of
many new opportunities in international markets through the
Internet.
Moderate
Proactive
Case
Gs003 SI - - - -
Maintains a forward-looking approach
to business but does not actively seek
out new opportunities.
Low
Reactive
Case
Gm004 VSI - - -
Highly international and forward-looking firm which has attained a
global partnership with an
international brand.
Moderate
Proactive
Case
Gm005 VSI -
Actively pursues high-context
cultures (e.g. China & India) and
creates first mover advantages.
Very High
Proactive
Case
Gm006 VSI -
Started a magazine which distributes
over 30, 000 copies internationally.
Creates first-mover advantages.
Very High
Proactive
Case
Ss007 MI - - - - -
Indicates low internationally focused
proactiveness, but anticipates future needs for the growing firm in a digital
space.
Low
Reactive
Case
Ss008 VSI - - -
Proactive in developing new products
to suit a changing market. Proactive
despite some noted barriers to entry.
Moderate
Proactive
Case
Ss009 VSI
First mover competitive advantages
in the development of ‘pay-per-click’
software unique and untried.
Very High
Proactive
Case
Sm010 VSI
Creates first-mover competitive
advantages through Internet-based
customised products for clients.
Very High
Proactive
Case
Sm011 MI - - - - - -
Domestic-based firm indicates no
level of proactiveness.
Low
Reactive
Case
Sm012 VSI - - -
Consistently targets high-context international markets (e.g. China,
Thailand & New Caledonia).
High
Proactive
Aggregate 4/12 5/12 3/12 10/12 5/12 11/12
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, tick represents
‘use’, dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates very high levels of international
technology-related proactiveness.
108
Evaluation of international technology-related proactiveness
The data indicates two aspects of international technology-related proactiveness that
positively influence firm performance: (1) Maintaining a forward-looking perspective
and, (2) Anticipating the future online needs of the firm. These key findings will now be
discussed.
(1) Maintaining a forward-looking perspective
A total of 10 firms in this research (see, Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) highlighted that maintaining a forward-looking
perspective in an online environment was one of the key priorities of the firm.
Participants indicated a forward-looking perspective by being able to clearly articulate the
business’s future direction and anticipate the future market challenges that may face the
business. For instance, a highly international firm such as Case Gm004 (Jeweller), as
shown in Table 4.6, has around 75% international revenue and consistently searches for
international growth opportunity. The international entrepreneur explained that the
business always maintains a forward-looking perspective through growth: ‘...we are
always looking at growth.... Making international decisions you constantly weigh up time
and money for the best rewards – personally and financially. The future in what we do
lies in developing our strategic alliances and in five years we will significantly increase
our international client database more than three-fold...’ (Case Gm004). Similarly, Case
Ss009 (plug-and-play software), as noted in Table 4.6, capitalised on creating a new
software management programs to cater industries beyond just jewellery: ‘Now, there’s
two ways we see ourselves moving forward. One is through international sales in the
jewellery market, the other involves going into a very similar market, which is the bicycle
industry. We believe our product will work in the same way so long as we set it up right
from the outset...’
Being ‘highly proactive’ by developing innovations to create opportunity was an aspect of
proactiveness evident in Case Gm005 (coffee roasting business). The manager explained
that the business had developed a new category of coffee, catering to those markets where
espresso coffee is most favoured; ‘I’ve taken a product that’s top quality and created a
109
new product category. There’s espresso coffee, instant coffee and I’ve made a third
category – espresso instant. Three years in the making and it will only be for sale online
as of next Monday...’ (Case Gm005). By developing new product categories, Case
Gm005 was also anticipating the future online needs of the firm.
(2) Anticipating the future online needs of the firm
Anticipating the future online needs of the firm was evident in 11 out of the 12 firms
interviewed (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010, Sm012). The international entrepreneurs indicating anticipation of the future
online market needs of the firms are alert perceivers of international market opportunity
and in some cases, (Ss008, Ss009, Sm010) as highlighted in Table 4.6, exploit the
markets operating environment to realise business potential. For example, Case Ss008
(no-deposit finance) highlights that the business was essentially established by exploiting
changing market needs. The international entrepreneur took advantage of declining
market value and explained: ‘...I developed the business because the market changed. A
lot of our clients were property developers; they were making big money when the market
was great. Then they stopped having any profit and the biggest issue was selling
property.’ Taking advantage of the unfavourable financial climate opened new
opportunities and possibilities, which were seized by the business: ‘...the benefit [of
exploiting market opportunity] was it created an opportunity for us to set up shop. We
have some pretty significant, not unsurpassable, barriers to entry. But we’ve also got the
first mover advantage...’ (Case Ss008). The data and quotes from interviews supporting
‘Anticipation of the future online needs of the firm’ are shown in Table 4.6 below.
Table 4.6 Supporting quotations for firms anticipating future online needs
Case
code Anticipating future online needs of the firm
Case
Gs001
Currently building an app to cater to the growing online customer clientele.
‘...the Internet will always be important for my type of business. Increasingly, the Internet will become more
important. I am currently building an app... That’s just one way I see y business growing.’
Case
Gs002
Invests in selected resources and runs a ‘tight-ship’ to keep the online side of the business successful.
‘Everything comes from Brisbane. Everything we do is in-house. Including all our photography. It’s the only
way we can remain completely competitive. And while we are still a ‘knock-on-doors’ business our online site
is becoming more important now more than ever.’
Case
Gs003 Development of online payment systems.
‘We are not using the Internet currently the best of our advantage. But we know it’s important and I know that
110
Case
code Anticipating future online needs of the firm
I will have to spend more money and time building my site. My US customers actually want this. An online
payment system would be something I would look into for the future.’
Case
Gm004
Future growth through strategic alliances
‘The Internet is helping us to overcome issues of country of origin in relation to Australian diamonds. You see
the people especially in China are only starting to understand Australian diamonds are fantastic. We have
just signed an international license, growth for us is still important but no through individual stores.’
Case
Gm005
New product development to serve new future market needs.
‘I’ve taken a product that’s top quality and created a new product category. There’s espresso coffee, instant
coffee and I’ve made a third category- espresso instant. This recognition is important for future growth
domestically but also internationally.’
Case
Gm006
Run’s a ‘tight-ship’ and keeps the business lean through online sales sites for international expansion.
‘Retail space right now [makes me] nervous and scared. Everything online is cheaper so people buy online.
We run a tight-ship in the good times, and manage downturns. Our online facilities are second to none in
relation to our competitors; they have to be because the GFC isn’t going away anytime soon.’
Case
Ss007
Increasing online traffic.
‘We have our Internet site and that works well for us. Our goal is to increase online traffic, currently there is
not so much.’
Case
Ss008
Exploiting the market operating environment.
‘...I developed the business because the market changed. A lot of our clients were property developers, they
were making big money when the market was great, and everybody was just rolling in money. Then they
stopped having any profit and the biggest issue was selling property. But the benefit to that was it created an
opportunity for us to set up shop. We have some pretty significant, not unsurpassable, barriers to entry. But
we’ve also got the first mover advantage...’
Case
Ss009
Exploits market opportunities.
‘Now, there’s two ways we see ourselves moving forward. One is through international sales in the jewellery
market, the other involves going into a very similar market, which is the bicycle industry. We believe our
product will work in the same way so long as we set it up right from the outset...’
Case
Sm010
Exploits the market operating environment.
‘...Tourism NZ tried to computerise the reservation and booking engine; it was a nightmare they failed...
There’s no middle man – no interim like Wotif.com; it’s complex but we’ve got it right and that’s unique to us
– we don’t lease our software, we are the first to develop it...’
Case
Sm011 ‘Indicates no anticipation of the future online needs of the firm’
Case
Sm012
Future growth through online brand awareness
‘We’ve got so much interest from a lot of Asian countries. They see the business on the Internet; they come
over and experience it... The Internet has made the world a smaller place... But is very good for brand
awareness and our international expansion to places never before we thought we would go... Egypt, Dubai,
China, Russia...’
Types of proactiveness not identified
The findings from the data indicate that the following factors are not essential
components of proactiveness required for firms operating in an online environment:
creating first-mover advantages in an online space, capitalising on new product
innovation to create opportunity online, being more proactive than competitors towards
new online marketplace opportunities, and being proactive in international opportunity
seeking in Internet-mediated environments. The cases indicating lower levels of
international proactiveness are less inclined to seek out new international opportunities
111
and fail to search for better opportunities presenting themselves abroad. The international
market is full of lucrative, but in many cases non-exploitable, opportunities for small
firms, even though these opportunities may be much more profitable than those existing
in the domestic market.
Overall discussion: International technology-related proactiveness
The findings from the data indicate that: (1) maintaining a forward-looking perspective,
and (2) anticipating the future online needs of the firm are important components of the
international proactiveness of international entrepreneurs in an online environment.
Maintaining a forward-looking opportunity seeking perspective was seen in nine out of
the 12 firms interviewed in this research. (Gs001, Gs002, Gs004, Gs005, Gm006, Ss008,
Sm010, Sm011, Sm012). These nine firms indicated that the primary motivation for
exporting was taking advantage of lucrative international opportunities. Firms stimulated
by this opportunity-seeking factor proactively devoted time and effort to systematically
tracking down international opportunities, rather than merely discovering them, ranking
opportunities in accordance with firm resources, and selecting those opportunities which
best fit with the firm’s own vision and international market objectives. The findings also
indicate that those firms with manufacturing sites close to export markets (Gs002,
Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) are more inclined to
engage proactively in internationalisation. Overall, Figure 4.3 shows that firms in close
physical proximity to international markets are very likely to consider their export
activities as merely an extension of domestic business activities and are more likely to
proactively commit resources to those international markets.
Figure 4.3 International technology-related proactiveness and international markets
(i) Anticipates the future
online needs of the firm
(ii) Maintains a ‘forward-
looking’ perspective
International
technology-related
PROACTIVENESS
(i) Anticipates the future
online needs of the firm
(ii) Maintains a ‘forward-
looking’ perspective
+
Markets of close
geographic proximity
Markets of distant
geographic proximity
+ + +
Note. Figure 4.3 shows a strong relationship between international technology-related proactiveness and
markets of close geographic proximity. Therefore firms are less inclined to engage proactively in
geographically distant markets despite the arguments that the Internet breaks down barriers.
112
4.3.3 Firm-level resource 3: International technology-related risk-taking propensity
The next concept to be addressed is international technology-related risk-taking
propensity. To address risk-taking propensity, all firms were asked: (i) to comment on
whether the firm had made any recent investments in costly international Internet-based
projects, and (ii) whether the firm would be specifically targeting any new international
markets via the Internet within the next two years. The questions in relation to
international technology-related risk-taking propensity can be seen in Appendix 1.
Two firms (Ss009, Sm010), as shown in column (A) of Table 4.7 below, viewed
international technology-related risk-taking propensity to be ‘very strongly important’.
Two firms (Gm005, Ss008) indicated ‘strong importance’, while a further three firms
(Gm004, Gm006, Sm012) indicated ‘moderate importance’; ‘limited importance’ of
international technology-related risk-taking propensity was noted in five firms (Gs001,
Gs002, Gs003, Ss007, Sm011). Nine cases (Gs001, Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), as shown in column (B), indicated the ability of the firm
to commit resources to Internet-mediated projects where the risk of failure was moderate.
Taking risks to try new Internet technologies was noted by two firms in this research
(Ss009, Sm010), as shown in column (C). Similarly, pursuing risky new initiatives in
highly dynamic Internet environments was identified in Cases Ss009 and Sm010, in
column (D).
An analysis of risk-taking in firms indicates that very high levels of international
technology-related risk-taking propensity, as shown in column (E), was noted in Cases
Ss009 and Sm010. Moderate levels of risk was noted in four firms (Gm004, Gm005,
Ss008, Sm012), while low risk-taking behaviour in international business decision-
making processes was identified in six out of the 12 firms in this study (Gs001, Gs002,
Gs003, Gm006, Ss007, Sm011).
113
Table 4.7 Levels of international technology-related risk-taking propensity
Type of risk-taking explicit in firm
processes in an Internet-based
environment
A B C D E
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f ri
sk-
tak
ing p
ropen
sity
Co
mm
its
reso
urc
es t
o I
nte
rnet
-
med
iate
d p
roje
cts
wh
ere
there
is a
ris
k o
f fa
ilu
re
Tak
es r
isk
to
try
new
In
tern
et
tech
nolo
gie
s
Pu
rsues
ris
ky
new
init
iati
ves
in
hig
hly
dyn
amic
Inte
rnet
env
iro
nm
ents
Descriptive comment
Level of
international risk-
taking propensity
Case
Gs001 LI - -
Does not indicate risk in making
internationalisation decisions. The Internet is merely seen as a tool for communication.
Low
Case
Gs002 LI - -
Commits resources to improvement of the website, for example SEO functions, but is not
actively taking risk in online environments. Low
Case
Gs003 LI - - -
Risk-averse to Internet use for international
market growth and performance outcomes. Limited resources for digital processes.
Low
Case
Gm004 MI - -
Risk-taking in developing new international
partnerships in an online space. Takes risk in
investing considerable amounts in online projects.
Moderate
Case
Gm005 SI - -
Takes high risks in offline environments, but in
an online space taking risk and making
investment are not priorities of this firm. Moderate
Case
Gm006 MI - -
Indicates low risk-taking propensity in an online environment. Pursues new initiatives
with an online trade publication/magazine. Low
Case
Ss007 LI - - -
No indication of risk-taking in an Internet
space. Resource commitment limited to domestic offline marketing activities.
Low
Case
Ss008 SI - -
New product development and risk evident in
the use of the Internet as the primary platform
for B-to-C communication with the client base. Moderate
Case
Ss009 VSI
High risk-taking levels evident in the
development of software used industry-wide.
High resource level commitment to the
product.
Very High
High-tech
Case
Sm010 VSI
Developed costly online/booking reservation
system – ‘one-stop-shop’ for clients. The
Internet is the only touch point for clients.
Very High
High-tech
Case
Sm011 LI - - -
Firm activities indicate very minimal levels of
risk-taking in online environments. Portable
Internet scanners are the extent to which
technology is adopted.
Low
Case
Sm012 MI - -
Uses the Internet to target countries of close proximity to the home market. Commits large
amounts of resources to online functions and
software for the business.
Moderate
Aggregate 9/12 2/12 2/12
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, LI = Limited
importance, tick represents ‘use’, dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates very high
levels of international technology-related risk-taking propensity, High-tech indicates the firm in primarily
exists in an online space.
114
Evaluation of international technology-related risk-taking propensity
The data identifies one key factor in relation to how international technology-related risk-
taking propensity can positively influence firm performance: (1) Commitment of
resources to Internet-mediated projects where the risk of failure is moderate.
(1) Commitment of resources to Internet-mediated projects where the risk of
failure is moderate
Nine out of the 12 firms interviewed (Gs001, Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008,
Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) demonstrated the ability to commit resources to Internet-mediated
projects where there is an evident risk of failure (see Table 4.7). For example, Case Ss009
(plug-and-play software), suggested that investing large amounts of capital into designing
and developing jewellery management software programs for the US market specifically
was a large risk. For example, the founder and managing director of Case Ss009 stated:
‘I’m thinking the US is definitely our market, it turns out Canada – even though it is a
fraction of the size of the US. It’s just because they’re more willing to do online business,
and don’t expect you to be down the road. So by us coming in with a model saying well
we’re not down the road – it didn’t work. We invested a lot and lost a lot in the US.’ The
case evidence also suggests that committing resources to Internet projects with a risk of
failure is an opportunity-seeking activity. For instance, Case Sm012 (food and beverage
provider) developed a website platform to cater to the interest the business had received
in the Chinese market. The co-founder and manager of Case Sm012 said that: ‘Everything
is risky because you’re dealing with people who don’t speak your language...I developed
a site for the Chinese market because we have huge interest in this market. I also believe
we will expand into China at a quicker rate than any other market, so I don’t mind
spending the time and money to advance technologies in this aspect.’
Case Ss009 has also invested and committed a high level of resources to the development
of software programs and customer relationship management systems, which have
revolutionised the operating environment in which these SMEs compete. For instance,
Case Ss009 (plug-and-play software) spoke of the business’s commitment of resources,
both financial and human, to re-develop a product for the online market: ‘...we went
115
purely web-based before anyone had understood the concept of cloud...we were
redeveloping a product that was selling really well...the risk wasn’t financial in a
sense...the risk was, well what if we do all this and we’re in the exact same position as
what we were before and I’ve just wasted $1 million in development...’ Similarly, Case
Sm010 (NZ travel provider) indicated that the business has faced several risks due to the
online nature of selling travel purely in an online space. For example, ‘...one of the
biggest risks that we have as a business is that we rely on our distribution system all in an
online fashion, which is travel agents... Our power is that we are specialists but it makes
us vulnerable. We have invested millions into our booking engine...’ Case Sm010 also
stated that the business was currently developing a ‘direct to the public site’, where
clients themselves could gather information, book and pay for New Zealand travel in
essentially one ‘click’.
Types of risk not identified
The types of international technology-related risk-taking propensities not found to be
important for the cases in this research are: taking risks to try new Internet technologies,
and pursuing risky new initiatives in highly dynamic Internet environments. It can be seen
in Table 4.7 that two firms (Ss009, Sm010) take risks within the firm and the industry to
try out new and untried Internet technologies. Both firms pursue risky new initiatives in
highly dynamic Internet environments. Both Cases Ss009 and Sm010 are indicative of
highly complex, high-technology pure.com firms, but are outliers when compared with
the cases presented in Table 4.7. However, it can be said that these types of risk may be
more important for pure.com firms internationally. The previous literature (Calof, 1993;
Westhead et al., 2001; Ruzzier et al., 2006) also states that size can have an impact on the
firm’s decision to internationalise, given that SMEs are unique in that they face risks,
typically because of their size, as well as their process of learning. The findings of this
research indicate, however, that size of the firm has no influence on the firm’s
international risk-taking propensity, but rather the level of ‘perceived’ risk is the
operating environment is the critical factor which influences the firm’s overall
international business decisions.
116
Overall discussion: International technology-related risk-taking propensity
The findings from the data show that: (1) commitment of resources to Internet-mediated
projects where the risk of failure is moderate was most frequently highlighted by case
firms as an important component of international technology-related risk-taking
propensity in an online environment. It has been suggested that the Internet can also assist
in reducing the perceived risk associated with strategic decisions in the
internationalisation of the firm, considering that the internationalisation processes of the
firm are often complex with a high degree of risk in failure (Mathews & Healy, 2007).
The findings of this research indicate that while the Internet has had an impact on
reducing risk in internationalisation, it has now created a perception in which
international entrepreneurial managers now view internationalisation as a low-risk
business practice. This is because the Internet has negated the traditional barriers faced by
firms in the internationalisation process. Figure 4.4 shows that Internet, international
marketing capabilities have had a positive effect on lowering the perceived risk in
internationalisation and negate key risk factors such as high uncertainty and costs, low
information and knowledge and the presence of psychic distance factors.
Figure 4.4 Relationship between the Internet and perceived risk reduction
Internationalisation
HIGH risk
RISK FACTORS
HIGH uncertainty
High cost
LOW information
LOW knowledge
Psychic distance factors
Perception of
internationalisation LOW
risk
International entrepreneurs
now perceive
internationalisation as a
low risk activity
+
Positive
impact
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
Internet capabilities negate key risk factors
-
Negates
Note. Figure 4.4 shows that Internet, international marketing capabilities have a positive impact on the
internationalisation of the firm, lowering the risk factors and barriers to internationalisation. As such,
international entrepreneurs now perceive internationalisation as a low risk activity, limiting the risk
factors. Thus the nature of internationalisation in this new digital age has changed.
117
4.3.4 Firm-level resource 4: Technology-related international vision
The next concept to be addressed is technology-related international vision. All firms
were asked to comment on the following: (i) whether the firm intended to target any new
international markets within the next two years, (ii) if the firm aspired to increase the
number of international customers and if the Internet would play a role in this process;
and, (iii) where the international entrepreneur envisaged the firm to be in five years’ time.
The questions in relation to technology-related international vision can be seen in
Appendix 1.
One firm (Ss009), as shown in column (A) of Table 4.8, viewed innovation to be ‘very
strongly important’. Six firms (Gs001, Gm004, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Sm010) indicated
‘moderate importance’, while a further five firms (Gs001, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011), indicated ‘limited importance’ of international
technology-related vision. Three firms in this research (Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) denote
that the business had encompassed an international and technologically focused mindset
from the firm’s inception, as noted in column (B). The firm’s ability to envision future
international business through the Internet, as shown in column (C) was noted in five
firms (Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012). A further three firms (Gm005, Gm006,
Sm012), as shown in column (D), state that the firm’s mission statement is geared
towards international outcomes. Procuring the best resources at the least expense in an
online environment, as shown in column (E), was also noted in 11 firms in this research
(Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011,
Sm012). A further 10 firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008,
Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) highlighted that the firm aspires to increase the number of
international customers as seen in column (F).
The level of innovation, as noted in column (G), shows very high levels in five firms
(Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), high levels in four firms (see, Gs001, Gs002,
Gs003, Gm004), moderate levels in one firm (Ss008), and low levels in a further two
firms (Ss007, Sm011).
118
Table 4.8 Levels of technology-related international vision
Type of technology-related international vision explicit within
the firm
A B C D E F G
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f
inte
rnat
ional
vis
ion
En
com
pas
ses
an i
nte
rnat
ion
al
and
tec
hn
olo
gic
al m
ind
set
fro
m t
he
ou
tset
Th
e ab
ilit
y t
o e
nv
isio
n
inte
rnat
ional
bu
sin
ess
/ In
tern
et
exp
ansi
on
in
th
e fu
ture
Th
e bu
sines
s’s
mis
sio
n
stat
emen
t is
gea
red
to
war
ds
inte
rnat
ional
ou
tco
mes
Pro
curi
ng
th
e b
est
reso
urc
es a
t
the
leas
t ex
pen
se i
n a
n o
nli
ne
env
iro
nm
ent
Th
e bu
sines
s as
pir
es t
o g
row
inte
rnat
ional
cust
om
ers
in a
n
Inte
rnet
env
iro
nm
ent
Descriptive comment
Level of technology-
related
international vision
Case
Gs001 MI - - -
Maintains a strong focus on customers
in international markets although was not international initially.
High
Case
Gs002 LI - - -
Maintains an international vision through Internet technologies rather than
in an offline space. High
Case
Gs003 LI - - -
Envisions the international customer
database to grow through the Internet, specifically throughout the US.
High
Case
Gm004 MI - - -
International vision in this firm is the
key link to aggressive international
opportunity seeking. High
Case
Gm005 LI -
International vision is represented in
the leadership aspirations and formal
titles of management. Very High
Case
Gm006 MI -
The focus of the business is on
exporting, the development of
international resources. Very High
Case
Ss007 MI - - - - -
Indicates non-existent levels of
international vision, remains domestic Low
Case
Ss008 MI - - -
Maintains a focus on providing clients
with the best deals sourced by management. Aims invest more in the
Internet.
Moderate
Case
Ss009 SI -
Management views the world as their
market rather than specific segments.
Highly visionary founder. Very High
Case
Sm010 MI -
Envisions international opportunity
and capitalises on market deficiencies
to be achieve international success. Very High
Case
Sm011 LI - - - -
Primarily a domestic firm with some international customers but does not
aspire to grow international clients. Low
Case
Sm012 LI
Allocates beyond sufficient human and
financial resources to achieving
international outcomes. Very High
Aggregate 3/12 5/12 3/12 11/12 10/12
Note. SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, LI = Limited importance, tick represents ‘use’,
dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates very high levels of international technology-
related vision.
119
Evaluation of technology-related international vision
Two key factors have been identified from the data in relation to how international
technology-related proactiveness influences firm performance: (1) Procuring the best
resources at the least expense in an online environment, and (2) Aspirations of business
growth through Internet-based platforms.
(1) Procuring the best resources at the least expense in an online environment
(efficiency seeking)
Procuring the best resources at the least expense was highlighted as being important in 11
out of the 12 firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010, Sm011, Sm012). For example, Case Gm006 (labelling and promotional
merchandise) said: ‘I’ve always had the belief that if you run a tight ship in the good
times then in the bad times you don’t have to adjust your business to compensate for a
downturn. So, from the get-go we’ve always had a very tight ship and run a low-overhead
operation, sourcing our products from China, which has made us very cash positive.’
Overall, the findings of this section on technology-related international vision indicate
that international entrepreneurs (six in total) from the goods industry (Gs001, Gs002,
Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006) show higher levels of technology-related international
vision, as opposed to the three firms within the services industry (Ss009, Sm101, Sm012).
(2) Actively seeks to grow the business through Internet-based platforms (growth
seeking)
A total of 10 firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010, Sm011, Sm012) affirmed that aspiring to increase the firm’s number of
international customers through Internet-based platforms was the primary goal of the
business. For instance, Case Gm005 (coffee roasting business) said that that business was
looking to implement new Internet platforms within the firm to secure new business
opportunities within the Indian market: ‘India is big on the Internet, so we will probably
invest more. Have we done a lot of work on it? No. But we envision international growth
throughout India and China. We will not invest in the Internet in China as it too
120
complicated. They shut down Google over there.’ Aspirations for international growth via
Internet platforms was also noted in Case Gm006 (labelling and promotional
merchandise), which has invested significantly in Internet-based industry publications for
international prospecting purposes. The CEO of Case Gm006 stated that, ‘Successful
projection of that message [brand message] is a significant driver of revenue. Our
philosophy is YOUR BRAND IS OUR BUSINESS…we provide cost-effective designs and
solutions to an impressively wide array of business sectors, via the Internet, ultimately we
still want to grow.’ This international scope of the firm means that the business is
constantly evaluating international market opportunities and is essentially open to
business no matter where it exists in the world. Similarly, Case Sm012’s (food and
beverage provider) vision is ‘To be a global leader in retail food, coffee and franchising’.
The overall vision of business also indicates the position the international entrepreneur in
wanting the business to occupy majority of the international market. Essentially,
international vision in this instance is providing international entrepreneurs with a
framework of where there business is going. For instance, Case Ss009 (plug-and-play
software), stated that, ‘We built it [the business] from the outset to go international
because we are jewellery specific...that’s our point of difference so we’ll go worldwide.
So yeah, we knew straight away that overseas was our solution.’ Being internationally
focused, Case Ss009 looked for new opportunities within the industry to fill a niche
market with a new product being – self-operational inventory management systems for
the jewellery industry.
Types of technology-related international vision not identified
The findings from the data indicate that: (1) encompassing an international and
technological mindset from the outset, having the ability to envision increasing
international business through the Internet, and (2) ensuring that the business’s mission
is geared towards international outcomes are not essential components of international
vision required for firms operating in an Internet environment. This is because the
Internet has negated the need for traditional requirements, such as international vision, in
the internationalisation process.
121
Overall discussion: Technology-related international vision
The findings from the data indicate two important components of technology-related
international vision: (1) procuring the best resources at the least expense in an online
environment (efficiency seeking), and (2) actively seeks to grow the business through
Internet-based platforms (growth seeking). The findings indicate that the Internet is
having an impact on international entrepreneurs’ perceptions of the level and degree to
which international vision is perceptible in business practice. Some scholars (see, Autio et
al., 2000; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Johnson, 2004; Andersson & Evangelista, 2006)
suggest that managers with an international mindset and increased levels of international
vision are more global in nature and tend to perform better than those firms without an
international vision from business inception. For example, in a multi-method study of
senior managers active in international markets, Knight (2001) found that entrepreneurial
mind-set and vision was critical for firms in engaging in challenging activities associated
with entering new international markets.
It has also been suggested that international vision is an important aspect of a firm’s
aggressive international opportunity-seeking behaviour (Autio et al., 2000). The findings
of this study argue that the nature and the level of international vision require for a firm’s
successful Internet internationalisation have changed. That is, efficiency seeking in
procuring resources and growth seeking in online environments are important
components enabling international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and
exploitation in firms.
The Internet has also negated the need for high levels of the traditional components of
international vision, such as the mission statement being geared towards international
outcomes, because the nature of international business has changed. The Internet has
negated the need for traditional requirements, such as international vision, in the
internationalisation process. Figure 4.5 illustrates the finding that the international vision
of the founder is important for both small- and medium-sized firms from both the goods
and services sectors, suggesting that international vision is a key factor influencing
international entrepreneurial SMEs operating in Internet environments.
122
Figure 4.5 Representation of the findings of technology-related international vision
Note. Figure 4.5 shows that the Internet has influenced the level of international vision in international
entrepreneurial firms. The Internet has negated the need for high levels of international vision because the
nature of international business has changed in an online context.
EFFICIENCY SEEKING
Procurement of resources
International
entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
GROWTH SEEKING
Online environments
Perceived international outcomes: Number of international export markets
and the proportion of revenue coming from international customers
123
4.3.5 Firm-level resource 5: International business experience
The next concept to be examined is international business experience. All firms were
asked about the following issues: (i) the level of education attained by the international
entrepreneur, (ii) previous international business experience where the manager had
previously worked for an international firm, (iii) number of years’ experience in the
current industry, (iv) number of years’ experience in the current firm, and (v) previous
experience of working with the Internet. These questions can be seen in Appendix 1.
One firm (Gm005), as shown in column (A) of Table 4.9, viewed international business
experience through experiential knowledge related to Internet technology in international
markets to be ‘very strongly important’. One firm (Sm010) indicated ‘strong importance’,
while a further ten firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm011, Sm012), indicated the ‘limited importance’ of experiential knowledge. Five
international entrepreneurs in this research (Gs001, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Sm012), as
seen in column (B), achieved a certificate level qualification, while a further two
managers (Ss007, Sm010), as seen in column (C), obtained a technical college/TAFE
equivalent diploma. Three managers, as noted in column (D), were awarded Bachelor’s
Degrees (Gm005, Ss008, Ss009). International business experience of living abroad and
working in another firm, as seen in column (E), was noted in one firm (Sm010). Seven
managers (Gs001, Gs002, Gm005, Ss007, Ss008, Sm010, Sm012), as noted in column
(F), indicated international business experience of working in another firm. International
business experience of working in another international firm, as indicated in column (G),
was seen in one firm (Sm010). High levels of international business experience, as seen in
column (H), were seen in three firms (Gm005, Ss008, Sm010), and low levels in nine
firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm006, Ss007, Ss009, Sm011, Sm012).
124
Table 4.9 Levels of international business experience
Types of international business experience identified
A B C D E F G H
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f
inte
rnat
ional
bu
sin
ess
exp
erie
nce
Ach
ieved
a c
erti
fica
te l
evel
qual
ific
atio
n
Ob
tain
ed a
tec
hnic
al c
oll
ege/
TA
FE
eq
uiv
alen
t d
iplo
ma
Ob
tain
ed a
Bac
hel
or’
s
deg
ree
Inte
rnat
ional
ex
per
ience
of
liv
ing a
bro
ad a
nd w
ork
ing
in
ano
ther
fir
m
Inte
rnat
ional
ex
per
ience
of
wo
rkin
g i
n a
noth
er f
irm
Exp
erie
nce
of
wo
rkin
g i
n
ano
ther
fir
m o
n I
nte
rnet
-
bas
ed p
roje
cts
Descriptive comment
Level of
international
business experience
Case
Gs001 LI - - - -
23 years’ experience in the naturopath industry but has never worked in an
international firm. Low
Case
Gs002 LI - - - - -
Previous experience of working for a current
substantial competitor. Case Gs002 left the business to start his own business, relying on
the little knowledge he had gathered.
Low
Case
Gs003 LI - - - - - -
‘The power learning when you reach a
roadblock...’ Case Gs003 started working for the family business early with no degrees or
formal qualifications.
Low
Case
Gm004 LI - - - - - -
‘Essentially learning as you go...’ After seeing a commercial about jewellery making
as a young boy, Case GM004 pursued his
dream with no degrees or experience.
Low
Case
Gm005 VSI - - - -
‘Everything comes with experience...’
Started out working in a competitor’s
company while studying for a business
degree the left to pursue his goals.
High
Case
Gm006 LI - - - - -
An entrepreneur who failed his HSC. With
no University degree the founder started off
as a hairdresser and started the current business out of his parents’ back-yard shed.
Low
Case
Ss007 LI - - -
Started in the business in 1986, and has
extensive experience of working in similar firms, but no related international or
technological experience in present.
Low
Case
Ss008 LI - - -
Obtained a science degree before moving
into the banking field. Has extensive experience working for other internationally
focused firms.
High
Case
Ss009 LI - - - - -
Completed two degrees before starting work
in the family software business. Has no previous international business experience.
Low
Case
Sm010 SI - -
‘Having experience is critical...’ The founder
has worked in NZ, US and the UK
previously. High
Case
Sm011 LI - - - - - -
Indicates no level of formal qualifications or
international experience. Low
Case
Sm012 LI - - - -
Obtained a certificate in hair dressing prior
to working in the current firm. Has no international experience.
Low
5/12 2/12 3/12 1/12 7/12 1/12
Aggregate
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, LI = Limited importance, tick represents ‘use’,
dashed line (-) = Non-use.
125
Evaluation of international business experience
The findings from the data indicate that: (1) International experience of working in
another firm is an important factor in influencing the firm’s international market
performance.
(1) International experience of working in another firm
International business experience of working in another firm, but not living abroad, was
identified in seven out of the 12 cases in this research (Gs001, Gs002, Gm005, Ss007,
Ss008, Sm010, Sm012). It was noted that this type of international exposure from
previous employment had provided international entrepreneurs with the resources and
knowledge to be successful in the current firm. For instance, Case Sm010 (NZ travel
provider) stated that his experience of working in another firm in New Zealand provided
the skills he required to succeed in his current business venture: ‘...experience is critical.
Having developed projects in the US and NZ markets has allowed me to use what I’ve
learnt – good and bad – to give everything my best shot at this business. Previous
experience is important, but experience and being open to experience as you go is more
important.’ Similarly, Case Gm005 (coffee roasting business), said that business
experience is an important quality: ‘Everything comes with experience. The one thing that
I can't substitute for, and I say this to everyone, I cannot give you business experience...
You learn more from what people do wrong and learn less from people that do things
right.’
Types of international business experience not identified
Achieving a certificate level qualification or technical college diploma; obtaining a
Bachelor’s Degree; international experience of living abroad and working in another
firm; and experience of working in another firm on Internet-mediated projects are not
essential components of experiential knowledge related to Internet technology and
international markets. One entrepreneur, (Sm010), had gained international experience of
living abroad and working in another firm. Similarly, Case Sm010 also indicated previous
experience of working in another firm on Internet-based projects. This is not an
126
unforeseen finding, however, as the Internet has only evolved into an important
international business tool within the last decade. Therefore, learning and experience with
Internet-based projects is only starting to take place.
The literature (see, Baruch, 1997) often states that higher education, such as obtaining a
bachelor’s degree, is a characteristic of successful high technology-mediated
entrepreneurs. Scholars (see, Bloodgood, Sapienza, & Almeida, 1996; Cavusgil, 1984;
Reid, 1980) have also suggested a link between higher education, international experience
and greater international openness. The findings indicate, however, that out of 12
international entrepreneurs, only three (see, Gm005, Ss008, Ss009) had obtained a
university-level qualification such as an undergraduate bachelor’s degree. Case Gm005
(coffee roasting business) spoke of his bachelor’s degree merely as a ‘tool’:
‘...Entrepreneur is way of life. So, tools, I go to university, I get basic tools to use. So I do
an undergraduate degree... All university can do for me is improve my tool. My tool gets
better but I don’t have experience...’ Although, obtaining a bachelor’s degree seems to be
important in the international success of Case Gmn005, the findings indicate that
certificate and diploma courses are more important in SMEs, and seem to matter more
than university degrees; although these courses do not influence the firm’s progression
into international markets.
Overall discussion of international business experience
The findings of the data indicate that: (1) international experience of working in another
firm was the most important form of international business experience. The findings of
the data also indicate a lack of specialised education in Internet technology and
international markets. This means that the lack of formal qualifications, such as
certificate, technical college/TAFE equivalent and bachelor’s degrees, has meant that
explicit knowledge and skills are not acquired which could be useful to international
entrepreneurs. One explanation or key reason for this finding may be the lag in Internet-
related programs in the pre-Internet era, prior to the dot.com boom, leading to a lack of
knowledge in this space. The findings of the data indicate, however, that the formal
qualifications of international entrepreneurs have not influenced the international
performance of the firms in this research.
127
The findings of this study can be contrasted with the findings of Wiklund and Shepherd
(2003) that growth aspirations are higher for entrepreneurs with higher levels of education
and experience. The findings of this study concur with the argument that growth occurs at
a faster rate and more efficiently in firms with higher levels of prior international business
experience, but is not correlated with the formal qualifications of international
entrepreneurs. Overall, it can be seen that prior international experience of international
entrepreneurs is a critical component of the international entrepreneur’s human capital,
and is important for internationalisation in an online environment. The Internet allows for
addressing customer needs regardless of geographic proximity, yet the findings indicate
overall that the successful exploitation of these new international market opportunities
necessitates the need for learning experience in an online context.
The findings of the data show that international entrepreneurs are learning to successfully
grow their businesses internationally by working in, and initiating, new international
business through learning and through previous experience in international business. It
can be said that as international entrepreneurial learning takes place, the international
business experience of the entrepreneur grows. The intellectual wealth accumulated by
international entrepreneurs is allowing the wealth of experience to grow over time,
enabling international entrepreneurs to better identify and exploit international online
opportunities as a result of knowledge and experience development. The experiences
gained by working in international firms domestically also aids in reducing international
entrepreneurs’ perceptions of risk and uncertainty, as shown in Figure 4.6, which
ultimately influences the firm’s internationalisation behaviours and performance, such as
the proportion of revenue coming from international customers and the number of
international export markets.
128
Figure 4.6 International business experience, opportunity recognition and
international outcomes
Note. Figure 4.6 indicates that prior international experience relevant to the current industry reduces the
constraints associated with international opportunity seeking in an international online environment, thus
increasing the perception that the firm will be achieve successful international market performance.
Domain relevant prior
international business experience
Decreases
International opportunity-
recognition constraints
(i) Seeking information
(ii) Gathering information
(iii) Analysing information
Increases
Perceptions in the efficiency with
which international entrepreneurial
efforts translate to international
performance outcomes
Enhances
129
4.3.6 Capability 1: Internet, international marketing capabilities
The first firm-level capability to be discussed is Internet, international marketing
capabilities. To address Internet, international marketing capabilities all firms were asked:
(i) to indicate which Internet-based technology mediums the firm is currently using, (ii)
the extent to which the Internet is generating international awareness for the firm, and
(iii) whether the firm places a strong importance on technological leadership. The
questions in relation to Internet, international marketing capabilities can be seen in
Appendix 1.
Six firms, (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009), as shown in column (A) of
Table 4.10, viewed Internet, international marketing capabilities overall to be ‘very
strongly important’. Five firms (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Sm010, Sm012) indicated
‘moderate importance’, while only one firm (Sm011) indicated ‘limited importance.’ All
12 firms indicated that the firm uses email applications, column (B), and has an official
company website, column (C). Use of the Internet for marketing and advertising
purposes, as seen in column (D), was noted in 11 firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004,
Gm005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012). Nine firms (Gs001, Gs002,
Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011), as seen in column (E), used the
Internet as a platform for online sales, while eight firms (Gs002, Gm004, Gm005,
Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011), as seen in column (F), provided after-sales
service via the Internet. Use of the Internet for market research purposes, as seen in
column (G), was identified in seven firms (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010, Sm012), while identification of international competitors on the Internet, as seen
in column (H), was seen in only three firms (Gm005, Ss009, Sm010).
All 12 firms participating in this research indicated the very strong importance of the
following Internet-related marketing capabilities: email applications (column B) (i), and
an official company website (column C) (i). Seven firms indicated the very strong
importance of Internet marketing and advertising (column D) (i): Gs002, Gm004, Gm005,
Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm012) and seven firms indicated the very strong importance of
online sales (column E) (i): Gs001, Gs002, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010). Use
130
of the Internet for after sales service was identified as being very strongly important in
five firms (column F) (i): Gs002, Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010), for market research
purposes in two firms (column G) (i): Gm006, Sm012), and to identify international
competitors in three firms (column H) (i): Gm004, Ss009, Sm010). Very high levels of
Internet use and integration was present in four firms (column I: Gm004, Gm005, Ss009,
Sm010), high levels in two firms (Gm006, Sm012), moderate levels in four firms (see,
Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Sm011), and low levels of Internet use and integration in only one
firm (Ss007).
131
Table 4.10 Internet usage and Internet, international marketing capabilities
Level of importance Use or non-use of Internet-related technologies
LOWInternet intensity levels HIGH
Level of Internet
integration & comment
A B C D E F G H B(i) C(i) D(i) E(i) F(i) G(i) H(i) I
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce
over
all
Em
ail
Web
site
Mar
ket
ing &
adv
erti
sing
On
line
sale
s
Aft
er s
ales
ser
vic
e
Mar
ket
res
earc
h
Iden
tify
inte
rnat
ional
com
pet
ito
rs
Em
ail
Web
site
Mar
ket
ing &
adv
erti
sing
On
line
sale
s
Aft
er s
ales
ser
vic
e
Mar
ket
res
earc
h
Iden
tify
inte
rnat
ional
com
pet
ito
rs
Case
Gs001 VSI - - - VSI VSI SI VSI SI MI NI
MODERATE Total dependency on
email, website and online
sales functions.
Case
Gs002 VSI - - VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI SI SI
MODERATE
Heavy dependency on
email, website and online marketing.
Case
Gs003 VSI - - - - VSI VSI MI NI NI LI NI
MODERATE
Limited Internet use. Only
email and website functions used.
Case
Gm004 MI - VSI VSI VSI SI SI SI VSI
VERY HIGH
Dependent on the Internet
and software management
systems.
Case
Gm005 MI VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI SI NI
VERY HIGH
Sophisticated website,
personalisation through
online sales.
Case
Gm006 MI - VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI SI
HIGH Heavy use of the Internet
for international market
management.
Case
Ss007 VSI - - - - VSI VSI NI MI NI MI NI
LOW
Minimal use of the
Internet. Limited to email and a website.
Case
Ss008 VSI - VSI VSI VSI VSI SI SI NI
HIGH
Gains exposure from the
website. Heavy use of online marketing.
Case
Ss009 VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI VSI SI VSI
VERY HIGH
Total dependency of
Internet technologies.
Pure.com firm.
Case
Sm010 MI VSI VSI SI VSI VSI MI VSI
VERY HIGH
Total dependency on
Internet technologies.
Pure.com firm.
Case
Sm011 LI - - - VSI VSI MI MI MI NI NI
MODERATE Limited integration of the
Internet. Email and website
functions only.
Case
Sm012 MI - - - VSI VSI VSI LI NI VSI NI
HIGH Moderate Internet use.
Important for online
marketing.
12 12 11 9 8 7 3
Aggregate
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, LI = Limited importance, NI
= No importance, i = Importance, tick represents ‘use’, dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates
very high levels of Internet usage and Internet, international marketing capabilities.
132
Evaluation of Internet, international marketing capabilities
Three key findings from the data were identified in relation to how Internet, international
marketing capabilities influence firm performance: (1) The use of email and company
websites, (2) Marketing and advertising capabilities, (3) The Internet as an online sales
mechanism, (4) After sale service, and (5) Market research capabilities. These key
findings will be discussed next.
(1) The use of email and official company websites
The findings from the data indicate that email remains the primary mechanism used by
businesses to facilitate international market transactions and to maintain customer and
distributor relationships. This is not surprising given the vast geographical distances
between firms and their export markets within this research. For example, Case Gs001
(heath and wellbeing services), as seen in Table 4.11, explained that, ‘...quite simply, my
business wouldn’t run without email. It’s my primary source for communication with my
suppliers and also distributors.’ Email has also been used by clients as a check-out
system where purchase orders are made. For example, one quote shows that Case Gs002
(textiles wholesaler) often had clients who used Email to place orders; ‘Most orders we
handle are so large – wholesale, that customers don’t use our check-out system. Instead
they email us...’ The official company website has also been identified as an important
component in the internationalisation of the firm.
In international markets, the official company website is an important tool that
international customers use to evaluate a purchase via the Internet. For example, Case
Gm004 (Jeweller) explains that the company website is an important part of the business,
enabling communication with customers across international markets:‘...Email and our
website assists to reaffirm what we do... We receive many letters of gratitude from our
website. I guess our website also appeals to customers much further away. Who thought
we would be creating custom pieces of jewellery for our client in Russia...’
Disintermediation of information was also identified in firms which had a website and
online sales system. For example, Case Sm010 (NZ travel provider) explained the
concept of disintermediation: ‘Our customers can do everything on our website. Look for
133
relevant NZ information as well as book tours, accommodation and flights. There is no
middle man. Our website is the between buyer and seller. That’s because we have spent
millions developing, not leasing our own software.’ The supporting quotes for the use of
Email and websites within firms can be seen in Table 4.11.
Table 4.11 Supporting quotations for the use of email and websites
Case
code Email (E) and Websites (W) in firms indicating ‘very strong’ importance
Case
Gs001
Uses email frequently and runs two website landing pages with a third in development to cater for
different regions
E: ‘...Quite simply... My business wouldn’t run without email. It’s my primary source for communication with
my suppliers and also distributors.’
W: ‘... I’ve been creating another website landing page, demand is just so big – one that is multi-lingual. I
can run my business from anywhere in the world because I’ve got my mobile phone and my laptop, it’s very
cool...’
Case
Gs002
Email becomes one of the most important aspects of the business combined with the website landing
page
E: ‘Most orders we handle are so large – wholesale, that customers don’t use our check-out system. Instead
they Email us...’
W: ‘We get told by almost everyone in the industry that we have by far the best website. And we’ve done it all
ourselves...WE hired an IT guy and that’s what he does. His job is to work at making that aspect of the
business consistently better.’
Case
Gs003
Email and website are important functions of the business international reach to the US market
E: ‘Are there any businesses these days that aren’t using the email? We couldn’t survive without it. It’s as
simple as that really.’
W: ‘...our website is important to us because it allows us to connect with customers in the US. They can
actually see the quality of the products we are offering...’
Case
Gm004
The company website assists in international market development in geography distant countries
W: ‘...email and our website assists to reaffirm what we do... We receive many letters of gratitude from our
website. I guess our website also appeals to customers much further away. Who thought we would be creating
custom pieces of jewellery for our client in Russia...’
Case
Gm005
The website ensures customer focus by guaranteeing receipt of goods if orders are placed before 9am
W: ‘...you know our website is fantastic? Our coffee website is one of (if not) the best in the country. We
deliver to some of the biggest offices in the country... order before 9am will be delivered to you on the same
day...’
Case
Gm006
The website has assisted the business in securing corporate clients worldwide
W: ‘...online search engines and optimisation play a big part in our business. We have an online ordering
system and a website landing pages that has helped us land some very big contacts in relation to corporate
divisions all over the globe.’
Case
Ss007
Email is more important than the company website as traditional networks followed up by emails are
often used
E: ‘Companies always contact us more by email now. So it’s more important for my business now than it ever
used to be...’
W: ‘We have a company website but it’s not generating a lot of traffic just as yet...’
Case
Ss008
Email and website functions are critical to the business’s growth. Cloud technology is also be utilised
E: ‘Email is defiantly important. Developers contact us regularly through Email. Particularly international
interest if we have it too.’
W: ‘...my website is my most important touch-point with my customers. We actually have a Cloud that backs
up our website- it’s our resource centre...’
Case
Ss009 Email and website are critical to the functioning of this firm being a pure.com
E: ’Because we are essentially a purely online firm, our customers will either email or call us. We have a
134
Case
code Email (E) and Websites (W) in firms indicating ‘very strong’ importance
guarantee to our customers to get back to all their queries within one working day.’
W: ‘We have interest from all over the world with our website. It’s a sole mechanism between us and our
clients.’
Case
Sm010
Has invested considerable amounts of time and money into a reservation system on the company’s
website
W: ‘Our customers can do everything on our website. Look for relevant NZ information as well as book tours,
accommodation and flights. There is no middle man. Our website is the between buyer and seller. That’s
because we have spent millions developing, not leasing our own software.’
Case
Sm011
Recognises the importance of online websites and places to invest more into the development of the
website for online traffic
W: ‘Our website is important, we do get new clients from there often, but we don’t have as much online
demand as what we thought we would...’
Case
Sm012
The website is particularly important for the international market rather than domestically
W: ‘The Internet, email, websites, Facebook and all that stuff is very important. We are now franchising and
who would think we have interest in the Egyptian market. The website is defiantly more important for
international scope than in Australia.’
(2) Marketing and advertising capabilities
The Internet as a medium for marketing and advertising purposes was identified as an
important Internet marketing capability. The most common method of marketing and
advertising for firms in this research was the use of third party websites. For example,
Case Sm010 (NZ travel provider) used third party websites such as Tourism New Zealand
and Tourism Queensland to promote travel packages and generate new business. Third
party websites have become important for Case Sm010, who deals directly with the
public. The use of third party websites in this case has created access to a new wide
customer base, previously not feasible without the Internet. For instance, Case Sm012
(food and beverage provider) describes the role of the Internet in creating international
brand recognition: ‘The Internet can have the ability to get any brand known worldwide.
Who in their right mind would have thought that we would get an expression of interest
from someone in Egypt that hasn’t even been to Australia. Yet they know about the brand,
they know everything about us. The Internet has made the world a smaller place. And
everybody’s knowledge hungry.’ Some firms also used information collected from
customer data collected at point of purchase and in after sales service to generate emails,
newsletters and direct marketing campaigns targeted towards the repeat customer
database. This form of database marketing was utilised in nine firms in this research
(Gs001, Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012). For example,
Case Gm005 (coffee roasting business) has developed a website to cater to wholesale
135
coffee buyers. Marketing campaigns are then targeted to each unique cafe, restaurant or
corporate office making the online coffee bean purchase.
(3) The Internet as an online sales mechanism
The Internet as an online sales mechanism was being utilised in nine firms in this research
(Gs001, Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011). For example,
digitalisation within Case Gs002 is being used to support the international aspirations of
the company through the recent development of an online store selling direct to
wholesalers and consumers in New Zealand and Fiji. Other firms, such as CaseSm010
(NZ travel provider), demonstrated highly innovative behaviour through the integration of
new Internet technologies, such as Internet-mediated customer relationship management
systems, and the development of software solutions to optimise business processes to
support the international business vision of the firm. Case Sm010 (NZ travel provider)
stated that,‘…The first, key creation that we’ve been working on forever since I’ve been
here, is a booking engine, which manages all your complete itinerary items.’ The booking
and reservation system was also effective in generating databases for the use of after sales
service and support.
(4) After sales service
The use of the Internet for after sales service and support was identified in eight out of the
12 firms (Gm002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011). For
example, Case Ss009 (plug-and-play software), have an integrated support system built
into the businesses website: ‘...if customers cannot find a solution to a problem within our
knowledge base, clients are welcome to submit tickets, to which we will respond to within
24 hours. Customers can also view existing tickets. All of our support is through web-
based videos.’ Case Sm010 is also now famous for their online support services and
training, including online chat, online support centres, phone and email support as well as
live remote access 24-hour support. Timely support was also noted in Case Sm010 (NZ
travel provider): ‘We provide support to our customers anywhere in the world. It’s
absolutely important.’
136
(5) Market research
The use of the Internet for market research purposes was noted by seven firms (Gm004,
Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012), which were predominantly medium-
sized businesses. It has been suggested that the Internet can increase the firm’s ability to
access information about rivals and international market operating environments (Hamill
& Gregory, 1997). The findings of this study show opportunistic motivations towards the
adoption of the Internet for use in market research. For example, Case Sm012 (food and
beverage provider) uses the Internet to gather firm and industry information to benchmark
the business against key rivals. The findings suggest that the Internet can facilitate the
process of market research gathering through efficient and timely access to information.
Types of Internet, international marketing capabilities not identified
Utilisation of the Internet to identify international market competitors was only noted in
three firms in this research (Gm005, Ss009, Sm010). For example, Case Gm005 (coffee
roasting business) stated that, ‘It’s about shaping behaviours. Coffee consumption in
China is only just taking off. We have been at the forefront of changing this slowly. I use
the Internet to search for, regularly, businesses that try to replicate what we are doing...’
Mostafa et al. (2006) suggest that the more international entrepreneurs are proactive
towards identifying competitors, the better their firms performance will be. The current
research findings suggest that use of the Internet for the identification of international
competitors has limited impact on the firm’s progression to internationalisation.
Overall discussion: Internet, international marketing capabilities
The findings from the data indicate that: (1) the use of email and official company
websites, (2) marketing and advertising capabilities, (3) the Internet as an online sales
mechanism, (4) after sales service, and (5) market research capabilities, are important
components related to how international entrepreneurial firms are achieving successful
Internet internationalisation. The findings from the data, as seen in Figure 4.7, show that
intensity of Internet use in firms is facilitating international market expansion. Intensity of
Internet use in firms is an important measure of the degree to which the firm integrates
137
Internet-related technological capabilities within international business operations
(Glavas, Pike & Mathews, 2014b). While the importance of firm-level capabilities to IE
was emphasised in the inception of IE as a field of inquiry (see, McDougall & Oviatt,
2003), Internet-mediated environments differ in that additional capabilities are vital. For
instance, it has been suggested that the Internet has brought about a generation of
computing that no longer includes simple email and website applications, but embraces
innovation, close collaboration, co-creation, networking and creativity in the use of
existing technologies to develop new and improved offerings (Bell & Loane, 2010).
Figure 4.7 shows an eight level approach to categorisation of the levels of Internet use
within the firm. For example, Stage 1: Moderate level of Internet capability integration
includes email and website use as well as using the Internet for marketing and advertising
purposes. Stage 2: High levels of Internet capability integration are identified in firms
using the Internet as an online sales channel for selling and purchasing goods and
services, for after sales support and market research purposes. Stage 3: Very high of
Internet integration is evident in firms utilising the Internet to identify foreign competitors
and for software development purposes. The opportunistic motivations to achieve
international market performance are also likely to increase with each Internet capability
integrated within the firm’s business activities. The model shows firms work towards
performance outcomes by increased integration of the Internet. For example, Moderate
levels of Internet integration: lead to international communications (level 1), brand
recognition and international growth (level 2), and brand recognition and an increase in
the number of international markets (level 3). High levels of Internet use are likely to lead
to: international market growth (level 4), international market management (level 5), and
international market growth plus an increase in the number of international networks
(level 6). Very high levels of Internet use lead to the firm’s ability to leverage growth
(level 7), and to achieve superior financial gains (level 8). Exceptions to the model are
likely to be identified; however Figure 4.7 shows how firms can leverage increased
Internet capability integration.
138
Figure 4.7 Internet, international marketing capabilities of the firm and
internationalisation
Note. Figure 4.7 shows a diagrammatic categorisation of Internet integration and
intensity within international entrepreneurial SMEs. The levels of Internet
integration lead to key international market outcomes for the firm. * Online sales
includes: The Internet as a online sales channel & for online purchasing
Source: Adapted from Glavas et al., (2012)
Email applications
Level: 1
Level: 2
Website applications Level: 3
Marketing Level: 4
Online sales*
After sales support
Market research
Level: 5
Level: 6
Pursuit of international
market opportunity
performance outcomes
Level 8: Superior financial
gains Level 7: Leverage growth
Level 6: International market
growth/ networks Level 5: International market
management
Level 4: International market growth
Level 3: Brand recognition/ number of markets increase
Level 2: Brand recognition/
international growth Level 1: International
communications
STAGE 1: MODERATE levels of Internet capabilities
STAGE 2: HIGH
Op
po
rtun
isti
c m
oti
vat
ion
s Identify competitors
Level: 7
STAGE 3: VERY HIGH
Software development
Level: 8
139
4.3.7 Capability 2: International virtual network capabilities
The next capability to be discussed is international virtual network capabilities. All firms
were asked: (i) to describe the business’s current relationships, (ii) to describe the
Internet’s impact on networking relationships, (iii) if the Internet had impacted the
development and maintenance of networks, and (iv) if networking capabilities had
influenced the international performance of the firm. The questions in relation to the
formal networking capabilities can be seen in Appendix 1.
Four firms (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Sm010), as shown in column (A) of Table 4.12,
viewed international virtual network capabilities overall to be ‘very strongly important’.
Six firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Ss008, Ss009, Sm012) indicated ‘strong importance’,
while a further two firms (Ss007, Sm011) indicated ‘moderate importance.’ Developing
relationships with suppliers online, as seen in column (B), was noted in 11 firms (Gs001,
Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011, Sm012).
Similarly, developing relationships with distributors online, as seen in column (C), was
noted in nine firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010,
Sm012). Creating ties with industry-specific competition, as shown in column (D), was
seen in nine firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009,
Sm010). Creating ties with customers online, as seen in column (E), was identified in
eight firms (see, Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012).
Maintaining relationships with industry-relevant authorities, as shown in column (F), was
evident in eight firms (Gs002, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012).
Paying for international networks was identified in five firms (column G: Gm004,
Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010). Very high levels of international virtual network
capabilities, as shown in column (H), are present in four firms (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Sm010), high levels in three firms (Gs002, Ss008, Ss009), moderate levels in three firms
(Gs001, Gs003, Sm012), and low levels in two firms (Ss007, Sm011).
140
Table 4.12 Levels of international virtual network capabilities
Type of international virtual network capabilities
A B(d) C(d) D(d) E(d) F G H
Case
Lev
el o
f im
po
rtan
ce o
f
net
wo
rks
Dev
elop
s re
lati
on
ship
s w
ith
suppli
ers
on
lin
e
Dev
elop
s re
lati
on
ship
s w
ith
dis
trib
uto
rs o
nli
ne
Cre
ates
tie
s w
ith
ind
ust
ry-
spec
ific
co
mp
etit
ion
Cre
ates
tie
s w
ith
cu
sto
mer
s
onli
ne.
Fo
r ex
amp
le, blo
gs
Mai
nta
ins
rela
tion
ship
s w
ith
ind
ust
ry r
elev
ant
auth
ori
ties
Pay
s fo
r in
tern
atio
nal
net
wo
rks
Descriptive comment
Level of
international virtual network
capabilities
Case
Gs001 SI - - -
Extensive use of online networks with
industry associations in the same and
competing industries. Moderate
Case
Gs002 SI -
Extensive use of online and offline domestic networks. Internationally is
limited however. High
Case
Gs003 SI - - -
Maintains relevant formal network
relationships, but still considers ‘knock-on-door’ business to be
important.
Moderate
Case
Gm004 VSI
Pre-established networks have
created opportunity for international
expansion. Extensive use of online
and offline networks.
Very High
Case
Gm005 VSI
Creates industry networks and
alliances to support business
development domestically and
internationally.
Very High
Case
Gm006 VSI
Maintains network relationships
between industry associates as well
as between strategic alliances. Very High
Case
Ss007 MI - - - - -
Indicates limited use of networking in
an online environment. Traditional networks are more important.
Low
Case
Ss008 SI - -
Utilised networks to raise capital for
the business. Also, runs key business
network seminars. High
Case
Ss009 SI -
Engages highly in network behaviour
and maintains contact with support communities in similar areas.
High
Case
Sm010 VSI
Has extensive preferred networks
with travel agent providers. Online
networks are core of the business. Very High
Case
Sm011 MI - - - - -
Maintains networks with sales reps
and suppliers in a limited capacity. Low
Case
Sm012 SI - -
Networks traditionally more than
virtually but maintains online networks for international expansion
throughout China and Thailand.
Moderate
Aggregate 11/12 9/12 9/12 8/12 8/12 5/12
Note. VSI = Very strong importance, SI = Strong importance, MI= Moderate importance, d = Developing
networks, tick represents ‘use’, dashed line (-) = Non-use, bold and italicised font = Indicates very high
levels of international virtual networking capabilities.
141
Evaluation of international virtual network capabilities
Three key factors from the data were identified in relation to how international virtual
network capabilities influence the international market performance of the firm: (1)
developing relationships with suppliers online, (2) developing relationships with
distributors online, (3) creating international virtual network relationships, and (4)
maintaining international virtual network relationships.
(1) Developing relationships with suppliers online
Developing relationships with suppliers in an online environment was identified as
important for international business practices. For instance, evidence of these key supplier
relationships was found in 11 firms out of the 12 firms in this research (Gs001, Gs002,
Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss007, Ss009, Sm010, Sm011, Sm012). For example,
Case Ss008 (no-deposit finance) noted that: ‘Networks are all important. If you look at
our business model and our key stakeholders – suppliers become very important to us.
These are banks and finance brokers...it’s critically important to maintain these
relationships they make our business run...’ Case Ss008 (no-deposit finance) also noted
that networks had assisted the business in raising capital to support the growth of the firm.
Conversely, Case Ss009 (plug-and-play software) highlighted that pre-established
Internet-enabled networks with suppliers in international markets such as India posed
many barriers, for example, ‘...originally we thought the way that we would sell is
through resellers overseas [in India]. So we built up all of our infrastructure and
business around the idea of reselling through the Internet overseas. Suppliers didn’t like
to sell our product because our product is subscription-based, it caused many problems
and networking through the Internet in this case was impossible...’
(2) Developing relationships with distributors online
Developing network relationships with distributors in an online space was identified to be
important in nine firms (Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss009, Sm010,
Sm012) (see Table 4.12). Firms used the Internet to establish and also to maintain ties
with distributors. For example, Case Gs001 (heath and wellbeing services) maintained
that ‘...the Internet has expedited the process of information flow between companies and
142
suppliers and distributors. There are language barriers with distributors in China and
email easily overcomes this.’
(3) Creating international virtual network relationships
Creating network relationships with industry-specific competition was recognised as
important by nine firms (see Table 4.12: Gs001, Gs002, Gs003, Gm004, Gm005, Gm006,
Ss008, Ss009, Sm010). Cases Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Sm010 and Sm012 invested time
in maintaining these key relationships with competitors. For example, Case Gm004
(jeweller) stated, ‘...there’s so much competition in the jewellery industry. My efforts to
maintain relationships with them [competition] is not for malevolent reasons, it’s because
we all share industry knowledge and we all benefit...’ Establishing ties with customers in
an online environment is also considered a network. Eight firms (Gs002, Gm004, Gm005,
Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012) claimed that maintaining relationships with
customers served two purposes. Firstly, developing ties with customers enabled the firm
to gain access to important information about repeat consumers, and secondly, networks
with customers were used to further promote the business in targeting new potential
business within current customer social groups. For example, Case Gs001 (health and
wellbeing services) said, ‘We contact our current client base regularly. Through email,
Facebook updates and also blogs. Potential interested customers can also register to
receive information about our new services and products...We try to tap into further
clusters of potential customers by asking for referrals and providing discounts.’
(4) Maintaining international virtual network relationships
Maintaining relationships with industry authorities was identified in eight firms (Gs002,
Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Ss009, Sm010, Sm012). Case Gm005 (coffee roasting
business) has extensive networks with authorities and local businesses with similar
business interests. It has been suggested that as these dynamic interactions take place,
increased trust and knowledge is generated between participant firms, in turn, leading to
greater international market commitment and internationalisation (Loane, 2006). Five
firms in this research (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010) also indicated that they
had bought into a pre-existing international technology-mediated network. For instance,
143
Case Ss008 used network ties extensively to raise business capital and fund business
growth: ‘I’ve actually used key business network functions to raise capital, where
business people talk to other business people. I sold the business concept to one person in
the network, the person who really owned the network, and then they sold it to everybody
else.’ The findings indicate that firms in this research were also developing entirely new
networks. Case Gm005 (coffee roasting business) was partly responsible for developing a
new online international network for like-minded young entrepreneurs and explained:
‘...the purpose of the club [is] to provide entrepreneurs with a trustworthy environment, a
group of similar like-minded people can connect and learn from each other...it’s a very
trustworthy environment.’ The relationship between international virtual network
capabilities and international markets is shown in Figure 4.8.
Types of international virtual network capabilities not identified
The findings from the data, as seen in Table 4.12, indicate that the concept of paying for
international networks is not an essential component of international virtual network
capabilities for firms operating in an Internet-based environment. Five firms in this
research (Gm004, Gm005, Gm006, Ss008, Sm010), indicated that they were not only
building networks but also buying into pre-existing network connections, mostly linked to
legal requirements.
Overall discussion: International virtual network capabilities
The findings from the data show that: (1) developing relationships with suppliers online,
(2) developing relationships with distributors online, (3) creating international virtual
network relationships, and (4) maintaining international virtual network relationships are
important components of the networking capabilities associated with international
entrepreneurial SMEs operating in an Internet environment and highly influence the
internationalisation process.
The findings from the data, which are presented in Figure 4.8, suggest that developing an
international virtual network capability (IVNC), comprised of international technology-
related networking capabilities, can enhance the firm’s progression and successful pursuit
144
of international opportunities in Internet markets. Specifically, the IVNC (i) develops
IVNC with suppliers; (ii) develops IVNC with distributors; (iii) creates IVNC with
industry specific; (iv) creates IVNC with customers; (v) maintains IVNC with industry
authorities. The Internet itself has become an IVNC. An important finding of the data is
that more firms involved in the research were developing new IVNCs rather than
maintaining and leveraging off established networks. This development of new IVNCs
was not confined to the firm’s export market, but was also seen in subsequent
internationalisation. As such, it can be said that developing an IVNC forms an important
part of the firm’s resource and capability base, which is just one component of a firm’s
resource bundle that builds towards successful internationalisation via an Internet
platform.
Figure 4.8 Components of international virtual network capabilities
Additional finding: International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
IE is primarily about opportunity identification and exploitation of international market
opportunities (Zahra et al., 2005). It has been argued that understanding how international
entrepreneurs make decisions to identify, pursue and exploit international opportunities is
necessary for the development of IE as a legitimate field of research (Shane &
Venkataraman, 2000; Zahra et al., 2005). A review of the IE literature in relation to the
internationalisation of SMEs revealed that empirical studies have given scant attention to
Developing an International Virtual
Network Capability (IVNC)
(i) Develops VN with suppliers
(ii) Develops VN with distributors
(iii) Creates VN with industry specific competition
(iv) Creates VN with customers. E.g.: blogs
(v) Maintains VN with industry authorities
Successful pursuit of
international opportunity
seeking and market
performance in Internet
markets
+
+
+
+
+
Note. NV refers to ‘virtual network’
145
the process of international opportunity recognition in an international Internet-based
environment. Instead, empirical studies of opportunity recognition have primarily been in
the domain of entrepreneurship research conducted in a domestic context (Shane, 2000;
Lumpkin & Lichtenstein, 2005).
A key finding from the literature suggests that international opportunity recognition is the
beginning of the internationalisation process and essentially is what ‘triggers’ everything
off (Chandra, Styles & Wilkinson, 2009). The findings of this study suggest that the
international opportunity recognition and subsequent exploitation of international market
opportunities of firms occur after the identification of firm-level resources and
capabilities. That is, international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is a mediating
variable between a firm’s resource and capability base and the international market
performance of firms. In the following section, the level of importance of the firm-level
resources and capabilities identified from the data will be presented in Table 4.13.
Following Table 4.13, concluding remarks for Chapter Four will be provided, along with
the proposed conceptual model for the qualitative findings of Study One.
146
Table 4.13 Research Issues: Analytic importance resources and capabilities
Construct variable identification Level of importance
RQ 1: What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing capabilities of firms, and how do
they influence international performance?
International technology-related innovation
01. New product development in an online environment High
02. Re-producing an existing online product in a new way Low
03. Introducing new methods of production in an online space Low
04. Opening new markets enabled by the Internet High
05. Developing new organisational structures in an online space Low
06. Implementing untried Internet technologies previously not used Low
07. Using the Internet to achieve international outcomes High
08. Experimentation of the Internet in firm internationalisation activities Low
09. Online innovation and markets of similarity High NEW FINDING
International technology-related proactiveness
01. Creates first-mover advantages in an online space Low
02. Capitalises on new product innovations to create opportunity online Low
03. More proactive than competitors towards new online marketplace opportunities Moderate
04. Maintains a ‘forward-looking’ perspective High
05. Proactive in international opportunity seeking in Internet-mediated environments Moderate
06. Anticipates the future online needs of the firm High
07. Online proactiveness and geographic market proximity Very high NEW FINDING
International technology-related risk-taking propensity
01. Commits resources to Internet-mediated projects where the risk of failure is moderate High
02. Takes risk to try new Internet technologies Low
03. Pursues risky new initiatives in highly dynamic Internet environments Low
04. Internet risk reduction in internationalisation Confirm NEW FINDING
Technology-related international vision
01. Encompasses an international / technological mindset from the outset Low
02. The ability to envision international business / Internet expansion in the future Moderate
03. The business’s mission statement is geared towards international outcomes Low
04. Procuring the best resources at the least expense High
05. The business aspires to grow international customers High
06. Online efficiency seeking and international vision Very high NEW FINDING
07. Online growth seeking and international vision Very high NEW FINDING
International business experience
01. Achieved a certificate level qualification Low
02. Obtained a technical college/TAFE equivalent diploma Low
03. Obtained a Bachelor’s degree Low
04. International experience of living abroad and working in another firm Moderate
05. International experience of working in another firm High
06. Experience of working in another firm on Internet-mediated projects Moderate
07. International experience and opportunity seeking Very high NEW FINDING
Internet, international marketing capabilities
01. Email High
02. Website High
03. Marketing and advertising High
04. Online sales High
05. After sales support High
06. Market research High
07. Identify international competitors Low
International virtual network capabilities
01. Develops relationships with suppliers online High
02. Develops relationships with distributors online High
03. Creates ties with industry specific competition High
04. Creates ties with customers online High
05. Maintains relationships with industry relevant authorities High
06. Pays for international networks Low
07. International virtual network capability (IVNC) Very high NEW FINDING
147
4.4 Evaluation of Chapter Four
The first concept to be addressed in this chapter was firm-level resource 1: International
technology-related innovation. Evidence from this research indicates that the
development of innovation in an online context is characterised by new product
development in an online space, opening of new Internet-enabled markets, and use of the
Internet to achieve international outcomes, such as growth. These key components of
international innovation are important for the innovative processes of the SME and are
critical to the identification and successful pursuit of international opportunities, and
subsequently the exploitation of these new international market spaces. Evidence from
Study One also indicates that use of the Internet as a medium to achieve international
performance outcomes is driven by the firm’s online opportunity recognition.
The evidence from firm-level resource 2: International technology-related proactiveness
indicates that SME international entrepreneurial firms display international proactiveness
through, firstly, maintaining a forward-looking perspective and secondly, anticipating the
future online needs of the firm. The primary motivation for SMEs in engaging in
exporting behaviour was taking advantage of lucrative online international opportunities.
Firms stimulated by the opportunity-seeking behaviour proactively devoted resources to
the firm’s Internet processes to systematically track down international growth
opportunities. Therefore, it can be said that the international technology-related
proactiveness of the international entrepreneur is an important firm-level resource in
assisting SMEs to uncover the motivations for internationalisation.
The data in relation to firm-level resource 3: International technology-related risk-taking
propensity shows that commitment of resources to Internet-mediated projects where the
risk of failure is moderate was noted as being the most influential component of risk in
the context of online international entrepreneurial internationalisation. Evidence from
Study One indicates that while the Internet did previously have an impact on reducing
risk in internationalisation, the Internet has now created a perception where international
entrepreneurial managers now view internationalisation as a low-risk business practice.
This is because the Internet has negated the traditional barriers faced by firms in the
148
internationalisation process. The evidence also shows that this perceived risk reduction
positively impacts the international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and
exploitation of the Internet’s international marketing capabilities to achieve successful
international market outcomes. These key findings as such provide important implications
for traditional models of internationalisation, such as the Uppsala model which has long
proposed that firms move into international markets gradually. The findings of this
research indicate that risk can be reduced in the internationalisation process because
Internet, international marketing capabilities have a positive impact on the
internationalisation process; thus, lowering the ‘overestimation’ that internationalisation
activities are high risk in nature.
Evidence from firm-level resource 4: Technology-related international vision shows that
procuring the best resources at the least expense in an online environment (efficiency
seeking), and actively seeks to grow the business through Internet-based platforms
(growth seeking) are important components of technology-related international vision.
Two themes – efficiency seeking in the procurement of resources and growth seeking in
online environments – were identified as important enablers to international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and exploitation of Internet, international
marketing capabilities and perceived international outcomes. The findings indicate that
the Internet is impacting on international entrepreneurs’ perceptions of the level and
degree to which international vision is perceptible in business practice.
The data in relation to firm-level resource 5: International business experience indicates
that international experience of working for an international firm, but not living in another
country, was the most important form of experiential knowledge. The findings of the data
show that international entrepreneurs are learning to successfully grow their businesses
internationally by working in and initiating new international business through learning
and the previous experience they had gained. The intellectual wealth accumulated by
international entrepreneurs is allowing the wealth of experience to grow over time,
enabling international entrepreneurs to better identify and exploit international online
opportunities as a result of knowledge and experience development. There is evidence
which also indicates a lack of knowledge in education in relation to prior experience with
149
Internet technology and in working in international markets. This means that the lack of
formal qualifications such as certificate, technical college/TAFE equivalent and
bachelor’s degrees, has led to the non-accumulation of explicit knowledge and skills
which could be useful to international entrepreneurs. The findings of this study differ
from the findings of Wiklund and Shepherd (2003), who found that growth aspirations
increase at a faster rate for entrepreneurs with higher levels of education.
The evidence from capability 1: Internet, international marketing capabilities, shows that
the findings from the data indicate that use of email and official company websites,
marketing and advertising capabilities, the Internet as an online sales mechanism, after
sales service, and market research capabilities, are important components related to how
international entrepreneurial firms are achieving successful Internet internationalisation.
The findings show that the intensity of Internet use in firms is facilitating international
market expansion to achieve international market outcomes. While the importance of
capabilities to IE was emphasised in the inception of IE as a field of inquiry, the findings
from Study One indicate that Internet environments are different in that additional
technology-related capabilities are vital. The evidence shows that while technology itself
is important, Internet, international marketing capabilities render sustainable competitive
advantage when the firm has the ability to configure bundles of Internet, international
marketing capabilities to leverage opportunity in highly complex and rapidly changing
Internet environments.
The data in relation to capability 1: International virtual network capabilities shows that
developing an international virtual network capability (IVNC), comprised of international
virtual networking capabilities, can enhance the firm’s progression and successful pursuit
of international opportunities in Internet markets. Specifically, the IVNC (i) develops
IVNC with suppliers; (ii) develops IVNC with distributors; (iii) creates IVNC with
industry specific; (iv) creates IVNC with customers; (v) maintains IVNC with industry
authorities. An important finding from Study One shows that more firms were developing
new IVNCs rather than maintaining and leveraging off established networks. The findings
from this research indicate that developing international virtual networking capabilities
can enhance the firm’s progression and successful pursuit of international opportunities.
150
The SMEs in this research were increasingly utilising the Internet for the acquisition and
maintenance of international networks.
Overall, Figure 4.9 shows that a relationship between three firm-level resources;
International entrepreneurial orientation, technology-related international vision, and
international business experience, and capabilities; International virtual network
capabilities and Internet, international marketing capabilities, which influence the
successful pursuit of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and the
international market performance of the firm. That is, firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities are expected to positively influence the international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition and international market performance outcomes for the firm.
Figure 4.9 Proposed conceptual model of firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities
Note. The following chapter will present the proposed model and hypothesis.
Technology-related
international vision
International business
experience
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
International virtual
networking capabilities
International
entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition
International market
performance
International innovativeness
International proactiveness
International risk-taking
propensity
Resources
Capabilities
151
4.5 Conclusion
This chapter provided the qualitative findings for Study One. The results addressed two
research questions by firstly identifying the firm-level resources and, secondly, the
capabilities influencing the international opportunity recognition and the international
market performance of entrepreneurial SMEs. Explanation of the inter-relationships
between how the firm-level resources and capabilities are influencing the international
opportunity recognition and the international market performance of firms was also
discussed. These key findings from Study One led to the development of a conceptual
model of international entrepreneurial firm-level resources and capabilities as shown in
Figure 4.9. This conceptual model identifies how firm-level resources and capabilities of
the international entrepreneur are influencing the international opportunity recognition
and exploitation behaviour of firms, consequently leading to international market
performance outcome for the firm. Next, Chapter Five will discuss the development of
the hypotheses and the theoretical model.
152
CHAPTER FIVE: HYPOTHESES AND THEORETICAL MODEL
DEVELOPMENT
5.1 Introduction
Based on the findings from the qualitative data in Chapter Four, Chapter Five discusses
the hypotheses for model development. Included in this chapter is a discussion of
knowledge gained from Chapter Four and research question one, as well as the hypothesis
developed as a result of the findings from the qualitative data. The hypotheses have been
developed from each construct of the proposed conceptual model: international
entrepreneurial orientation; technology-related international vision; international
business experience; Internet, international marketing capabilities; international virtual
network capabilities; and international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. The full
hypothesised model for structural equation modelling is also presented in conjunction
with the measures utilised. Concluding comments for Chapter Four are also provided. A
diagrammatic overview of Chapter Five can be seen in Figure 5.1.
Figure 5.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Five
Introduction (5.1)
Cross-case evaluation and hypotheses development (5.2)
Factor variable labels for measurement (5.3)
Measures and expected relationships (5.5)
Conclusion (5.6)
Full hypothesised model (5.4)
153
5.2 Cross case evaluation: Hypotheses and model development
Based on the analysis of data in Chapter Four, hypotheses were developed for Study Two.
In Study Two, quantitative modelling of the findings from the data in Chapter Four is
conducted. The formulation of hypotheses for Study Two can be seen in Table 5.1. In
addition, a pre-structural equation model in presented in Figure 5.3, the theoretical
concepts of which are included in Table 5.1. Following Table 5.1, the hypotheses
developed for international entrepreneurial orientation will be discussed.
Table 5.1 Research questions and variable identification and hypotheses
Research question
Qualitative
protocol
questions
Construct findings
(F) Hypotheses development
RQ 2a: What is
the relative
influence of firm-
level resources
and Internet,
international
marketing
capabilities on
international
performance?
RQ 2b: How do
international
entrepreneurs
leverage Internet,
international
marketing
capabilities for
international
performance?
PART E:
Qs: 6, 7, 8, 9
International
entrepreneurial
orientation
IEO (F1)
H1: ‘International entrepreneurial orientation is
positively related to international market performance’
H2: ‘International entrepreneurial orientation is
positively related to international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition’
PART F:
Qs: 10, 11,
12, 13
Technology-related
international vision
TRIV (F2)
H3: ‘Technology-related international vision is
positively related to international market performance’
H4: ‘Technology-related international vision is
positively related to international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition’
H5: ‘Technology-related international vision is
positively related to Internet, international marketing
capabilities
PART G:
Qs 14, 15, 16,
17, 18, 19
International business
experience
IBE (F3)
H6: ‘International business experience is positively
related to international market performance’
H7: ‘International business experience is positively
related to international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition’
PART H:
Qs: 20, 21, 22
Internet, international
marketing capabilities
IIMC (F4)
H8: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are
positively related to international market performance’
H9: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are
positively related to international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition’
H10: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are
positively related to international virtual networking
capabilities’
PART I:
Qs 23, 24, 25,
26
International virtual
networking capability
IVNC (F5)
H11: ‘International virtual networking capabilities are
positively related to international market performance’
H112: ‘International virtual networking capabilities
are positively related to international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition’
PART J: Qs
27, 28, 29, 30,
31
*International
entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition
IEOP (F6)
International market
performance
IMP (F7)
H13: ‘International entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition is positively related international market
performance’
Note. *New construct identified and therefore not addressed in the interview protocol. F = factor variable,
H= Hypotheses.
154
5.2.1 International entrepreneurial orientation
The concept of international entrepreneurial orientation reflects the firm’s overall
innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-taking propensities in the pursuit of international
markets (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004). From a conceptual standpoint, research describes
international entrepreneurial orientation as an antecedent to phenomena including
internationalisation (Knight, 2001: Ripollés-Meliá et al., 2007), and international
performance (Jantunen et al., 2005; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2003; Mostafa et al., 2006). An
international entrepreneurial orientation also gives rise to innovative processes and
practices intended to maximise organisational success in new markets (Lumpkin & Dess,
1996). When examining international entrepreneurial orientation from a quantitative
perspective, a minority of researchers test the individual dimensions (e.g. innovativeness)
of international entrepreneurial orientation singularly. Instead, most research modifies
classic entrepreneurial orientation measures into an international entrepreneurial
orientation scale encompassing the three dimensions of international innovativeness,
proactiveness and risk-taking propensities (for example see, Knight 2001). As such, the
three dimensions of international entrepreneurial orientation will not be tested singularly
in Study Two, but rather as a total. The findings of Study One suggest that firms with an
international entrepreneurial orientation engage in international innovative, proactive and
risk-seeking behaviours in order to achieve the firm’s competitive and internationally
oriented goals and successful international market performance. As such, Hypothesis one
(H1) can be postulated:
H1: International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to
international market performance
International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is described as the beginning of the
internationalisation process, and includes the deliberate and systematic search of the ways
in which firms discover opportunities to enter international markets (Chandra et al.,
2009). International entrepreneurial orientation has also been found to increase the firm’s
chance of identifying new means-end relationships, leading to international market
opportunity (Chandra et al., 2009). Accordingly, international entrepreneurial orientation
is also suggested to be instrumental in the development and enactment of key
155
organisational international business processes (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004). Further,
Jantunen et al. (2005) suggest that an international entrepreneurial orientation supports
opportunity recognition in international markets, giving reason to suppose that
international entrepreneurial orientation has a positive effect on international
performance. The findings of Study One suggest that having an international
entrepreneurial orientation can prompt the development of international opportunity
recognition and exploitation of new market opportunities. As such, Hypothesis two (H2)
can be postulated:
H2: International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
5.2.2 Technology-related international vision
Entrepreneurs with an international vision play an important role in the firm’s
international progression as well as in the international strategies implemented within the
firm (Andersson, 2000). Evidence suggests that an entrepreneur’s international vision is a
capability essential for the firm’s progression into international markets (Tesar &
Tarleton, 1982; Autio et al., 2000; Johnson, 2004). Research indicates that Internet-
enabled SMEs with an international vision adopt Internet technologies to realise their
international intentions to achieve international performance (Aspelund & Moen, 2004).
Scholars (Autio et al., 2000; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Johnson, 2004; Andersson &
Evangelista, 2006) argue that managers with an international mindset and high levels of
international vision are more global in nature and tend to outperform those firms without
an international vision. The findings from the data in Study One corroborate these key
findings. As such, Hypothesis three (H3) can be postulated:
H3: Technology-related international vision is positively related to
international market performance
The international vision of the entrepreneur is also argued to be an important component
in businesses seeking international market expansion, allowing firms to seek out new
international opportunities aggressively (Autio et al., 2000; Nummela et al., 2004). In
156
many instances, it is the entrepreneur’s drive and international vision that allows firms to
expand into international markets and seek out new business opportunities (Andersson &
Evangelista, 2006). The findings of Study One suggest a relationship between
technology-related international vision and the international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition of the firm. As such, Hypothesis four (H4) can be postulated:
H4: Technology-related international vision is positively related to
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
Study One of this research argued that Internet, international marketing capabilities have
a positive impact on the perception and the reduction of risk in internationalisation. This
is because the Internet has negated the key risk factors of more traditional forms of
internationalisation (Mathews & Healy, 2008), such as high uncertainty about export
markets due to limited information and knowledge, high costs, and psychic distance
(Petersen, et al., 2002). This key reduction in risk overall has led to many SME
entrepreneurial firms seizing opportunities available in an Internet environment (Mathews
& Healy, 2008). Internet, international marketing capabilities provide SMEs with the
proclivity to engage in international activity (Mathews et al., 2012). Research conducted
on small high-tech exporting manufacturers also identifies that SMEs with an
international vision adopt information communication technologies, such as the Internet,
to realise the firm’s international intentions (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Andersson &
Evangelista, 2006). For this reason, it is suggested that Internet, international marketing
capabilities will have a positive influence on the firm’s international vision to exist and
operate in an Internet environment, allowing technologically advanced firms to with an
international vision to adopt international strategies (Loane, 2006; Johnson, 2004;
Aspelund & Moen, 2004). As such, Hypothesis five (H5) can be postulated:
H5: Technology-related international vision is positively related to Internet,
international marketing capabilities
157
5.2.3 International business experience
Prior international business experience of the entrepreneur has an important effect upon
entrepreneurial firms, particularly on the initial decision to expand and in the continuation
of the strategy into international markets (Dyer & Handler, 1994; Loane & Bell, 2002;
Fischer & Reuber, 2003; Hutchinson et al., 2006). The findings of the data from Study
One indicate that international entrepreneurs are learning to successfully grow their
businesses in by working in and initiating new international business through learning and
previous experience. As international entrepreneurial learning takes place, the
international business experience of the entrepreneur grows (Stuart & Albetti, 1990;
Reuber & Fischer, 1997, 1999). Prior international experience is also a critical component
of the international entrepreneur’s human capital for internationalisation (Stuart &
Albetti, 1990). As such, Hypothesis six (H6) can be postulated:
H6: International business experience is positively related to international
market performance
The findings from Study One indicate that the intellectual wealth accumulated by
international entrepreneurs allows experience to grow over time, enabling international
entrepreneurs to better identify and exploit international opportunities as a result of
knowledge and experience development (Stuart & Albetti, 1990; Venkataraman, 1997).
The transmission and retrieval of knowledge such as information about export markets,
competitor intelligence and market research from international experience is also
suggested to influence the successful recognition and exploitation of international
opportunities. According to Venkataraman (1997), each entrepreneur’s prior knowledge
creates a ‘knowledge passage’ that allows opportunities to be recognised. For instance, in
a study of technological innovations, Shane (2000) argued that differences in prior
knowledge influenced who discovered entrepreneurial opportunities and that different
entrepreneurs seek different opportunities. It has also been suggested that the more prior
international experience and knowledge a firm has, the greater its chance of identifying
unanticipated international opportunity (Chandra, et al., 2009). Therefore, Hypothesis
seven (H7) can be postulated:
158
H7: International business experience is positively related to international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
The findings of Study One indicate that increased levels of experiential knowledge related
to the Internet and international markets through international experience, lead to the
entrepreneur having a more internationally oriented vision. Research suggests that prior
international business experience influences the way entrepreneurs comprehend and
recognise international opportunities (Chandra et al., 2009). This is because the
international entrepreneur is better equipped with the information and knowledge required
to make investments in internationalisation activities. The information and knowledge
gained from prior international experiences also reduces the perceived risks and
uncertainties associated with internationalisation (Chandra et al., 2009). As a direct
consequence of the reduction of risks in internationalisation, opportunities in the
international marketplace arise, which in conjunction with increased levels of
international experience, create increased international opportunity recognition.
5.2.4 Internet, international marketing capabilities
It is now widely acknowledged that the Internet has provided entrepreneurial SMEs with
new ways to conduct business, communicate ideas, and exchange information, allowing
businesses to improve the efficiency of their internationalisation activities (Aspelund &
Moen, 2004; Gibbs & Kraemer, 2004; Loane, 2006; Bell & Loane, 2010). The literature
suggests that Internet, international marketing capabilities are an important and unique
capability (Loane, 2006; Etemad et al., 2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). More than the
Internet itself, the sustainability of competitive advantage in the international marketplace
lies in the firm’s ability to re-configure and leverage the capabilities provided by the
Internet to achieve successful international market performance outcomes. Further, the
Internet has been found to be associated with increased international market performance
(Mostafa et al., 2006; Bell & Loane, 2010; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). As such, Hypothesis
eight (H8) can be postulated:
H8: Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related to
international market performance
159
Prior research in IE also proposes that Internet, international marketing capabilities can
improve the firm’s pursuit of international opportunities (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). That
is, the Internet can assist in the recognition of international opportunities. Data from
Study One corroborates these findings and suggests that encompassing Internet,
international marketing capabilities will better enable firms to pursue internationalisation
opportunities as a result of Internet environments. As such, Hypothesis nine (H9) can be
postulated:
H9: Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related to
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
5.2.5 International virtual networking capabilities
The importance of networks in the internationalisation of international entrepreneurial
firms operating in an Internet environment is widely accepted (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004;
Loane, 2006; Loane & Bell, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2007; Mathews et al., 2012). SMEs
utilise the Internet to acquire information and knowledge, but also increasingly to develop
and maintain international network relations (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mathews &
Healy, 2008; Aspelund, Moen & Madsen, 2007; Moen et al., 2008; Reuber & Fischer,
1997). It is argued that international virtual networking capabilities substantially enhance
the knowledge base of SME entrepreneurial firms by providing businesses with the ability
to generate international market performance through Internet environments. The research
findings of Study One suggest that while more traditional networks are important, greater
emphasis is now placed on strategic use of the Internet for internationalisation. Thus,
international virtual network capabilities are a valuable resource for SMEs operating in
Internet environments (Coviello & Munro, 1995; Poon & Jevons 1997; Loane, 2006;
Loane & Bell, 2006). As such, Hypothesis ten (H0) can be postulated:
H10: Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related to
international virtual networking capabilities
Research suggests that firms with extensive international virtual networks internationalise
quicker and more successfully than firms without virtual networks (Loane, 2006;
160
Mathews & Healy, 2007). The value of international virtual networking capabilities as an
integral part of the explanation of international entrepreneurial success is also widely
acknowledged in the literature (Coviello & Munro, 1995; Dimitratos & Plakoyiannaki,
2003; Loane & Bell, 2006; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006). The findings from Study One
suggest that developing international virtual networking capabilities can enhance the
firm’s progression and successful pursuit of opportunities to achieve international market
performance outcomes. This is in line with research that argues that virtual networks have
a positive influence on the firm’s international performance outcomes (Aspelund &
Moen, 2004; Mathews & Healy, 2008; Moen et al., 2008; Reuber & Fischer, 1997). As
such, Hypothesis eleven (H11) can be postulated:
H11: International virtual networking capabilities are positively related to
international market performance
The Internet plays a pivotal role in the creation of relationships for SMEs and is a
mechanism for the creation of international growth opportunities (Loane, 2006; Mathews
& Healy, 2008; Chandra et al., 2009). Scholars also suggest that virtual networks can
assist firms recognising and exploiting new international market opportunities (Loane,
2006; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006). Further, it can be said that developing international
virtual networking capabilities also forms an important part of the firm’s capability base,
one component of a firm’s resource bundle that builds towards successful
internationalisation and exploitation of new international market opportunities, thus
driving growth performance outcomes of the firm. As such, Hypothesis twelve (H12) can
be postulated:
H12: International virtual networking capabilities are positively related to
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
5.2.6 International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
IE concerns opportunity identification and exploitation across international markets
(Zahra et al., 2005). Research suggests that the process of international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition is a critical component of a firm’s international market strategy,
161
because it is primarily concerned with the ways in which firms identify and take
advantage of new international market opportunity to leverage international market
performance (Chandra et al., 2005; Zahra et al., 2005, Dimitratos et al., 2012). A review
of the IE literature in relation to the internationalisation of SMEs revealed that empirical
studies have paid scant attention to the relationship between international opportunity
recognition and a firm’s international market performance (Zahra et al., 2005; Cooper &
Park, 2008; Chandra et al., 2009; Chandra, Styles & Wilkinson, 2012). Instead, empirical
studies of opportunity recognition have primarily been in the research domain of
entrepreneurship, primarily conducted in a domestic context (Shane, 2000; Lumpkin &
Lichtenstein, 2005). This is despite the finding that international opportunity recognition
is the beginning of the internationalisation process and deserves more systematic research
attention due to the nature of its role in starting the internationalisation process (Chandra
et al., 2009). As such, it is evident that opportunities are recognised, acted on and
exploited by international entrepreneurial firms to achieve international firm performance
in various ways that are not yet well understood (Chandra et al., 2009). As such,
Hypothesis thirteen (H13) can be postulated:
H13: International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is positively related
to international market performance
The hypotheses presented in this research forms the basis of quantitative Study Two. The
proposed conceptual model in Figure 5.2 indicates the hypothesis for confirmation in
Study Two.
5.3 Full hypothesised model
The full hypothesised model presented in Figure 5.2 outlines the expected relationships
between constructs in this research as denoted by the hypotheses. The full hypothesised
model exhibits three resources; International entrepreneurial orientation, technology-
related international vision, and international business experience and three capabilities;
International virtual networking capabilities, international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition, and Internet, international marketing capabilities. The dependent variable is
162
denoted by the international market performance construct. The factor variable labels for
measurement in this research will be outlined following Figure 5.2.
Figure 5.2 Hypothesised model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities
5.4 Factor variable labels for measurement
The seven factor variable labels identified in Figure 5.2 are each discussed individually
below.
5.4.1 International entrepreneurial orientation: (Factor 1)
Three decades since its conceptualisation, entrepreneurial orientation is a central
component and a well-established area of entrepreneurship and strategy research (Slevin
& Terjesen, 2011). Drawing from entrepreneurial orientation, international
F2. Technology-
related international
vision
F1. International
entrepreneurial orientation
F7. International market performance
F4. Internet,
international marketing
capabilities
F5. International
virtual networking
capabilities
H1
F3. International
business experience
F6. International
entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition
H2
H3
H4
H12
H13
H5
H10
H6
H8
H11
H9
H7
Note. F = Factor variable and H = Hypotheses.
163
entrepreneurial orientation reflects the firm’s overall international innovativeness,
proactiveness and risk-seeking propensities in the pursuit of international markets
(Knight, 2001). From a conceptual standpoint, international entrepreneurial orientation
has been described as an antecedent to various phenomena including international
exporting (Ibeh & Young, 2001), internationalisation (Knight, 2001) and international
performance (Jantunen et al., 2005; Mostafa et al., 2006), as well as an outcome of the
firm’s overall efforts to internationalise (Slevin & Terjesen, 2011). Extant studies indicate
that researchers often use the term entrepreneurial orientation to theorise, develop
hypotheses and to test relationships with a variety of measures from entrepreneurial
orientation in the context of international entrepreneurial orientation (Slevin & Terjesen,
2011). In terms of measuring international entrepreneurial orientation, a minority of
internationally related studies utilise the ‘classic’ M/CS scales where individual
dimensions of entrepreneurial orientation are tested (see, Mostafa et al., 2006).
Most research instead modifies classic entrepreneurial orientation scales into some type
of international entrepreneurial orientation scale (Slevin & Terjesen, 2011). This is
because international entrepreneurs possess a unique and distinctive orientation or
outlook, which when combined with other resources and capabilities, allows them to see
and exploit opportunities in international markets, best captured by an international
entrepreneurial orientation aggregate scale (Knight & Cavusgil, 2004). This work draws
on nine measures as proposed by Knight and Cavusgil (2004), which draws on the work
of Khandwalla (1977), Miller and Friesen, (1984), and Covin and Slevin (1989). These
researchers measured international entrepreneurial orientation, including international
innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-taking propensities, with 12 items, as shown in
Table 5.2.
5.4.2 Technology-related international vision: (Factor 2)
The international vision of the entrepreneur is argued to be imperative for allowing firms
to seek new international opportunities aggressively (Autio et al., 2000). Research
suggests that the firm’s decision to pursue international opportunities is dependent on the
founding entrepreneur’s international competencies and vision for international growth
(Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Grilo & Thurik, 2005). Oviatt and McDougall (2005) invoke
164
the importance of an entrepreneur’s vision, calling for a closer examination of
entrepreneurs' cognition in shaping the internationalisation process. Yet despite the
importance of international vision for the firm’s performance, understanding of the vision
related to an entrepreneurial firm’s progression into international markets is an under-
examined research phenomenon. Measures for international vision in a technology-related
context in this research study were derived from the work of Nummela et al. (2004).
5.4.3 International business experience: (Factor 3)
A number of studies have examined the impact of a manager’s international experience
on their firms’ internationalisation behaviours (Reid, 1981; Oviatt & McDougall, 1994;
Reuber & Fischer, 1997; Sapienza, et al., 2006). Given that the focus in this research is on
SME internationalisation, utilisation of a measure for the entrepreneur’s length of
experience in international business was justified (Fischer & Reuber, 2003). It has also
been suggested that a successful predictor for international experience is the manager’s
level of past experience in working on projects where developing international markets
for a firm was a priority (Reuber & Fischer, 1997; Sapienza et al., 2006). Measures for
examining international experience have been drawn the work of Stuart and Albetti
(1990) and Reuber and Fischer (1997).
5.4.4 Internet, international marketing capabilities: (Factor 4)
This research coins the term, ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities’, which make
reference to the capabilities provided by the Internet. Internet capabilities are defined as
the ‘engagement of routines, prior and emergent knowledge, analytic processes, and
simple rules to turn information technology into customer value’ (Zhu & Kraemer, 2002,
p. 278). Internet marketing capabilities are an important and unique firm resource in the
context of SME internationalisation (Loane, 2006; Etemad et al., 2010; Reuber & Fischer,
2011). More than the Internet itself, it has been argued that competitive advantage in the
global marketplace from technology lies in the firm’s ability to re-configure and leverage
technology in rapidly changing Internet environments (Zhu & Kraemer, 2002; Liao et al.,
2009).
165
This research draws on a number of measures presented in empirical quantitative studies
(e.g. Zhu & Kraemer, 2002; Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Gibbs & Kramer, 2004; Liao et al.,
2009) and from the recent conceptual work of Reuber and Fischer (2011). Internet usage
is measured through applications of Internet technology including email applications,
website, advertising and marketing, online sales and after sales service (Gibbs & Kramer,
2004); as well as market research to identify international competitors (Aspelund &
Moen, 20004) and software development. The firm’s ability to leverage the Internet for
international markets and the renewal of Internet operational capabilities was applied
using adapted measures by Zhu and Kraemer (2009), while technology and performance
variables were measured from the conceptual work of Reuber and Fischer (2011).
5.4.5 International virtual networking capabilities: (Factor 5)
The ways in which firms are using international virtual networking capabilities to
leverage firm internationalisation to achieve international market performance has not
been reported. Traditionally, an international network perspective highlights that
networks and relationships are important in the internationalisation of small firms,
enabling firms to link activities and tie resources together (Coviello & Munro, 1995;
Chetty & Wilson, 2003; Andersson & Wictor, 2003; Mort & Weerawardena, 2006). The
findings from Chapter Four indicate, however, that developing international virtual
networking capabilities can enhance the firm’s progression and successful pursuit of
international opportunities. SMEs are increasingly utilising the Internet for the acquisition
and maintenance of international networks (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mathews & Healy,
2008; Aspelund, Moen & Madsen, 2007; Moen, et al., 2008; Reuber & Fischer, 1997).
As such, it is argued that further research should be conducted into whether international
virtual networking capabilities substantially enhances the knowledge base and
international market performance of the firm. Research also suggests that developing
international virtual networking capabilities forms an important part of the firm’s
resource base that builds towards successful internationalisation (Aspelund & Moen,
2004; Mathews & Healy, 2008; Reuber & Fischer, 1997). Despite these key findings, the
importance of the Internet for international networking capabilities in small firms is still
an underdeveloped topic of research (Loane, 2006; Mathews et al., 2012). Traditional
166
measures of business networks by Wu, Mahajin and Balasubramanian (2003) and the
conceptual work of Loane (2006) were adapted to align with the international
entrepreneurial nature and Internet context of this research.
5.4.6 International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition: (Factor 6)
International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, one of the central ideas of IE, is the
ability to recognise a good idea and transform it into an international business concept
that adds value and generates international revenues (Lumpkin & Lichtenstein, 2005).
Although research in the field of IE has recently experienced growth, the development of
constructs required to test firm-level IE has not been established accordingly (Dimitratos
et al., 2012). More importantly, IE constructs do not directly address the extent to which
firms are involved in the recognition and exploitation of international opportunities
(Brown, Davidsson & Wiklund, 2001). It has been argued in the literature that an
international entrepreneurial culture (Dimitratos et al., 2012) can provide an
encompassing construct that captures international entrepreneurial activities of the firm
seeking to identify and pursue international opportunities (Zahra et al., 2005; Dimitratos
et al., 2012). The literature suggests that an international entrepreneurial culture is
expected to be related to the firm’s international market performance. In an Internet
context, these opportunity-based constructs are yet to be tested. As such, measures
adapted from the work of Lumpkin and Lichtenstein (2005) and Dimitratos et al., (2012)
were utilised.
5.4.7 International market performance: (Factor 7)
In previous studies growth has been used as a proxy for firm performance (Wiklund &
Shepherd, 2005). In this study it is argued that performance is a multi-dimensional
construct in nature, which should incorporate different dimensions of performance in
empirical studies (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). To capture the different dimensions of
SME performance, a combination of financial performance and growth measures were
utilised. For financial performance, utilisation of international profitability measures and
overall assessments of performance were justified (Moen et al., 2008). In terms of
measuring international performance, Murphy et al. (1996) argue that the construct of
167
international performance should be measured by more than one dimension of
performance to give greater accuracy in examination of the firm’s overall performance
(Murphy et al., 1996). Wiklund and Shepherd (2005) also agree that international
performance should be measured through at least two different dimensions of
performance, preferably including both financial and non-financial performance
indicators (Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005). Validated measures of international firm
performance utilised in this research include sales growth, sales growth relative to
competitions, international market share (Moen et al., 2008), satisfaction with
international activities (Jantunen et al., 2004), and the percentage of sales as international
revenue and profit.
5.5 Measures and excepted relationships
The scales utilised for this study were constructed following the systematic approach
outlined by Churchill (1979). This systematic approach to the development of scales
ensured that scales were adopted without change, or adapted from international business
literature with the core concept of the measure remaining intact. Thus, all measures
utilised in this study have been drawn from extant literature in the fields of international
business and IE. The summary of measures utlised in this research can be seen in Table
5.2, where the factor variable (label) and scale for measurement, expected relationships,
measures and whether the scales were adopted without change or adapted are described.
Following Table 5.2, concluding statements for Chapter Five will be presented.
168
Table 5.2 Summary of measures
Factor variable (label) and scale for measurement Expected relationships Measures Adopted or adapted
International entrepreneurial orientation IEO: Consisting of
innovativeness, proactiveness and risk-taking propensity (F1)
*Knight and Cavusgil (2004) (KC) drawing from:
Khandwalla (1977)
Miller and Friesen, (1984)
Covin and Slevin (1989)
IEO --- WWORLD IEO --- ACTEXPL
IEO --- MISION
IEO --- RESALO IEO --- EXPBUS
IEO --- MKTIIB
IEO --- HIRISK
IEO --- SUCINT
IEO --- VISDRI
1. The world as the marketplace (KC) 2. Active exploration of new business opportunities abroad (KC)
3. Communication of mission to succeed in international markets (KC)
4. Human and financial resource allocation for international markets (KC) 5. Top management is experienced in international business (KC)
6. Marketing of many products in international markets (KC)
7. Proclivity for high risk projects with chances of high returns (KC)
8. Management goes to great lengths to be successful internationally (KC)
9. Vision and drive are important for international business decisions (KC)
Adopted Adopted
Adopted
Adopted Adopted
Adapted
Adopted
Adopted
Adopted
Technology-related international vision TRIV (F2)
Nummela, Saarenketo and Puumalainen (2004) (NSP)
TRIV --- SERINC
TRIV --- RESINT TRIV --- GROWTH
TRIV --- IEXPIM
TRIV --- ACHIEV
1. Committed to servicing international customers (NSP)
2. Commits human and financial resources to international markets (NSP) 3. Emphasises the importance of growth to employees (NSP)
4. International experience is viewed as important (NSP)
5. Views Internet internationalisation as achievable (NSP)
Adapted
Adapted Adapted
Adapted
Adapted
International business experience IBE (F3) Loane (2006)
IBE --- YEAREX
IBE --- NUMVEN
IBE --- EDUCAT
1. The number of years of experience related to exporting
2. The number of pervious entrepreneurial ventures
3. Highest level of education
Adopted
Adopted
Adopted
Internet, international marketing capabilities IIMC (F4)
Zhu and Kraemer (2002) (ZK)
Aspelund and Moen (2004) (AM) Gibbs and Kramer (2004) (GK)
Liao, Kickul and Ma (2009) (LKM)
Reuber and Fischer (2011) (RF) Conceptual work
IIMC --- INTUSE
IIMC --- LEVTEC
IIMC --- TECPEF
IIMC --- RENTRC IIMC --- INVIOC
IIMC --- TECINF
1. Internet usage: Email applications (GK), website (GK), advertising and marketing (GK), online sales (GK, AM), after sales service (GK), market
research (AM), identify foreign competitors (AM), software development.
2. Ability to leverage technology (ZK) 3. Technology and performance variables (RF)
4. Renewal of technology-related capabilities (ZK) 5. Investment in Internet operational capabilities (LKM)
6. Technological infrastructure to engage in Internet initiatives (LKM)
Adapted
Adapted
Adapted
Adapted Adapted
Adapted
International virtual networking capabilities IVNC (F5)
Wu, Mahajin and Balasubramanian (2003) (WMB) Conceptual work of Loane (2006) (L)
IVNC --- CUSREL IVNC --- EXIREL
IVNC --- LONGRE
IVNC --- ACQNEW IVNC --- NEWMAR
IVNC --- NINTPE
1. Maintaining international customer relationships (WMB) 2. Strengthening the existing relationships (WMB)
3. Develops longer lasting relationships (WMB)
4. Acquiring new international customers (L) 5. Entering new international markets (L)
6. Enhancing the firms international performance (L)
Adapted Adapted
Adapted
Adapted Adapted
Adapted
International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition IEOR
(F6)
Lumpkin & Lichtenstein (2005) (LL) Dimitratos, Voudouris, Plakoyiannaki & Nakos (2012) (DVPN)
IEOR --- ACTIVE IEOR --- RESEXP
IEOR --- PUROPP
IEOR --- PROEVL IEOR --- ADDVAL
1. Firm actively seeks out new Internet, international opportunities (DVPN) 2. Investing resources to exploit opportunity
3. Pursuing international opportunity regardless of resources
4. Processes to evaluate effectiveness of international market activity (DVPN) 5. International opportunity recognition adds value (LL)
Adapted Adapted
Adapted
Adapted Adapted
International market performance IMP (F7)
Moen, Masden & Aspelund (2008) (MMA)
Nummela, Saarenketo and Puumalainen (2004) (NSP) Jantunen, Puumalainen and Saarenketo (2005) (JPS)
IMP --- MRKSHA IMP --- SALGROW
IMP --- SALGVC
IMP --- INTPRO IMP --- OPERAS
IMP --- SATIAC
1. Market share (MMA) 2. Sales growth (MMA)
3. Sales growth vs. competitors (MMA)
4. International profitability objectives (MMA) 5. Overall performance assessment (MMA)
6. Satisfaction with international activities (JPS)
Adopted Adopted
Adopted
Adopted Adapted
Adapted
Note. Adopted = Adopted without any modifications and Adapted = Modified with the core concept intact.
169
5.6 Conclusion
Chapter Five provided a comprehensive discussion of the hypothesised relationships
between the firm-level resources and the capabilities that are expected to be related to the
firm’s pursuit of opportunities and international market performance in an Internet
environment. Chapter Five presented the full hypothesised model for testing of the key
inter-relationships between resources and firm-level capabilities. The full hypothesised
model exhibited three firm-level resources; International entrepreneurial orientation,
technology-related international vision and international business experience, and three
capabilities; International virtual networking capabilities, international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition and Internet, international marketing capabilities. Study Two
will quantitatively test the full hypothesised model developed from the findings of Study
One. Chapter Six will outline the quantitative methodology utilised to test the proposed
model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities.
170
CHAPTER SIX: QUANTITATIVE METHODOLOGY: STUDY TWO
6.1 Introduction
Chapter Six outlines the quantitative methodology for Study Two. The research design
and analytical techniques used in Study Two are explained and justified. In Chapter Six,
the population and study sample is addressed, as well as the unit of analysis, selection of
key informants, pre-test of the questionnaire, data collection procedures, validity and
reliability, non-response bias, and common method variance. Further, the EFA and the
justification for the use of structural equation modelling is outlined, along with
concluding comments of the chapter. A diagrammatic overview of Chapter Six can be
seen in Figure 6.1.
Figure 6.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Six
Population and study sample (6.2.1) Unit of analysis (6.2.2) Selection of key informants (6.2.3)
Pre-test of the questionnaire (6.2.5) Data collection procedure (6.2.6)
Non-response bias (6.2.8) Common method variance (6.2.9)
Exploratory factor analysis (6.3)
Introduction (6.1)
Quantitative research design (6.2)
Structural equation modelling (SEM) (6.4)
Conclusion (6.5)
Validity and reliability (6.2.7)
Questionnaire development (6.2.4)
171
6.2 Quantitative research design
Denzin and Lincoln (1994) suggest that the basic beliefs of alternative inquiry paradigms
exist along a continuum. This research falls within the postpositivism research paradigm,
which is a rejection or modification of numerous core beliefs of positivism (Onwuegbuzie
et al., 2009). The postpositivism paradigm relies on multiple methods as a way of
capturing as much of reality as possible, while emphasising the discovery and verification
of theories (Denzin & Lincoln, 2011). Based on this view, the postpositivism paradigm
extends beyond relativism, but retains the idea of objective truth (Denzin & Lincoln,
1994). In Study Two, quantitative data was collected to test the model of firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities established in Chapter Five. The aim of employing a
quantitative approach in Study Two is to confirm the key interrelations in the
hypothesised model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities. This deductive
approach therefore sought to quantify specific relationships through statistical analysis,
where hypotheses are either supported or not supported (Aker, Kumar, Day & Lawley,
2005).
The following research discussion will outline the population and sample of this study,
the unit of analysis, selection of key informants, pre-testing procedures, data collection
procedures, response rates, non-response bias, analysis of the quantitative data presented,
an EFA, and the structural equation model. Firstly, the population and sample of this
study will be discussed.
6.2.1 Population and study sample
Research Study Two focuses on individual Australian SMEs that have engaged in
international market activity. This study is focused on a single country, and population
parameters were limited and confined only to Australian firms that are international.
Considering that a large sample of international entrepreneurial SMEs was required for
Study Two, the Australian Trade Commission (Austrade) database provided an
appropriate means of sourcing Australian firms engaged in international activities. The
Austrade database is the Australian Government’s trade, investment and
education promotion agency (Austrade, 2012), assisting Australian SMEs to grow their
172
business into international markets. Given that the Austrade database provides a
creditable and comprehensive overview of Australian exporting SMEs, the use of this
database in this study is justified. An extensive manual data retrieval process was
conducted to gather the contact information of Australian international entrepreneurial
firms eligible to participate in this research. The data retrieval process included the
development of an Excel spreadsheet, which contained information about the firms
eligible to participate in the research as well as their contact details. Given that 2,322
firms were called and encouraged to pre-screen and participate in the research, the
spreadsheet also assisted in the management of firms, ensuring businesses were not
contacted on more than one occasion. An overview of the sample selection pool utilised
in this study can be seen in Table 6.1.
Table 6.1 Sample selection pool from the Austrade database
Selected industry Contacted Eligible Response rates
Consumer Goods (1,730)
Information Communication
Technology (1,020)
Manufacturing (2,864)
Professional Business Services
(1,622)
Tourism (203)
Total firms: 7,439 firms
732
141
860
522
67
2,322 firms
called and
screened to
participate
421
82
320
673
98
1,594
firms
eligible to
participate
‘yes’ : 947
‘no’ : 647
75 firms *23cases removed
8 firms *1 case removed
89 firms
50 firms *9 cases removed
19 firms
Data cleaning eliminated: 33 cases
Eligible ‘yes’ responses to the
questionnaire: 947 (removal of 33
cases left 914 cases)
Total responses: 241 responses
Final responses: 208 (after data
cleaning)
Response rate: 22.75 %
Note. *A total of 33 cases were removed from the sample due to owner/founders not completing the
questionnaire. Data cleaning left 208 cases, all of which are owner/founders of the firm.
The sample selection pool in Table 6.1 includes the industries represented in the
questionnaire sample, in conjunction with the number of firms from selected industries
contacted, the number of eligible responses and the final response rate after data cleaning.
This study also includes respondents from the consumer goods sector, information
communication technology, manufacturing, professional business services and tourism.
These five industries were chosen because they rank among Australia’s top 25 export
industries (ABS, 2011). For example, consumer goods is one of Australia’s most dynamic
export industries, representing A$13.1 billion in 2010-2011 (ABS, 2012). Australia’s
173
ICT market is worth A$100 billion and is the fifth largest in the Asia-Pacific region,
employing 400,000 people (Austrade, 2010). Exports of goods from manufacturers
totalled A$41.7 billion, a 13.3% share of the export sector (Austrade, 2012). The
professional business services sector totalled A$3.2 billion in 2010-2011 (ABS, 2012). In
2010-2011, tourism contributed A$23.7 billion to Australia’s export earnings, a share of
8% of total export earnings for all goods and services (Department of Resources, Energy
and Tourism, 2012). Tourism’s total contribution to Australia’s GDP in 2010-2011 was
A$73.3 billion, a 5.2% share of Australia’s economy. In addition, the industry employed
907,100 people representing 7.9% of Australia’s total employment. Along with education,
tourism is Australia’s leading services exporter (Department of Resources, Energy and
Tourism, 2012). Further, these five industries collectively are worth more than $181
billion to Australia’s export performance, and account for more than 80% of all exports.
A total of 7,439 firms were included in the sample frame for Study Two. The Austrade
database provided the firms’ contact information, including company name, the owner or
best contact for the firm, the role of the individual contact, email and postal address,
phone number, the product or service offering details, and information about the export
history of the firm. For data management purposes, all firms eligible to participate in the
research were listed in an Excel spreadsheet. Every second firm in the export spreadsheet
was telephoned and encouraged to screen for participation in the research. A total of
2,322 firms were phoned and screened for eligibility as well as encouraged to participate
in the study. Duplication in firm contacts was avoided by a manual cross-check of the
2,322 firms, through the spreadsheet and hardcopy printouts of the company profiles. A
total of 1594 firms were eligible to participate in the research. That is, these 1594 firms
indicated that they were active in export behaviour. A total of 947 firms indicated ‘yes’,
that they would participate in the questionnaire, and 647 indicated ‘no’. A total of 947
firms were eligible to participate in the questionnaire. A total of 241 responses was
achieved initially, data cleaning eliminated 33 cases, due to the failure of an
owner/founder to complete the survey. The final number of completed questionnaires was
208, a response rate of 22.75%.
174
6.2.2 Unit of analysis
For the purpose of Study Two, international entrepreneurs from Australian SMEs were
selected to participate in the questionnaire. Research papers in international business have
argued that the international entrepreneur can be seen as the single representative of the
firm in relation to internal decision-making processes (Jantunen et al., 2005; Loane, 2006;
Mostafa et al., 2006). This is because decision-making power within SMEs is generally
concentrated in the hands of one or very few people (Reid, 1981). For instance,
owner/founders are generally the principal force behind the initiation, development,
sustenance and success of SME internationalisation (Chetty & Hamilton, 1993;
Hutchinson et al., 2006). Therefore, only owner/founders of international entrepreneurial
SMEs were accepted to participate in this research.
6.2.3 Selection of key informants
The selection of key informants was conducted in accordance with Huber and Power’s
(1985) guidelines in determining the appropriateness of informants for questionnaires.
Huber and Power (1985) suggest that an attempt should be made to identify the person
most knowledgeable in regards to the issue of interest. In this study, only the
owner/founder who possessed knowledge related to the firm’s resources and capabilities
were required to complete the online questionnaire. That is, only those data-rich
international entrepreneurs with the capacity to communicate and articulate the firm’s
perspective through a questionnaire format are appropriate for the study. As informants
will be largely chosen on the basis of their organisational title (Seidler, 1974), it is also
imperative to ascertain whether the person holding the title carries out the duties as
outlined in the questionnaire (Huber & Power, 1985). It is also important to note that
informants are asked to verify responses with another firm employee, such as the chief
financial officer, if the need arises.
The necessity for honesty and accuracy in the responses provided by the informants was
impressed upon entrepreneurs before they began completing the questionnaire. For
example, informants were reminded that ‘accuracy and honesty in their answers will
assist in building theory and a better understanding of how firms are using their resource
175
and capability base to achieve successful international market performance’. The
questionnaire can be seen in Appendix 2.
6.2.4 Instrument development
More general questions were placed at the beginning of the questionnaire to increase
respondents’ confidence (Lumsden, 2007), ensuring that participants would proceed with
the questionnaire. The format of the questions was considered important given that
international entrepreneurs were asked to reveal firm performance and financial
indicators. The items in the questionnaire were divided across pages to encourage survey
pacing (Malhotra, 2008), and also to decrease the likelihood of respondents missing
information by scrolling (Lumsden, 2007). However, it is important to note that
participants could not proceed to a question until the previous question had been
completed. A simple questionnaire design was employed to minimise the download time
and reduce the possibility of questionnaire abandonment (Dillman, 2011).
6.2.5 Pre-test of questionnaire
Before administering the online questionnaire via the Key Survey online questionnaire
platform, it was necessary to pre-test the instrument. The systematic process of pre-testing
a questionnaire instrument is central to the planning and implementation of a reliable
questionnaire (Malhotra, 2008; Hair, Black, Babin & Anderson, 2010). Pre-testing the
questionnaire is critical for identifying issues such as misinterpretation or confusion with
the overall meaning of questions. To pre-test the questionnaire a panel of six academics
were recruited to review the instrument. Three of these academics were experts in the
field of international business and entrepreneurship, and were familiar with the
questionnaire content. Three academics were not familiar with the content of the
questionnaire, but provided feedback on the on the structure and overall design of the
instrument. The expert reviews of the questionnaire can be seen in Appendix 3. Managers
from a total of 10 Australian SMEs engaged in international activity were also recruited
to informally review the questionnaire. The first 100 questionnaires were also utlised to
pre-test the instrument. The pre-test of the questionnaire revealed minor modifications
176
were necessary to re-word questions difficult to interpret. These key changes were
modified in the questionnaire, and again pre-tested to ensure no issues were apparent.
6.2.6 Data collection procedure
The questionnaire instrument was administered only via the Key Survey online platform.
Key Survey is an online survey creation tool that allows researchers to create and
distribute surveys and sort response data. The Key Survey online platform was deemed
appropriate in gaining responses from a large number across Australia. A total of 947
firms were initially sent a link to the online survey via email (see Appendix 4), and
telephoned to encourage to screen for participation in the study (see Appendix 5).
Critical to data collection procedure is the questionnaire design. Churchill’s (1979)
seminal paper critiques the scale development process and also provides a structured
approach to questionnaire design through developing measures. Firstly, step one is to
specify Study One. This involved establishing and defining the constructs and parameters
included in each construct. Secondly, Churchill (1979) recommends generating a sample
of items from multiple sources. In this study the multiple sources included a literature
review and multiple case studies. In this research a set of items was also established,
drawing upon the full hypothesised model. The questionnaire in this study was also pre-
tested as per Churchill (1979) and Bagozzi’s (1994) recommendation to pre-test the items
in the questionnaire, ensuring content and construct validity. Next, the items are subject to
data collection. Churchill (1979) recommends purification of the measures. In this study,
examination of the internal consistency utilising Chronbach’s alpha was conducted in
association with the elimination of items on the basis of the EFA.
Sources of information
The construct specification as shown in Table 6.2 was drawn from a convergence of a
literature review and the data collected in Study One. Primarily, Likert scales were
employed with a number of scale anchors utilised. The scale anchors utilised included the
following: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree; (1) limited use – (7) extensive use;
(1) significantly increased – (7) significantly decreased; (1) satisfied – (7) dissatisfied,
177
and (1) not at all important – (7) extremely important. The question, construct, scale and
measure of each item is shown in Table 6.2 below.
Table 6.2 Questionnaire construct specification
Number Scale Description and measure
Pre-survey
question Q1 Nominal
Do you own a business?
(yes) (no)
Pre-survey question Q2
Nominal Is the firm Australian owned? (yes) (no)
Pre-survey
question Q3 Nominal
Are you Australian?
(yes) (no)
Pre-survey question Q4
Nominal Are you the founder of the business? (yes) (no)
Pre-survey
question Q5 Nominal
How many employees does your business have?
(yes) (no)
PART A. International entrepreneurial orientation. Scale: (1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree) (Independent variable Factor 1)
Part A Q6 (IEOQ6)
Interval The firm tends to see the world as the firm’s marketplace.
Part A Q7
(IEOQ7) Interval
The culture at our firm is to actively explore new business opportunities internationally.
Part A Q8 (IEOQ8)
Interval The firm continuously communicates its mission to succeed in international markets.
Part A Q9
(IEOQ9) Interval
The firm develops resources (such as financial and human) for achieving our goals in international
Markets.
Part A Q10
(IEOQ10) Interval
The firm is experienced in international business.
Part A Q11
(IEOQ11) Interval
Over the past 5 years, our firm has marketed many products in international markets.
Part A Q12
(IEOQ12) Interval
In international markets, the firm has a tendency to take on high-risk projects.
Part A Q13
(IEOQ13) Interval
The firm is willing to go to great lengths to make our products succeed in international markets.
Part A Q14
(IEOQ14) Interval
The drive of managers in the firm is important in our decision to enter international markets.
PART B. Technology –related international vision. Scale: (1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree) (Independent variable Factor 2)
Part B. Q15 (TRIVQ15)
Interval The firm is committed to servicing international customers on the Internet.
Part B. Q16
(TRIVQ16) Interval
The firm commits sufficient human (e.g. staff) and financial resources (e.g. capital) to technology for
International market(s).
Part B. Q17 (TRIVQ17)
Interval The firm emphasises the importance of technology for international growth.
Part B. Q18
(TRIVQ18) Interval
The firm views managerial technology experience as important for entering international market(s).
Part B. Q19 (TRIVQ19)
Interval The firm views international growth through the Internet as achievable.
PART C. International business experience (Independent variable Factor 3)
Part C. Q20
(IBEQ20)
Interval
Please indicate the number of years’ experience related to export work you have as an owner/founder.
(1 none, 2 1-2 years, 3 2-3 years, 4 4-5 years, 5 5-6 years, 6 7-8 years, 7 8 years or more)
Part C. Q21
(IBEQ21) Interval
What is the number of previous entrepreneurial ventures where you have played similar management role?
(1 none, 2 1-2 years, 3 2-3 years, 4 4-5 years, 5 5-6 years, 6 7-8 years, 7 8 ventures or more)
Part C. Q22
(IBEQ22) Interval
What is your highest level of education?
(1 no formal education, 2 high school, 3 certificate level, 4 TAFE/technical college equivalent, 5 undergraduate university study, 6 postgraduate university study, 7 doctoral degree)
PART D. Internet, international marketing capabilities (Independent variable Factor 4)
Part D. Q23
(IIMCQ23) Interval
Please indicate your Internet usage - email, official company website, advertising and marketing, online sales,
after sales service, market research, identify competitors, in-house software development (1 limited use – 7 extensive use)
Part D. Q24
(IIMCQ24) Interval
Please indicate how much time is devoted in your firm to the strategic use of the Internet through the following
categories. Please indicate the percentage in the space provided. Categories - email, official company website, advertising and marketing, online sales, after sales service, market research, identify competitors, in-house
software development. (All categories must add up to 100%)
Part D. Q25
(IIMCQ25) Interval
Ability to leverage technology is important in my firm.
(1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
Part D. Q26
(IIMCQ26) Interval
Renewal of technology is important in my firm.
(1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
178
Number Scale Description and measure
Part D. Q27
(IIMCQ27) Interval
Investment in technology has led to greater international sales.
(1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
Part D. Q28 (IIMCQ28)
Interval The firm has strong IT operations capabilities. (1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
Part D. Q29
(IIMCQ29) Interval
The firm has the technological infrastructure and competencies to engage in e-commerce initiatives.
(1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
PART E. International virtual networking capability. Scale: (1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree) (Independent variable Factor 5)
Part E. Q30 (IVNCQ30)
Interval The firm uses the Internet to maintain international customer relationships.
Part E. Q31
(IVNCQ31) Interval
The firm uses the Internet to strengthen existing international relationships.
Part E. Q32 (IVNCQ32)
Interval The firm uses the Internet to develop longer lasting international relationships.
Part E. Q33
(IVNCQ33) Interval
The firm uses the Internet to acquire new international customers.
Part E. Q34 (IVNCQ34)
Interval The firm uses the Internet to enter new international country market(s).
Part E. Q35
(IVNCQ35) Interval
The firm uses the Internet to enhance our firm’s international performance.
PART F. International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. Scale: (1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree) (Independent variable Factor 6)
Part F. Q36
(IEORQ36) Interval
The firm actively seeks out new international market opportunities.
Part F. Q37
(IEORQ37) Interval
When we see a new international market opportunity we invest resources to exploit the new international
opportunity.
Part F. Q38
(IEORQ38) Interval
We pursue international opportunities regardless of the resources the firm may or may not have.
Part F. Q39 (IEORQ39)
Interval The firm has many formal or informal processes that evaluate the effectiveness of its activities in international markets.
Part F. Q40
(IEORQ40) Interval
We believe that recognising international opportunities and exploiting these opportunities adds value to the
firm.
PART G. International market performance (Independent variable factor 7)
Part G. Q41 (IMPQ41)
Interval Please indicate the extent of an increase or decrease since internationalisation on international market share. (1 significantly increased – 7 significantly decreased)
Part G. Q42
(IMPQ42) Interval
Please indicate the extent of an increase or decrease since internationalisation on international growth..
(1 significantly increased – 7 significantly decreased)
Part G. Q43
(IMPQ43) Interval
Please indicate the extent of an increase or decrease since internationalisation on international sales growth vs.
competitors.
(1 significantly increased – 7 significantly decreased)
Part G. Q44 (IMPQ44)
Interval Please indicate the extent of an increase or decrease since internationalisation on International profitability. (1 significantly increased – 7 significantly decreased)
Part G. Q45
(IMPQ45) Interval
Please indicate the extent of an increase or decrease since internationalisation on overall international
performance.
(1 significantly increased – 7 significantly decreased)
Part G. Q46
(IMPQ46) Interval
How satisfied have you been with your international activities during the last five years?
(1 dissatisfied– 7 satisfied)
Part G. Q47
Product
marker
variable
Interval
The following questions concern your firm’s product characteristics. Please indicate by selecting the appropriate
box. In my firm the company's product/s are classified as sophisticated, complex in nature, need(s) specialised know how to market, takes(s) a long time to learn about, has/have a large proportion that is technological in
nature, need(s) a high level of specialised service.
(1 strongly agree – 7 strongly disagree)
PART H. Demographic information and general business background
Part H. Q48 Nominal What is your age?
Part H. Q49 Nominal What is your gender?
Part H. Q50 Nominal My business sells products or services?
Part H. Q51 Nominal The industry our firm operates in is?
Part H. Q52 Nominal What percentage of the firm’s total gross sales generated from international customers over the last 12 months?
Part H. Q53 Interval What is the firm’s total revenue of sales generated from international customers over the last 12 months?
Part H. Q54 Nominal What year was your business established?
Part H. Q55 Nominal What is the number of countries you currently have customers in?
Part H. Q56 Nominal In what year did you gain your first international market?
Part H. Q57 Nominal What was the first international country your firm exported to?
Part H. Q58 Nominal What are the top five international countries you export to?
Part H. Q59 Nominal What is your firm’s postcode?
Part H. Q60 Open Do you have any further questions or information you would like to provide the research team?
179
Intervening variables
The first intervening variable, as seen in Table 6.2, is international entrepreneurial
orientation, where questions were asked concerning the firm’s innovativeness,
proactiveness and risk-taking propensities. Explicit questions related to the firm’s
international entrepreneurial orientation are posed in questions Q6 to Q14, Part A of the
questionnaire. The scale anchors utilised were derived from a seven-point Likert scale, (1)
strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree, the measures of which are adopted from the work
of Knight and Cavusgil (2004), which draws from Khandwalla (1977), Miller and Friesen
(1984), and Covin and Slevin (1989).
The second intervening variable is technology-related international vision. Questions
were asked in relation to the firm’s commitment to international customers, the resources
committed to international business, the importance for technology and international
growth, and managerial technology experience. Explicit questions associated with
technology-related international vision are posed in questions Q15 to Q19, Part B of the
questionnaire. The scale anchors used included were derived from a seven-point Likert
scale including: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree. The measures have been
adapted from the work of Nummela et al. (2004). It is important to note that all
adaptations of the measures were made ensuring the core concept of the item remained
intact. That is, only minimal changes were made to the measures on the basis of the
context of the research, which is the international environment in which these firms
operate.
The third intervening variable is international business experience. Questions related to
international business experience included the years of experience related to export
activities, the number of previous entrepreneurial ventures, and level of education of the
international entrepreneur. Explicit questions of international business experience were
posed in questions Q20 to Q22, Part C of the questionnaire. The scale anchors as seen in
Table 6.3 have been adapted from the work of Loane (2006).
180
Table 6.3 Items and scale anchors for international business experience
Item Scale anchor utilised
Years of experience in exporting (1) none
(2) 1-2 years
(3) 2-3 years
(4) 4-5 years
(5) 5-6 years
(6) 7-8 years
(7) 8 or more years
Number of previous entrepreneurial ventures (1) none
(2) 1-2 years
(3) 2-3 years
(4) 4-5 years
(5) 5-6 years
(6) 7-8 years
(7) 8 or more years
Highest level of education (1) no formal education
(2) high school
(3) certificate level
(4) TAFE/technical college equivalent
(5) undergraduate university study
(6) postgraduate university study
(7) Doctorate degree
The forth intervening variable is Internet, international marketing capabilities. Questions
related to the firm’s ability to integrate the Internet into the international business
activities of the business were asked. Explicit questions related to Internet, international
marketing capabilities within the firm were posed in questions Q24 to Q29, Part D of the
questionnaire. The scale anchors used included: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree,
and (1) limited use – (7) extensive use. These measures are adapted from the work of Zhu
and Kramer (2002), Aspelund and Moen (2004), Gibbs and Kramer (2004) and Liao et
al., (2009), with the core concept of the measure remaining intact.
The fifth intervening variable is international virtual networking capability. Questions
were related to the firm’s use of the Internet for maintaining customer relationships,
strengthening existing relationships, developing longer lasting networks, acquiring new
customers, entering new international markets, and enhancing the firm’s performance.
Explicit questions were posed in questions Q30 to Q35, Part E of the questionnaire. The
scale anchors were derived from a seven-point Likert scale including: (1) strongly agree –
(7) strongly disagree. The measures were adapted from the work of Wu et al. (2003) and
Loane (2006), with the core concept of the measure remaining intact.
181
The sixth intervening variable is international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition.
Questions asked related to the firm’s ability to seek out new international opportunities in
an Internet space, the ability of the firm to invest resources to exploit opportunity, the
processes in place to evaluate the effectiveness of international market activity, and
international opportunity as adding value to the firm. Explicit questions were posed in
questions Q36 to Q40, Part F of the questionnaire. The scale anchors are adapted from a
seven-point Likert scale including: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree. The
measures were adapted from Lumpkin and Lichtenstein (2005) and Dimitratos et al.
(2012).
Dependent outcome variable
The last variable to be considered is the dependent variable, international market
performance. The international market performance variable is central to the model as the
variable measures the output performance of the firm. International market performance
was measured by the extent of the decrease or increase in market share, sales growth,
sales growth versus competitors, international profitability and overall international
performance since internationalisation, as well through an assessment of the firm’s
overall satisfaction with international activities during the last five years. Explicit
questions were posed in questions Q41 to Q46, Part G of the questionnaire. The scale
anchors were derived from a seven-point Likert scale including: (1) significantly
increased – (7) significantly decreased, and (1) satisfied – (7) dissatisfied. The measures
have been both adopted intact and adapted from the work of Moen, Masden and Aspelund
(2008), Nummela et al. (2004) and Jantunen et al. (2005).
6.2.7 Evaluation of reliability and validity
Content validity
Content validity refers to the extent to which a measure represents all facets of a given
construct (Hair et al., 2010), and that the measures represent adequately the set of item
indicators intended (Sekeran, 2000). A number of steps to ensure content validity were
actioned. Firstly, a review and synthesis of the literature pertaining to IE and the Internet
182
within international business studies was conducted in Chapter Two. Secondly, multiple
case study analysis in Chapter Four assisted in the confirmation and refinement of
constructs. Thirdly, the questionnaire was developed from the findings of the data in
Chapter Four and was initially pre-tested with both academics and international
entrepreneurial business owners. Fourthly, an EFA and CFA were conducted. The CFA is
explained further in Chapter Seven.
Construct validity
Construct validity refers to whether a scale measures or correlates with the actual
construct being investigated (Hair et al., 2010). Thus, construct validity is also the degree
to which inferences can be made legitimately from the operationalisation of the
constructs. Construct validity can be assessed by convergent and discriminant validity.
Convergent validity refers to the degree to which two measures of constructs that
theoretically should be related are actually related (Churchill, 1979; Hair et al., 2010). In
this study, convergent validity was measured using the scores obtained from two different
instruments measuring the same concept to indicate whether the constructs were
positively related. The data analysis in Chapter Six was utlised to assist in the
identification of similar scale measures, which are addressed in the EFA and CFA.
Discriminant validity by contrast tests whether concepts or measurements that are
supposed to be unrelated are actually unrelated (Hair et al., 2010). That is, discriminant
validity is the degree to which a measure is different from others and the extent to which
the measure is novel or different (Churchill, 1979). In this study data analysis was utilised
to distinguish accurate measures for specific constructs, which are evaluated in the EFA
and CFA.
Reliability
Reliability is the degree to which the observed variable measures the ‘true’ value and is
‘error free’ (Hair et al., 2010). Reliability indicates the extent to which a measure is free
from bias and offers consistent stable measures across time within questionnaire items
(Churchill, 1979). To ensure reliability of the questionnaire, interval scales were utilised
predominantly throughout with limited use of ratio or nominal scales. The constructs
183
were also operationalised with multiple indictors as opposed to a single-measure item
(Churchill, 1979). To increase reliability, the questionnaire was also pre-tested and
modified according to feedback from academics and international entrepreneurial
owner/founders.
6.2.8 Non-response bias
Non-response bias refers to the bias that exists when respondents to a questionnaire are
different from those that did not respond in terms of demographic and attitudinal
variables (Sax, Gilmartin & Bryant, 2003). There are a number of ways to address and
overcome the issues associated with non-response bias (Armstrong & Overton, 1977).
Firstly, Study Two utilised the government-founded Austrade database to recruit
respondents. An independent data source (Australian Bureau of Statistics) was utilised to
assess respondent characteristics so as to establish a respondent sample that is
representative of the broader Australian SME population.
Both geographical locations by postcode and size of the firm were utilised
(Wickramasekera & Oczkowski, 2006). That is, selection of firms by postcode and size of
the firm will ensure that equal amounts of small- and medium-sized firms will be eligible
to participate in the questionnaire. For example, the Australian Bureau of Statistics (2010-
2011) indicates that 33.14% of businesses are located in New South Wales (NSW), and
the questionnaire closely aligned with 34.13% of respondents. Businesses located in
Victoria (VIC) account for 25.51% of businesses (33.17% of responses); 20.19% of
businesses are located in Queensland (28.37% of responses); South Australian (SA)
businesses account for 6.95% (2.40% of responses); Western Australian (WA) businesses
account for 10.44% (1.92% of responses). The postcode characteristics of the
questionnaire responses in Table 6.4 are representative of the counts of Australian
business by main state.
184
Table 6.4 Postcode characteristics of the survey responses
Postcode ABS
Statistics*
(2008-2009)
ABS
Statistics*
(2009-2010)
ABS
Statistics*
(2010-2011)
Responded Percentage
(%)
NSW 33.15% 33.17% 33.14% 71 34.13%
VIC 25.13% 25.30% 25.51% 69 33.17%
QLD 20.52% 20.39% 20.19% 59 28.37%
SA 7.04% 7.00% 6.95% 5 2.40%
WA 10.40% 10.04% 10.44% 4 1.92%
TOTAL - - - 208 100%
The respondents contacted to complete the online questionnaire were also representative
of the industry proportions eligible and accepted to participate in the research. There was
similarity in those who were eligible and accepted to participate and those that actually
participated in all industry sectors. For example, consumer goods accounted for 24.08%
of all firms eligible and accepted to participate, and 25% of all firms responded.
Information communication technologies accounted for 2.01% of firms and 3.37% of
firms responded, indicating that information communication technologies are
proportionate to the industry. The manufacturing industry accounted for 42.03% of firms
and all 42.79% of firms responded to the questionnaire. In the professional business
services sector, 23.02% of firms were eligible and accepted to participate and 19.71% of
firms responded. The tourism sector accounted for 8.87% of eligible and accepted
responses and all 9.13% of firms responded to the questionnaire. The findings of Table
6.5 indicate that the responding firms in this research that were eligible and accepted to
participate in the questionnaire were representative of the industry proportions. Therefore,
non-response bias is reduced.
Table 6.5 Representative industry proportions
Industry Accepted Percentage (%) Responded Percentage (%)
Consumer goods 228 24.08% 52 25.00%
Information communication technology 19 2.01% 7 3.37%
Manufacturing 398 42.03% 89 42.79%
Professional business services 218 23.02% 41 19.71%
Tourism 84 8.87% 19 9.13%
TOTAL 947 eligible 100% 208 responses 100%
Source: *(ABS 2012).
185
Lastly, non-response bias was evaluated utilising a two-tail T test. The process of using
an extrapolation method, such as a two-tail T test, also ensures that the data set will be
similar with respect to those respondents who submitted early and those respondents who
submitted late with coaxing (Armstrong & Overton, 1997). Estimating non-response bias
by equating individuals who responded later in the administration period with non-
respondents, then comparing with the early respondents to determine types of bias, is
considered to be an appropriate method for estimating non-response bias (Hutchinson,
Tollefson & Wigington, 1987; Sax et al., 2003).
Non-response bias was evaluated using the extrapolation method of a two-tail T test (Hair
et al., 2010). The two-tail T test indicated that only international business experience
shows a non-significant difference. The literature acknowledges that many factors will
impact a firm’s performance, and that experience is not necessarily the strongest of these
factors (Reuber & Fischer, 1999). The measurement of international business experience
is often fragmented and inconclusive (Reuber & Fischer, 1999). In particular, the
international business experience construct is most often utlised in more traditional,
generic models of internationalisation. The results of the two-tail T test indicate that the
construct does not fit well with the other key factors. The significance two-tail test for
non-response bias is shown in Table 6.6.
Table 6.6 Significance two-tail test for non-response bias
Factor Factor label Factor
code
Item code Question Sig.
Two- tail
Analysis
Factor 1 International entrepreneurial
orientation IEO WWORLD Q6 (1)* .016 sig.
Factor 2 Technology-related
international vision TRIV SERINC Q15 (1)* .002 sig.
Factor 3 International business
experience IBE YEAREX Q20 (1)* .546 not sig.
Factor 4 Internet, international
marketing capabilities IIMC LEVTEC Q25 (1)* .004 sig.
Factor 5 International, virtual
networking capability IVNC CURSEL Q30 (1)* .048 sig.
Factor 6 International entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition IEOR ACTIVE Q36 (1)* .029 sig.
Factor 7 International market
performance IMP MRKSHA Q41 (1)* .001 sig.
Note. *Only question (1) was utlised in significance two-tail test for non-response bias. Question (1) of
each construct in the questionnaire is also noted.
186
6.2.9 Common method variance
Common method variance is an increasingly important issue faced by many researchers
in the international business field (Chang, van Witteloostuijn & Eden, 2010). Common
method variance is defined as the ‘variance that is attributable to the measurement
method rather than to the constructs the measures represent’ (Podsakoff, MacKenzie,
Yeon Lee & Podsakoff, 2003, p. 879). Common method variance can create a false
internal consistency, an apparent correlation among variables generated by their common
source (Chang et al., 2010). For example, Chang et al. (2010) highlight that common
method variance can occur if the researcher asks respondents to evaluate a firm’s
organisational capabilities and international market performance in the same
questionnaire. Considering that Study Two utilised a single respondent and both the
independent and dependent variables are measured at one point in time, it is necessary to
investigate the potential of common method variance, as bias can lead to a distortion or
inflation of the correlations presented. A number of considerations have been taken into
account in dealing with common method variance. First, the reliability of the questions
presented in the questionnaire were validated and therefore verified by five co-
researchers.
To overcome the issue of common method variance, a seven-point Likert scale was
employed and a number of scale anchors utilised. The scale anchors utilised in the seven-
point Likert scale included: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree, (1) limited use – (7)
extensive use, (1) significantly decreased – (7) significantly increased, (1) satisfied – (7)
dissatisfied, and (1) not at all important – (7) extremely important. Using differing scale
anchors limits the potential for bias from common method variance. Separate questions
for both the independent and dependent variables in this study were also asked in order to
generate responses unique for each question. The measures utilised in this research have
also been collated from a number of sources, thus limiting the common method bias in the
procedural controls of the study (Podsakoff et al., 2003). By integrating a variety of
questions into the questionnaire, the likelihood of common method bias is reduced
(Podsakoff et al., 2003).
187
Respondents are also asked to answer all questions honestly and accurately and where
necessary are urged to seek further information from a company representative to clarify
responses. Informing respondents that there are no wrong or right answers in the
questionnaire also diminishes the possibility of common method bias (Podsakoff et al.,
2003; Chang et al., 2010). Protecting the anonymity of the respondent is also an
additional procedure to reduce common method variance (Podsakoff et al., 2003).
Participants in this research were informed that all information collected was anonymous
and will be treated confidentially; the names of individuals and firms completing the
questionnaire were also not required.
Podsakoff et al. (2003) also suggest the use of a Harman’s Single-Factor Test, a technique
most widely utilised by researchers to address the issue of common method variance.
Lindell and Whitney (2001) suggest that when researchers are assessing correlations that
have been identified as being highly vulnerable, such as those questions requiring self-
reporting, a Correlated Marker Variable Technique should be utilised. The Correlated
Marker Variable Technique utilised in this study is ‘product characteristics’, theoretically
not related to the constructs as presented in the model. The Harman’s Single-Factor Test
and the Correlated Marker Variable Technique are discussed further in Chapter Seven.
6.3 Exploratory factor analysis (EFA)
Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) coefficients for reliability and validity
Factor analysis is an interdependence technique where the primary purpose is to define
the underlying structure among the variables in the analysis (Hair et al., 1010). Factor
analysis is a data reduction technique whereby a large number of variables can be
summarised into a more meaningful, smaller set of factors and used to identify inter-
relationships between variables in a data set (Allen & Bennett, 2012). The test for internal
consistency and reliability of the scale items was carried out using Chronbach’s Alpha
(ά), following Churchill’s (1979) suggestion that the test of alpha be the initial measure to
assess the quality of the instrument. According to Anderson and Gerbing (1988),
structural equation modelling consists of a two-step modelling approach including an
EFA and CFA. The first step is to subject the items to an EFA prior to structural equation
188
modelling. The factors in the Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) coefficient output indicate values of
(ά < .7) except for the international business experience factor.
The output indicates values of international entrepreneurial orientation (ά .913),
technology-related international vision (ά .859), international business experience (ά
.376), Internet, international marketing capabilities (ά .914), international virtual network
capabilities (ά .921), international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (ά .920), and
international market performance (ά .776). The Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin (KMO) measures
sampling adequacy. Higher KMO values are more acceptable (Allen & Bennett, 2012);
values (.5) or lower are unacceptable. The KMO values are above (< .8) except Factor 3:
International business experience.
Given the Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) coefficient is at an unacceptable level, the KMO value
for international business experience is also affected. This is because the international
business experience construct is often not the strongest factor in determining the
international market performance of the firm in more contemporary models of
internationalisation (Reuber & Fischer, 1999). The KMO values for the remaining six
factors are at acceptable levels: international entrepreneurial orientation (.890),
technology-related international vision (.824), international business experience (.516*),
Internet, international marketing capabilities (.844), international virtual network
capabilities (.826), international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (.874), and
international market performance (.934). The reliability and internal consistency tests are
presented in Table 6.7.
189
Table 6.7 Reliability and internal consistency tests
Factor Factor name Factor
code
Number of
items per
factor
Chronbach’s
Alpha
(ά)
KMO
Factor
1
International entrepreneurial
orientation IEO 9 .913 .890
Factor
2 Technology-related international vision TRIV 5 .859 .824
Factor
3 International business experience IBE 3 .376 .516*
Factor
4
Internet, international marketing
capabilities IIMC 6 .914 .844
Factor
5 International virtual network capability INVC 6 .921 .826
Factor
6
International entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition IEOR 5 .920 .874
Factor
7 International market performance IMP 6 .934 .858
Bartlett’s Test of Sphericity
Bartlett’s Test of Sphericity indicates how suitable the data are for factor analysis. The
test was utilised to examine the correlation matrix, which provides an assessment of the
statistical correlation between factors, or the overall significance of all correlations within
a correlation matrix (Hair et al., 2010). Bartlett’s Test of Sphericity should be significant
(Sig < 0.5) for factors to be considered appropriate for factor analysis (Allen & Bennett,
2012). In this study all the factors were considered to be significant (Sig < .5).
Factor loadings and the Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin measure of sampling adequacy
In assessing statistical significance Hair et al. (2010) note that a factor loading represents
the correlation between an original variable and its factor. In determining the significance
level for the interpretation of the loadings, an approach similar to determining the
statistical significance of correlation coefficients was utilised. The KMO measure of
sampling adequacy in Table 6.7 and the factor loadings in Table 6.8 will now be
discussed in relation to the EFA in Table 6.8. Firstly, international entrepreneurial
orientation will be discussed.
*Note. The Chronbach Alpha (ά) and KMO indicate that the international business experience construct
is not fit for factor analysis.
190
Factor 1: International entrepreneurial orientation indicates all items (IEO Q6 to Q14),
as seen in Table 6.8 loaded together as a factor. That is, the multi-item factoring of these
items represents the construct, international entrepreneurial orientation. The factor
loadings are above (> .5) with the KMO measure of sampling adequacy at (.890). The
KMO indicates the amount of variance in the data that can be explained by the factors
(Allen & Bennett, 2012). Higher values are more appropriate, and values (.5) or lower are
unacceptable. Factor 2: technology-related international vision indicates all items (TRIV
Q15 to Q19) loaded together as a factor. The factor loadings are above (.6) and the KMO
is (.824). Factor 3: International business experience factor loaded with two main items
(IBE Q20 to Q21), with factor loadings (.710) and (.451). Item IBEQ22 indicated a factor
loading of (.160). The KMO is (.516). Given that the measure of sampling adequacy
indicates that values of (> .5) or lower are unacceptable and values of (> .6) or above are
acceptable, the international business experience factor will be excluded from the model.
This is because the international business experience construct is most often identified in
more generic/traditional models of internationalisation. As such, the international
business experience construct is not relevant for this study. Factor 4: Internet,
international marketing capabilities indicates all items (IIMC Q25 to Q29) loaded
together as a factor. The factor loadings are above (> .7) and the KMO is (.844).
Factor 5: International virtual networking capability factor is loaded with two main items
(IVNC Q33 to Q34) – that is, international virtual network capability loaded with two
items that are capturing new relationships. The items IVNC Q33 and Q34 were extracted
by evaluating the factor using a Varimax rotation (Hair et al., 2010). The two main items
(IVNC Q33 to Q34) indicate low factor loadings of (.135) and (.110), and therefore have
been excluded from the model. The remaining four items (IVNC Q30, Q31, Q32, Q35)
are loaded together as factor. The factor loadings were above (> .7) and the KMO is
(.826). The remaining four items represent the construct, international virtual network
capability.
Factor 6: International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition indicates all items (IEOR
Q36 to Q40) loaded together as a factor. The factor loadings are above (> .7) and the
KMO is (.874). Factor 7: International market performance indicates the factor loaded
191
with one main item. The item IMPQ46 was extracted by evaluating the factor using a
Varimax rotation (Hair et al., 2010). IMPQ46 captures a new relationship that is not
consistent with the remaining five items (IMP Q41 to Q45). The item IMPQ46 indicates a
factor loading of (.440). Although Hair et al. (2010) suggest that with a sample size of at
least 200 responses, factor loadings should be above (> .4), the item is excluded from the
model due to weakness in the measure as compared with items (IMP Q41 to Q45). The
remaining five items (IMP Q41 to Q45) indicate factor loadings above (> .7) and the
KMO (.868).
Table 6.8 EFA measurement model
Expected
relationships
Item question Measures Factor
loading
Confirm or
disconfirm
Comment
Factor 1 IEO International entrepreneurial orientation
WWORLD IEOQ6 Firm’s view of the world as the market .746 Confirmed Items loaded well on the factor international entrepreneurial
orientation. KMO is .890 ACTEXPL IEOQ7 Culture and pursuing new opportunities .833
MISION IEOQ8 Mission and international markets .773
RESALO IEOQ9 Develops resources to achieve goals .863
EXPBUS IEOQ10 Experience in international business .637
MKTIIB IEOQ11 Marketing products over the past five years .727
HIRISK IEOQ12 Tendency to take on high-risk projects .583
SUCINT IEOQ13 Great lengths taken to succeed internationally .807
VISDRI IEOQ14 Importance of the drive of entrepreneurs .645
Factor 2 TRIV Technology-related international vision
SERINC TRIVQ15 Commitment to serving Internet customers .821 Confirmed Items loaded well on the factor
technology-related international
vision. KMO is .824 RESINT TRIVQ16 Commits resources to Internet marketing .773
GROWTH TRIVQ17 Emphasis on international growth .746
IEXPIM TRIVQ18 Managerial technology experience importance .726
ACHIEV TRIVQ19 Growth through the Internet is achievable .642
Factor 3 IBE International business experience
YEAREX IBEQ20 Years’ experience related to export work .710 Disconfirm Items are excluded from the final
model. KMO is .516 NUMVEN IBEQ21 Number of previous ventures .451
EDUCAT IBEQ22 Highest level of education .160
Factor 4 IIMC Internet, international marketing capabilities
LEVTEC IIMCQ25 Ability to leverage technology in the firm .886 Confirmed Items loaded well on the factor
Internet, international marketing
capabilities. KMO is .844 TECPEF IIMCQ26 Renewal of technology importance .835
RENTRC IIMCQ27 Investment in technology and sales .791
INVIOC IIMCQ28 IT operational capabilities of the firm .841
TECINF IIMCQ29 Technological infrastructure and e-commerce .769
Factor 5 IVNC International virtual networking capability Modified and confirmed
CUSREL IVNCQ30 Internet to maintain international relations .944 .943 Two-factors were extracted. Only
one factor is statistically evident. Two weak items are excluded
from the model (IVNCQ33 and
IVNCQ34). The subsequent items load well. KMO is .826
EXIREL IVNCQ31 Internet to strengthen international relations .956 .946
LONGRE IVNCQ32 Internet to develop longer lasting relations .907 .913
ACQNEW IVNCQ33 Internet to acquire new international relations .135*
NEWMAR IVNCQ34 Internet to enter new international countries .110*
NINTPE IVNCQ35 Internet to enhance international performance .735 .792
Factor 6 IEOR International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
ACTIVE IEORQ36 Actively seeks new international opportunity .860 Confirmed Items loaded well on the factor
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. KMO is
.874
RESEXP IEORQ37 Invests resources to exploit opportunities .904
PUROPP IEORQ38 Pursues opportunity regardless of resources .827
PROEVL IEORQ39 Formal and informal processes for evaluation .869
ADDVAL IEORQ40 Recognising and exploiting opportunities .719
Factor 7 IMP International market performance (DV) Modified and confirmed
MRKSHA IMPQ41 International market share .904 .907 Two factors were extracted. Only
one factor is statistically evident. One weak item (IMPQ46) is
excluded from the model. The
SALGROW IMPQ42 International growth .896 .895
SALGVC IMPQ43 International sales growth vs. competitors .721 .732
INTPRO IMPQ44 International profitability .877 .872
192
Expected
relationships
Item question Measures Factor
loading
Confirm or
disconfirm
Comment
OPERAS IMPQ45 Overall international market performance .896 .889 remaining items (IMPQ41- Q45)
load well. The KMO is .858. SATIAC IMPQ46 Satisfaction with international activities .440*
6.4 Structural equation modelling
Structural equation modelling (SEM) is a technique that allows for separate relationships
for a set of dependent variables, and provides the appropriate and most efficient
estimation technique for a series of separate multiple regression equations estimated
simultaneously (Hair et al., 2010). SEM is characterised by two components: (i) the
structural model, and (ii) the measurement model (Anderson & Gerbing, 1988). The
structural model is the path model, which relates independent to dependent variables
(Hair et al., 2010). The measurement model enables the researcher to utilise several
variables or indictors for a single independent or dependent variable. SEM is not made up
of a single form of analysis; instead the analytical process consists of a CFA, covariant
analysis and latent variable analysis (Anderson & Gerbing, 1988).
Preceding Study One, verification of constructs and modelling of the initial qualitative
data in conjunction with the quantitative modelling process gives statistical
generalisability to the research through a confirmatory process (Eisenhardt, 1989). SEM
is used often used in complex studies that have multiple variables as seen in this project
where inter-relationships can be identified across firm-level resources, capabilities,
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, and international market
performance. This multivariate approach allows researchers to confirm and construct
theory through identification of the strength of relationships in a holistic manner
(Bagozzi, 1994). As such, scholars agree that SEM identifies a greater degree of
complexity than other more traditional methods of multivariate analysis (Hair et al.,
2010). This is because SEM goes beyond simple linear relationships to identify variables
which are not directly measured (Hair et al., 2010).
Several aspects of SEM set it apart from more traditional means of multivariate
procedures. Firstly, SEM takes a confirmatory rather than an exploratory approach to the
analysis of data (Byrne, 2010). Secondly, SEM lends itself well to the analysis of data for
Note. *Item excluded due to low factor loadings.
193
inferential purposes; most other multivariate procedures by contrast are descriptive in
nature (Byrne, 2010). Thirdly, more traditional multivariate procedures are incapable of
either assessing or correcting for measurement error; SEM provides explicit estimates of
these error variance parameters (Byrne, 2010; Hair et al., 2010). Therefore, a key benefit
of utilising SEM is the ability to provide greater flexibility to the inter-relationships of the
model. Fourthly, although data analyses using more traditional means of multivariate
analysis, such as component, factor and discriminant analysis or multiple regression, are
based on observed measurements only, analysis using SEM can incorporate both
unobserved (i.e. latent), and observed variables (Bryne, 2010). Given that there are no
widely and easily applied alternative methods for modelling multivariate relations, or for
the estimation of indirect effects as proposed by SEM, this research will utilise the SEM
process to effectively address the inter-relationships between firm-level resources and
capabilities.
6.5 Conclusion
In summary, Chapter Six outlined the quantitative methodology that will be used to test
the model of ‘Capabilities in IE’. The quantitative research design was outlined with
specific attention given to the population and study sample, the unit of analysis, selection
of key informants, the process of pre-testing the questionnaire, the data collection
procedures, non-response bias, common method variance, and data analysis. An EFA was
conducted and discussed. Next, Chapter Seven will present and discuss the results of
quantitative Study Two.
194
CHAPTER SEVEN: RESULTS OF QUANTITATIVE STUDY TWO
7.1 Introduction
In Chapter Seven the results of Study Two are presented and the evaluation for the
measurement and structural models is provided. Study Two addresses research question
two (RQ2a), ‘What is the relative influence of firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities on international performance?’, and research
question two (RQ2b), ‘How do international entrepreneurs leverage Internet,
international marketing capabilities for international performance?’ The aim of Study
Two is to test the hypothesis developed from Study One, and to confirm the model of
‘Capabilities in IE’. The reliability and validity of the measurement model is assessed
with the relevant model-fit indices for the final and competing models. The sample
characteristics and data screening are also assessed. Initial analysis of the data was
undertaken using IBM SPSS Statistics 19, followed by a structural equation model
utilising IBM SPSS AMOS 21 software to test the inter-relationships between the
constructs identified in the theoretical model. This chapter also provides evaluations and
conclusions that are drawn from the data. A diagrammatic overview of Chapter Seven is
provided in Figure 7.1.
Figure 7.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Seven
Full structural model (7.4)
Introduction (7.1)
Initial examination of the data (7.2)
Hypothesises evaluation (7.5)
Conclusion (7.6)
Measurement model (7.3)
195
7.2 Initial examination of the data
7.2.1 Profile of responding firms
Initial examination of the data revealed the average number of people employed in firms
is between 6 and 20 persons, with 99% of the data falling within the Australian Bureau of
Statistics (2012) classification of an SME, employing between 1 and 200 people. A total
of 39 firms were classified as small-sized, accounting for 18.75% of the total number of
respondents (employing between 1 and 5 people); 100 firms medium sized, accounting
for 48.08% of the sample (employing between 6 and 20 people); and 69 firms are
medium-sized in nature, accounting for 33.17% (employing between 21 and 200 people).
Table 7.1 gives a profile of respondent firms, including size and location of firms.
Table 7.1 Profile of respondent firm’s including size and location
*Profile Parameters Number of
respondents
Percentage (%)
Size 1-5 persons
6- 20 persons
21- 200 persons
Missing
TOTAL
39
100
69
0
n=208
18.75%
48.08%
33.17%
-
100%
Location New South Wales
Victoria
Queensland
South Australia
Western Australia
Missing
TOTAL
71
69
59
5
4
0
n=208
34.13%
33.17%
28.37%
2.40%
1.92%
-
100%
Note. n= 208 firms (total firms surveyed)
Profile of respondent firms per main state
Respondents in this study were drawn from main five states as shown in Table 7.1.
Overall, the sample approximates national representativeness of the broader business
population in Australia for the five main states only as established in section 6.2.8. The
percentage of respondents per main state as compared with ABS (2012) statistics can be
seen in Table 7.2.
196
Table 7.2 Percentage of respondents per main state compared with ABS statistics
Postcode ABS
Statistics*
(2010-2011)
Responded Percentage
(%)
NSW 33.14% 71 34.13%
VIC 25.51% 69 33.17%
QLD 20.19% 59 28.37%
SA 6.95% 5 2.40%
WA 10.44% 4 1.92%
TOTAL - n= 208 100%
Source: *(ABS 2012).
Profile of respondent firm’s international market behaviour
The data in Appendix 6 outlines the international market behaviour of firms in this study,
indicating that the majority of firms (75.96%) were established between the years 1981
and 2000 and that 17.31% of firms were established between 2001 and 2006. Recent
business start-ups established between 2007 and 2012 account for 6.25% of the sample.
The annual turnover figures indicate that 11.05% of firms earn less than $100,000
annually, 27.41% of firms earn between $100,000 and $500,000, and 48.56% of firms
earn between $500,000 and $5 million. Only 12.98% of firms earn more than $5 million
annually.
The profile of respondent firms’ international market behaviour also indicates that
49.04% of firms receive between 16% and 49% of their revenue from international
markets, 35.10% of firms receive between 50% and 100% of revenue from international
markets, and 11.06% of firms receive between 6% and 15% of revenue from international
markets. A total of 10 firms (4.81%) indicated the proportion of revenue coming from
international markets was less than 5%.
A total of 49.04% of respondent firms have customers in up to five countries, 22.60% of
firms are active in 6 to 10 markets, and 28.37% of firms are active in more than 10
international markets. The data in Appendix 6 also indicates that the main first
international markets firms for respondent firms included both English-speaking and non-
English-speaking markets. For example, the firms first exporting to English-speaking
markets accounted for 44.22% of the sample. Firms first exporting to non-English-
197
speaking markets accounted for 55.78 % of the sample. More specifically, the top three
first export markets were the United Kingdom (19.71%), China (15.53%) and New
Zealand (15.38%). The data in Appendix 6 also indicates that 47.20% of firms are
currently engaged in exporting activity in English-speaking markets. The majority of
firms (52.44%) are currently exporting to non-English-speaking markets.
Profile of international entrepreneurs demographics
All respondents in this study were owner/founders of an SME, responsible for key
decision-making within the firm. That is, all international entrepreneurs were responsible
for the international decisions made within the firm. The data in Table 7.3 indicates that
the sample is slightly skewed towards males, with male respondents accounting for
65.38% of the sample and females for 34.62%. A total of 92.31% of international
entrepreneurs surveyed were of Australian nationality, while only 7.69% of respondents
were not Australian-born. The data indicates that the majority of the international
entrepreneurs (84.13%) were aged 40 and above. International entrepreneurs aged below
40 only accounted for 15.59% of the sample. A demographic profile of the international
entrepreneur’s demographics is provided in Table 7.3 below.
Table 7.3 Demographic profile of international entrepreneur’s demographics
Profile Parameters Number Percentage
(%)
Gender Male
Female
Missing
TOTAL
136
72
0
n=208
65.38%
34.62%
0
100%
Nationality of
the owner
Australia
Other
Missing
TOTAL
192
16
0
n=208
92.31%
7.69%
0%
100%
Age of the owner 20-29
30-39
40-49
50-59
60 or above
Missing
TOTAL
6
27
47
85
43
0
n=208
2.61%
12.98%
22.59%
40.86%
20.68%
0
100%
Note. n = 208 firms (total firms surveyed)
198
Profile of respondents’ international experience
The data on the level of education of international entrepreneurs shows that 28.37% of the
sample had obtained a university-level degree at the undergraduate level. A total of
15.38% of the sample attended a TAFE/technical college, while 14.90% of respondents
had obtained a postgraduate degree such as a masters. The lack of a formal education is
evident in 14.42% of firms, while 13.94% of international entrepreneurs had obtained a
high school certificate. The data also indicates that 12.98% of respondents reached the
certificate level of formal education. The majority of respondents in the questionnaire
(62.50%) indicated that they had more than eight years of industry experience, while
11.06% of the sample indicated no prior industry experience. A total of 44.71% of firms
indicated that they had not worked previously in an entrepreneurial venture. International
entrepreneurs who had previously worked in one-to-three ventures accounted for 48.08%
of the sample, those who had previously worked in four-to-six ventures accounted for
4.81% of the sample, while only 2.40% of international entrepreneurs indicated working
in seven or more ventures. The profile of respondents’ international experience can be
seen in Table 7.4 below.
Table 7.4 Profile of respondents’ international experience
Profile Parameters Number Percentage (%)
Level of education No formal education
High school
Certificate level
TAFE/college
Undergraduate
Postgraduate
Missing
TOTAL
30
29
27
32
59
31
0
n=208
14.42%
13.94%
12.98%
15.38%
28.37%
14.90%
0
100%
Years of industry
experience
No experience
1-5 years
More than 5 less than 8 years
8+ years
Missing
TOTAL
23
37
18
130
0
n=208
11.06%
17.79%
8.66%
62.50%
0
100%
Number of
previous
entrepreneurial
ventures worked
No previous ventures
1-3 ventures
4-6
7 or more ventures
Missing
TOTAL
93
100
10
5
0
n=208
44.71%
48.08%
4.81%
2.40%
0
100%
Note. n = 208 firms (total firms surveyed)
199
Internet usage profile
The Internet usage summary in Table 7.5 indicates that all firms were using the Internet
for email purposes. A total of 61.54% of firms indicated extensive use of email
applications within the firm. A total of 71.63% of firms indicated extensive use of the
company’s website, while only 2.88% of firms that indicated no use or limited use of the
Internet for website purposes. A total of 62.02% of firms indicated extensive use of online
advertising and marketing, as opposed to 4.33% of firms that indicated no use or limited
use. The data also indicates complex use of the Internet beyond simple use such as email,
website application and advertising and marketing. For example, extensive use of the
Internet for the use of online sales accounts was reported by 39.42% of firms, with
15.87% of firms indicating no use or limited use of the Internet for this purpose. After
sales research through the Internet was extensively utilised in 25.96% of firms, while
6.25% of firms indicated no use or limited use. Conducting market research online was
identified by 21.15% of firms, with only 2.40% of firms indicating no use or limited use.
Extensive use of the Internet to identify competition was exhibited in 16.83% of firms,
while 3.85% of firms indicated no use or limited use. In-house software development is
most often a costly exercise, especially for the resource-constrained firm. The data shows
that only 5.77% of the sample invested resources in software development for their
international customer database, while 37.05% of the sample indicated that they were not
investing or had invested minimally into the development of software.
Table 7.5 Internet usage summary
Scales 1-7 as noted in the questionnaire (Counts and percentage % provided)
Profile Limited use (%)
2 3 4 5 6 Extensive
use TOTAL Mean
Email 0 0 1
(0.48%)
7
(3.37%)
19
(9.13%)
53
(25.48%)
128
(61.54%) n=208 6.44
Official company
website
6 (2.88)
2 (0.96%)
1 (0.48%)
3 (1.44%)
20 (9.62%)
27 (12.98%)
149 (71.63%)
n=208 6.39
Advertising and
marketing
9
(4.33%)
5
(2.40%)
3
(1.44%)
10
(4.81%)
29
(13.94%)
23
(11.06%)
129
(62.02%) n=208 6.03
Online sales 33
(15.87) 2
(0.96%) 3
(1.44%) 23
(11.06%) 15
(7.21%) 50
(24.04%) 82
(39.42%) n=208 5.23
After sales research 13
(6.25%)
4
(1.92%)
4
(1.92%)
19
(9.13%)
37
(17.79%)
77
(37.02%)
54
(25.96%) n=208 5.45
Market research 5
(2.40%) 5
(2.40%) 8
(3.85%) 21
(10.10%) 53
(25.48%) 72
(34.62%) 44
(21.15%) n=208 5.42
Identify competition 8
(3.85%)
5
(2.40%)
12
(5.77%)
47
(22.60%)
52
(25.00%)
49
(23.56%)
35
(16.83%) n=208 5.00
In-house software
development
78 (37.50%)
15 (7.21%)
8 (3.85%)
58 (27.88%)
23 (11.06%)
14 (6.73%)
12 (5.77%)
n=208 3.11
Note. n = 208 firms (total firms surveyed). The number of respondents is noted in the table with the
percentage of firms in brackets.
200
7.2.2 Missing data
The questionnaire was administered via QUT’s online Key Survey platform. Because Key
Survey allows users to design surveys where respondents are unable to proceed forward
without answering questions or leaving questions unanswered, missing data was not
identified in the dataset. Utilising online surveys limits the possibility for missing data.
As such, online surveys contain fewer missing data fields as compared with traditional
paper-based surveys (Stanton, 1998). It was expected that the dataset would contain no
missing data because respondents were not able to leave fields blank. Options for
‘limited’ and ‘no’ response answers were also provided. As such, respondents could not
proceed to a question in the survey unless an answer (cell) in the previous question was
highlighted. As such, respondents in the survey were not given the opportunity to proceed
forward without answering questions, or leaving questions unanswered.
7.2.3 Normality of the data
Two descriptive measures, skewness and kurtosis, were utilised to assess the normality of
the data. Skewness is used to describe the balance of the distribution, and whether the
data is unbalanced and shifted to one side or is centred and symmetrical (Hair et al.,
2010). Kurtosis refers to the ‘peakedness’ or relative ‘flatness’ of the distribution of the
data as compared with normal distribution (Hair et al., 2010). Bentler (2005) suggests that
in practice values (> 5.) are indicative of data that is non-normally distributed. The data
indicates values as seen in Appendix 7, where the skewness and kurtosis of the factor
items are presented. Item IVNCQ30 indicates a kurtosis value of (6.007) and item
IVNCQ31 indicates a value of (5.512). Statistical tests of univariate normality, such as
the Kolmogorov-Smirnov and Shapiro-Wilk tests, reveal a significant departure from
normality for all of the variables in the study tested at the p-value (.05) (two-tailed) level.
Upon closer examination of the data using box and whisker plots, several outliers were
revealed across the variables. The univariate outliers in this case were not removed since
the mathematical and 5% trimmed level means of the variables were similar, indicating
that the outliers had minimal effect on the data at the univariate level (Pallant & Manual,
2007).
201
7.2.4 Data outliers defined by Mahalanobis Distance (D2) Test
Outliers represent cases whose scores are substantially different from all other in the data
set (Bryne, 2010). No missing data was present; therefore outliers due to insufficient
information are limited. Within a univariate outlier analysis, a common rule for detecting
an outlier is that more than three standard deviations away from the mean may indicate
the presence of an outlier (Kline, 2005; Hair et al., 2010). In multivariate outlier analysis,
extreme scores are identified with two or more variables (Kline, 2005). Prior to
interpreting the results, several assumptions were evaluated. Firstly, stem-and-leaf plots
and boxplots were analysed to examine the normality of the items, which indicated that
departure from normality was mild (Allen & Bennett (2012). Secondly, inspection of the
scatterplots and standardised residuals against predicted values was conducted. Thirdly, a
common approach to the detection of multivariate outliers is the computation of the
squared Mahalanobis Distance D2
Test for each item (Bryne, 2010).
The Mahalanobis Distance (D2) Test measures the distance in standard deviation units
between a set of scores for one item and the sample means for all variables (Bryne, 2010).
Bryne (2010) suggests that an outlying item will have a D2 value that stands distinctively
apart from all other D2 values. The Mahalanobis Distance D
2 Test indicates several
outliers in the dataset. Given that the outliers exhibited similar D2 values, deleting all
offending cases was deemed unfeasible as this would result in an unreasonable reduction
in sample size. Under closer examination of the data and outliers, no truly abnormal
observations were apparent (Hair et al., 2010). The Mahalanobis Distance (D2) Test can
be seen in Appendix 8. It is also important to highlight that the ‘bootstrap’ procedure was
employed to account for the presence of multivariate non-normality (Bryne, 2001;
Schumacker & Lomax, 2004). The ‘bootstrap procedure’ will be discussed in section 7.4
of this chapter.
7.3 Measurement model
A two-step approach to SEM as advocated by Anderson and Gering (1988) was adopted
in Study Two. A two-step approach to SEM requires the development and evaluation of
both (i) the measurement model, and (ii) the full structural model (Anderson & Gerbing,
202
1998). The measurement model utilised a congeneric model for maximum reliability.
Anderson and Gerbing (1988) acknowledge that re-specification of the measurement
model will be required in practice; however, re-specification decisions should not be
based on statistical considerations alone but rather in conjunction with theory and content
considerations. As such, the re-specifications made to measurement model have been
conducted with due reference and consideration to the theory (Anderson & Gerbing,
1988). The re-specification of the measurement model means that the SEM output
becomes primarily exploratory with confirmatory elements (Anderson & Gerbing, 1988).
7.3.1 Confirmatory factor analysis (CFA)
The CFA, is used in a deductive mode to test hypotheses regarding unmeasured sources
of variability responsible for the commonality among a set of factors (Hoyle, 2000). A
CFA tests the uni-dimensionality of each factor leading to the development of a valid
measurement model (Bryne, 2010). Construct validity is often assessed within the CFA,
the factor loading scores of this study indicating acceptable levels at (> .7). That is,
convergent validity was deemed to be adequate, as factor loadings were at an acceptable
level. Within the CFA, a composite construct reliability test was conducted to test for
internal reliability. The rule of thumb for the composite construct reliability is that a value
of (> .7) indicates an acceptable level of internal consistency (Hair et al., 2010). Where a
four-item solution was apparent an average variance extracted test was also conducted to
assess convergence. A score of (> .5) or also indicates adequate construct convergence or
internal consistency (Hair et al., 2010).
A Chi-squared comparison discriminant validity test was performed in assessing
differentiation in all factors in the final model. Model fit indictors supplied an average fit
to the model to assist in theoretical confirmation of the models inter-relationships. A
single-model index is limited; as such several indicators were utlised to establish good
model fit. Further, the Chi-square statistic (χ2) and two additional absolute or global fit
indices (RMSEA and SRMR), in conjunction with two incremental fit indices (CFI and
TLI) and a parsimony index (CMIN χ2/df), were utilised to determine model tenability
(Markland, 2007). The model fit indices utilised to establish the measurement model can
be seen in Table 7.6.
203
Table 7.6 Model fit indicators
Model fit
indicator
Definition Rule of thumb
(CMIN) χ2/df Chi-squared Normed 0 to 2.0
(RMSEA) Root Mean Square Error of Approximation < .10
(CFI) Comparative Fit Index >. 90
(TLI) Tucker-Lewis Index >. 90
(SRMR) Standardised Root Mean Residual < .10
Source: CMIN χ2/df (Allen & Bennett, 2012); RMSEA (Bryne, 2010); CFI (Kline, 2005); TLI (Bryne,
2010; Hair et al., 2010); SRMR (Hair et al., 2010).
Chi-squared Normed (χ2/df) (CMIN)
The Chi-square Normed (χ2/df) (CMIN) test for goodness of fit is used to assess whether
observed relationships differ from hypothesised or expected relationships (Allen &
Bennett, 2012). The CMIN is the ratio between the Chi-square and the degrees of
freedom (Bentler & Bonett, 1980; Kline, 2005). A significant CMIN indicates a lack of
satisfactory model fit. Kline (2005) indicates that the general rule of thumb is that a value
of χ2/df = 0 to 2.0 is an acceptable CMIN level. As such, the smaller the CMIN the better
the model fit will be. Further, it has been suggested that the CMIN is affected by very
large sample sizes (Kline, 2005), although a sample of n=208 is not large enough to
adversely affect this test.
Root Mean Square Error of Approximation (RMSEA)
Root Mean Square Error of Approximation (RMSEA) is widely utilised in structural
equation modelling and characterises how well the model fits the population, not just the
sample used for estimation (Bryne, 2010). The approximation attempts to correct for both
model complexity and sample size by including both in the computation (Hair et al.,
2010). Lower values of RMSEA indicate better fit, with values (< .10) considered
acceptable; however, values between (.03) and (.08) indicate better model fit and a 95%
confidence interval (Bryne, 2010).
204
Comparative Fit Index (CFI)
The Comparative Fit Index (CFI) is an incremental fit index that avoids the
underestimation of fit that is often apparent in small samples, for example, Bentler and
Bonett's (1980) study where the Normed Fit Index (NFI) is utilised. The CFI was used in
this research study rather than the Normed Fit Index that assumes zero error (Kline,
2011). A widely recognised model fit indicator, the CFI has a range from 0 to 1 and is
similar to other incremental-fit indices. The CFI assesses relative improvement in fit of
the researcher’s model (Kline, 2011). An index of (.90) is preferable (Kline, 2011).
Tucker-Lewis Index (TLI)
The Tucker-Lewis Index (TLI) is also commonly referred to as the non-normed fit index
(Kline, 2005). The TLI was initially developed for factor analysis but has recently been
extended to include structural equation modelling (Schumacker & Lomax, 2010). The
measure can be used to compare alternative models or a proposed model against a null
model (Schumacker & Lomax, 2010). The model can fall outside 0 and 1 as it is not
normed, although models approaching (1.0) are considered better than those with lower
values (Bryne, 2010). Hair et al. (2010) advocate that the index should be larger than
(.90) or (.92) if the sample size is less than 250 and the number of variables is greater than
three.
Standardised Root Mean Residual (SRMR)
The Standardised Root Mean Residual (SRMR) is based on covariance residuals that
evaluate the difference between observed and predicted covariance (Kline, 2005; Hair et
al., 2010). The SRMR is a measure of the mean absolute value of covariance residues,
whereby values less than (.10) are considered appropriate (Hair et al., 2010). Because the
SRMR can be difficult to interpret when different scales are used, the Standardised Mean-
squared Residual was utilised in this study. The SRMR represents the average value
across the standardised residuals ranging from 0 to 1 (Bryne, 2010), while Kline (2005),
advocates a value of (< .10).
205
Analysis of model indicators for the initial CFA findings
A CFA is a process that is utilised to test how well measured variables represent a smaller
number of constructs (Hair et al., 2010). A CFA is used to provide a confirmatory test or
measurement theory, which specifies how measured variables logically and
systematically represent constructs in the proposed model (Hair et al., 2010). The six
factors included in the CFA will now be discussed in relation to the model for indicators
presented in Table 7.7. Firstly, international entrepreneurial orientation will be discussed.
Knight and Cavusgil (2004) present nine items for measurement of international
entrepreneurial orientation, which draw from the work of Khandwalla (1977), Miller and
Friesen (1984) and Covin and Slevin (1989). All items except (IEOQ10, IEOQ12,
IEOQ14, TRIVQ18 and TRIVQ19), as seen in Table 7.7 indicate item factor loadings
above the accepted (> .70) level (Hair et al., 2010), and are therefore confirmed for the
structural model. Hair et al., (2010) suggest that standardised loading estimates should be
ideally at the level of (> .70); as such, items included in the international entrepreneurial
orientation construct include: IOEQ6 (.75), IEOQ7 (.84), IEOQ8 (.80), IEOQ9 (.87),
IEOQ11 (.70), and IEOQ13 (.80). Items not included in the measurement model are:
IEOQ10, IEOQ12, and IEOQ14, all of which fall below the accepted level of (> .7). A
total of three items are included in the measurement of technology-related international
vision with factor loadings above the (> .70) level. For instance TRIVQ15 indicates an
item factor loading of (.83), TRIVQ16 (.83), TRIVQ17 (.72), TRIVQ18 (.66), and
TRIVQ19 (.62). As such, all three items drawn from the work of Nummela et al., (2004)
have been found to capture the construct of technology-related international vision. The
items not included in the measurement model are: TRIVQ18 and TRIVQ19, which
display weak factor loadings below the accepted (> .7) level.
The items included in the measurement of Internet, international marketing capabilities
are confirmed, with factor loadings above the (> .7) level. For instance IIMCQ25
indicates an item factor loading of (.89), IIMCQ26 (.83), IIMCQ27 (.82), IIMCQ28 (8.2),
and IIMCQ29 (.76). As such, all five items drawn from the work of Zhu and Kraemer
(2002), Liao et al., (2009) and the conceptual work of Reuber and Fischer (2001) have
been found to capture the construct of Internet, international marketing capabilities. The
206
items included in the measurement of International, virtual networking capabilities are
confirmed, with factor loadings above the (> .7) level. For instance IVNCQ30 indicates
an item factor loading of (.94), IVNCQ31 (.95), IVNCQ32 (.88), and IVNCQ35 (.70). As
such, all four items drawn from the work of Wu et al., (2003) and the conceptual work of
Loane (2006) have been found to capture the construct of international virtual networking
capabilities.
The items included in the measurement of international, entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition are confirmed, with factor loadings above the (> .7) level. For instance
IEORQ36 indicates an item factor loading of (.89), IEORQ37 (.90), IEORQ38 (.82),
IEORQ39 (8.5), and IEORQ40 (.73). As such, all five items drawn from the work of
Lumpkin and Lichtenstein (2005) and Dimitratos et al., (2012) have been found to
capture the construct of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. The items
included in the measurement of international market performance are confirmed, with
factor loadings above the (> .7) level. For instance IMPQ41 indicates an item factor
loading of (.93), IMPQ42 (.92), IMPQ43 (.71), IMPQ44 (8.5), and IMPQ46 (.86). As
such, all five items drawn from the work of Moen et al., (2008), Nummela et al., (2004),
and Jantunen et al., (2005) have been found to capture the construct of international
market performance.
Overall, the CFA eliminated a total of five items with factor loadings below the accepted
(> .7) level. For example, IEOQ10 indicated a weak factor loading of (.60), IEOQ12
(.59), IEOQ14 (.65), TRIVQ18 (.66), and TRIVQ19 (.62). Since the purpose of the CFA
is to specify how the variables measured logically and systematically represent the
constructs in the proposed model (Hair et al., 2010), the five items mentioned here have
been removed. It is also important to note that the international business experience
construct has not been included here in the CFA. Statistical validation signifies that the
construct is not fit for factor analysis, indicating a Chronbach Alpha of (.376) and a KMO
value of (.516). Reuber and Fischer (1999) acknowledge that many factors will impact a
firm’s performance, and that experience is not necessarily the strongest of the factors,
also indicating that the literature assessing international business experience is often
207
fragmented and inconclusive. As such, international business experience is no longer
assessed. A summary of the initial CFA findings can be seen in Table 7.7.
Table 7.7 Summary of initial CFA findings
Item Question/ item Initial
standardised
loadings
Final Standardised
loadings
IEO International entrepreneurial orientation
IEOQ6 Firm’s view of the world as the market .75 #
IEOQ7 Culture and pursuing new opportunities .84 .73
IEOQ8 Mission and international markets .80 .74
IEOQ9 Develops resources to achieve goals .87 .82
IEOQ10 Experience in international business *.60 #
IEOQ11 Marketing products over the past five years .70 .41
IEOQ12 Tendency to take on high-risk projects *.59 #
IEOQ13 Great lengths taken to succeed internationally .80 #
IEOQ14 Importance of the drive of entrepreneurs *.65 #
TRIV Technology-related international vision
TRIVQ15 Commitment to serving Internet customers .83 .64
TRIVQ16 Commits resources to Internet marketing .83 .74
TRIVQ17 Emphasis on international growth .72 .48
TRIVQ18 Managerial technology experience importance *.66 #
TRIVQ19 Growth through the Internet is achievable *.62 #
IIMC Internet, international marketing capabilities
IIMCQ25 Ability to leverage technology in the firm .89 .83
IIMCQ26 Renewal of technology importance .83 .71
IIMCQ27 Investment in technology and sales .82 .69
IIMCQ28 IT operational capabilities of the firm .82 .61
IIMCQ29 Technological infrastructure and e-commerce .76 #
IVNC International virtual networking capabilities
IVNCQ30 Internet to maintain international relations .94 .88
IVNCQ31 Internet to strengthen international relations .95 .91
IVNCQ32 Internet to develop longer lasting relations .88 .77
IVNCQ35 Internet to enhance international performance .70 #
IEOR International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
IEORQ36 Actively seeks new international opportunity .89 .78
IEORQ37 Invests resources to exploit opportunities .90 .81
IEORQ38 Pursues opportunity regardless of resources .82 .66
IEORQ39 Formal and informal processes for evaluation .85 .72
IEORQ40 Recognising and exploiting opportunities .73 .53
IMP International market performance
IMPQ41 International market share .93 .87
IMPQ42 International growth .92 .85
IMPQ43 International sales growth vs. competitors .71 .50
IMPQ44 International profitability .85 .72
IMPQ45 Overall international market performance .86 .74
Excluded at the CFA level
IEOQ10 Experience in international business (.60)*
IEOQ12 Tendency to take on high-risk projects (.59)*
IEOQ14 Importance of the drive of entrepreneurs (.65)*
TRIVQ18 Managerial technology experience importance (.66)*
208
Item Question/ item Initial
standardised
loadings
Final Standardised
loadings
TRIVQ19 Growth through the Internet is achievable (.62)*
Achieved fit indices
Note.*Item removed at the CFA level. # = removed at the measurement model stage,
7.3.2 Measurement model evaluation
The full structural model, ‘Capabilities in IE’, was subjected to a saturated measurement
model analysis. A saturated model should be tested after a CFA has validated the
measurement model (Hair et al., 2010). Hox (2010) argues that a saturated model allows
researchers to visualise the inter-relationships and therefore asses the level of contribution
of a given factor. A fully saturated model, which was derived from the CFA, was first
examined to identify the inter-relationships between factors, and to identify where
mediation of the model is apparent (Bryne, 2010). The initial model summary fit indices
demonstrate that the model does not indicate close fit with the data. The summary of
measurement model fit in Table 7.8 indicates fit indices of: (CMIN χ2/df = 2.213,
RMSEA = .077, CFI = .900, TLI = .890, SRMR = .0654). The CMIN χ2/df is slightly
greater than (< 2), indicating acceptable, but not parsimonious, fit (Kline, 2005; Goffin,
2007). The RMSEA is (< .10), indicating acceptable fit (Hair et al., 2010). The CFI meets
the (> .90) level, indicating acceptable model fit given the model complexity and sample
size (Hair et al., 2010). The TLI is slightly less than the (> .90) level required for good
model fit, but is acceptable and nearing the required limit. The SRMR indicates an
acceptable fit at (< .10). The summary of measurement model fit can be seen in Table 7.8.
Table 7.8 Summary of measurement model fit
Model (CMIN)
χ2/df
RMSEA CFI TLI SRMR
Specified
model 2.213 .077 .900 .890 .0654
Note. CMIN χ2/df = the ratio between the Chi-squared and the degrees of freedom or Chi-square Normed,
RMSEA = Root Mean Square Error of Approximation, CFI = Comparative Fit Index, TLI = Tucker-Lewis
Index, SRMR = Standardised Root Mean Residual.
CMIN/ DF
(D2/ DF)
RMSEA CFI TLI SRMR
Initial 2.213 .077 .900 .890 .0654
Final 1.910 .066 .950 .943 .0520
209
The measurement model results in Figure 7.2 indicate that the covariance matrix was well
produced in the data in parts, but that changes to the model are warranted. As such re-
specification of the measurement model will be conducted. Anderson and Gerbing (1988)
acknowledge that re-specification of the measurement model is required in practice;
however, the decision to re-specify a model should not be based on statistical
considerations alone but rather in conjunction with theory and content considerations. As
previously mentioned, the re-specifications made to the measurement model have been
conducted with due reference and consideration to the theory (Anderson & Gerbing,
1988). MacCullum, Roznowski and Necowitz (1992) suggest that model should fit be
assessed after each modification.
210
Figure 7.2 Model 1: Measurement model for factorial validity
Note. IEO = International entrepreneurial orientation, TRIV = Technology-related international vision,
IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities, IVNC = International virtual networking
capabilities, IEOR = International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and IMP = International
market performance. CMIN χ2/df = the ratio between the Chi-squared and the degrees of freedom or Chi-
square Normed, RMSEA = Root Mean Square Error of Approximation, CFI = Comparative Fit Index, TLI
= Tucker-Lewis Index, SRMR = Standardised Root Mean Residual.
CMIN / DF = 2.213
RMSEA = .077
CFI = .900
TLI = .890
SRMR = .0654
211
Re-specification of the measurement model
As the measurement model does not demonstrate close fit with the data, the model was
re-specified to improve model fit on statistical and theoretical grounds. As previously
discussed, model fit in this study was assessed after each single modification (MacCullum
et al., 1992). Path estimates (Λ < .70) (Hair et al., 2010), standardised residuals (+/- 1.96)
(Schumacker & Lomax, 2004), squared multiple correlations (R2 < .50) (Kline, 2005),
and modification indices (M.I. > 10) (Bryne, 2010), were utlised to identify areas of
model strain, where re-specifications could be implemented. A total of two items from the
international entrepreneurial orientation factor (IEOQ6 and IEOQ13), one item from the
Internet, international marketing capabilities factor (IIMCQ29), and, one item from the
international virtual networking capabilities factor (IVNCQ35) were deleted prior to
estimating the structural model.
The removal of the four items from the model indicted good model fit. Only minor
modifications to the measurement model were required, given that only a limited number
of modification indices exceeded the (> 4.) or greater value (Hair et al., 2010). It is also
important to note that modifications to the measurement model have not been based
solely on modification indices for model improvement, but also on theoretical grounds
through the CFA, which tests the measurement theory. The modifications to the
measurement model are also considered to be minor given that less than 30% of the
measured variables were dropped or changed with regard to the factors represented
(Bryne, 2010). As such, removal of less than 30% of the items is considered to be less
consequential to the dataset.
7.4 Full structural model
The full structural model summary fit indices demonstrate that the model does display
close fit with the data at acceptable levels. The summary of model fit for the full
structural model in Table 7.9 indicates fit indices of: (CMIN χ2/df = 1.910, RMSEA =
.066, CFI = .950, TLI = .943 and, SRMR = .0520). The CMIN χ2/df is below the accepted
level (< 2), indicating acceptable and parsimonious fit (Kline, 2005; Goffin, 2007). The
RMSEA is (< .10), indicating acceptable fit (Hair et al., 2010). The two incremental fit
212
indices, the CFI and TLI meet the (> .90) level, indicating acceptable model fit (Hair et
al., 2010). The SRMR indicates an acceptable fit at (< .10). ‘Good model fit’, or models
that indicate close fit with the data, are based on the assertion that if a majority of the fit
indices indicate an acceptable model, then the model is supported by the data
(Schumacker & Lomax, 2010; Hair et al., 2010). The summary of model fit can be seen in
Table 7.9, followed by a discussion of the reliability and validity of the full structural
model.
Table 7.9 Summary of model fit for the full structural model
Model (CMIN)
χ2/df
RMSEA CFI TLI SRMR
Specified
model 2.213 .077 .900 .890 .0654
Full
structural
model
1.910 0.66 .950 .943 .0520
Note. CMIN χ2/df = the ratio between the Chi-squared and the degrees of freedom or Chi-square Normed,
RMSEA = Root Mean Square Error of Approximation, CFI = Comparative Fit Index, TLI = Tucker-Lewis
Index, SRMR = Standardised Root Mean Residual.
Reliability and validity of the full structural model
To establish internal consistency and reliability, Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) coefficients, as
seen in Table 7.10, were calculated in SPSS and composite reliabilities (CR) were
calculated from the CFA analysis in AMOS. All Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) coefficients
exceeded the optimal level of (> .7) (Gefen, Straub & Boudreau, 2000). The CR values
for each factor also exceeded the acceptable threshold level of (>. 7) (Hair et al., 2010).
The final composite construct reliability value indicates reliability of the constructs in the
study given that composite construct reliability measure is suggested to be superior to
Chronbach Alpha since it utilises the item loadings obtained within the casual model
(Wertz & Allinger, 1974). These coefficients demonstrate that the items reflecting the
latent factors are internally consistent. The values for the Average Variance Extracted
(AVE) also exceeded the threshold of (> .5), indicating convergent validity (Hair et al.,
2010). The Average Variance Extracted (AVE) was proposed by Fornell and Larcker
(1981), and is a measure of the shared or common variance in a latent variable, or the
213
measure of the error-free variance of a set of items. AVE is utilised in this study as a
measure of convergent validity, and which is the average percentage of variation
explained (Hair et al., 2010).
The Maximum Shared Variance (MSV) shows that all latent variables are less than the
AVE values, except international entrepreneurial orientation (.672) and technology-
related international vision (.651). This cross-loading between international
entrepreneurial orientation and technology-related international vision was expected due
to the nature of international entrepreneurial orientation which draws from components of
innovation, proactiveness, risk and vision to create the variable. For example, Kropp,
Lindsay and Shoham (2008) suggest that there is great overlap between individual
entrepreneurial orientation and vision because vision is what shapes the firm’s overall
outlook and international orientation. The MSV values are also only slightly higher than
the AVE values, which indicates discriminant validity. The ASV values are less than the
AVE values, indicating discriminant validity (Hair et al., 2010). Further, the structural
model demonstrates good and close fit with the data, providing additional evidence which
supports the assumption that the latent factor variables in the structural model are
adequately differentiated (Hair et al., 2010). The assessment of reliability and validity of
the structural model can be seen in Table 7.10 and also in Appendix 9).
Table 7.10 Assessment of reliability and validity of the structural model
Latent variables Chronbach’s
Alpha
(ά)
Composite
Reliabilities
(CR)
Average
Variance
Extracted
(AVE)
Maximum
Shared
Variance
(MSV)
Average
Shared
Variance
(ASV)
International entrepreneurial
orientation .913 .915 .548 .672 .435
Technology-related
international vision .859 .856 .547 .651 .526
Internet, international
marketing capabilities .914 .914 .651 .651 .457
International virtual
networking capabilities .921 .926 .760 .420 .317
International entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition .920 .921 .702 .672 .530
International market
performance .934 .932 .560 .560 .424
Note. Chronbach’s Alpha (ά) was calculated in SPSS. Composite Reliabilities (CR), Average Variance
Extracted (AVE), Maximum Shared Variance (MSV) and Average Shared Variance (ASV) was calculated
in AMOS.
214
Figure 7.3 Model 2: Full structural model of ‘Capabilities in IE’
Note. IEO = International entrepreneurial orientation, TRIV = Technology-related international vision,
IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities, IVNC = International virtual networking
capabilities, IEOR = International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and IMP = International
market performance. CMIN χ2/df = the ratio between the Chi-squared and the degrees of freedom or Chi-
square Normed, RMSEA = Root Mean Square Error of Approximation, CFI = Comparative Fit Index, TLI
= Tucker-Lewis Index, SRMR = Standardised Root Mean Residual.
Model comparison
In order to test whether the addition of international virtual networking capabilities
significantly improves the firm’s international market performance, the likelihood ratio
(LR) or Chi-square Difference Test was utilised. The LR Chi-square Difference Test was
used to investigate the difference in CMIN χ2 between alternative nested models
(Schumacker & Lomax, 2010; Kline, 2011). Model 1, or the hypothesised model in Table
CMIN / DF = 1.910
RMSEA = .066
CFI = .950
TLI = .943
SRMR = .0520
215
7.11, indicates values of: (CMIN = 466.053, a CMIN χ2
value of = 1.910 and df =244
degrees of freedom). The degrees of freedom value is (Δ df = 2), exhibiting acceptable
and parsimonious model fit with the data. The results from the data indicate that the
model that freely estimates the direct and indirect path estimates, including both IVNC
and TRIV, significantly fits the data better than the models where path estimates for
IVNC and TRIV have been fixed to zero. For example, Model 2 indicates values of:
(CMIN = 569.942, a CMIN χ2 = 2.317, df = 246, with the χ
2 diff significant at 407, and Δ
df = 2, significance at the p = < .001*** level). Model 2 does not indicate acceptable fit
with the data. Model 3 indicates values of: (CMIN = 801.368, a CMIN χ2 = 3.231, df =
248, with the χ2 diff significant at 1321, and Δ df = 4, significance at the p = < .001***
level). Model 3, however, does not indicate acceptable fit with the data. Model 4 indicates
values of: (CMIN = 883.100, a CMIN χ2 = 3.547, df = 249, with the χ
2 diff significant at
1637, and Δ df = 5, significance at the p = < .001*** level). However, Model 4 also does
not indicate acceptable fit with the data. A summary of the results of the Chi-square
difference tests results can be seen in Table 7.11.
Table 7.11 Summary of the results of the Chi-square difference tests
Model CMIN CMIN
χ2
Degrees of
freedom
df
χ2 diff Δ df
1. Hypothesised model
2. Model without IVNC
Difference between Model 1 and Model 2
3. Model without TRIV
Difference between Model 1 and Model 3
4. Model without IVNC and TRIV
Difference between Model 1 and Model 4
466.053
569.942
801.368
883.100
1.910
2.317
3.231
3.547
244
246
248
249
.407***
1321***
1637***
2
4
5
Note. CMIN = Chi-square Normed, χ2 = CMIN Chi-squared, df = Degrees of freedom, χ2 diff = difference
in χ2 between models, Δ df = degrees of freedom lost, p-values = significance at *** p < .001 level.
Overall, the LR Chi-square difference test analysis provides evidence for the significant
contribution made by international virtual networking capabilities in explaining the
international market performance of the firm. That is, the hypothesised model indicates a
significantly better model fit with the addition of international virtual networking
216
capabilities. This is because Model 1 indicates the most parsimonious and acceptable
model fit with the data (for example, CMIN = 466.053, CMIN χ2 = 1.910, df =244, χ2
diff
= .407, Δ df = 2). Next, the ML bootstrap procedure will be discussed.
ML Bootstrap procedure
Bootstrapping is an approach to validating a multivariate model by extending a model’s
sample to include a larger number of sub-samples, estimating models for each sub-
sample, and then determining the values for the parameter estimates from the set of
models by calculating the mean of each estimated coefficient (Hair et al., 2010). Further,
utilisation of the bootstrapping technique is essential in determining the stability of the
model (Boomsma, 2000). The ML bootstrap procedure was based on 2000 bootstrap
samples at 90% bias-corrected confidence intervals (Bryne, 2010), and was performed on
the structural model so the mediation hypothesises effects of technology-related
international vision and international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition could be
examined. Model fit was deemed to be satisfactory, given that more complex models with
larger sample sizes are subject to somewhat less stringent criteria for model fit indices
(Hair et al., 2010).
Analysis of the ML bootstrap procedure showed that no significant difference existed
between the analyses of the re-specified model with a bootstrap test based on 2000
bootstrap samples. For example, the fit indices for the full structural model with an ML
bootstrap procedure employed indicates values of: (CMIN χ2/df = 1.910, RMSEA = .066,
CFI = .950, TLI = .943, SRMR = .0520, p-value = significance at the p = < .001***
level). No difference exists between analyses of the full structural model with an ML
bootstrap procedure employed based on 2000 bootstrap samples, further highlighting the
robustness of the model. The summary of model fit for the full structural model
employing an ML bootstrap procedure can be seen in Table 7.12.
217
Table 7.12 Summary of model fit for the full structural model employing bootstrap
procedure
Model (CMIN)
χ2/df
RMSEA CFI TLI SRMR p-values
Full structural
model with
ML bootstrap procedure
1.910 0.66 .950 .943 .0520 .000***
Note. CMIN χ2/df = the ratio between the Chi-squared and the degrees of freedom or Chi-square Normed,
RMSEA = Root Mean Square Error of Approximation, CFI = Comparative Fit Index, TLI = Tucker-Lewis
Index, SRMR = Standardised Root Mean Residual, p-values = significance at *** p < .001 level.
Test for direct and indirect effects
A post hoc test revealed a number of mediating relationships between variables in the
model. A mediating effect is established when a third variable intervenes between two
other related constructs in a model (Hair et al., 2010). Direct effects are those
relationships that link two constructs with a single arrow, with indirect effects
representing a sequence of relationships with at least one intervening construct (Kline,
2005). Thus, an individual effect is a sequence of two or more direct effects or compound
paths and is visually represented by multiple arrows, as seen in Figure 7.4.
Figure 7.4 Mediation of direct and indirect relationships
Note. The model demonstrates basic mediation, whereby Z = independent variable, Y = the dependent
variable and X = the mediating variable. * Represents the mediating path relationships between variables.
Source: Adapted from Baron and Kenny (1986) and Hair et al. (2010).
In establishing the properties of a mediation model, a suggested framework by Baron and
Kenny (1986) was utilised to examine the direct and indirect effects. Each proposed direct
and indirect effect was tested separately according to Baron and Kenny’s (1986) approach
to mediation. The overall mediation test revealed a mediated model, whereby
international market performance is fully mediated by international entrepreneurial firm-
X
Z Y
a* b*
c*
218
level resources and Internet capabilities. The mediated paths in the model can be seen in
Table 7.13. The full analysis of the standardised indirect effects can be seen in Appendix
10, and the standardised direct effects can be seen in Appendix 11.
The results of the mediation test suggest that the relationship between ainternational
entrepreneurial orientation and international market performance is fully mediated by
international market performance (β = .46, p-value = < .001***, CI = .34 - .55). The
confidence interval levels (CI) are 99% bias corrected. As the Beta weight (β) is between
the upper bounds and the lower bounds with a < .001*** significance level, mediation is
observed. Mediated effects between binternational entrepreneurial orientation to Internet,
international marketing capabilities through technology-related international vision is
observed (β = .43, p-value = < .001***, CI = .30 - .55). Other mediated effects can be
seen in the following: cinternational entrepreneurial orientation to international virtual
network capabilities through technology-related international vision (β = .35, p-value = <
.001***, CI = .22 - .47); dinternational entrepreneurial orientation to international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition through technology-related international vision (β
= .28, p-value = < .001***, CI = .17 - .42); etechnology-related international vision to
international market performance through Internet, international marketing capabilities (β
= .43, p-value = < .002**, CI = .29 - .54); ftechnology-related international vision to
international virtual networking capabilities through Internet, international marketing
capabilities (β = .23, p-value = < .010*, CI = .051 - .413). The summary of the indirect
effects can be seen in Table 7.13.
Table 7.13 Summary of the indirect effects
Relationship β p-value CI
Upper Bounds Lower Bounds
aIEO - IEOR - IMP β.46 .001*** .55 .34
bIEO - TRIV - IIMC β.43 .001*** .55 .30
cIEO - TRIV - IVNC β.35 .001*** .47 .22
dIEO - TRIV - IEOR β.28 .001*** .42 .17
eTRIV - IIMC - IMP β.43 .002** .54 .29
fTRIV - IIMC - IVNC β.23 .010* .413 .051
Note. IEO = International entrepreneurial orientation, IEOR = International entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition, IMP = International market performance, TRIV = Technology-related international vision,
IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities, IVNC = International virtual networking capabilities.
β = Beta weight, CI = confidence level, p-values = significance at p < .05*, p < .01**, p < .001*** level.
219
Common method variance and the Correlated Marker Technique
Cross-sectional research of behavioural relationships is vulnerable to inflation of
correlations by common method variance (Lindell & Whitney, 2001). Scholars who study
firm behaviours, such as those characterised by the international entrepreneur, have a
vested interest in problems associated with the use of self-reporting to describe variables
such as attitudes, emotions and perceptions of the work environment (Williams, Hartman
& Cavazotte, 2010). Lindell and Whitney (2001) introduced a partial correlation
technique, which is referred to as the Correlational Marker Technique. The Correlational
Marker Technique is utilised for controlling method variance using a marker variable that
is theoretically unrelated to substantive variables in a study (Williams et al., 2010).
Podsakoff and Organ (1986) point out that common method variance can be due in part to
item similarity, mood states, illusory correlations and social desirability. Social
desirability is often a cause for concern for researchers investigating international
entrepreneurial behaviour, as most often the entrepreneur is critical for triggering
desirability to portray outcomes more favourable than reality (Chen, Greene & Crick,
1998) or optimised perceptions of reality (Shepherd & Krueger, 2002).
The ‘product characteristics’ factor was utilised as the product marker variable in this
study. A key requirement of the Correlated Marker Technique, the marker variable
(product characteristics), is noted as being theoretically unrelated to the substantive
variables in the model (Williams et al., 2010). This is opposed to other organisational
studies that utilise marker variables similar to the context of the research and therefore do
not completely satisfy the requirement that the marker variable must be theoretically
unrelated to the other substantive variables in the research (Irving & Coleman, 2003;
Griffith & Lusch, 2007; Luthans, Zhu, & Avolio, 2006) – for example, a marker variable
related to ‘leadership’ in organisational research (Zhu, Chew, & Spangler, 2005). A
seven-point Likert scale was applied to six items in the product characteristic marker
variable. The product characteristics marker variable item specification can be seen in
Table 7.14.
220
Table 7.14 Product characteristics marker variable item specification
Questionnaire
number
Construct Scale Description and measure
Part G. Q47
Product
marker
variable
Product
characteristics
marker
variable
Interval The following questions concern your firm’s product
characteristics.
Please indicate by selecting the appropriate box. In my firm
the company's product/s...
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
(a) is/are classified as sophisticated?
(b) is/are complex in nature
(c) need(s) specialised know how to market
(d) take(s) a long time to learn about
(e) has/have a large proportion that is technological in nature
(f) need(s) a high level of specialised service
A latent variable approach to marker variables in overcoming common method bias
Given the increasing use of SEM with latent variables in firm research, Williams et al.
(2010) suggest the use of SEM to investigate marker variables. In this study, the
Correlated Marker Technique was employed in SEM, following the suggestion of
Williams et al. (2003) to provide product characteristics with the label of the marker
technique. Williams et al. (2010) suggest that an SEM latent variable approach puts the
area of marker variable method variance investigation in line with other method variance
research by approaching the technique from a measurement model perspective via factor
loadings. This approach also provides a statistical test of bias due to overcoming the
limitation that there is no test to compare the zero-order and partial correlations with the
Correlational Marker Technique (Williams et al., 2003; Williams et al., 2010). The
marker variable Delta, which is the calculated difference between the standardised
regression weights, indicates no extreme values and therefore a limited number of paths
in the structural model are affected by common method bias. The comparison of
standardised regression weights for the Correlated Marker Technique can be seen in
Appendix 12.
221
Post Hoc Harman’s Single-Factor Test
One technique widely utilised by researchers to address the issue of common method bias
is the Harman’s Single-Factor Test, proposed by Podsakoff et al. (2003). The test reveals
that 52.39% of the variance in the data can be attributed to a single factor. Although some
researchers may report this value as being relatively ‘high’, Chang at al. (2010) highlight
that there is no useful guideline as to what would be the acceptable percentage of
explained variance in a model and that simply reporting seemingly reassuring outcomes
from Harman’s single-factor test is insufficient to prove that common method variance is
not an issue. As such, use of the Correlated Marker Technique is a more valid measure of
variance (Chang et al., 2010; Ariño, 2002).
7.5 Hypotheses evaluation
The results of this study provide support for the majority of hypotheses (see Table 7.16).
The hypothesis that international entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to
international market performance (H1) is partially supported. This finding indicates two
results. Firstly, that international entrepreneurial orientation has a significant, positive
effect on international market performance, and secondly, that international
entrepreneurial orientation exhibits a significant direct and indirect effect, fully mediated
by international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, on international market
performance. As such, the hypothesis that international entrepreneurial orientation is
positively related to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (H2) is
supported.
The hypothesis that technology-related international vision is positively related to
international market performance (H3) is partially supported. This is because technology-
related international vision has a significant positive effect on international market
performance, but is also fully mediated through both international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition and Internet, international marketing capabilities. This finding,
therefore, provides support for the hypothesis that technology-related international vision
is positively related to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (H4),
222
attributed to the significant direct effect on international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition.
The hypothesis that technology-related international vision is positively related to
Internet, international marketing capabilities (H5) is supported, indicating a significant
positive effect on Internet, international marketing capabilities. The hypothesis that
Internet, international marketing capabilities is positively related to international market
performance (H8) is supported. That is, Internet international marketing capabilities have
a significant direct effect on international market performance. The hypothesis that
Internet, international marketing capabilities is positively related to international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (H9) is not supported. The results from the data
indicate that Internet, international marketing capabilities did not exhibit a significant and
direct relationship with international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition.
The hypothesis that Internet, international marketing capabilities is positively related to
international virtual networking capabilities (H10) is supported, as a significant direct
effect was exhibited. The hypothesis that international virtual networking capabilities is
positively related to international market performance (H11) is not supported. The results
from the data indicate that international virtual networking capabilities did not exhibit a
significant and direct relationship with international market performance. The hypothesis
that international virtual networking capabilities is positively related to international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition (H12) is not supported. The results from the data
indicate that international virtual networking capabilities did not exhibit a significant and
direct relationship with international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition.
The hypothesis that international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is positively
related to international market performance (H13) is supported. The results from the data
suggest that the international opportunity recognition and subsequent exploitation of
international market opportunities of firms occurs after the identification of firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities. The results exhibit a significant direct effect between
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and international market
performance outcomes.
223
The results of the study also signify three non-hypothesised relationships. Firstly, a
significant direct effect between international entrepreneurial orientation and technology-
related international vision was observed. Secondly, international entrepreneurial
orientation is positively related to Internet, international marketing capabilities, but is
mediated through technology-related international vision. And thirdly, technology-related
international vision is positively related to international virtual networking capabilities.
These three non-hypothesised relationships were accepted and supported by the full
structural equation model. The hypothesised and non-hypothesised relationships from the
structural equation model can be seen in Table 7.15.
Table 7.15 Evaluated hypothesised relationship table
Code Hypotheses Regression
weights^
Result
IEO - IMP H1: ‘International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to
international market performance’ - Supported*
IEO - IEOR H2:‘International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition’
.35 Supported
TRIV - IMP H3: ‘Technology-related international vision is positively related to
international market performance’ - Supported*
TRIV - IEOR H4: ‘Technology-related international vision is positively related to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition’
.59 Supported
TRIV - IIMC H5: ‘Technology-related international vision is positively related to
Internet, international marketing capabilities’ .79 Supported
IIMC - IMP H8: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related to international market performance’
.25 Supported
IIMC - IEOR H9: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related
to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition’ - Unsupported
IIMC - IVNC H10: ‘Internet, international marketing capabilities are positively related to international virtual networking capabilities’
.29 Supported
IVNC - IMP H11: ‘International virtual network capabilities are positively related to
international market performance’ - Unsupported
IVNC - IEOR H12: ‘International virtual network capabilities are positively related to international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition’
- Unsupported
IEOR - IMP H13: ‘International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition is
positively related to international market performance’ .58 Supported
Non- hypothesised relationships
Code Hypotheses Regression
weights^ Result
IEO - TRIV International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to
technology-related international vision .68 Supported
IEO - IIMC International entrepreneurial orientation is positively related to Internet, international marketing capabilities but is mediated through
technology-related international vision - Supported
TRIV - IVNC Technology-related international vision is positively related to
international virtual networking capabilities .42 Supported
Note. H6 and H7 are no longer applicable as international business experience (F3) was not a part of the
full structural model. *Partially supported, however, the construct is mediated through another variable. ^
Regression weights in the table are standardised.
224
Theoretical inter-relationships in the final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’
With regard to the final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’, positive effects are exhibited across
a number of factors. The standardised regression weights are presented in Table 7.16. The
standardised coefficients indicate loadings above (> .7) except for item TRIVQ17 which
indicates a loading of .691. This estimate is approaching the (> .7) level of acceptance,
and therefore is not a cause for concern. The relatively high standardised regression
weights are indicative of the significant inter-relationships represented in the structural
model. The overall correlations and covariances for the final model can be seen in
Appendices 13–18.
Table 7.16 Standardised regression weights
Estimate
TRIVQ17 TRIV .691
TRIVQ16 TRIV .862
TRIVQ15 TRIV .801
IMPQ45 IMP .863
IMPQ44 IMP .847
IMPQ43 IMP .709
IMPQ42 IMP .919
IMPQ41 IMP .930
IEORQ40 IEOR .726
IEORQ39 IEOR .846
IEORQ38 IEOR .815
IEORQ37 IEOR .902
IEORQ36 IEOR .883
IVNCQ32 IVNC .880
IVNCQ31 IVNC .956
IVNCQ30 IVNC .937
IIMCQ28 IIMC .779
IIMCQ27 IIMC .829
IIMCQ26 IIMC .843
IIMCQ25 IIMC .913
IEOQ11 IEO .640
IEOQ9 IEO .908
225
Estimate
IEOQ7 IEO .855
IEOQ8 IEO .857
Note. TRIV = Technology-related international vision, IMP = International market performance, IEOR =
International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, IVNC = International virtual networking
capabilities, IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities, IEO = International entrepreneurial
orientation. Estimate = Standardised regression weight.
The majority of the structural paths in the model ‘Capabilities in IE’ exhibit significant
effects. The model also indicates a number of significant, non-significant and new
pathways. A visual representation of the hypothesised and non-hypothesised relationships
can be seen next in Figure 7.5.
Figure 7.5 Final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’: Significant, non-significant and new
pathways
Note. IEO = International entrepreneurial orientation. TRIV = Technology-related international vision.
IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities. INCV = International virtual networking
capabilities. IEOR = International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. IMP = International market
performance. [F] Factor variable. Dark structural line indicates a significant and direct path. Dashed
arrow indicates non-significant (n.s.) relationship. Dotted line indicates a new path (n.p.) relationship.
The beta (β) weights in the final model of the theoretical inter-relationships between firm-
level resources and Internet capabilities show a significant and direct relationship
[F1] IEO
[F2] TRIV
[F4] IIMC
[F5] IVNC
[F6] IEOR
[F7] IMP
H1
H2
H3
H4
H5
H8
H9
H10
H11
H12
H13
n.s.
n.s.
n.s.
n.p.
n.p.
n.p.
226
between international entrepreneurial orientation and technology-related international
vision, β = .68, and a significant and direct relationship with international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition, β = .35. A significant and direct relationship is also exhibited by
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition on international market
performance, β = .58. Technology-related international vision also exhibits a significant
relationship with international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, β = .59, and
international virtual networking capabilities, β = .42. A significant and direct relationship
is exhibited between technology-related international vision and Internet, international
marketing capabilities with a final β = .79. Internet, international marketing capabilities
also exhibits a significant relationship with international market performance, with a final
β = .25, and international virtual networking capabilities, β = .29. The final model of
‘Capabilities in IE’ can be seen in Figure 7.6.
Figure 7.6 Final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’
Note. IEO = International entrepreneurial orientation. TRIV = Technology-related international vision.
IIMC = Internet, international marketing capabilities. INCV = International virtual networking
capabilities. IEOR = International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. IMP = International market
performance. [F] Factor variable. Dashed arrow indicates non-significant (n.s.) relationship. Dark
structural line indicates a significant and direct path. β = Beta values or factor loadings.
β.35
β .58
β.25
β.68
β.79
β.59
β.42
[F1] IEO
[F2] TRIV
[F4] IIMC
[F5] IVNC
[F6] IEOR
[F7] IMP
n.s.
β.29
n.s.
n.s.
n.s.
227
7.6 Conclusion
In conclusion, this chapter has presented the results of the structural equation model in
Study Two. In this chapter, questionnaire data was collected from n=208 international
entrepreneurial SMEs engaged in exporting activity. The data was collected via an online
Key Survey platform and analysed in IBM SPSS AMOS 21, in accordance with the two-
step approach as proposed by Anderson and Gerbing (1988). The two-step approach to
structural equation modelling included: (i) the measurement model, and (ii) the structural
model. The structural equation modelling process also included an EFA and CFA. The
results of the structural equation model indicated that the majority of the hypothesised
relationships were supported. The results from the data indicate that the model of
‘Capabilities in IE’ is more complex than originally proposed. As such, post hoc testing
revealed the existence of three additional significant non-hypothesised relationships in the
full structural model of ‘Capabilities in IE’, which were confirmed and accepted. Chapter
Eight will provide a discussion of the overall findings of Study One and Study Two, as a
discussion of the theoretical and practical contributions of this thesis. The limitations and
directions for future research will also be discussed.
228
CHAPTER EIGHT: DISCUSSION AND CONCLUSION
8.1 Introduction
The aim of this thesis was to empirically investigate the influence of international
entrepreneurial resources and capabilities in achieving international performance
outcomes. Although research pertaining to the resources and capabilities of firms in the
entrepreneurship and international business is well established, and the assumed
performance outcomes of firm-level capabilities has been identified (McKelvie &
Davidsson, 2009), the emergent literature on Internet capabilities for international
entrepreneurial remains underdeveloped. With the exception of a small number of studies
(see, Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Loane et al., 2004; Morgan-Thomas & Bridgewater, 2004;
Loane, 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer, 2011), researchers have paid
limited attention to the role of the Internet in firms’ performance outcomes. To address
the three gaps in the literature, three research questions were developed to investigate
how international entrepreneurs utilise resources and Internet capabilities to achieve
international market performance. Research question one (RQ1) is as follows:
RQ1: What are the firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing
capabilities of firms, and how do they influence international
performance?
The purpose of research question one (RQ1) was, firstly, to identify the specific firm-
level resources and Internet capabilities of international entrepreneurial firms, and
secondly, to then understand how these firm-level resources and Internet capabilities are
influencing international market performance. The aim of research question two (RQ2a)
was firstly to examine the relative importance of firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities in influencing the firm’s international market performance. Research question
two (RQ2a) is as follows:
RQ2a: What is the relative influence of firm-level resources and Internet,
international marketing capabilities on international performance?
229
Secondly, the aim of research question two (RQ2b) was to understand the role of the
international entrepreneur in influencing the international market performance of the firm.
Research question two (RQ2b) is as follows:
RQ2b: How do international entrepreneurs leverage Internet, international
marketing capabilities for international performance?
Chapter Eight is segmented into eight main sections, as seen in Figure 8.1. Firstly,
introductory comments are provided. Secondly, the overall key findings of the research
are presented followed by the contributions to theory and practice. Limitations and
directions for future research are also discussed followed by concluding comments.
Figure 8.1 Diagrammatic overview of Chapter Eight
Introduction (8.1)
Overall findings (8.2)
Limitations and directions for future research (8.7)
Summary (8.8)
Internet, international marketing capabilities and firm performance (8.4)
Role of international entrepreneurial orientation on firm performance (8.3)
Contributions to international entrepreneurship theory (8.5)
Managerial contributions (8.6)
The key role of Internet, international marketing capabilities on performance (8.3.1)
The key role of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition on performance (8.3.2)
230
8.2 Overall findings
The overall findings of this thesis emphasise the inter-connecting relationship between
firm-level resources and Internet capabilities for the exploitation of international market
performance. International entrepreneurs can reduce uncertainty when entering
international markets by building firm-level resources, and Internet-related capabilities to
exploit opportunities. The decision to exploit an opportunity represents a commitment to
international market entry (Choi & Shepherd, 2004). Thus, this thesis identifies a specific
‘bundle’ of firm-level resources required for firms in pursuing international market
performance outcomes; (i) international entrepreneurial orientation capabilities; (ii)
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and, (iii) Internet, international
marketing capabilities.
The findings from Study One indicate that international entrepreneurial orientation is a
critical firm-level resource for firms in identifying new international market opportunities
and for leveraging international market performance. The findings from Study Two also
suggest that international entrepreneurial orientation is a precursor to identification of
other key firm-level resources such as technology-related international vision, and the
development of capabilities such as international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition.
International entrepreneurial orientation is also a precursor to the identification of
capabilities such as international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, and Internet,
international marketing capabilities. These key findings support Wiklund and Shepherd
(2005) who suggest that firm-level resources are relevant for enacting entrepreneurial
orientation, and that the strength of a firm’s performance relies on the internal resources
of the firm.
The findings from Study One also support Knight (2001) who suggested that firms with
an international entrepreneurial orientation will perform better than those without one. As
such, the findings of this thesis suggest that international entrepreneurial orientation
positively influences the firm’s performance. However, relying on this main critical
resource provides an incomplete understanding of why some firms perform better than
others or achieve superior international market performance. As such, the identification of
231
other key Internet capabilities contributing to the firm’s international market performance
is imperative.
The findings from Study One indicate that a second critical element in the creation of a
firm’s resource and capability bundle is international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition. The findings show that international entrepreneurs utilise international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition to explore new international markets. The
findings suggest that international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition occurs after the
identification of firm-level resources and is the capability through which firms identify
international opportunities.
The findings from Study One suggest that Internet capabilities are an important and
complex multi-faceted concept, one that occupies an important role in this thesis. Internet,
international marketing capabilities, for instance, allow the firm to create and deliver
superior customer value through efficient and fast-responding marketing processes (Day,
1994). As such, the Internet can be employed not only as a tool to improve international
market performance, but also as a core capability underpinning the firm’s overall
international strategy. The findings also indicate that Internet, international marketing
capabilities directly lead to international market performance.
The ‘bundle’ of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities, as presented in Figure 8.1,
represent important intangible assets that are critical elements for firms in achieving
international market performance. Further, the findings from Study Two suggest that
collectively these firm-level resources and Internet capabilities contribute to the creation
of a unique resource bundle. Moreover, this research provides scholars with an
understanding of the total number of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities
required for international market performance, beyond a singular viewpoint. The overall
findings of this thesis indicate that resources (international entrepreneurial orientation)
coincide with capabilities (international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition,
Internet, international marketing capabilities), in a model which predicts how
opportunity recognition is operationalised and how international market performance is
achieved.
232
Table 8.1 Summary of key findings from Study One and Study Two
Construct Summary of findings
(i)
*R
eso
urc
e
International
entrepreneurial
orientation
- International entrepreneurial orientation occurs at the cognitive
level and is what initiates firm internationalisation.
- Firms emphasising international innovative, proactiveness and
risk-taking propensities will generally have higher levels of
Internet, international marketing capability development.
- International entrepreneurial orientation is a critical resource for
firms to leverage on for improved international market
performance.
(ii)
*C
ap
ab
ilit
ies
International
entrepreneurial
opportunity
recognition
- International entrepreneurs are taking advantage of firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities through opportunity
exploration and recognition.
- International entrepreneurs utilise ‘international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition’ as a tool for exploration in international
markets to exploit new international opportunities.
- International opportunity recognition is a critical factor that
directly contributes to a firm’s international market performance.
- International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition occurs after
cognition and is the capability through which firms are identifying
international opportunity.
(iii
) I
nte
rnet
cap
ab
ilit
ies
Internet,
international
marketing
capabilities
- The Internet can be employed not only as a tool to improve
international market performance, but also as a core capability
underpinning the firm’s overall international strategy.
- Two critical elements are required for the development of
Internet, international marketing capabilities to leverage
international business performance: (i) international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, and (ii) international
entrepreneurial orientation.
Note. * The ‘bundle’ of international entrepreneurial orientation, international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition, and Internet, international marketing capabilities, is critical to the firm’s exploration of
international activity and subsequent exploitation of new international market opportunities.
8.3 The positive influence of firm-level resources and capabilities on performance
8.3.1 The key role of Internet, international marketing capabilities on performance
The first research question (RQ1) sought to address ‘What are the firm-level resources
and Internet, international marketing capabilities of firms, and how do they influence
international performance?’ Previous research suggests that the overall success of
international entrepreneurial SMEs in international markets relies profoundly on the
capacity of the firm to change and adapt to new developments that characterise an online
environment, such as the existence of Internet, international marketing capabilities
233
(Mostafa et al., 2006; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). The findings of this thesis support the key
role played by Internet, international marketing capabilities in positively influencing the
firm’s international market performance. Defined as a firm’s capability for utilising
Internet technology in marketing-related functional areas to respond to market changes,
while generating value for customers (Morgan, 2012), Internet, international marketing
capabilities are classified as an important for the firms international outcomes. This is
because Internet capabilities can assist the firm in leveraging the international business
processes of the firm by improving the transference of knowledge and the efficiency of
international market transactions (Glavas & Mathews, 2014a). The findings from Study
Two suggest that a positive relationship exists between Internet, international marketing
capabilities and the firm’s international market performance. This is in contrast to
research that suggests that the extent to which Internet capabilities contribute to the
international market performance of the firm through marketing-related and technology-
based capabilities remains unclear (Celuch & Murphy, 2010). Further, a summary of key
findings in relation to Internet, international marketing capabilities can be seen in Table
8.2.
Table 8.2 Summary of findings: Internet, international marketing capabilities
Overall findings Construct Summary of key findings from Study One
Internet,
international
marketing
capabilities
- The findings from Study One indicate that the Internet can be employed not only
as a tool to improve international performance, but also as a core capability
underpinning the firm’s overall international strategy.
- The findings suggest that Internet, international marketing capabilities facilitate
international market performance, as an international entrepreneurial orientation
geared towards the implementation of Internet, international marketing capabilities
supports opportunity recognition in new international markets.
- The findings from Study Two indicate that Internet, international marketing
capabilities has a direct relationship with international market performance.
Nevertheless, the findings from Study One diverge from previous research in part, which
states that Internet capabilities are critical to the successful pursuit of international
marketing opportunities. In particular, the findings from Study One suggest that the
relationship between Internet, international marketing capabilities and international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition does not exist. That is, although previously
thought to impact international entrepreneur’s capability to identify and exploit
234
international opportunity through recognition, Internet, international marketing
capabilities do not directly affect the performance of the firm. One possible
rationalisation for this finding is the Internet’s ability to serve as a platform which allows
firms to take advantage of international market opportunity. In itself, the Internet could be
seen a mechanism for opportunity recognition, and therefore a significant relationship
exists only with international market performance.
Although previous studies have argued that virtual networks are positively related to the
international market performance of the firm (see, Aspelund & Moen, 2004), the findings
of Study One suggest that international virtual networking capabilities are not directly
related to the firm’s international market performance. This finding suggests that
international virtual networking capabilities are not necessarily a precursor to the
successful integration of Internet capabilities for the international market performance of
the firm. The summary of findings in relation to international virtual networking
capabilities can be seen in Table 8.3.
Table 8.3 Summary of findings: International virtual networking capabilities
Overall findings Construct Summary of key findings from Study One
International
virtual
networking
capabilities
- The findings indicate that developing an international virtual network capability is
comprised of:
(a) Developing an international network with suppliers and distributors
(b) Developing international networks with industry-specific firms
(c) Developing international networks with customers and industry
authorities.
- The findings show that a greater number firms were developing new international
virtual networking capabilities rather than maintaining and leveraging off
established networks.
- New networking capabilities were not only confined to the firm’s export market,
but were also seen in subsequent internationalisation activities.
8.3.2 The key role of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition on
performance
The second research question (RQ2a) sought to address, ‘What is the relative influence of
firm-level resources and Internet, international marketing capabilities on international
performance?’ The findings from Study Two suggest that international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition is characterised as capability. This is because opportunity
235
recognition is an iterative process, wherein the entrepreneur revises their international
strategy over time. This finding is supported by Zahra et al. (2005) who suggest that the
revisions in the international entrepreneur’s strategy is largely based on the entrepreneur’s
intuition, formal and informal feedback from the market, and from the results of trial and
error. Previous research studies in IE examining firms in an Internet context have
underscored the importance of a firm’s international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition (Sinkovics & Bell, 2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Mathews & Zander, 2007).
The findings from Study One, however, indicate the importance of international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition in mediating the relationship between firm-level
resources such as international entrepreneurial orientation and technology-related
international vision. Importantly, the research findings indicate a significant mediation
effect of international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition in explaining the fully
mediated effect of international entrepreneurial orientation and technology-related
international vision on international market performance.
Nevertheless, the findings from Study One diverge from the work of Chandra et al.,’s
(2009) contention that international opportunity recognition is the beginning of the
internationalisation process and is essentially what ‘triggers’ everything off. The findings
of this thesis, however, show that international opportunity recognition and the
subsequent exploitation of international market opportunities occur after the identification
of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities. That is, firms achieve international
market performance by identification of resources and Internet capabilities to exploit
international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and achieve performance outcomes.
The findings of this thesis demonstrate the factors influencing the international
entrepreneurial opportunity recognition of firms include international entrepreneurial
orientation and the vision of international entrepreneurs. Examining the opportunity
recognition behaviour exhibited by international entrepreneurs is important for the
identification of how international entrepreneurs transcend national boundaries in
recognition and enactment of new international market opportunities. A summary of the
findings of international entrepreneurial orientation can be seen in Figure 8.4.
236
Table 8.4 Summary of findings: International entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition
Overall findings Construct Summary of key findings from Study One
International
entrepreneurial
opportunity
recognition
- The findings from Study One indicate that entrepreneurs are recognising and
taking advantage of international opportunity despite some research (Chandra et
al., 2009) contending that international opportunity recognition is the beginning of
the internationalisation process and is essentially what ‘triggers’ everything off.
- The findings from Study Two show that international entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition of firms occurs after the identification of firm-level resources and
Internet capabilities.
- The findings from Study Two indicate that international entrepreneurial
opportunity recognition mediates the relationship between international
entrepreneurial orientation and international vision of international entrepreneurs.
The findings from Study One and Study Two demonstrate that no single firm-level
resource or Internet capability stands to achieve performance, but rather a total or
‘bundle’ of resources and capabilities is required for the firm’s international strategies. In
considering the RBV, it is the firm’s ‘bundle’ of resources and Internet capabilities which
offers firms an approach to understanding how international market performance can be
achieved. As such, this research highlights the importance of a firm’s unique resource
‘bundle’, which is comprised of capabilities (Amit & Schoemaker, 1993; Schoemaker &
Amit, 1994; Mahoney & Pandian, 1992), as proposed by Teece et al. 1997 and Teece
(2007).
8.4 The key role of international entrepreneurial orientation in firm performance
The second sub-research question (RQ2b) sought to address; ‘How do international
entrepreneurs leverage Internet, international marketing capabilities for international
performance?’ Previous research highlights that the individual dimensions of
international entrepreneurial orientation (for example, international innovativeness,
international proactiveness and international risk-taking propensity) can have a positive
effect on the firm’s international market performance (Knight, 2001; Jantunen et al.,
2005; Ripollés- Meliá et al., 2007; Kuivalainen et al., 2007). Three key findings from
Study One support the notion that international innovativeness influences the firm’s
performance in international markets: (i) firms engaged in new product development via
an Internet platform, (ii) the opening of new Internet-related markets and (iii) the use of
the Internet to achieve international outcomes was found to be related to increased level
237
of innovation in an Internet context. In particular, the findings indicate that firms that
engage in innovative behaviour and encompass the key nuances of innovation as defined
in this thesis stand to achieve international gains that extend beyond performance
indicators such as an increase in market share. Importantly, the research findings provide
support for the assertion that innovation processes are more important in Internet
environments and are critical to a firm’s successful pursuit of international markets.
The findings of Study Two suggest that international entrepreneurial orientation does not
share a direct relationship with international market performance, as previously predicted
by a number of scholars (Zahra & Garvis, 2000; Knight, 2001; Wiklund & Shepherd,
2005; Mostafa et al., 2006; Wang, 2008). Instead, the results of Study Two signify that
international entrepreneurial orientation is the only single firm-level resource in the
model that influences the deployment of capabilities for opportunity recognition and
international market performance. Although the literature has previously digressed around
IE theory, this research highlights the pivotal role played by the individual international
entrepreneur in achieving international market performance.
Importantly, the findings from Study One also indicate two key findings in relation to
how international technology-related proactiveness influences the firm’s international
market performance. Firstly, the findings demonstrate that international entrepreneurial
firms engaged in maintaining a forward-looking perspective, while anticipating the future
needs of the firm, are required to be more proactive in terms of seeking out new
international opportunities in an Internet context. Secondly, the findings indicate that
firms stimulated by opportunity-seeking proactively devoted time and resources to the
Internet to systematically track down new international opportunities.
The research findings from Study One also provide support for the key finding that the
commitment of resources to Internet-related projects where the risk of failure was
moderate is an important component of risk-taking behaviour in an online context.
Previous research argues that the Internet can assist in reducing the perceived risk
associated with strategic decisions in the internationalisation of the firm (Loane, 2006),
considering that the internationalisation processes of the firm are often complex with a
high degree of risk of failure (Mathews & Healy, 2007). The findings from Study One
238
also indicate that the Internet has reduced the traditional barriers of risk faced by firms in
the internationalisation process. The key risk factors negated by the Internet, as shown in
Study One include; high uncertainty and costs, low information and knowledge risk
barriers, and the presence of psychic distance factors, which indicate high levels of risk in
a more traditional offline environment.
The findings from Study One also provide support for the argument that firms developing
an international entrepreneurial orientation perceive new international market
opportunities more quickly, outperform competitors, and improve the international
market performance of the firm (Knight, 2001; Jantunen et al., 2005; Mostafa et al., 2006;
Ripollés- Meliá et al., 2007; Moreno & Casillas, 2008; Wang, 2008; Slevin & Terjesen,
2011). The research findings diverge from those of Lee et al. (2001), who identified only
weak evidence to support the positive relationship between entrepreneurial orientation
and international market performance outcomes.
Importantly, the results from Study Two, as shown in Table 8.5, demonstrate a substantial
contribution of international entrepreneurial orientation in improving the international
market performance of the firm. In particular, the results signify that international
entrepreneurial orientation is fully mediated by both technology-related international
vision and international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. The results signify a
mediated model whereby international entrepreneurial orientation does not share a direct
relationship with international market performance, as previously predicted by a number
of scholars (Zahra & Garvis, 2000; Knight, 2001; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005; Mostafa et
al., 2006; Wang, 2008). Instead, the results signify that international entrepreneurial
orientation is the only single firm-level resource in the model that influences the
deployment of Internet capabilities for the firm’s international market performance.
239
Table 8.5 Summary of findings: International entrepreneurial orientation
Overall findings Construct Summary of key findings from Study One
International
entrepreneurial
orientation
- The findings from Study One show firms developing an international
entrepreneurial orientation perceive new international market opportunities more
quickly.
- The findings indicate that international entrepreneurs with an international
entrepreneurial orientation allow managers to outperform competitors and improve
the international market performance of the firm.
- The research findings diverge from those predicted by Lee et al. (2001), who
identified only weak evidence to support the positive relationship between
entrepreneurial orientation and international market performance outcomes.
International
innovativeness
- The findings from Study One show that firms are developing international
innovativeness in business through
(a) New product development via an Internet platform
(b) Opening of new Internet-related markets, and
(c) The innovative use of the Internet to achieve international outcomes
- The findings provide support for the assertion that innovation processes are critical
to the firm’s successful pursuit of international markets in an Internet
environment.
International
proactiveness
- The findings from Study One demonstrate that international entrepreneurial firms
engaged in proactive behaviour
(a) Maintain a forward-looking perspective
(b) Anticipate the future needs of the firm
- The findings indicate that firms stimulated by opportunity-seeking proactively
devoted time and resources to the Internet to systematically track down new
international opportunities.
- Firms with a psychical closeness to international markets are more likely to
consider their international activities as merely an extension of domestic-based
business and are more inclined to proactively commit resources to internationalise
to those markets of close geographic proximity.
International
risk-taking
propensity
- The findings from Study One indicate that firms indicated they engaged in risk-
taking behaviour by the
(a) Commitment of resources to Internet-related projects where the risk of
failure was moderate
- This research indicates that the Internet has negated the traditional barriers of risk
faced by firms in the internationalisation process. This diverges from research that
suggests otherwise (Loane, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2007).
8.5 Contributions to international entrepreneurship theory
This thesis identifies a specific ‘bundle’ of capabilities that are required for the firm’s
ability in pursuing international opportunities to achieve international market
performance. Framed within an Internet context, this thesis provides scholars with an
additional means to specify and conceptualise firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities required for performance by providing measures useful for future research.
The following discussion is based on the three key theoretical contributions of this
research. Firstly, the research contributes to theory where generally a greater emphasis
240
has been placed on the practice of IE ahead of theory development. Secondly, this
research contributes to the empirical validation of resources and capabilities in IE and
therefore a discussion of current research from a conceptual standpoint will be provided.
Next, much ambiguity exists in defining the Internet capabilities required for the
successful performance of firms in international markets; therefore, a discussion of the
Internet capabilities required for firms in pursuing international performance will be
provided. Lastly, findings from the research indicate that the Internet has reduced the risk
perceptions associated with traditional forms of internationalisation. The implications of
this contribution for internationalisation theory will also be discussed.
(i) The advancement of theory derived from the practice of international entrepreneurship
Although academic interest in IE is increasing, research and scholarly investigation into
the phenomenon is not the catalyst behind the recent momentum of IE. The practice of IE
has in recent years developed well ahead of the advancement of theory, and, as a
consequence IE theory remains fragmented and devoid of unifying theoretical direction
(Coombs et al., 2009; Zahra & George, 2002; Peiris et al., 2012). As such, the diversity of
approaches found in the IE literature suggests that a unifying and clear methodological
direction is currently remote (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As such, a core contribution of
this research lies in its ability to deflect attention back to the importance of the
development of theory for the field of IE.
Although IE has benefited from previous research, which has added to the academic and
methodological rigor of the field (Peiris et al., 2012), understanding of how and why
some international entrepreneurial firms are taking advantage of international market
opportunities to achieve successful international market performance in Internet
environments is lacking. And despite the growing number of international entrepreneurial
firms utilising the Internet to pursue international opportunities, and the international
performance potential rising from such activities (Reuber & Fischer, 2012), the IE
literature has paid limited attention to this phenomenon. As a consequence, some
theoretical approaches to explaining IE are now outdated.
241
The interviews conducted with key informants in this study suggest that two commonly
used approaches to understanding of the performance of international entrepreneurial
firms are now outdated. Firstly, studies examining IE from an RBV perspective without
considering capabilities fail to provide an accurate understanding of the how firm-level
resources, and more specifically Internet capabilities, are influencing the firm’s
international strategies and performance. The results of this thesis highlight the increased
importance of a capabilities approach (Teece, 1986, 2007) in building, integrating and re-
configuring the internal and external competencies of the firm to assist businesses who
operate in environments characterised by rapid change (Teece et al., 1997). This is
because firm-level resources themselves are not a direct source of competitive advantage
(Teece, 2007); instead the research findings support the view that resources should be
transformed into capabilities in order to achieve superior international market
performance (Teece, 2007; Ordanini & Rubera, 2008).
Secondly, the research findings suggest that performance is contingent upon the
integration of an aggregation of Internet capabilities, beyond just a singular perspective
which has plagued recent studies in IE. To date, most studies identify links between the
capabilities of international entrepreneurial Internet firms, yet no model examines the
specific capability ‘bundle’ that may affect the international market performance of the
firm. This study, however, offers this model, and provides both international
entrepreneurs and international marketing managers with an effective way to utilise and
deploy the Internet capabilities as presented in the model for achieving international
market performance.
(ii) The empirical validation of resources and capabilities in international
entrepreneurship
Empirical research in IE studies examining the firm-level resource and capability
development of firms remains at a relatively conceptual level. As a consequence, there is
a lack of empirical validation of the specific variables that might affect the international
market performance of the firm. The majority of the research in the emerging IE field is
also generally characterised by studies focusing on quantitative analysis, and as a result,
complex processes in building and deploying resources and Internet capabilities are not
242
being captured, unless at a narrow level (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As such, a quantitative
approach dominates IE (Coviello & Jones, 2004; Coviello & McAuley, 1999), with the
bulk of data emphasising inferential statistics and hypothesis testing. This finding reflects
a perceived need by researchers to provide ‘significant’ empirical evidence in order to
justify research in a new field (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As such, qualitative approaches
to IE are fewer in number, representing weakness in the field, which is concerned with
behaviour and value-creating processes (McDougal & Oviatt, 2000). This research has
contributed to the field of IE by providing an increased understanding of IE, by bringing
together both qualitative and quantitative methodologies to explore a complex
phenomenon.
Research also suggests that IE research has focused too narrowly on singular method
studies, relying on either quantitative, aggregate-level data, or qualitative context-specific
data only (Coviello & Jones, 2004). To date, there is general consensus in the literature
that that there has been an increased emphasis placed on pattern identification/matching,
and explanation building (Coviello & Jones, 2004) rather than analytic approaches to the
statistical validation of constructs. Because IE remains at a relatively nascent stage, a
number of researchers (Knight, 2001; Zahra & George, 2002; Oviatt & McDougall, 2005)
have argued that employing both qualitative and quantitative methodologies will ensure
research contributions in IE move away from basic conceptualisation to identifying new
theories and statistical validation of constructs. Furthermore, this research has addressed
this call for mixed-method research contributions by employing the use of both
qualitative and quantitative methods.
(iii) Identification of the key Internet capabilities required for international performance.
Previous research widely acknowledges the importance of the Internet as one of the most
important tools for modern day business (Petersen et al., 2002; Loane et al., 2004;
Mostafa, et al., 2006; Loane, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2007). Current research has
attempted to explain the Internet’s impact on the internationalisation of firms (Petersen et
al., 2002; Loane, 2006). Predominantly, research highlights the positive impact of the
Internet on the firm, but neglects the significant influence of the international
entrepreneur’s role in exploiting Internet capabilities for the international business
243
processes of the firm (Glavas & Mathews, 2014a). With the exception of a small number
of studies, researchers to date have paid limited attention to the relationship between IE
and the firm-level resources and Internet capabilities required for firms in achieving
international market performance (Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Loane et al., 2004; Loane,
2006; Mostafa et al., 2006; Morgan-Thomas, 2009; Reuber & Fischer, 2011). To date,
most research (e.g. Aspelund & Moen, 2004; Mostafa et al., 2006) identifies the potential
for links between resources, capabilities and performance, but no one model examines the
specific resources and Internet capabilities that may affect the performance outcomes
firms operating in an Internet environment.
Confirmation and modelling of the model also further indicates an explicit link between
firm-level resources and Internet capabilities. The key research findings support the work
of Eisenhardt and Martin (2000) and Winter (2003), who argue that capabilities do not
directly influence a firm’s performance, but rather indirectly through a mediating
variable, such as international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. As such, the
research findings extend the IE literature in two key ways. First, the research findings
contribute to the IE literature by examining the role of firm-level resources and the
Internet capabilities of international entrepreneurial firms. This contribution addresses the
gap in the literature by identifying a key ‘resource and Internet capability bundle’, related
to the firm’s international market performance, in an Internet environment.
Secondly, the results support the contribution of capabilities in improving the firm’s
international market performance as predicted by Teece (2007). More specifically, the
findings support the assertion that capabilities are required for firms to deploy and
reconfigure resources to generate firm growth (Teece et al., 2007; Pisano, 1994). This
means that firms can ultimately re-deploy firm-level resources and capabilities to respond
to changing market circumstances in environments characterised by rapid and
unpredictable change, such as Internet environments. This is particularly important for
SMEs as their inherent flexibility enhances the ability of the firm to transform ideas into
business activities that can support the firm’s international performance strategies
(Weerawardena et al., 2007; Lewin & Massini, 2003; Wu, 2006; Liao et al., 2009).
Overall, this complex understanding highlights the increased importance of international
244
entrepreneurial SMEs in acquiring and deploying Internet capabilities in environments
characterised by rapid change to achieve and sustain international market performance
outcomes.
(iv) Risk perceptions associated with the Internet and implications for
internationalisation process theory
It has been suggested that the Internet can also assist in reducing the perceived risk
associated with strategic decisions in the internationalisation of the firm, considering that
the internationalisation processes of the firm are often complex with a high degree of risk
in failure (Mathews & Healy, 2007). The findings of this research indicate that Internet,
international marketing capabilities have had a positive effect on lowering the perceived
risk in internationalisation and aid in reducing the key risk factors of traditional
internationalisation such as, high uncertainty and costs, low information and knowledge
and the presence of psychic distance factors. This is in contrast to much of the
internationalisation literature, which highlights that high risk and uncertainty are
constraining factors for the impetus of firm internationalisation (Liesch, Welch &
Buckley, 2011). Recent research also states that in the early stages of internationalisation,
various firms have been found to be lacking basic information and knowledge about, and
experience in, the international marketplace and the ‘practicalities’ of international
activity which add to risk perceptions (Liesch et al., 2011).
This research shows however, that the perception of high risk is lowered however when
firms engage in internationalisation activities via the Internet. The findings have
implications for traditional internationalisation theories, such as the Uppsala model of
internationalisation which has long proposed that firms move into international markets
gradually, and where learning about international operations and commitment to
international business are coupled. The findings of this research begin to show how risk
can be reduced in the internationalisation process because Internet, international
marketing capabilities such as the ability to utilise the Internet as a sales channel, have a
positive impact on the internationalisation of the firm; thus, lowering the ‘overestimation’
that internationalisation activities are high risk.
245
8.6 Managerial contributions
This research offers three managerial contributions that are important for international
entrepreneurs: (i) identification of a strategy tool to reconfigure existing resources and
capabilities, (ii) identification of the levels of innovation required for international
performance, and (iii) identification of the need to recruit employees with an international
entrepreneurial orientation.
(i) Identification of a strategy tool to reconfigure existing resources and capabilities
The research findings indicate a number of variables influencing the international market
performance of the firm. The firm-level resources and Internet capabilities exhibited in
Table 8.6 indicate the ‘essential’ and ‘desirable’ resource capabilities that managers can
utilise to in order to achieve international market performance outcomes. International
entrepreneurial managers can use these key capabilities as tools to reconfigure the
existing resource base to achieve performance. The essential firm-level resources required
for firms to achieve performance in international markets include international
entrepreneurial orientation and international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition. The
findings of this thesis indicate that these two components of a firm’s resource base are
critical for international business strategy. Similarly, Internet, international marketing
capabilities are also a critical firm-level capability. ‘Desirable’, but not essential to the
firm’s progression in international markets, technology-related international vision and
international virtual networking capabilities are not important components for the
international market success of Internet firms, but may be more beneficial for non-
entrepreneurial firms.
246
Table 8.6 Essential and desirable resources and capabilities for practice
Summary of resources and Internet capabilities for practice
‘Essential’ Internet capabilities, capabilities and firm-level resources
Capabilities Firm-level Resources
*International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
* Internet, international marketing capability
* International entrepreneurial orientation
‘Desirable’ Internet capabilities, capabilities and firm-level resources
Capabilities Firm-level Resources
International virtual network capabilities
Technology-related international vision
Note. * Internet, international marketing capabilities, international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
and international entrepreneurial orientation interconnect. Thus, this table provides some explanation as to
why some firms are achieving ‘superior’ international market performance far beyond competitors.
(ii) Identification of the levels of innovation required for international performance
While the final model of ‘Capabilities in IE’ shows an aggregate or total of variables
required for firms to achieve international performance outcomes, innovation is perhaps
one of the most important resources for internationally focused business operating in an
Internet environment. For instance, the research findings show a clear relationship
between the acceptance and application of the Internet and the development of new
innovative products to increase customer value in Internet environments. Because the
Internet has become increasingly competitive, firms need to ensure they are more
innovative in an online environment. This research shows that firms can become more
innovative in an online environment through developing new products, opening up new
markets, and strategic use of the Internet to achieve successful international outcomes.
The findings of this thesis also suggest that firms placing a greater emphasis on
innovation in an Internet environment will stand to achieve increased international market
performance outcomes.
(iii) Identification of the need to recruit employees with an international entrepreneurial
orientation
The findings of the research show that while the Internet has been one of the most
important tools for internationally focused businesses in recent times (Petersen et al.,
2002; Loane, 2006; Mathews & Healy, 2008; Mathews et al., 2012), the ‘human’
247
component of IE remains important. This thesis shows that while capabilities such as
Internet, international marketing capabilities are important for the firm’s progression in
international markets, international entrepreneurial orientation plays a substantial role in
the international market performance outcomes of the firm. As such, international
entrepreneurs should seek to recruit employees with an international entrepreneurial
orientation. That is, international entrepreneurs should consider recruitment of employees
that exhibit innovative behaviours, those who are forward-looking and proactive, and
those who are willing to take risks in an international business environment.
8.7 Limitations and directions for future research
Research limitations are inherent in all research studies and can be addressed in future
research. As such, a discussion of the five key limitations of this research is provided in
conjunction with the directions for future research. The key limitations include (i) the
nature of international entrepreneurs, (ii) the context of the Internet, (iii) the context of
SMEs, (iv) the context of an Australian study, and (v) consideration of other Internet
capabilities.
(i) The nature of international entrepreneurs
The evidence gathered in this thesis is based on self-reporting, which raises the potential
for social desirability response bias. Social desirability bias is a long-standing issue for IE
researchers. The appropriate selection of key informants for this study was a critical
consideration, necessary for the accuracy of responses, and in the elicitation of the
international entrepreneur’s knowledge. The selection of key informants was conducted
in accordance with Huber and Power’s (1985) guidelines in determining the
appropriateness of informants such as owner/founders. Since only one international
entrepreneur per firm was accepted for this study, Huber and Power (1985) suggest that
an attempt should be made to identify the person most knowledgeable in regards to the
issue of interest. As such, questions relating to the international entrepreneur’s key role
within the firm were asked to ensure only owner/founders were recruited. The necessity
for honesty and accuracy in the responses provided by the informants was also
emphasised prior to the commencement of the interviews and the online questionnaire.
248
Common method bias was also tested by use of the Correlated Marker Technique (Lindell
& Whitney, 2001). The marker variable Delta indicated that only minimal paths in the
structural model were affected by common method bias. Future research should seek to
verify the results of this thesis through replication of the research.
(ii) The context of the Internet
A contextual factor that constitutes a boundary condition restricting the generalisability of
the findings presented is the context of the Internet. Although the research sample
consisted of firms actively operating in an Internet environment, firms’ Internet use
ranged from limited to extensive. Because markets are becoming increasingly global in
nature (Reuber & Fischer, 2011), investigation of how international entrepreneurial firms
were pursuing opportunities in an Internet environment was essential. This is because
Internet environments can support international business by enabling access to
international markets and lowering transaction costs (Kontinen & Ojala, 2010), while
improving the efficiency of communications and the flow and exchange of information
and knowledge (Gabrielsson, et al., 2004; Prasad et al., 2001, Loane, 2006). Because the
results of the research have important implications for firms operating in an Internet
environment, future research should seek to validate the findings as presented in the final
model, and/or identify any other variables influencing IE in an Internet environment.
(iii) The context of SMEs
The findings in this research are drawn only from SMEs employing between 1 and 200
people (ABS, 2012). A discussion of context is imperative, given that it establishes where
situational opportunities are apparent (Johns, 2006; Zahra, 2007). Because the research
findings are specifically delimited to SMEs, a question in relation to whether the findings
of the research are less applicable to other specific types of firms, such as multi-national
corporations, could be raised (Reuber & Fischer, 2011). From an RBV perspective, there
is variation in what firms do to succeed in business. The research findings in the final
model are endogenous to the SME context of the study. As such, future research should
consider investigation of IE from an RBV and capabilities perspective with firms not
included in the scope of this study. Such firms may include micro enterprises and large
249
multi-national corporations. International entrepreneurial behaviour may still be present
beyond the SME scope and therefore future research is warranted.
(iv) The context of an Australian study
This study is delimited to the investigation of Australian firms only. Although this study’s
sample appears to approximate national representativeness, the broader generalisability of
the research findings is limited. This is because population parameters were limited and
confined to Australian firms. It is not known whether international entrepreneurs in other
countries share similar value or culture systems, or utilise the same firm-level resources
or Internet capabilities to achieve international market performance. As such, further
research should consider replication of this study in a cross-cultural context. That is,
future research which seeks to identify the key firm-level resources and Internet
capabilities of international entrepreneurial firms should consider a sample beyond
Australia, to include other international markets. This cross-national comparison will
ensure richness in geographic coverage of IE (Coviello & Jones, 2004). As noted by Tan
(2002), researchers employing cross-cultural comparisons will need to distinguish
between both cultural and national effects on IE behaviour.
(v) Consideration of other key Internet capabilities
This study investigates IE from the RBV of the firm. The thesis indicates that
international entrepreneurial orientation plays a pivotal role in influencing the application
of Internet capabilities for international market performance. Opportunities for future
research exist in utilising mixed-method approaches to verify the findings of this thesis
and to identify whether there are any other Internet capabilities influencing the
international market performance of firms. Other key Internet capabilities could include
online marketing-related capabilities, which are required for firms to exploit potential
benefits that can ensure online innovation and customisation of an Internet presence to
achieve performance outcomes (Park, Mezias & Song, 2004; Reuber & Fischer, 2011).
Empirical studies have also shown that online marketing-related capabilities can influence
a firm’s development of technological competencies for positive performance outcomes
(Prasad et al., 2001). As such, more focused attention on whether other key Internet
250
capabilities are influencing the international market performance of the firm is required.
Adopting a mixed-method approach will also assist in improving the current state of the
IE field, where theory remains in a position of fragmentation (Coombs et al., 2009; Zahra
& George, 2002; Peiris et al., 2012).
8.8 Summary
Overall, this research has specifically addressed three pertinent gaps within the IE
literature. Firstly, most studies to date have only started to identify the links between the
application of the Internet and the factors that may influence the performance of firms.
Although the RBV approach has previously been applied to the internationalisation of
firms, no one model has specifically examined the relationship between Internet
capabilities and a firm’s international market performance, in conjunction with firm-level
resources. This thesis has addressed this gap in the literature by identification of the firm-
level resources (international entrepreneurial orientation), which coincide with
capabilities (international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, Internet, international
marketing capabilities) in a model that predicts how international market performance is
achieved. The findings of this thesis also indicate that international market performance is
contingent upon the integration of an aggregation or total of resources and Internet
capabilities beyond just a singular perspective.
Secondly, this thesis has added to the IE literature by providing an understanding of how
firm-level resources and Internet capabilities are being characterised and how these
resource capabilities are influencing the firm’s progression towards achieving
international market performance. The findings of this research indicate that the Internet
is a strategic capability that assists firms in achieving operational efficiency and
functionality when operating internationally. More importantly, the findings indicate that
firm-level resources and capabilities are a critical variable to the successful pursuit of
international marketing opportunities. Although previous discussions in the literature
begin to highlight the impact of the Internet on international market performance, this
research has identified Internet, international marketing capabilities as a critical
component of the firm’s progression to international markets. That is, this research has
shed light on the impact of Internet, international marketing capabilities, which have
251
previously not been identified in the literature. Specifically, this thesis extends RBV to IE
by providing a model of firm-level resources and Internet capabilities, which suggests
that Internet, international marketing capabilities can combine with other resources such
as international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition and, capabilities such as
international entrepreneurial orientation to facilitate superior international market
performance.
Thirdly, this research has fulfilled a gap within the IE literature by understanding of the
positive influence of the individual international entrepreneur in exploiting firm-level
resources and Internet capabilities to achieve international market performance.
Predominantly neglected in prior studies of IE, the international entrepreneurial
orientation of the international entrepreneur is an important catalyst for driving
internationalisation within the firm. The findings of this thesis also suggest that
international entrepreneurial orientation does not share a direct relationship with
international market performance, as previously predicted by a number of scholars (Zahra
& Garvis, 2000; Knight, 2001; Wiklund & Shepherd, 2005; Mostafa et al., 2006; Wang,
2008). Instead, international entrepreneurial orientation is the only single firm-level
resource influencing the deployment of Internet capabilities for opportunity recognition
and international market performance. Although the literature has previously digressed
around the theory, this research highlights the pivotal role played by the international
entrepreneur in facilitating increased financial and non-financial international market
performance outcomes for the firm.
252
REFERENCE LIST
Aaker, D., & Kumar, A. V., Day, GS, & Lawley, M. (2005). Marketing research: The
Pacific Rim edition. New York: Free Press.
Abouzeedan, A., & Busler, M. (2004). Typology analysis of performance models of small
and medium-size enterprises (SMEs). Journal of International Entrepreneurship,
2(1-2), 155-177.
Allen, P., & Bennett, K. (2012). SPSS Statistics. A practical guide: Version 20. South
Melbourne: CENGAGE Learning.
Ambrosini, V., & Bowman, C. (2009). What are dynamic capabilities and are they a
useful construct in strategic management? International Journal of Management
Reviews, 11(1), 29-49.
Amit, R., & Schoemaker, P. J. (1993). Strategic assets and organizational rent. Strategic
Management Journal, 14(1), 33-46.
Anderson, J.C., & Gerbing, D. W. (1988). Structural equation modelling in practice: A
review and recommended two-step approach. Psychological Bulleting, 103(3),
411- 423.
Andersson, S. (2000).The internationalisation of the firm from an entrepreneurial
perspective. International Studies of Management and Organisation, 30 (1), 63-
92.
Andersson, S., & Evangelista, F. (2006). The entrepreneur in the born global firm in
Australia and Sweden. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development,
13 (4), 642- 659.
Andersson, S., & Wictor, I. (2003). Innovative internationalisation in new firms: Born
globals–the Swedish case. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1(3), 249-
275.
Andersson, S., Gabrielsson, J., & Wictor, I. (2004). International activities in small firms:
Examining factors influencing the internationalization and export growth of small
firms. Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences/Revue Canadienne des
Sciences de l'Administration, 21(1), 22-34.
Arenius, P., Sasi, V., & Gabrielsson, M. (2006). Rapid internationalisation enabled by the
Internet: The case of a knowledge intensive company. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 3, 279-290.
Ariño, A. (2002). Measures of strategic alliance performance: An analysis of construct
validity. Journal of International Business Studies, 34(1), 66-79.
253
Armstrong, J. U. S. T., & Overton, T. (1977). Estimating non-response bias in mail
surveys. Journal of Marketing Research, 14, 396-402.
Aspelund, A., & Moen, O. (2004). Internationalization of small high-tech firms: The role
of information technology. Journal of European Marketing, 13 (1), 85-105.
Aspelund, A., Madsen, T. K., & Moen, Ø. (2007). A review of the foundation,
international marketing strategies, and performance of international new ventures.
European Journal of Marketing, 41(11/12), 1423-1448.
Augier, M., & Teece, D. J. (2007). Dynamic capabilities and multinational enterprise:
Penrosean insights and omissions. Management International Review, 47(2), 175-
192.
Austrade. (2010). Information Communication Technology (ICT): A proven testing-
ground for global projects. Retrieved from
http://www.austrade.gov.au/Buy/Australian-Industry-
Capability/ICT/default.aspx.
Austrade. (2011). Australian services sector posts higher figures despite global
downturn. Retrieved from http://www.austrade.gov.au/Invest/Investor-
Updates/100319-Australian-services-sectorposts-higher-figures-despite-global-
downturn/default.aspx.
Austrade. (2012). Australian Trade Commission. Retrieved from
http://www.austrade.gov.au/.
Australian Bureau of Statistics (ABS). (2008). Year book Australia: Tourism industry.
Retrieved from
http://www.abs.gov.au/AUSSTATS/abs@.nsf/bb8db737e2af84b8ca
2571780015701e/12CE2C8EC09187A2CA2573D20010B550?opendocument.
Australian Bureau of Statistics (ABS). (2010). Characteristics and performance of small
and medium-sized business in Australia. Retrieved from
http://www.abs.gov.au/AUSSTATS/abs@.nsf/Lookup/1350.0Feature+Article3Jan
+2010.
Australian Bureau of Statistics (ABS). (2012). Counts of Australia businesses, including
entries and exits, June 2007 to June 2011. Retrieved from
http://www.ausstats.abs.gov.au/ausstats/subscriber.nsf/0/3501C8DDF770CC94A2
579950012015F/$File/81650_jun%202007%20to%20jun%202011.pdf.
Australian Bureau of Statistics (ABS). (2013). Summary of IT use and innovation in
Australian Businesses. Retrieved from
http://www.abs.gov.au/ausstats/abs@.nsf/latestProducts/8166.0Media%20Release
12011-12
254
Autio, E., Sapienza, H. J., & Almeida, J. G. (2000). Effects of age at entry, knowledge
intensity, and imitability on international growth. Academy of Management
Journal, 43(5), 909-924.
Bagozzi, R. (1994). Measurement in marketing research in principle of marketing
research. Oxford: UK, Blackwell.
Barney, J. B. (2001). Resource-based theories of competitive advantage: A ten-year
retrospective on the resource-based view. Journal of Management, 27(6), 643-
650.
Barney, J., B (1986). Strategic factor markets: Expectations, luck, and business strategy.
Management Science, 32(10), 123-1241.
Barney, J., B (1991). Firm resources and sustained competitive advantage. Journal of
Management, 17(1), 99- 120.
Barney, J., Wright, M., & Ketchen, D. J. (2001). The resource-based view of the firm:
Ten years after 1991. Journal of Management, 27(6), 625-641.
Baron, R. M., & Kenny, D. A. (1986). The moderator-mediator variable distinction in
social psychological research: Conceptual, strategic, and statistical considerations.
Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 51(6), 1173-1182.
Baruch, Y. (1997). High tech organization: What is it, what it isn’t. International Journal
of Technology Management, 13(2), 179-195.
Begley, T. M., & Boyd, D. P. (1987). A comparison of entrepreneurs and managers of
small business firms. Journal of management, 13(1), 99-108.
Bell, J. & S. Loane (2010). New-wave global firms: Web 2.0 and SME
internationalisation. Journal of Marketing Management, 26(3), 213-229.
Bell, J., Crick, D., & Young, S. (2004). Small firm internationalization and business
strategy: An exploratory study of ‘knowledge-intensive’ and ‘traditional’
manufacturing firms in the UK. International Small Business Journal, 22(1), 23-
56.
Bell, J., McNaughton, R., Young, S., & Crick, D. (2003).Towards an integrative model of
small firm internationalisation. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1 (4),
339-362.
Bentler, p, M. (2005). EQS 6 Structural equations program manual. Encino, CA:
Multivariate Software.
Bentler, P. M., & Bonett, D. G. (1980). Significance tests and goodness of fit in the
analysis of covariance structures. Psychological Bulletin, 88(3), 588-606.
255
Bhuian, S. N, Menguc, B. & Bell, S. J. (2005). Just entrepreneurial enough: The
moderating effect of entrepreneurship on the relationship between market
orientation and performance. Journal of Business Research, 58 (1), 9-17.
Bloodgood, J. M., Sapienza, H. J., & Almeida, J. G. (1996). The internationalization of
new high-potential US ventures: Antecedents and outcomes. Entrepreneurship
Theory and Practice, 20, 61-76.
Boomsma, A. (2000). Reporting analyses of covariance structures. Structural Equation
Modeling, 7(3), 461-483.
Boyatzis, R. E. (1998). Transforming qualitative information: Thematic analysis and
code development. Thousand Oaks: Sage.
Brown, T. E., Davidsson, P., & Wiklund, J. (2001). An operationalization of Stevenson's
conceptualization of entrepreneurship as opportunity‐based firm behavior.
Strategic Management Journal, 22(10), 953-968.
Busenitz, L. W., West, G. P., Shepherd, D., Nelson, T., Chandler, G. N., & Zacharakis, A.
(2003). Entrepreneurship research in emergence: Past trends and future directions.
Journal of Management, 29(3), 285-308.
Buttriss, G., & Wilkinson, I. (2003). Towards a process model of internetalisation:
Becoming an e-Business, Paper presented at the 19th
Annual IMP Conference,
Switzerland: Lugano.
Byrne, B. M. (2001). Structural equation modeling with AMOS, EQS, and LISREL:
Comparative approaches to testing for the factorial validity of a measuring
instrument. International Journal of Testing, 1(1), 55-86.
Byrne, B. M. (2010). Structural equation modelling with Amos: Basic concepts,
applications, and programming. Multivariate applications book series. London:
Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
Cavusgil, S. T. (1984). Differences among exporting firms based on degree of
internationalisation. Journal of Business Research, 12(2), 195-208.
Cavusgil, S. T., & Nevin, J. R. (1981). Internal determinants of export marketing
behavior: an Empirical investigation. Journal of Marketing Research, 18(1), 114-
119.
Cavusgil, S. T., & Zou, S. (1994). Marketing strategy-performance relationship: An
investigation of the empirical link in export market ventures. The Journal of
Marketing, 58(1), 1-21.
256
Celuch, K., & Murphy, G. (2010). SME Internet use and strategic flexibility: The
moderating effect of IT market orientation. Journal of Marketing Management,
26(1-2), 131-145.
Chandra, Y., Styles, C., & Wilkinson, I. (2009). The recognition of first-time
international entrepreneurial opportunities: Evidence from firms in knowledge-
based industries. International Marketing Review, 26(1), 30-61.
Chandra, Y., Styles, C., & Wilkinson, I. F. (2012). An opportunity-based view of rapid
internationalization. Journal of International Marketing, 20(1), 74-102.
Chang, S. J., van Witteloostuijn, A., & Eden, L. (2010). From the editors: Common
method variance in international business research. Journal of International
Business Studies, 41(2), 178-184.
Chen, C. C., Greene, P. G., & Crick, A. (1998). Does entrepreneurial self-efficacy
distinguish entrepreneurs from managers? Journal of Business Venturing, 13(4),
295-316.
Chen, P. Y. S., & Hitt, L. M. (2002). Measuring switching costs and the determinants of
customer retention in Internet-enabled businesses: A study of the online brokerage
industry. Information Systems Research, 13(3), 255-274.
Chen, X., Zou, H., & Wang, D. T. (2009). How do new ventures grow? Firm capabilities,
growth strategies and performance. International Journal of Research in
Marketing, 26(4), 294-303.
Chetty, S. & R. Hamilton, T. (1993). Firm-level determinants of export performance: A
meta-analysis. International Marketing Review, 10(3), 26-34.
Chetty, S. K., & Wilson, H. I. (2003). Collaborating with competitors to acquire
resources. International Business Review, 12(1), 61-81.
Chetty, S., & Campbell- Hunt, C. (2004).Internationalisation strategy and its impact on
learning during the process. Journal of Asia Pacific Marketing, 3(2), 38- 52.
Choi, Y. R., & Shepherd, D. A. (2004). Entrepreneurs’ decisions to exploit opportunities.
Journal of Management, 30(3), 377-395.
Churchill Jr, G. A. (1979). A paradigm for developing better measures of marketing
constructs. Journal of Marketing Research, 16(1), 64-73.
Collis, D, J. (1994). Research note: How valuable are organizational capabilities?
Strategic Management Journal, 15, 143-152.
257
Coombs, J, E., Sadrieh, F., Annavarjula, M. (2009). Two decades of international
entrepreneurship research: What have we learned, where do we go from here?
International Journal of Entrepreneurship, 13, 23.
Cooper, S. Y., & Park, J. S. (2008). The impact of incubator organizations on opportunity
recognition and technology innovation in new, entrepreneurial high-technology
ventures. International Small Business Journal, 26(1), 27-56.
Corbin, J. M., & Strauss, A. (1990). Grounded theory research: Procedures, canons, and
evaluative criteria. Qualitative Sociology, 13(1), 3-21.
Corbin, J., & Strauss, A. (Eds.). (2008). Basics of qualitative research: Techniques and
procedures for developing grounded theory. Thousand Oaks: Sage Publication.
Coviello, N. E., & Cox, M. P. (2007). The resource dynamics of international new
venture networks. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 4 (2-3), 113-132.
Coviello, N. E., & Jones, M. V. (2004). Methodological issues in international
entrepreneurship research. Journal of Business Venturing, 19(4), 485-508.
Coviello, N. E., & Munro, H. J. (1995). Growing the entrepreneurial firm: Networking for
international market development. European Journal of Marketing, 29 (7), 49-62.
Coviello, N., E. & McAuley, A. (1999). Internationalisation and the smaller firm: A
review of contemporary empirical research. Management International Review,
39(3), 223- 256.
Covin, J. G. & Slevin, D. P (1991). A conceptual model of entrepreneurship as a firm
behaviour. Entrepreneurship: Theory & Practice, 16, 7-25.
Covin, J. G., & Slevin, D. P. (1989). Strategic management of small firms in hostile and
benign environments. Strategic Management Journal, 10(1), 75-87.
Creswell, J., W. (2003). Research design: Qualitative, quantitative, and mixed methods
approaches. Thousand Oaks: Sage.
Davidsson, P., & Wiklund, J. (2007). Levels of Analysis in Entrepreneurship Research:
Current Research Practice and Suggestions for the Future. In Entrepreneurship
(pp. 245-265).Berlin Heidelberg: Springer.
Davis, P. S., Harveston, P. D., & Nicovich, S. G. (2000). Internationalization and
organizational growth: The impact of Internet usage and technology involvement
among entrepreneur-led family businesses. Paper presented at the American
Marketing Association. Conference Proceedings.
Day, G. S. (1994). The capabilities of market-driven organizations. The Journal of
Marketing, 58(4), 37-52.
258
Denzin, N. K., & Lincoln, Y. S. (1994). Handbook of qualitative research. Thousand
Oaks: Sage Publications.
Denzin, N. K., & Lincoln, Y. S. (Eds.). (2011). The SAGE handbook of qualitative
research. Thousand Oaks: Sage Publications.
Department of Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy. Australian
Government (2011). Australia’s Digital Economy: The importance of the digital
economy. Retrieved from
http://www.dbcde.gov.au/digital_economy/what_is_the_digital_econom
y/australias_digital_economy_future_directions/snapshot/.
Department of Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy. Australian
Government (2012). More Australian Businesses getting online: Latest ABS
Statistics. Retrieved from http://www.digitalbusiness.gov.au/2012/08/02/more-
australian-businesses-getting-online-latest-abs-statistics/.
Department of Broadband, Communications and the Digital Economy. Australian
Government (2013). Statistical snapshot. Retrieved from
http://www.dbcde.gov.au/__data/assets/pdf_file/0006/163059/Statistical_snapshot
_20130417.pdf.
Department of Innovation, Industry, Science and Research. Australian Government
(2011). Key statistics: Australian small business. Retrieved from
http://www.innovation.gov.au/SmallBusiness/KeyFacts/Documents/SmallBusines
sPublication.pdf.
Department of Industry, Innovation, Science, Research and Tertiary Education.
Australian Government (2012). Australian small business key statistics and
analysis. Retrieved from
http://www.innovation.gov.au/SmallBusiness/KeyFacts/Documents/AustralianSm
allBusinessKeyStatisticsAndAnalysis.pdf.
Department of Resources, Energy and Tourism. Australian Government (2011). State of
the industry report.
http://www.ret.gov.au/tourism/Documents/tmc/stateofindustry.pdf.
Department of Resources, Energy and Tourism. Australian Government (2012). Facts
and figures at a glance. Retrieved from
http://www.ret.gov.au/tourism/research/tra/Pages/default.aspx.
Deshpande, R. (1983). "Paradigms lost": On theory and method in research in
marketing. The Journal of Marketing, 47(4), 101-110.
Dholakia, R. R., & Kshetri, N. (2004). Factors impacting the adoption of the internet
among SMEs. Small Business Economics, 23(4), 311-322.
259
Dillman, D. A. (2011). Mail and Internet surveys: The tailored design method--2007
update with new Internet, visual, and mixed-mode guide. New Jersey: Wiley.
Dimitratos, P. & Plakoyiannaki, E. (2003). Theoretical foundations of an international
entrepreneurial culture. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1(2), 187- 215.
Dimitratos, P., Lioukas, S., & Carter, S. (2004). The relationship between
entrepreneurship and international performance: The importance of domestic
environment. International Business Review, 13(1), 19-41.
Dimitratos, P., Voudouris, I., Plakoyiannaki, E., & Nakos, G. (2012). International
entrepreneurial culture: Toward a comprehensive opportunity-based
operationalization of international entrepreneurship. International Business
Review, 21(4), 708-721.
Døving, E., & Gooderham, P. N. (2008). Dynamic capabilities as antecedents of the scope
of related diversification: The case of small firm accountancy practices. Strategic
Management Journal, 29(8), 841-857.
Dyer, J. W., G. & Handler, W. (1994). Entrepreneurship and family business: Exploring
the connections. Entrepreneurship: Theory & Practice, 19(1), 71- 83.
Dyke, L. S., E. Fischer, M., & Reuber, R. A. (1992). An inter-industry examination of
the impact of owner experience on firm performance. Journal of Small Business
Management, 30(4): 72- 87.
Easterby- Smith, M., Lyles, M, & Peteraf, M, A. (2009). Dynamic capabilities: Current
debates and future directions. British Journal of Management 20: S2- S8.
Eisenhardt, K. M. (1989). Building theories from case study research. Academy of
Management Review, 14(4), 532-550.
Eisenhardt, K. M., & Graebner, M. E. (2007). Theory building from cases: Opportunities
and challenges. Academy of Management Journal, 50(1), 25-32.
Eisenhardt, K. M., & Martin, J. A. (2000). Dynamic capabilities: What are they? Strategic
Management Journal, 21(10-11), 1105-1121.
Elfring, T., & Hulsink, W. (2003). Networks in entrepreneurship: The case of high-
technology firms. Small Business Economics, 21(4), 409-422.
Eriksson, P., & Kovalainen, A. (2008). Qualitative methods in business research.
Thousand Oaks: Sage Publications .
Etemad, H. (2001). The knowledge and network of international entrepreneurship:
Theory and evidence. Small Business Economics, 20(1), 5-23.
260
Etemad, H. I., Wilkinson I., & Dana, L-P. (2010). Internetization as the necessary
condition for internationalization in the newly emerging economy. Journal of
International Entrepreneurship, 8(4), 319-342.
Fereday, J., & Muir-Cochrane, E. (2008). Demonstrating rigor using thematic analysis: A
hybrid approach of inductive and deductive coding and theme development.
International Journal of Qualitative Methods, 5(1), 80-92.
Fischer, E., & Reuber, A. R. (2003). Targeting export support to SMEs: Owners'
international experience as a segmentation basis. Small Business Economics,
20(1), 69-82.
Fornell, C., & Larcker, D. F. (1981). Evaluating structural equation models with
unobservable variables and measurement error. Journal of Marketing Research,
18(1), 39-50.
Forsgren, M., & Hagström, P. (2007). Ignorant and impatient internationalization?: The
Uppsala model and internationalization patterns for Internet-related firms. Critical
Perspectives on International Business, 3(4), 291-305.
Freeman, J., Styles, C., & Lawley, M. (2012). Does firm location make a difference to the
export performance of SMEs? International Marketing Review, 29(1), 88-113.
Frishammar, J. & Andersson, S. (2010). The overestimated role of strategic orientations
for international performance in smaller firms. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 7, 57- 77.
Gabrielsson, M., & Manek Kirpalani, V. H. (2004). Born globals: How to reach new
business space rapidly. International Business Review, 13(5), 555-571.
Gabrielsson, M., & Pelkonen, T. (2008). Born internationals: Market expansion and
business operation mode strategies in the digital media field. Journal of
International Entrepreneurship, 6(2), 49-71.
Gamboa, E. C., & Brouthers, L. E. (2008). How international is entrepreneurship?
Entrepreneurship Theory and Practice, 32(3), 551-558.
Gefen, D., Straub, D. W., & Boudreau, M. C. (2000). Structural equation modeling and
regression: Guidelines for research practice. In Communications of the association
for information systems.
Gibbs, J. L., & Kraemer, K. L. (2004). A cross‐country investigation of the
determinants of scope of e‐commerce use: An institutional approach. Electronic
Markets, 14(2), 124-137.
261
Glavas, C, R., Mathews, S. (2014a). How international entrepreneurial characteristics
influence Internet capabilities for the international business processes of the firm?
International Business Review, 1(23), 228-245.
Glavas, C, R., Pike, S., and Mathews, S. (2014b). Internet-enabled tourism entrepreneurs.
International entrepreneurial values elicited through repertory test and laddering
analysis. International Journal of Tourism Research, 1(16), 44-55.
Goffin, R. D. (2007). Assessing the adequacy of structural equation models: Golden rules
and editorial policies. Personality and Individual Differences, 42(5), 831-839.
Griffith, D. A., & Harvey, M. G. (2001). A resource perspective of global dynamic
capabilities. Journal of International Business Studies, 32(3), 597-606.
Griffith, D. A., & Lusch, R. F. (2007). Getting marketers to invest in firm-specific capital.
Journal of Marketing, 71(1), 129-145.
Grilo, I., & Thurik, R. (2005). Latent and actual entrepreneurship in Europe and the US:
Some recent developments. The International Entrepreneurship and Management
Journal, 1(4), 441-459.
Guba, E. G. (1990). The paradigm dialog. London: Sage Publications.
Gummesson, E. (2000). Qualitative methods in management research (2nd ed.). London:
Sage Publications.
Gummesson, E. (2004). Return on relationships (ROR): The value of relationship
marketing and CRM in business-to-business contexts. Journal of Business &
Industrial Marketing, 19(2), 136-148.
Hair, J, F Jr., Black, W. C., Babin, B. J., & Anderson, R. E. (2010). Multivariate data
analysis: A global perspective (7th ed.). New Jersey: Pearson Prentice Hall:
Hamill, J. (1997). The Internet and international marketing. International Marketing
Review, 14(5), 300-323.
Hamill, J., & Gregory, K. (1997). Internet marketing in the internationalisation of UK
SMEs. Journal of Marketing Management, 13, 9-28.
Hartman, A., Sifonis, J. G., & Kador, J. (2000). Net ready: Strategies for success in the
e-conomy. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Haynes, P. J., Becherer, R. C., & Helms, M. M. (1998). Small and mid-sized businesses
and Internet use: Unrealized potential? Internet Research, 8(3), 229-235.
262
Helfat, C. E., & Winter, S. G. (2011). Untangling dynamic and operational capabilities:
Strategy for the (N) ever‐changing world. Strategic Management Journal,
32(11), 1243-1250.
Hisrich, R., & Brush, C. (1984). The woman entrepreneur: Management skills and
business problems. Journal of Small Business Management, 22(1), 30-37.
Hisrich, R.D., Honig-Haftel, S., McDougall, P.P. and Oviatt, B.M. (1996). Guest
editorial: International entrepreneurship: past, present, and future.
Entrepreneurship Theory and Practice, Summer.
Hite, J., M., & Hesterly, W, S. (2001). The evolution of firm networks: From emergence
to early growth of the firm. Strategic Management Journal, 22(3), 275-286.
Hohenthal, J. Eriksson, K., & Lindbergh, J. (2006). Factors affecting SME export
channel choice in foreign markets. Advances in International Marketing, 16 (1-
22), 2-22.
Hox, J. (2010). Multilevel analysis: Techniques and applications. London: Routledge
Academic.
Hoyle, R. H. (2000). Confirmatory factor analysis. Handbook of applied multivariate
statistics and mathematical modelling, San Diego: Academic Press.
Huber, G. P., & Power, D. J. (1985). Retrospective reports of strategic‐level managers:
Guidelines for increasing their accuracy. Strategic Management Journal, 6(2),
171-180.
Hutchinson, K. Quinn, B., & Alexander, N. (2006). The role of management
characteristics in the internationalisation of SMEs: Evidence from the UK retail
sector. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development, 13(4) 513-534.
Hutchison, J., Tollefson, N., & Wigington, H. (1987). Response bias in college
freshmen's responses to mail surveys. Research in Higher Education, 26(1), 99-
106.
Ibeh, K. I., & Young, S. (2001). Exporting as an entrepreneurial act: An empirical study
of Nigerian firms. European Journal of Marketing, 35(5/6), 566-586.
Internet World Statistics. (2012). Internet users in the world. Distribution by world
regions. Retrieved from http://www.internetworldstats.com/stats.htm.
Irving, P. G., & Coleman, D. F. (2003). The moderating effect of different forms of
commitment on role ambiguity‐job tension relations. Canadian Journal of
Administrative Sciences/Revue Canadienne des Sciences de l'Administration,
20(2), 97-106.
263
Jantunen, A. Puumalainen, K. Saarenketo, S., & Kylaheiko, K. (2005). Entrepreneurial
orientation, dynamic capabilities and international performance. Journal of
International Entrepreneurship, 3, 232-243.
Johanson, J. & Vahlne, J-E. (1977). The internationalization process of the firm: A model
of knowledge development and increasing foreign market commitments. Journal
of International Business Studies, 8 (1), 23-32.
Johanson, J., & Vahlne, J.-E. (2003). Business relationship learning and commitment in
the internationalization process. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1(1)
83-101.
Johanson, J., & Wiedersheim‐Paul, F. (1975). The internationalization of the firm: Four
Swedish cases 1. Journal of Management Studies, 12(3), 305-323.
Johns, G. (2006). The essential impact of context on organizational behavior. Academy of
Management Review, 31(2), 386-408.
Johnson, J. E. (2004). Factors influencing the early internationalization of high
technology start-ups: US and UK evidence. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 2(1), 139-154.
Jones, M. V., Coviello, N., & Tang, Y. K. (2011). International entrepreneurship research
(1989–2009): A domain ontology and thematic analysis. Journal of Business
Venturing, 26(6), 632-659.
Katz, J. A., Safranski, S. R., & Khan, O. (2003). Virtual instant global entrepreneurship.
Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1(1), 43-57.
Khandwalla, P. N. (1977). The design of organizations (Vol. 260). New York: Harcourt
Brace Jovanovich.
Kirzner, I, M. (1973). Competition and entrepreneurship. Chicago: University of Chicago
Press.
Kline, R.B., 2005. Principles and practice of structural equation modeling. New York:
Guilford Press.
Kline, R.B., 2011. Principles and practice of structural equation modeling (3rd ed.). New
York: Guilford Press.
Knight, G. A., & Cavusgil, S. T. (2004). Innovation, organizational capabilities, and the
born-global firm. Journal of International Business Studies, 35, 334- 334.
Knight, G., A (2001). Entrepreneurship and strategy in the international SME. Journal of
International Management, 7(3), 155- 171.
264
Knudsen, T., & Madsen, T. K. (2002). Export strategy: A dynamic capabilities
perspective. Scandinavian Journal of Management, 18(4), 475-502.
Kontinen, T., & Ojala, A. (2010). Internationalization pathways of family SMEs: Psychic
distance as a focal point. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development,
17(3), 437-454.
Kotha, S. Rindova, V. P., & Rothaermel, F. T. (2001). Assets and actions: Firm-specific
factors in the internationalization of U.S Internet firms. Journal of International
Business Studies, 32(4), 769- 791.
Kropp, F., Lindsay, N. J., & Shoham, A. (2008). Entrepreneurial orientation and
international entrepreneurial business venture startup. International Journal of
Entrepreneurial Behaviour & Research, 14(2), 102-117.
Kuivalainen, O., Sundqvist, S., & Servais, P. (2007). Firms’ degree of born-globalness,
international entrepreneurial orientation and export performance. Journal of
World Business, 42(3), 253-267.
Kvale, S. (1996). Interviews: An introduction to qualitative research interviewing.
California: Sage Publications.
Lee, S. M, Kyungmook, L., & Pennings, J. M. (2001). Internal capabilities, external
networks, and performance: A study on technology-based ventures. Strategic
Management Journal, 22(6-7), 615-640.
Lewin, A. Y., & Massini, S. (2003). Knowledge creation and organizational capabilities
of innovating and imitating firms. Organizations as Knowledge Systems, 209-237.
Li, M., & Ye, R, L. (1999). Information technology and firm performance: Linking
with environmental, strategic and managerial contexts. Information &
Management, 35(1), 43-51.
Liao, J., Kickul, J. R., & Ma, H. (2009). Organizational dynamic capability and
innovation: An empirical examination of Internet firms. Journal of Small Business
Management, 47(3), 263- 286.
Liesch, P., Welch, L, S., & Buckley, P, J. (2011). Risk and uncertainty in
internationalisation and international entrepreneurship studies. Management
International Review, 51(6), 851-873.
Lindell, M. K., & Whitney, D. J. (2001). Accounting for common method variance in
cross-sectional research designs. Journal of Applied Psychology, 86(1), 114-121.
Lituchy, T. R., & Rail, A. (2000). Bed and breakfasts, small inns, and the Internet: The
impact of technology on the globalization of small businesses. Journal of
International Marketing, 8(2), 86-97.
265
Loane, S. (2006).The role of the Internet in the internationalisation of small and medium
sized companies. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 10(1), 263-277.
Loane, S., & Bell, J. (2002). A cross-national comparison of the internationalisation
trajectories of internet start-ups. Irish Journal of Management, 23(2), 53-73.
Loane, S., & Bell, J. (2006). Rapid internationalisation among entrepreneurial firms in
Australia, Canada, Ireland and New Zealand. International Marketing Review,
23(5), 467- 485.
Loane, S., McNaughton, R. B., & Bell, J. (2004).The internationalization of Internet-
enabled entrepreneurial firms: Evidence from Europe and North America.
Canadian Journal of Administrative Sciences, 21, 79- 96.
Lohrke, F. T., Franklin, G. M., & Frownfelter-Lohrke, C. (2006). The Internet as an
information conduit: A transaction cost analysis model of US SME Internet
use. International Small Business Journal, 24(2), 159-178.
Lu, J. W., & Beamish, P. W. (2001). The Internationalization and performance of SMEs.
Strategic Management Journal, 22(6/7), 565-586.
Lumpkin, G. T & G. Dess, G (2001). Linking two dimensions of entrepreneurial
orientation to firm performance. Journal of Business Venturing, 16(5), 429-451.
Lumpkin, G. T. & Dess, G. G. (1996). Clarifying the entrepreneurial orientation construct
and linking it to performance. Academy of Management Review, 21(1), 135-172.
Lumpkin, G. T., & Lichtenstein, B. B. (2005). The role of organizational learning in the
opportunity‐recognition process. Entrepreneurship Theory and Practice, 29(4),
451-472.
Lumsden, J. (2007). Online-questionnaire design guidelines. In RA Reynolds, R. Woods,
& JD Baker (Eds), Electronic Surveys and Measurements (pp. 44-64).
Luthans, F., Zhu, W., & Avolio, B. J. (2006). The impact of efficacy on work attitudes
across cultures. Journal of World Business, 41(2), 121-132.
Lynch, P. D. & Beck, J. C. (2001). Profiles of Internet buyers in 20 countries: Evidence
for region-specific strategies. Journal of International Business Strategies, 32(4),
725-748.
MacCullum, R. C., Roznowski, M., & Necowitz, L. B. (1992). Model modifications in
covariance structure analysis: The problem of capitalization on chance.
Psychological Bulletin, 111(3), 490.
266
Mahoney, J. T., & Pandian, J. R. (1992). The resource‐based view within the
conversation of strategic management. Strategic management Journal, 13(5), 363-
380.
Makadok, R. (2001). Toward a synthesis of the resource‐based and dynamic‐capability
views of rent creation. Strategic Management Journal, 22(5), 387-401.
Malhotra, N. K. (2008). Marketing Research: An Applied Orientation (5th ed.). India:
Pearson Education.
Markland, D. (2007). The golden rule is that there are no golden rules: A commentary on
Paul Barrett’s recommendations for reporting model fit in structural equation
modelling. Personality and Individual Differences, 42(5), 851-858.
Marshall, C., & Rossman, G. B (2006). Designing qualitative research (4th ed.).
Thousand Oaks, SAGE Publications.
Mason, J. (2006). Qualitative researching (2nd ed.). London: SAGE Publications.
Mathews, J. A., & Zander, I. (2007). The international entrepreneurial dynamics of
accelerated internationalisation. Journal of International Business Studies, 38(3),
387-403.
Mathews, S. Healy, M., & Wickramasekera, R. (2012). The internetalisation of
information, knowledge, and interaction components of the firm's
internationalisation process. Journal of Marketing Management, 19 April 2011
(iFirst).
Mathews, S. W., & Healy, M. J. (2007). The Internet and information capability reduces
perceived risk of internationalisation: An Australian SME perspective.
International Journal of Organisational Behaviour,12(1), 71-87.
Mathews, S. W., & Healy, M. J. (2008). From garage to global: The Internet and
international market growth, an SME perspective. International Journal of
Internet and Marketing Advertising, 4(2/3), 179-196.
McDougall, P, P., Shane, S., & Oviatt, B. M. (1994). Explaining the formation of
international new ventures: The limits of theories from international business
research. Journal of Business Venturing, 9, 469-487.
McDougall, P. P., & Oviatt, B. M. (2000). International entrepreneurship: The
intersection of two research paths. Academy of Management Journal, 43(5), 902-
906.
McDougall, P. P., & Oviatt, B. M. (2003). Some fundamental issues in international
entrepreneurship. Entrepreneurship Theory & Practice, 18, 27.
267
McKelvie, A., & Davidsson, P. (2009). From resource base to dynamic capabilities: An
investigation of new firms. British Journal of Management, 20(s1), S63-S80.
Melawar, T. C. & Stead, C. (2002). The impact of information technology on global
marketing strategies. Journal of General Management, 27(4), 15- 26.
Miles, M. B., & Huberman, M. A. (1984). Qualitative data analysis: A sourcebook of new
methods. Beverley Hills: Sage Publications.
Miller, D. & Friesen, P (1984).Organizations: A Quantum View. Englewood Cliffs, New
Jersey: Prentice Hall.
Miller, D. (1983). The correlates of entrepreneurship in three types of firms. Management
Science, 29(7), 770-791.
Miller, W. L., & Crabtree, B. F. (1999). Depth interviewing. Doing Qualitative Research,
2, 123-201.
Moen, Ø. & Servais, P. (2002).Born global or gradual global? Examining the export
behavior of small and medium-sized enterprises. Journal of International
Marketing 10(3), 49-72.
Moen, Ø., Madsen, T. K., & Aspelund, A. (2008). The importance of the internet in
international business-to-business markets. International Marketing Review,
25(5), 487-503.
Moreno, A. M.,& Casillas, J. C. (2008). Entrepreneurial orientation and growth of SMEs:
A causal model. Entrepreneurship: Theory and Practice, 32(3), 507-528.
Morgan, N. A. (2012). Marketing and business performance. Journal of the Academy of
Marketing Science, 40(1), 102-119.
Morgan-Thomas, A. (2009). Online activities and export performance of the smaller firm:
A capability perspective. European Journal of International Management, 3(3),
266-285.
Morgan-Thomas, A., & Bridgewater, S. (2004). Internet and exporting: Success in virtual
export channels. International Marketing Review, 21(4/5), 393-408.
Morrow, J.F. (1988). International entrepreneurship: A new growth opportunity. New
Management, 3, 59-61.
Mort, G. S., & Weerawardena, J. (2006). Networking capability and entrepreneurship:
How networks function in Australian born global firms. International Marketing
Review, 23 (5), 549-572.
268
Mostafa, R. H. A., Wheeler, C., & Jones, M. V. (2006). Entrepreneurial orientation
commitment to the Internet and export performance in small and medium sized
exporting firms. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 3(1), 291-302.
Murphy, G. B., Trailer, J. W., & Hill, R. C. (1996). Measuring performance in
entrepreneurship research. Journal of Business Research, 36(1), 15-23.
Nelson, R., R & S. Winter, G (1982). The Schumpeterian trade-off revisited. American
Economic Review, 72(1), 114-132.
Nieto, M. J., & Fernandez, Z. (2006). The role of information technology in corporate
strategy of small and medium enterprises. Journal of Entrepreneurship, 3, 251-
262.
Nummela, N., & Welch, C. (2006). Qualitative research methods in international
entrepreneurship: Introduction to the special issue. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 4(4), 133-136.
Nummela, N., Saarenketo, S., & Puumalainen, K. (2004). A global mindset: A
prerequisite for successful internationalization. Canadian Journal of
Administrative Sciences, 21(1), 51-63.
Onetti, A., Zucchella, A., Jones, M, V., & McDougall-Covin. (2012).Internationalization,
innovation and entrepreneurship: Business models for new technology-based
firms. Journal of Management and Governance, 16(3), 337-368.
Onwuegbuzie, A. J., Johnson, R. B., & Collins, K. M. (2009). Call for mixed analysis: A
philosophical framework for combining qualitative and quantitative approaches.
International journal of multiple research approaches, 3(2), 114-139.
Ordanini, A., & Rubera, G. (2008). Strategic capabilities and internet resources in
procurement: A resource-based view of B-to-B buying process. International
Journal of Operations & Production Management, 28(1), 27-52.
Overby, J. W., & Servais, P. (2005). Small and medium-sized firms' import behavior: The
case of Danish industrial purchasers. Industrial Marketing Management, 34(1),
71-83.
Oviatt, B. M., & McDougall, P. (1994). Toward a theory of international new ventures.
Journal of International Business Studies, 25(1), 45- 64.
Oviatt, B. M., & McDougall, P. (2005). Defining international entrepreneurship and
modeling the speed of internationalization. Entrepreneurship: Theory and
Practice, 29(5), 537- 553.
269
Oviatt, B. M., & McDougall, P. P. (1997). Challenges for internationalization process
theory: The case of international new ventures. MIR: Management International
Review, 85-99.
Oviatt, B. M., & McDougall, P. P. (2004). The internationalization of entrepreneurship.
Journal of International Business Studies, 36(1), 2-8.
Oviatt, B. M.,& McDougall, P. (1995). Global start-ups: Entrepreneurs on a worldwide
stage. Academy of Management Executive, 9(2), 30-43.
Pallant, J., & Manual, S. S. (2007). A step by step guide to data analysis using SPSS
for Windows version 15. Melbourne: Open University press.
Park, N. K., Mezias, J. M., & Song, J. (2004). A resource-based view of strategic
alliances and firm value in the electronic marketplace. Journal of Management,
30(1), 7-27.
Patton, M. Q. (1990). Qualitative evaluation and research methods. California: Sage
Publications.
Peiris, I. K., Akoorie, M. E., & Sinha, P. (2012). International entrepreneurship: A critical
analysis of studies in the past two decades and future directions for research.
Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 10(4), 279-324.
Penrose, E. T. (1959). The theory of the growth of the firm. Oxford: Basil Blackwell.
Perry, C. (1998a). A structured approach for presenting theses. Australasian Marketing
Journal (AMJ), 6(1), 63-85.
Perry, C. (1998b). Processes of a case study methodology for postgraduate research in
marketing. European Journal of Marketing, 32(9/10), 785-802.
Petersen, B. Welch, L. S., & Liesch, P.W. (2002). The Internet and foreign market
expansion by firms. Management International Review, 42(2), 207-221.
Pettigrew, A. M. (1990). Longitudinal field research on change: theory and practice.
Organization Science, 1(3), 267-292.
Pisano, G. P. (1994). Knowledge, integration, and the locus of learning: An empirical
analysis of process development. Strategic Management Journal, 15(S1), 85-100.
Podsakoff, P. M., & Organ, D. W. (1986). Self-reports in organizational research:
Problems and prospects. Journal of Management, 12(4), 531-544.
Podsakoff, P. M., MacKenzie, S. B., Lee, J. Y., & Podsakoff, N. P. (2003). Common
method biases in behavioral research: A critical review of the literature and
recommended remedies. Journal of Applied Psychology, 88(5), 879-903.
270
Poon, S. & Jevons, C. (1997). Internet-enabled international marketing: A small business
network perspective. Journal of Marketing Management, 13, 29-41.
Poon, S., & Swatman, P, M, C (1997). Small business use of the Internet: Findings from
Australian case studies. International Marketing Review, 14(5), 385-402.
Prange, C., & Verdier, S. (2011). Dynamic capabilities, internationalization processes and
performance. Journal of World Business, 46(1), 126-133.
Prasad, V. K., Ramamurthy, K.,& Naidu, G. M. (2001). The influence of Internet-
marketing integration on marketing competencies and export performance.
Journal of International Marketing, 9(4), 82-110.
Prashantham, S. (2005). Toward a knowledge-based conceptualization of
internationalization. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 3(1), 37-52.
Priem, R. L., & Butler, J. E. (2001). Is the resource-based "view" a useful perspective for
strategic management research? Academy of Management Review, 26(1), 22-40.
Quan, J. (2008). Evaluating e-business leadership and its link to firm performance.
Journal of Global Information Management, 16(2), 81-90.
Quelch, J. B., & Klein, L. (1996). The Internet and international marketing. Sloan
Management Review 37(3), 60-76.
Qureshil, S. Kamal, M., & Wolcott, P. (2009). Information technology interventions for
growth and competitiveness in micro-enterprises. International Journal of E-
Business Research, 5 (1), 117-140.
Ramsey, E., & Ibbotson, P. (2005). ’E’entrepreneurial SMEs: An Irish study of micro and
macro influences. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 3(4), 317-332.
Ray, G., Barney, J. B., & Muhanna, W. A. (2004). Capabilities, business processes, and
competitive advantage: choosing the dependent variable in empirical tests of the
resource‐based view. Strategic Management Journal, 25(1), 23-37.
Ray, G., Muhanna, W. A., & Barney, J. B. (2005). Information technology and the
performance of the customer service process: A resource-based analysis. MIS
Quarterly, 625-652.
Raymond, L., & Bergeron, F. (2008). Enabling the business strategy of SMEs through e-
business capabilities: a strategic alignment perspective. Industrial Management &
Data Systems, 108(5), 577-595.
Reid, S., D. (1981). The decision- maker and export entry and expansion. Journal of
International Business Studies 12(2), 101-121.
271
Reuber, A. R., & Fischer, E. (1999). Understanding the consequences of founders'
experience. Journal of Small Business Management, 37(2), 30-45.
Reuber, R. & Fischer, E. (2011). International entrepreneurship in Internet-enabled
markets. Journal of Business Venturing, 26, 660-679.
Reuber, R. A., & Fischer, E. (1997). The influence of the management team's
international experience on the internationalization behaviors of SMEs. Journal
of International Business Studies, 28, 807- 825.
Ripollés-Meliá, M., Menguzzato-Boulard, M., & Sánchez-Peinado, L. (2007).
Entrepreneurial orientation and international commitment. Journal of
International Entrepreneurship, 5(3-4), 65-83.
Rothaermel, F., T (2007). Building dynamic capabilities: Innovation driven by individual-
firm- and network-level effects. Organization Science, 18(6), 898-921.
Ruzzier, M., Hisrich, R. D., & Antoncic, B. (2006). SME internationalization research:
Past, present, and future. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development,
13(4), 476-497.
Samiee, S. (1998). Exporting and the Internet: A conceptual perspective. International
Marketing Review, 15(5), 413-426.
Sapienza, H. J., Autio, E., George, G. & Zahra, S, A. (2006). A capabilities perspective
on the effects of early internationalization on firm survival and growth. The
Academy of Management Review, 31(4), 914-933.
Sax, L. J., Gilmartin, S. K., & Bryant, A. N. (2003). Assessing response rates and non-
response bias in web and paper surveys. Research in Higher Education, 44(4),
409-432.
Schoemaker, P., & Amit, R. (1994). Investment in Strategic Assets: Industry and Firm
Level Perspectives. Advances in Strategic Management A, 10, 3-33.
Schumacker, R, E & Lomax, R, G. (2010). A beginners guide to structural equation
modeling. New Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, Inc.
Schumacker, R, E. & Lomax. R,G (2004). A beginner's guide to structural equation
modeling, 2. New Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, Inc.
Schwens, C., & Kabst, R. (2009). How early opposed to late internationalizers learn:
Experience of others and paradigms of interpretation. International Business
Review, 18(5), 509-522.
272
Seidler, J. (1974). On using informants: A technique for collecting quantitative data and
controlling measurement error in organization analysis. American Sociological
Review, 816-831.
Sekaran, U. (2000). Research method for Business: A skill-building approach. New
York: John Wiley & Sons.
Shane, S. (2000). Prior knowledge and the discovery of entrepreneurial opportunities.
Organization Science, 11(4), 448-469.
Shane, S., & Venkataraman, S. (2000). The promise of entrepreneurship as a field of
research. Academy of Management Review, 25(1), 217-226.
Shepherd, D. A., & Krueger, N. F. (2002). An intentions‐based model of entrepreneurial
teams’ social cognition. Entrepreneurship Theory and Practice, 27(2), 167-
185.
Sher, P. J., & Lee, V. C. (2004). Information technology as a facilitator for enhancing
dynamic capabilities through knowledge management. Information &
Management, 41(8), 933-945.
Sinkovics, R., & Bell, J. (2006). Current perspectives on international entrepreneurship
and the Internet. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 3(1), 247-249.
Sinkovics, R., & Penz, E. (2006). Empowerment of SME websites: Development of a
web empowerment scale and preliminary evidence. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 3, 305-315.
Slevin, D, P & Terjesen, S, A. (2011) .Entrepreneurial orientation: Reviewing three
papers and implications for further theoretical and methodological development.
Entrepreneurship: Theory & Practice, 35(5), 973-987.
Stake, R. E. (1995). The art of case study research. Thousand Oaks: Sage Publications.
Standing, C., & Vasudavan, T. (2000). The marketing of regional tourism via the Internet:
Lessons from Australian and South African sites. Marketing Intelligence and
Planning, 18(1), 45-49.
Stanton, J. M. (1998). An empirical assessment of data collection using the Internet.
Personnel Psychology, 51(3), 709-725.
Stray, S., Bridgewater, S., & Murray, G. (2001). The internationalisation process of small,
technology-based firms: Market selection, mode choice and degree of
internationalisation. Journal of Global Marketing, 15(1), 7-29.
Stuart, R. W., & Abetti, P. A. (1990). Impact of entrepreneurial and management
experience on early performance. Journal of Business Venturing, 5(3), 151-162.
273
Styles, C., & Seymour, R. G. (2006). Opportunities for marketing researchers in
international entrepreneurship. International Marketing Review, 23(2), 126-145.
Tan, J. (2002). Culture, nation, and entrepreneurial strategic orientations: Implications for
an emerging economy. Entrepreneurship: Theory and Practice, 26(4), 96-111.
Teece, D. J. (1982). Towards an economic theory of the multiproduct firm. Journal of
Economic Behavior & Organization, 3(1), 39-63.
Teece, D. J. (1986). Profiting from technological innovation: Implications for integration,
collaboration, licensing and public policy. Research Policy, 15(6), 285-305.
Teece, D. J. (2007). Explicating dynamic capabilities: The nature and microfoundations
of (sustainable) enterprise performance. Strategic Management Journal, 28(13),
1319-1350.
Teece, D. J., Pisano, G., & Shuen, A. (1997). Dynamic capabilities and strategic
management. Strategic Management Journal, 18(7), 509-533.
Teece, D., & Pisano, G. (1994). The dynamic capabilities of firms: An introduction.
Industrial and Corporate Change, 3(3), 537-556.
Tesar, G., & Tarleton, J. S. (1982). Comparison of Wisconsin and Virginia small and
medium-sized exporters: Aggressive and passive exporters. Export Management:
An International Context, 85-112.
Tourism Research Australia. Australian Government Department of Resources, Energy
and Tourism (2012). Tourism industry, facts and figures at a glance. Retrieved
from
http://www.ret.gov.au/tourism/Documents/tra/Economic%20Analysis/FactsFigur
esSep2012.pdf.
Tourism Research Australia. Australian Government. (2012). State of the industry: Full
report. Retrieved from
http://www.ret.gov.au/tourism/Documents/tra/Economic%20Analysis/State_of_th
e_Industry_2012.pdf.
Venkataraman, S. (1997). The distinctive domain of entrepreneurship research.
Foundations of entrepreneurship. Charlottesville: Edward Elgar Press.
Vogel, R., & Güttel, W, H. (2013). The dynamic capability view in strategic
management: A biometric review. International Journal of Management Reviews,
15, 426-446.
274
Wakkee, I. (2006). Mapping network development of international new ventures with the
use of company e-mails. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 4(4), 191-
208.
Wang, C, L & Ahmed, P, K. (2007). Dynamic capabilities: A review and research
agenda. International Journal of Management Reviews, (9)1, 31-51.
Wang, C, L. (2008). Entrepreneurial orientation, learning orientation, and firm
performance. Entrepreneurship: Theory and Practice, 32(4), 635- 657.
Weerawardena, J., Mort, G. S., Liesch, P. W., & Knight, G. (2007). Conceptualizing
accelerated internationalization in the born global firm: A dynamic capabilities
perspective. Journal of World Business, 42(3), 294-306.
Welch, C. (2004). Broadening the concept of international entrepreneurship:
Internationalisation, networks and politics. Journal of International
Entrepreneurship, 2(3), 271-237.
Welch, D, E & R. Luostarinen (1993). Inward-outward connections in
internationalization. Journal of International Marketing 1(1), 46-58.
Wernerfelt, B. (1984). A resource‐based view of the firm. Strategic Management Journal,
5(2), 171-180.
Wertz, D, H., & Allinger, N. L. (1974). Conformational analysis—CI: The gauche-
hydrogen interaction as the basis of conformational analysis. Tetrahedron, 30(12),
1579-1586.
Westhead, P., Wright, M., & Ucbasaran, D. (2001). The internationalization of new and
small firms: A resource-based view. Journal of Business Venturing, 16, 333-358.
Wickramasekera, R., & Oczkowski, E. (2006). Stage models re-visited: A measure of the
stage of internationalisation of a firm. Management International Review, 46(1),
39-55.
Wiklund, J. & Shepherd, D. (2005). Entrepreneurial orientation and small business
performance: A configurational approach. Journal of Business Venturing, 20(1),
71- 91.
Wiklund, J., & Shepherd, D. (2003). Knowledge‐based resources, entrepreneurial
orientation, and the performance of small and medium‐sized businesses. Strategic
management journal, 24(13), 1307-1314.
Wilden, R., Gudergan, S. P., Nielsen, B. B., & Lings, I. (2013). Dynamic capabilities and
performance: strategy, structure and environment. Long Range Planning, 46(1-2),
72-96.
275
Williams, L. J., Hartman, N., & Cavazotte, F. (2010). Method variance and marker
variables: A review and comprehensive CFA marker technique. Organizational
Research Methods, 13(3), 477-514.
Williams, L., Hartman, N., & Cavazotte, F. (2003). Method variance and marker
variables: An integrative approach using structural equation methods. Seattle,
WA: Academy of Management.
Winter, S. G. (2003). Understanding dynamic capabilities. Strategic Management
Journal, 24(10), 991-995.
Wright, R. W., & Dana, L. P. (2003). Changing paradigms of international
entrepreneurship strategy. Journal of International Entrepreneurship, 1(1), 135-
152.
Wright, R. W., & Ricks, D. A. (1994). Trends in international business research: Twenty-
five years later. Journal of International Business Studies, 25(4), 687-701.
Wu, F., Mahajan, V., & Balasubramanian, S. (2003). An analysis of e-business adoption
and its impact on business performance. Journal of the Academy of Marketing
Science, 31(4), 425-447.
Wu, L. Y. (2006). Resources, dynamic capabilities and performance in a dynamic
environment: Perceptions in Taiwanese IT enterprises. Information &
Management, 43(4), 447-454.
Yin, R. K. (1981). The case study crisis: Some answers. Administrative Science
Quarterly, 26(1), 58- 65.
Yin, R. K. (1992). The case study method as a tool for doing evaluation. Current
Sociology, 40(1), 121-137.
Yin, R. K. (1994).Case study research: Design and methods (2nd ed.). Newbury Park,
California: Sage.
Yin, R. K. (2009). Case study research. Design and methods (4 Ed). Thousand Oaks
California: Sage.
Zahra, S. A. (2004). A theory of international new ventures: A decade of research.
Journal of International Business Studies, 36(1), 20-28.
Zahra, S. A. (2007). Contextualizing theory building in entrepreneurship research.
Journal of Business Venturing, 22(3), 443-452.
Zahra, S. A., & Dess, G. G. (2001).Entrepreneurship as a field of research: Encouraging
dialogue and debate. Academy of Management Review, 26(1), 8-10.
276
Zahra, S. A., & Garvis, D. M. (2000). International corporate entrepreneurship and firm
performance: The moderating effect of international environmental hostility.
Journal of Business Venturing, 15(5), 469-492.
Zahra, S. A., & George, G. (2002). International entrepreneurship: The current status of
the field and future research agenda. Strategic entrepreneurship: Creating a new
mindset, 255-288.
Zahra, S. A., Korri, J. S., & J, Yu. (2005). Cognition and international entrepreneurship:
Implications for research on international opportunity recognition and
exploitation. International Business Review, 14(2), 12-146.
Zahra, S., Sapienza, H., & Davidsson, P. (2006). Entrepreneurship and dynamic
capabilities: a review, and research agenda. Journal of Research Studies, 43, 4.
Zhu, K. & K. Kraemer (2002). E-commerce metrics for net-enhanced organizations:
Assessing the value of e-commerce to firm performance in the manufacturing
sector. Information Systems Research, 13(3), 275-295.
Zhu, W., Chew, I. K., & Spangler, W. D. (2005). CEO transformational leadership and
organizational outcomes: The mediating role of human–capital-enhancing human
resource management. The Leadership Quarterly, 16(1), 39-52.
Zucchella, A. (2007). The drivers of the early internationalization of the firm. Journal of
World Business, 42(3), 268- 280.
277
APPENDIX
278
Appendix 1. Interview Protocol
CONFIDENTIAL
Interview Protocol
An investigation of the inter-relationships between firm resources, capabilities and
international market performance.
Ms. Charmaine Glavas
PhD Candidate
School of Business
Advertising, Marketing and Public Relations
Queensland University of Technology
Phone: (07) 3138 8074
Fax: (07) 3138 1811
E- mail: charmaine.glavas@qut.edu.au
279
INTERVIEW PROTOCOL
PART A: OPENING: Thank the participant for their time
Firstly, thank you for taking the time today to have this discussion with me. This PhD research would not
be possible without your valuable contribution. We have come together today to discuss the resource
capabilities of your firm and how you are using technology, such as the Internet to leverage your firm’s
international market performance. It is excepted that the outcomes of this PhD research will assist
international entrepreneurs, such as yourself, in identifying your firms unique resources and capabilities that
can be used to explore international markets, including the ability to adapt the firms services and products
to foreign market needs. These key findings will further assist international entrepreneurially focused firms
in understanding foreign market needs and demands, but also facilitate the development of knowledge
crucial for internationalisation.
PART B: AIM OF THE RESEARCH: Explain the outcome of the PhD research
The aim of this PhD research is to explore and investigate an under-researched topic: the relationship
between capabilities, resources, the Internet and the international market performance among international
entrepreneurial firms. The aim of this PhD research is to demonstrate the role of a firm’s unique resource/
capability bundle on the international market performance of the firm.
PART C: PROCESS OF THE INTERVIEW: Explain how the interview will operate
In regards to our discussion today, there are no right or wrong answers to the questions we will discuss. I
am simply interested in your opinions and experiences. This is totally confidential conversation and
information I record, such as your full-name and demographic information will not be kept by the
researcher or Queensland University of Technology. For the safety of yourself and your firm, I will disguise
your name, company name and any personal identifying information in the final report, so you remain
Case number Interview number Date
Business name
Interviewee’s name
Interviewee’s job title
Interview location
Interview start time Finish time
280
anonymous, unless prior permission in writing has been obtained by you to reveal your identify. All
undisguised information will not be made public, nor will the information be given to a third party outside
of my direct primary supervisor Dr. Shane Mathews. Today’s process involves a conversation to discuss
your opinions and experiences about the types of resources your firm uses to attract and attain customers in
international markets. The complete interview process will take approximately one hour. I would like to
tape record today’s session, as I will be transcribing this discussion for analysis purposes. When I have
completed the analysis, I will provide participants with a copy of the summary report for feedback and to
ensure that your views have been appropriately represented.
As part of the University’s ethical clearance policies, you are required you to complete the two forms in
front of you:
1. An ethical clearance form; it is a requirement of the university’s research policy to complete this
form. The document outlines that the research team will respect your confidentiality and that any
information discussed here today will not be used to personally identify participants here today in any
publications or conference discussions.
2. An informant details sheet; general demographic information about you. Only members of the
research team will be privy to this information.
If you require confirmation or further details about the research project you can contact my primary
PhD supervisor:
Dr Shane Mathews- Primary Supervisor
School of Advertising, Marketing and Public Relations
Queensland University of Technology
Phone: 3138 5310
E- mail: sw.mathews@qut.edu.au
If you require any information in regards to the ethics of this PhD research project, you are instructed to
contact, Dr. Marilyn Healy:
Dr Marilyn Healy- Business School Ethics Advisor
Queensland University of Technology
Phone: 3138 7651
E- mail: m.healy@qut.edu.au
Just before we start, can I please get you to state your name and your businesses name?
PART D: OPENING QUESTIONS (10 MIN)
Objective: To obtain general business information and participant details
1. Are you the owner/ founder of this firm? If so, are you also the central decision maker within the
firm? If so, can you tell me about the types of decisions you make in your firm on a daily basis?
2. Can you please tell me about the nature of your business? Do you export products, services or
both?
281
3. What is the age of the firm?
4. How many people does your business employ?
5. How many offices do you have?
PART E: INTERNATIONAL ENTREPRENEURIAL ORIENTATION (15 MIN)
Objective: To explore the degree to which the participant is internationally entrepreneurially oriented
6. Do you use the Internet to attract customers in overseas markets? If so, what types of technologies
do you use?
7. Are you likely to make investments in new international projects that are risky? If so, will the use
of the Internet play a role?
8. Do you consider yourself to be highly innovative within your firm? If so, can you please give me
an example/s of something different or new you have done in the past year to do with your
international customers?
9. How important is it for you to be continually innovative within your firm? (Tick)
IMPORTANCE OF INTERNATIONAL INNOVATION
No importance slight importance Moderate
importance
Strong importance Very strong
importance
PART F: INTERNATIONAL VISION (15 MIN)
Objective: To explore the international vision/ motivations of the international entrepreneur
10. Do you intend to target any country markets within the next two years? Which markets and why?
11. Do you aspire to increase the number of your current international customer database? If so, will
the Internet play a role in increasing the number of international customers?
12. Where do you envisage your firm to be in five years time?
13. How important is it for you to have an international vision in your firm? (Tick)
IMPORTANCE OF INTERNATIONAL VISION
No importance slight importance Moderate
importance
Strong importance Very strong
importance
PART G: INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS EXPERIENCE (20 MIN)
Objective: To explore the prior and current international experience of the international entrepreneur
14. Can you please tell me about the level (if any) of education that you have attained?
15. Do you have previous international business experience? If so, can you tell me about your previous
experience?
16. Can you please indicate how important to you is your international business experience? (Tick)
282
IMPORTANCE OF INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS EXPERIENCE
No importance Slight importance Moderate
importance
Strong importance Very strong
importance
17. How many years experience do you have in this industry?
18. How many years experience do you have in this current business?
19. Have you previously used technology such as the Internet in your previous international business
experience?
PART H: INTERNET INTERNATIONAL MARKETING CAPABILITIES (15 MIN)
Objective: To explore the extent to which the firm utilises the Internet as an international marketing tool.
20. To what extent does your firm use the Internet? (Tick) & (Rate importance to your business
with a tick)
INTERNET USE
MEDIUMS TICK No
importance
Slight
importance
Moderate
importance
Strong
importance
Very strong
importance
Third party websites
Official business website
Advertising and marketing
Online sales
After sales service and support
Online purchasing
Market research
Contact overseas customers
Contact overseas suppliers
International market management
Exchange of operational data with
suppliers
Exchange of operational data with customers
Internet videoconferencing
Recruit personnel
Receiving overseas enquiries
Receiving overseas orders
Identify foreign competitors
Identify foreign markets
Identify potential business partners
Identify potential foreign customers
Dealing with international public authorities
21. Do you think that the use of the Internet has helped to generate international awareness of your
firm?
22. Does your firm place a strong emphasis on technological leadership? If so, why is this important?
PART I: INTERNATIONAL NETWORK CAPABILITIES (15 MIN)
Objective: To explore the extent to which the firm has and/ or is using international networks within the
firm.
283
23. Do you have international business networks? If so, can you please explain the types of
international networks you have?
24. How important are your international networks to you? (Tick)
IMPORTANCE OF INTERNATIONAL NETWORKS
No importance Slight
importance
Moderate
importance
Strong
importance
Very strong
importance
25. Has the Internet impacted on the development and maintenance of your international network
relationships? If so, can you please explain why?
26. In your opinion, do you think that your international networks have influenced your firm’s
international market performance? Why do you think so?
PART J: INTERNATIONAL MARKET PEFORMANCE (10 MIN)
Objective: To explore the firm’s international market performance success.
27. Can you please tell me how many years your firm has been exporting?
28. Can you please tell me the number of countries/ markets your firm currently exports to?
29. Which country did your firm first export to? (Tick)
FIRST EXPORT MARKET
NZ US UK CANADA JAPAN CHINA INDONESIA SINGAPORE TAIWAN
OTHER:
30. What are the top five countries you export to? Briefly, why are they the top five? (Tick)
TOP FIVE EXPORT MARKETS
NZ US UK CANADA JAPAN CHINA INDONESIA SINGAPORE TAIWAN
OTHER:
31. Has the Internet influenced the way in which you export your product/ service? If so, how?
PART K: WRAP UP
Objective: To conclude the interview and thank participant for their time.
32. Do you have any other comments in relation to the questions I have asked you today?
33. Can you provide the details of anyone who you think may be useful for this PhD research project?
Finally, thank you for your time
Your input will be valuable for this PhD research.
284
Appendix 2. Questionnaire
PARTICIPANT INFORMATION FOR QUT RESEARCH PROJECT
International Entrepreneurship in an Internet environment
QUT Ethics Approval Number
1200000678
RESEARCH TEAM
Principal Researcher:
Charmaine Glavas - PhD Candidate, AMPR: QUT Business School
Associate Researchers:
Dr. Shane Mathews - Principal Supervisor, AMPR: QUT Business School
Prof. Rebekah Russell- Bennett - Associate Supervisor, AMPR: QUT Business School
DESCRIPTION
This project is being undertaken as part of a PhD for Charmaine Glavas, at Queensland University of
Technology (QUT). The purpose of this project is to explore the relationship between technology and a firm’s
resource capabilities and international market performance. To do this you will be asked to evaluate statements
relating your firms international business practices by ranking a variety of statements according to ‘strongly
disagree’ to ‘strongly agree’. You are invited to participate in this project because you are the owner/ founder of
your firm and you have international customers.
PARTICIPATION
Your participation in this project is entirely voluntary. If you do agree to participate you can withdraw from the
project without comment or penalty prior to submitting your fully completed survey. Any information already
obtained from you will be deleted. However, once you agree to submit your completed online survey you will
not be able to withdraw your data as it is anonymous and your data will not be able to be identified. Your
decision to participate or not participate will in no way impact upon your current or future relationship with
QUT. Participation will involve completing an anonymous online survey. This online survey will take 10-12
minutes of your time. Questions will include: The firms is committed to servicing international customers- Rank
1-7: strongly disagree to strongly agree. If you agree to participate you will have to complete all of the
questions, some of which you may be uncomfortable answering. However, the responses you provide are
completely anonymous in the survey.
Please also not that if you need to seek further information in regards to the questions presented, please do
so. For example, you may need to seek further information from your chief financial officer in regards to the
financial performance questions.
EXPECTED BENEFITS
Your participation in this project will be aiding the academic community in developing a better
understanding of how managers recognise and take advantage of international opportunities. The results of
this PhD study may be beneficial for firms in identifying the resources and capabilities which lead to
improved international market performance. A summary of the results will also be made available (upon
request).
285
RISKS
There are no risks beyond normal day-to-day living associated with your participation in this survey. Further,
the research team does not believe that there are any risks for you if you choose to participate in this research. It
should be noted that if you do agree to participate you can withdraw from the project without comment or
penalty prior to submitting your fully completed survey. Any information already obtained from you will be
deleted. However, once you agree to submit your completed online survey you will not be able to withdraw your
data as it is anonymous and your data will not be able to be identified.
PRIVACY & CONFIDENTIALITY
All comments and responses are anonymous and will be treated confidentially. The names of individual persons
are not required in any of the responses. Any data collected as part of this project will be stored securely as per
QUT’s Management of research data policy. Please note that data collected in this project may be used as
comparative data in future projects.
CONSENT TO PARTICIPATE
Submitting the completed online survey is accepted as an indication of your consent to participate in this
project.
QUESTIONS / FURTHER INFORMATION ABOUT THE PROJECT
If have any questions or require any further information, such as s summary of the research results please
contact: Charmaine Glavas – PhD Candidate (Principal Researcher) AMPR: QUT Business School (07)
3138 8074 or Email charmaine.glavas@qut.edu.au
CONCERNS / COMPLAINTS REGARDING THE CONDUCT OF THE PROJECT
QUT is committed to research integrity and the ethical conduct of research projects. However, if you do
have any concerns or complaints about the ethical conduct of the project you may contact the QUT
Research Ethics Unit on [+61 7] 3138 5123 or Email ethicscontact@qut.edu.au. The QUT Research Ethics
Unit is not connected with the research project and can facilitate a resolution to your concern in an impartial
manner.
ACCURACY AND HONESTY IN RESPONSES
Please not that accuracy and honesty in their answers will assist in building a better understanding of how
firms are using their resource and capability base to achieve successful international market performance in
Internet-enable environments.
Thank you for helping with this research project. Please keep this sheet for your information.
‘The focus of this survey is on how your firm uses resources and Internet capabilities to achieve
international market successes. Your accuracy and honesty in answering these questions for the
development of theory is greatly appreciated’
286
Pre-survey screening questions
The following questions concern your business.
Please indicate (by selecting the appropriate box), either YES or NO
Q1. Do you own a business?
(a) Yes
(b) No
Q2. Is the firm Australian owned?
(a) Yes
(b) No
Q3. Are you Australian?
(a) Yes
(b) No
Q4. Are you the founder of the business?
(a) Yes
(b) No
Q5. How many employees does your business have?
1- 5
6- 20
21- 200
Above 200
Part A: International entrepreneurial orientation
The following questions concern your international entrepreneurial orientation within the firm. Please
indicate (by selecting the appropriate box) the extent of agreement or disagreement.
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree – (7) strongly disagree
Q6. The firm tends to see the world as the firm’s marketplace?
Q7. The culture at our firm is to actively explore new business opportunities internationally?
Q8. The firm continuously communicates its mission to succeed in international markets?
Q9. The firm develops resources (such as financial and human) for achieving our goals in international
markets?
Q10. The firm is experienced in international business?
Q11. Over the past 5 years, our firm has marketed many products in international markets?
Q12. In international markets, the firm has a tendency to take on high-risk projects?
Q13. The firm is willing to go to great lengths to make our products succeed in international markets?
Q14. The drive of managers in the firm is important in our decision to enter international markets?
287
Part B: Technology-related international vision
The following questions concern your international vision within the firm. Please indicate (by selecting the
appropriate box) the extent of agreement or disagreement.
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
Q15. The firm is committed to servicing international customers on the Internet?
Q16. The firm commits sufficient human (e.g. staff) and financial resources (e.g. capital) to technology
for international market (s)?
Q17. The firms emphasises the importance of technology for international growth.
Q18. The firm views managerial technology experience as important for entering international market
(s)?
Q19. The firm views international growth through the Internet as achievable?
Part C: International business experience
The following questions concern your international business experience. Please indicate (by selecting the
appropriate box).
Q20. Please indicate the number of years experience related to export work you have as an owner/
founder?
Scale anchor:
(1) None
(2) 1-2
(3) 2-3
(4) 4-5
(5) 5-6
(6) 7-8
(7) 8 years or more
Q21. What is the number of previous entrepreneurial ventures where you have played a similar
management role?
Scale anchor:
(1) None
(2) 1-2
(3) 2-3
(4) 4-5
(5) 5-6
(6) 6-7
(7) 8 ventures or more
Q22. What is your highest level of education?
Scale anchor:
(1) No formal education
(2) High school
(3) Certificate level
(4) TAFE/ technical college equivalent
288
(5) Undergraduate
(6) Postgraduate - including Masters
(7) Doctoral Degree
Part D: Internet, international marketing capability
The following questions concern your firms Internet use. Please indicate (by selecting the appropriate box)
the extent of agreement or disagreement.
Scale anchor: (1) limited use - (7) extensive use
Q23. Please indicate your firms Internet usage.
(a) Email
(b) Official company website
(c) Advertising and marketing
(d) Online sales
(e) After sales service
(f) Market research
(g) Identify competitors
(h) In-house software development
Q24. Please indicate how much time is devoted in your firm to the strategic use of the Internet through
the following categories.
All categories must add up to 100%. Please indicate the percentage in the space provided:
(a) Email
(b) Official company website
(c) Advertising and marketing
(d) Online sales
(e) After sales service
(f) Market research
(g) Identify competitors
(h) In-house software development
The following questions concern your firms Internet use. Please indicate (by selecting the appropriate box)
the extent of agreement or disagreement.
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
Q25. Ability to leverage technology is important in my firm?
Q26. Renewal of technology is important in my firm?
Q27. Investment in technology has lead to greater international sales?
Q28. The firm has strong IT operations capabilities?
Q29. The firm has the technological infrastructure and competencies to engage in e-commerce
initiatives?
Part E: International virtual network capability
The following questions concern the virtual business networks within the firm. Please indicate (by selecting
the appropriate box) the extent of agreement or disagreement.
289
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
Q30. The firm uses the Internet to maintain international customer relationships?
Q31. The firm uses the Internet to strengthen existing international relationships?
Q32. The firm uses the Internet to develop longer lasting international relationships?
Q33. The firm uses the Internet to acquire new international customers?
Q34. The firm uses the Internet to enter new international country market (s)?
Q35. The firm uses the Internet to enhance our firm’s international performance?
Part F: International entrepreneurial opportunity recognition
The following questions concern your opportunity recognition within Internet international markets. Please
indicate (by selecting the appropriate box) the extent of agreement or disagreement.
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
Q36. The firm actively seeks out new international market opportunities?
Q37. When we see a new international market opportunity we invest resources to exploit the new
international opportunity?
Q38. We pursue international opportunities regardless of the resources the firm may or may not have?
Q39. The firm has many formal or informal processes that evaluate the effectiveness of its activities in
international markets?
Q40. We believe that recognising international opportunities and exploiting these opportunities adds
value to the firm?
Part G: International market performance
The following questions concern your firm’s international market performance. Please indicate (by
selecting the appropriate box) the extent of a decrease or increase since internationalisation.
Our performance outcomes since we have become international have significantly decreased or
significantly increased in:
Scale anchor: (1) significantly increased - (7) significantly decreased
Q41. International market share?
Q42. International growth?
Q43. International sales growth vs. competitors?
Q44. International profitability?
Q45. Overall international performance?
The following question concerns your firm’s international market performance. Please indicate (by
selecting the appropriate box) the extent of satisfaction.
Scale anchor: (1) dissatisfied - (7) satisfied
Q46. How satisfied have you been with your international activities during the last five years?
Q47. The following questions concern your firm’s product characteristics. Please indicate by selecting
the appropriate box. In my firm the company's product/s...
Scale anchor: (1) strongly agree - (7) strongly disagree
(a) is/ are classified as sophisticated?
290
(b) is/ are complex in nature
(c) need(s) specialised know how to market
(d) take(s) a long time to learn about
(e) has/ have a large proportion that is technological in nature
(f) need(s) a high level of specialised service
Part H: Demographic information and general business background
Q48. What is your age?
Scale anchor:
a) Under 20 years old
b) 20-24
c) 25-29
d) 30-34
e) 35-39
f) 40-44
g) 45-49
h) 50-54
i) 55-59
j) 60-64
k) 65-69
l) 70 years old or over
Q49. What is you gender?
Scale anchor:
a) Male
b) Female
Q50. My business sells
Scale anchor:
a) Products
b) Services
Q51. The industry our firm operates in is?
Scale anchor:
a) Consumer goods
b) Information communication technology
c) Manufacturing
d) Professional business services
e) Tourism
Q52. What percentage of the firm’s total gross sales generated from international customers over the last
12 months?
Please indicate gross sales in percentage
291
Q53. What is the firm’s total revenue of sales over the last 12 months?
Scale anchor:
a) $20,000 or below
b) $20,001- $50,000
c) $50,001- $100,00
d) $100,001- $150,000
e) $150,001- $200,000
f) $200,001- $300,000
g) $300,001- $400,000
h) $400,001- $500,000
i) $500,001- $1 million
j) above $1 million- $2 million
k) above $2 million- $3 million
l) above $3 million- $4 million
m) above $4 million- $5 million
n) above $5 million- 10 million
o) above $10 million- $15 million
p) above $15 million- $20 million
q) above $20 million- $25 million
r) above $25 million- $30 million
s) above $30 million- $35 million
t) above $35 million- $40 million
u) above $40 million- $45 million
v) above $45 million- $50 million
w) above $50 million
Questions Q54 through to Q60 are open-ended ordinal questions
Q54. What year was your business established?
Q55. What is the number of countries you have customers in?
Q56. In what year did you gain your first international market?
Q57. What was the first international country your firm exported to?
Q58. What are your top five international countries you export to?
Q59. What is your firm’s postcode?
Q60. Do you have any further questions or information you would like to provide the research team?
Finally, thank you for your time
Your input will be valuable for this PhD research.
292
Appendix 3. Expert reviews for the pre-testing of the questionnaire
Academic institution Expertise Outcome
Provided feedback on the content and knowledge behind the questionnaire
Dr Shane Mathews
Queensland University of Technology
Expert in SEM and has published research
in International Business and Marketing
journals.
Feedback for
minor
adjustments to
terminology
Professor Per Davidsson
Queensland University of Technology
Director, Australian Centre for
Entrepreneurship Research, highly
regarded entrepreneurship scholar.
Measurement
refinement
Professor Rebekah Russell- Bennett
Queensland University of Technology
Familiar with entrepreneurship studies and
SEM.
Questionnaire
design and
content
Provided feedback on structure and design of the questionnaire
Professor Boris Kabanoff
Queensland University of Technology
Prior roles include; Director of research
and development, faculty of business and
Australian Centre for Business Research at
QUT.
Questionnaire
refinement and
terminology
Associate Professor Len Coote
University of Queensland
Head of the Marketing cluster of
academics within the UQ Business School.
Serves a vice-chair for ACSPRI and runs
the LISERAL, SEM course at ACSPRI.
Model validity
queries
Dr Gary Mortimer
Queensland University of Technology
Familiar with both International Business
and marketing research, including survey
development.
Questionnaire
refinement
293
Appendix 4. Recruitment Email for qualitative interviews
APPLICATION FOR REVIEW OF LOW RISK RESEARCH INVOLVING HUMAN
PARTICIPANTS
RECRUITMENT EMAIL Subject Title: Participate in a PhD research study looking into how firms can improve their international market
performance!
Dear (INSERT NAME)
My name is Charmaine Glavas from the School of Advertising, Marketing, and Public Relations at
Queensland University of Technology. I am currently completing my PhD on firm resource capabilities in
technology mediated environments, and am looking for respondents to help me complete my PhD research.
I am looking for people like yourself to answer some questions about the different types of resources and
capabilities your firm uses to leverage your international market performance. This is important given that
the firm’s success in international markets relies heavily on the firm’s ability to recognise and deploy
resource capabilities.
This would involve completing a questionnaire (10-15 minutes of your time). I have attached a document
providing more information about this PhD research. If you would like to be part of this research, please
click on the link below to fill in the online questionnaire. Should you require more information, please do
not hesitate to contact me to request further information. Please note that this study has been approved by
the QUT Human Research Ethics Committee. The ethics approval number is: 1200000678.
Link to the online questionnaire: http://survey.qut.edu.au/f/175704/116d/
Your contribution to this PhD research will be greatly appreciated. Thank you for your consideration of this
request.
Warm regards,
Charmaine Glavas
PhD Candidate
Advertising, Marketing and Public Relations
QUT Business School
Queensland University of Technology
2 George Street, Brisbane QLD 4001
Phone: 3138 8074
E- mail: charmaine.glavas@qut.edu.au
294
Appendix 5. Profile of respondent firm’s international market behaviour
*Profile Parameters Number of
respondents
Percentage (%)
Firms year of
establishment
1951- 1980
1981- 2000
2001- 2006
2007- 2012
Missing
TOTAL
1
158
36
13
0
n=208
0.48%
75.96%
17.31%
6.25%
0
100%
Annual turnover
$20,000 or below
$20,001- $50,000
$50,001- $100,000
$100,001- $ 150,000
$150,001- $200,000
$200,001- $300,000
$300,001- $400,000
$400,001- $500,000
$500,001- 1 m
Above $1 m - $2 m
Above $2 m - $3 m
Above $3 m - $4 m
Above $4 m - $5 m
Above $5 m - $10 m
Above $10 m - $15 m
Above $20 m - $25 m
Above $25 m - $30 m
Above 30 m - $35 m
Above $35 m - $40 m
Above $50 m
Missing
TOTAL
4
6
13
7
7
15
13
15
25
23
28
17
8
10
10
1
3
1
1
1
0
n=208
1.92%
2.88%
6.25%
3.37%
3.37%
7.21%
6.25%
7.21%
12.02%
11.06%
13.46%
8.17%
3.85%
4.81%
4.81%
0.48%
1.44%
0.48%
0.48%
0.48%
0
100%
International percentage
of annual revenue
(%)
< 5%
1- 5 %
6- 15%
16-49%
50- 100%
Missing
TOTAL
1
9
23
102
73
0
n=208
0.48%
4.33%
11.06%
49.04%
35.10%
0
100%
Number of international
export countries
1 market
2 market
3 countries
4 countries
5 countries
6 countries
7 countries
8 countries
9 countries
10 countries
More than 10 countries
Missing
TOTAL
4
11
29
33
25
26
8
8
1
4
59
0
n=208
1.92%
5.29%
13.94%
15.87%
12.02%
12.50%
3.85%
3.85%
0.48%
1.92%
28.37%
0
100%
First international country
Export countries beyond
the firm’s top ten main
international markets are
not included
United Kingdom
United States
New Zealand
United Arab Emirates
Singapore
China
Japan
Taiwan
Indonesia
Thailand
Other
Missing
TOTAL
41
19
32
1
14
32
18
9
2
3
37
0
n=208
19.71%
9.13%
15.38%
0.48%
6.73%
15.38%
8.65%
4.33%
0.96%
1.44%
17.79%
-
100%
Main international export
countries
United Kingdom
United States
New Zealand
United Arab Emirates
Singapore
China
Japan
Taiwan
Indonesia
Thailand
Missing
TOTAL
122
103
104
81
77
76
51
35
26
22
0
697/ from 208
17.50%
14.78%
14.92%
11.62%
11.05%
10.90%
7.32%
5.02%
3.73%
3.16%
0
-
Note. n = 208 firms (total firms surveyed) and m = Million
295
Appendix 6. Telephone script for qualitative interviews
TELEPHONE SCRIPT
Hello (INSERT NAME)
My name is Charmaine Glavas from the School of Advertising, Marketing, and Public Relations at
Queensland University of Technology.
I am currently completing my PhD on firm resource capabilities in Internet environments, and am looking
for respondents to help me complete my PhD research.
I am looking for people like you to answer some questions about the different types of resources and
capabilities your firm uses to achieve successful international market performance. This would involve
completing a questionnaire (10-15 minutes of your time). Would you be interested in completing a 10-15
minute questionnaire to assist me in my PhD research? If so, can I please Email you the link to the online
survey? I will also send you further information about this PhD research including an ethics consent form
and information flyer.
Please be aware that answers to all the questions are required. You can withdraw anytime during the
questionnaire, EXCEPT after the questionnaire has been submitted. You will no longer be able to withdraw
after this time.
Also, so you are aware, the research has been approved by the QUT Human Research Ethics Committee.
The ethics approval number is 1200000678.
Thank you very much for your time. It is greatly appreciated.
Have a lovely day.
296
Appendix 7. Descriptive statistics- Skewness and Kurtosis
Descriptive Statistics
N Minimum Maximum Mean Std. Deviation Skewness Kurtosis
Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Statistic Std. Error Statistic Std. Error
IEOQ6 208 1 7 1.83 1.227 1.903 .169 3.859 .336
IEOQ7 208 1 7 2.08 1.111 1.693 .169 3.789 .336
IEOQ8 208 1 7 2.40 1.337 1.186 .169 1.393 .336
IEOQ9 208 1 7 2.33 1.341 1.172 .169 1.133 .336
IEOQ10 208 1 7 2.24 1.340 1.509 .169 2.537 .336
IEOQ11 208 1 7 2.21 1.172 1.265 .169 2.328 .336
IEOQ12 208 1 7 3.51 1.958 .287 .169 -1.129 .336
IEOQ13 208 1 7 2.22 1.368 1.444 .169 2.179 .336
IEOQ14 208 1 7 1.89 1.294 1.870 .169 3.700 .336
TRIVQ15 208 1 7 1.86 1.346 1.866 .169 3.236 .336
TRIVQ16 208 1 7 2.18 1.378 1.222 .169 .860 .336
TRIVQ17 208 1 7 2.04 1.177 1.514 .169 2.477 .336
TRIVQ18 208 1 6 2.07 1.133 1.204 .169 1.292 .336
TRIVQ19 208 1 7 2.12 1.405 1.284 .169 1.084 .336
IIMCQ25 208 1 7 1.80 1.254 1.887 .169 3.750 .336
IIMC26 208 1 7 1.91 1.119 1.706 .169 3.978 .336
IIMC27 208 1 7 2.13 1.404 1.745 .169 3.096 .336
IIMC28 208 1 7 2.42 1.583 1.155 .169 .592 .336
IIMC29 208 1 7 2.48 1.668 1.125 .169 .402 .336
IVNCQ30 208 1 7 1.74 1.270 2.370 .169 6.007 .336
IVNC31 208 1 7 1.91 1.172 2.095 .169 5.512 .336
IVNCQ32 208 1 7 2.07 1.167 1.866 .169 4.589 .336
IVNCQ35 208 1 7 2.35 1.299 1.111 .169 1.309 .336
IEORQ36 208 1 7 1.81 1.344 1.867 .169 2.911 .336
IEORQ37 208 1 7 2.12 1.447 1.478 .169 1.972 .336
IEORQ38 208 1 7 2.54 1.943 1.112 .169 -.051 .336
IEORQ39 208 1 7 2.25 1.517 1.354 .169 1.316 .336
IEORQ40 208 1 7 1.85 1.088 1.787 .169 4.241 .336
IMPQ41 208 1 7 2.45 1.322 1.062 .169 1.168 .336
IMPQ42 208 1 7 2.52 1.270 1.092 .169 1.378 .336
IMPQ43 208 1 7 3.18 1.265 .230 .169 -.085 .336
IMPQ44 208 1 7 2.78 1.322 .845 .169 .621 .336
IMPQ45 208 1 7 2.67 1.301 .823 .169 .766 .336
IMPQ46 208 1 7 4.70 1.493 -.252 .169 -.591 .336
Valid N (listwise) 208
297
Appendix 8. Mahalanobis Distance (D2) test
Variable Case no. Mahalanobis Distance (D
2)
International entrepreneurial orientation 1
32
91
132
140
152
185
36.16
30.40
32.70
31.26
27.28
27.33
28.16
Technology-related international vision 1
123
126
129
140
40.80
47.05
25.60
22.59
23.31
Internet, international marketing
capabilities
27
121
147
35.78
50.26
32.15
International virtual network capabilities
128
129
147
34.15
24.98
21.45
International entrepreneurial opportunity
recognition
132
136
156
33.49
37.00
29.67
International market performance 53
122
126
137
20.38
18.79
39.92
28.96
Appendix 9. Assessment of the reliability and validity of the structural model -
complete
CR AVE MSV ASV IVNC IEO TRIV IMP IEOR IIMC
IVNC 0.926 0.760 0.420 0.317 0.872
IEO 0.915 0.548 0.672 0.435 0.515 0.740
TRIV 0.856 0.547 0.651 0.526 0.648 0.696 0.739
IMP 0.932 0.735 0.560 0.424 0.448 0.676 0.682 0.857
IEOR 0.921 0.702 0.672 0.530 0.552 0.820 0.780 0.748 0.838
IIMC 0.914 0.682 0.651 0.457 0.628 0.544 0.807 0.661 0.710 0.826
Note. INCV = international virtual networking capabilities, IEO = international entrepreneurial
orientation, TRIV = technology-related international vision, IMP = international market performance,
IEOR = international entrepreneurial opportunity recognition, IIMC = Internet, international marketing
capabilities.
298
Appendix 10. Standardised indirect effects for mediation
Standardized Indirect Effects - Lower Bounds (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .000 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .177 .000 .000 .000
IIMC .301 .000 .000 .000
IVNC .227 .051 .000 .000
IMP .348 .293 .000 .000
Standardized Indirect Effects - Upper Bounds (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .000 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .421 .000 .000 .000
IIMC .554 .000 .000 .000
IVNC .479 .413 .000 .000
IMP .556 .548 .000 .000
Standardized Indirect Effects - Two Tailed Significance (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model) (p-
value)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV ... ... ... ...
IEOR .001 ... ... ...
IIMC .001 ... ... ...
IVNC .001 .010 ... ...
IMP .001 .002 ... ...
Standardized Indirect Effects (Group number 1 - Default model) (β)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .000 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .284 .000 .000 .000
IIMC .430 .000 .000 .000
IVNC .352 .235 .000 .000
IMP .463 .432 .000 .000
299
Appendix 11. Standardised direct effects for mediation
Standardized Direct Effects - Lower Bounds (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .455 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .222 .310 .000 .000
IIMC .000 .583 .000 .000
IVNC .000 .076 .000 .061
IMP .000 .000 .308 .081
Standardized Direct Effects - Upper Bounds (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .723 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .564 .617 .000 .000
IIMC .000 .802 .000 .000
IVNC .000 .603 .000 .587
IMP .000 .000 .657 .486
Standardized Direct Effects - Two Tailed Significance (BC) (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .001 ... ... ...
IEOR .001 .002 ... ...
IIMC ... .001 ... ...
IVNC ... .012 ... .011
IMP ... ... .001 .002
Standardized Direct Effects (Group number 1 - Default model) (β)
IEO TRIV IEOR IIMC
TRIV .608 .000 .000 .000
IEOR .402 .466 .000 .000
IIMC .000 .707 .000 .000
IVNC .000 .343 .000 .332
IMP .000 .000 .499 .282
300
Appendix 12. Comparison of standardised regression weights: Correlated Marker
Technique
Standardised Regression Weights: (with marker variable)
Standardised Regression Weights: (without marker variable)
Estimate
Estimate
Delta
TRIVQ16 <--- TRIV 0.77
TRIVQ16 <--- TRIV 0.863
0.093
TRIVQ15 <--- TRIV 0.663
TRIVQ15 <--- TRIV 0.803
0.14
IMPQ45 <--- IMP 0.793
IMPQ45 <--- IMP 0.864
0.071
IMPQ44 <--- IMP 0.751
IMPQ44 <--- IMP 0.847
0.096
IMPQ43 <--- IMP 0.692
IMPQ43 <--- IMP 0.71
0.018
IMPQ42 <--- IMP 0.838
IMPQ42 <--- IMP 0.919
0.081
IMPQ41 <--- IMP 0.865
IMPQ41 <--- IMP 0.93
0.065
IEORQ40 <--- IEOR 0.644
IEORQ40 <--- IEOR 0.725
0.081
IEORQ39 <--- IEOR 0.737
IEORQ39 <--- IEOR 0.85
0.113
IEORQ38 <--- IEOR 0.651
IEORQ38 <--- IEOR 0.819
0.168
IEORQ37 <--- IEOR 0.811
IEORQ37 <--- IEOR 0.904
0.093
IEORQ36 <--- IEOR 0.822
IEORQ36 <--- IEOR 0.881
0.059
IVNCQ32 <--- IVNC 0.877
IVNCQ32 <--- IVNC 0.88
0.003
IVNCQ31 <--- IVNC 0.934
IVNCQ31 <--- IVNC 0.956
0.022
IVNCQ30 <--- IVNC 0.893
IVNCQ30 <--- IVNC 0.937
0.044
IIMCQ28 <--- IIMC 0.693
IIMCQ28 <--- IIMC 0.783
0.09
IIMCQ27 <--- IIMC 0.736
IIMCQ27 <--- IIMC 0.827
0.091
IIMCQ26 <--- IIMC 0.793
IIMCQ26 <--- IIMC 0.843
0.05
IIMCQ25 <--- IIMC 0.839
IIMCQ25 <--- IIMC 0.911
0.072
IEOQ11 <--- IEO 0.624
IEOQ11 <--- IEO 0.638
0.014
IEOQ9 <--- IEO 0.888
IEOQ9 <--- IEO 0.907
0.019
IEOQ7 <--- IEO 0.844
IEOQ7 <--- IEO 0.855
0.011
IEOQ8 <--- IEO 0.84
IEOQ8 <--- IEO 0.859
0.019
TRIVQ17 <--- TRIV 0.607
TRIVQ17 <--- TRIV 0.696
0.089
PRODQ47a <--- Marker_PC 0.484
PRODQ47b <--- Marker_PC -0.638
PRODQ47c <--- Marker_PC -0.77
PRODQ47d <--- Marker_PC -0.8
PRODQ47e <--- Marker_PC -0.73
PRODQ47f <--- Marker_PC -0.786
IEOQ11 <--- Marker_PC 0.155
IEOQ9 <--- Marker_PC 0.188
IEOQ8 <--- Marker_PC 0.184
IEOQ7 <--- Marker_PC 0.153
TRIVQ17 <--- Marker_PC 0.382
TRIVQ16 <--- Marker_PC 0.409
TRIVQ15 <--- Marker_PC 0.492
IIMCQ28 <--- Marker_PC 0.39
301
Standardised Regression Weights: (with marker variable)
continued
Estimate
IIMCQ27 <--- Marker_PC 0.397
IIMCQ26 <--- Marker_PC 0.315
IIMCQ25 <--- Marker_PC 0.372
IVNCQ32 <--- Marker_PC 0.127
IVNCQ31 <--- Marker_PC 0.205
IVNCQ30 <--- Marker_PC 0.299
IEORQ40 <--- Marker_PC 0.366
IEORQ39 <--- Marker_PC 0.44
IEORQ38 <--- Marker_PC 0.55
IEORQ37 <--- Marker_PC 0.412
IEORQ36 <--- Marker_PC 0.35
IMPQ45 <--- Marker_PC 0.36
IMPQ44 <--- Marker_PC 0.417
IMPQ43 <--- Marker_PC 0.2
IMPQ42 <--- Marker_PC 0.389
IMPQ41 <--- Marker_PC 0.354
302
Appendix 13. Implied (for all variables) Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO
TR
IV
IIM
C
IEO
R
IVN
C
IMP
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IEO
0.55
9
TRIV
0.41
4
0.65
8
IIMC
0.49
7 0.79
1.51
2
IEOR
0.44
6
0.53
3 0.64
0.62
1
IVNC
0.33
7
0.53
6
0.77
9
0.43
4 1.05
IMP
0.48
5
0.62
5 0.88
0.66
3 0.54 1.25
IVNCQ30 0.39
0.62
1
0.90
3
0.50
3
1.21
6
0.62
6
1.60
6
IVNCQ31
0.36
7
0.58
4 0.85
0.47
3
1.14
5
0.58
9
1.32
7
1.36
8
IVNCQ32
0.33
7
0.53
6
0.77
9
0.43
4 1.05 0.54
1.21
6
1.14
5
1.35
5
IIMCQ25
0.46
1
0.73
4
1.40
5
0.59
5
0.72
4
0.81
8
0.83
9 0.79
0.72
4
1.56
5
IIMCQ26 0.38
0.60
5
1.15
7 0.49
0.59
6
0.67
4
0.69
1 0.65
0.59
6
1.07
5
1.24
6
IIMCQ27
0.46
9
0.74
6
1.42
7
0.60
4
0.73
6
0.83
1
0.85
2
0.80
2
0.73
6
1.32
6
1.09
2
1.96
3
IIMCQ28
0.49
7 0.79
1.51
2 0.64
0.77
9 0.88
0.90
3 0.85
0.77
9
1.40
5
1.15
7
1.42
7
2.49
3
IEORQ36
0.67
1
0.80
1
0.96
2
0.93
3
0.65
2
0.99
6
0.75
6
0.71
1
0.65
2
0.89
4
0.73
6
0.90
8
0.96
2
1.79
7
IEORQ37
0.73
7
0.88
1
1.05
7
1.02
6
0.71
7
1.09
5
0.83
1
0.78
2
0.71
7
0.98
2
0.80
9
0.99
8
1.05
7
1.54
1
2.08
3
IEORQ38
0.89
5
1.06
9
1.28
3
1.24
6 0.87
1.32
9
1.00
8
0.94
9 0.87
1.19
3
0.98
2
1.21
2
1.28
3
1.87
1
2.05
7
3.75
8
IEORQ39
0.72
5
0.86
7 1.04 1.01
0.70
5
1.07
7
0.81
7
0.76
9
0.70
5
0.96
7
0.79
6
0.98
2 1.04
1.51
7
1.66
7
2.02
4
2.29
1
IEORQ40
0.44
6
0.53
3 0.64
0.62
1
0.43
4
0.66
3
0.50
3
0.47
3
0.43
4
0.59
5 0.49
0.60
4 0.64
0.93
3
1.02
6
1.24
6 1.01
1.17
8
IMPQ41
0.53
1
0.68
4
0.96
4
0.72
6
0.59
1
1.36
8
0.68
5
0.64
5
0.59
1
0.89
6
0.73
7 0.91
0.96
4 1.09
1.19
9
1.45
5
1.17
9
0.72
6
1.73
1
IMPQ42
0.50
4 0.65
0.91
6 0.69
0.56
2 1.3
0.65
1
0.61
3
0.56
2
0.85
1
0.70
1
0.86
5
0.91
6
1.03
6
1.13
9
1.38
3
1.12
1 0.69
1.42
3
1.59
9
IMPQ43
0.38
7
0.49
9
0.70
3 0.53
0.43
1
0.99
8 0.5
0.47
1
0.43
1
0.65
4
0.53
8
0.66
4
0.70
3
0.79
6
0.87
5
1.06
2
0.86
1 0.53
1.09
3
1.03
8
1.58
8
IMPQ44
0.48
3
0.62
3
0.87
8
0.66
1
0.53
9
1.24
6
0.62
4
0.58
7
0.53
9
0.81
6
0.67
2
0.82
9
0.87
8
0.99
3
1.09
2
1.32
6
1.07
4
0.66
1
1.36
4
1.29
6
0.99
5
1.73
4
IMPQ45
0.48
5
0.62
5 0.88
0.66
3 0.54 1.25
0.62
6
0.58
9 0.54
0.81
8
0.67
4
0.83
1 0.88
0.99
6
1.09
5
1.32
9
1.07
7
0.66
3
1.36
8 1.3
0.99
8
1.24
6
1.67
7
TRIVQ15
0.54
8
0.87
2
1.04
7
0.70
7 0.71
0.82
8
0.82
3
0.77
4 0.71
0.97
3
0.80
1
0.98
8
1.04
7
1.06
2
1.16
7
1.41
7
1.14
9
0.70
7
0.90
7
0.86
1
0.66
2
0.82
6
0.82
8
1.80
3
TRIVQ16
0.60
4
0.96
2
1.15
4
0.77
9
0.78
3
0.91
3
0.90
7
0.85
3
0.78
3
1.07
2
0.88
3
1.08
9
1.15
4 1.17
1.28
6
1.56
2
1.26
6
0.77
9
0.99
9
0.94
9
0.72
9 0.91
0.91
3
1.27
4 1.89
TRIVQ17
0.41
4
0.65
8 0.79
0.53
3
0.53
6
0.62
5
0.62
1
0.58
4
0.53
6
0.73
4
0.60
5
0.74
6 0.79
0.80
1
0.88
1
1.06
9
0.86
7
0.53
3
0.68
4 0.65
0.49
9
0.62
3
0.62
5
0.87
2
0.96
2
1.37
8
IEOQ7
0.70
9
0.52
5
0.62
9
0.56
6
0.42
7
0.61
5
0.49
5
0.46
6
0.42
7
0.58
5
0.48
2
0.59
4
0.62
9 0.85
0.93
4
1.13
5
0.91
9
0.56
6
0.67
3
0.63
9
0.49
1
0.61
3
0.61
5
0.69
5
0.76
6
0.52
5
1.22
9
IEOQ8
0.85
5
0.63
3
0.75
9
0.68
2
0.51
5
0.74
1
0.59
6
0.56
1
0.51
5
0.70
5
0.58
1
0.71
7
0.75
9
1.02
5
1.12
7
1.36
8
1.10
9
0.68
2
0.81
1
0.77
1
0.59
2
0.73
9
0.74
1
0.83
8
0.92
4
0.63
3
1.08
4
1.77
8
IEOQ9
0.90
8
0.67
2
0.80
6
0.72
5
0.54
7
0.78
7
0.63
3
0.59
6
0.54
7
0.74
9
0.61
7
0.76
1
0.80
6
1.08
9
1.19
7
1.45
3
1.17
8
0.72
5
0.86
2
0.81
9
0.62
9
0.78
5
0.78
7 0.89
0.98
1
0.67
2
1.15
1
1.38
8
1.78
9
IEOQ11
0.55
9
0.41
4
0.49
7
0.44
6
0.33
7
0.48
5 0.39
0.36
7
0.33
7
0.46
1 0.38
0.46
9
0.49
7
0.67
1
0.73
7
0.89
5
0.72
5
0.44
6
0.53
1
0.50
4
0.38
7
0.48
3
0.48
5
0.54
8
0.60
4
0.41
4
0.70
9
0.85
5
0.90
8
1.36
6
303
Appendix 14. Implied (for all variables) Correlations (Group number 1 - Default model)
IEO
TR
IV
IIM
C
IEO
R
IVN
C
IMP
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IEO 1
TRIV
0.6
82 1
IIMC
0.5
4
0.7
92 1
IEOR
0.7
57
0.8
34
0.6
6 1
IVNC
0.4
39
0.6
44
0.6
18
0.5
37 1
IMP
0.5
8
0.6
89
0.6
41
0.7
52
0.4
72 1
IVNCQ30
0.4
12
0.6
04
0.5
79
0.5
04
0.9
37
0.4
42 1
IVNCQ31
0.4
2
0.6
16
0.5
91
0.5
14
0.9
56
0.4
51
0.8
95 1
IVNCQ32
0.3
87
0.5
67
0.5
44
0.4
73
0.8
8
0.4
15
0.8
25
0.8
41 1
IIMCQ25
0.4
93
0.7
23
0.9
13
0.6
03
0.5
65
0.5
85
0.5
29
0.5
4
0.4
97 1
IIMCQ26
0.4
55
0.6
67
0.8
43
0.5
56
0.5
21
0.5
4
0.4
88
0.4
98
0.4
59
0.7
7 1
IIMCQ27
0.4
47
0.6
56
0.8
29
0.5
47
0.5
12
0.5
31
0.4
8
0.4
9
0.4
51
0.7
57
0.6
98 1
IIMCQ28
0.4
21
0.6
17
0.7
79
0.5
14
0.4
81
0.4
99
0.4
51
0.4
6
0.4
24
0.7
11
0.6
56
0.6
45 1
IEORQ36
0.6
69
0.7
37
0.5
84
0.8
83
0.4
75
0.6
65
0.4
45
0.4
54
0.4
18
0.5
33
0.4
92
0.4
83
0.4
54 1
IEORQ37
0.6
83
0.7
52
0.5
96
0.9
02
0.4
85
0.6
79
0.4
54
0.4
63
0.4
27
0.5
44
0.5
02
0.4
94
0.4
64
0.7
97 1
IEORQ38
0.6
17
0.6
8
0.5
38
0.8
15
0.4
38
0.6
13
0.4
1
0.4
19
0.3
86
0.4
92
0.4
54
0.4
46
0.4
19
0.7
2
0.7
35 1
IEORQ39
0.6
41
0.7
06
0.5
59
0.8
46
0.4
55
0.6
37
0.4
26
0.4
35 0.4
0.5
1
0.4
71
0.4
63
0.4
35
0.7
48
0.7
63
0.6
9 1
IEORQ40
0.5
5
0.6
06
0.4
8
0.7
26
0.3
9
0.5
46
0.3
66
0.3
73
0.3
44
0.4
38
0.4
04
0.3
97
0.3
73
0.6
42
0.6
55
0.5
92
0.6
15 1
IMPQ41
0.5
39
0.6
41
0.5
96 0.7
0.4
39
0.9
3
0.4
11
0.4
19
0.3
86
0.5
44
0.5
02
0.4
94
0.4
64
0.6
18
0.6
31
0.5
71
0.5
92
0.5
08 1
IMPQ42
0.5
33
0.6
33
0.5
89
0.6
92
0.4
34
0.9
19
0.4
06
0.4
14
0.3
82
0.5
38
0.4
96
0.4
88
0.4
59
0.6
11
0.6
24
0.5
64
0.5
85
0.5
02
0.8
55 1
IMPQ43
0.4
11
0.4
88
0.4
54
0.5
33
0.3
34
0.7
09
0.3
13
0.3
19
0.2
94
0.4
15
0.3
83
0.3
76
0.3
53
0.4
71
0.4
81
0.4
35
0.4
51
0.3
87
0.6
59
0.6
52 1
IMPQ44
0.4
91
0.5
83
0.5
42
0.6
37
0.3
99
0.8
47
0.3
74
0.3
81
0.3
51
0.4
95
0.4
57
0.4
49
0.4
22
0.5
63
0.5
75
0.5
19
0.5
39
0.4
63
0.7
87
0.7
78 0.6 1
IMPQ45
0.5
01
0.5
95
0.5
53
0.6
49
0.4
07
0.8
63
0.3
81
0.3
89
0.3
58
0.5
05
0.4
66
0.4
58
0.4
31
0.5
74
0.5
86
0.5
29
0.5
5
0.4
72
0.8
03
0.7
94
0.6
12
0.7
31 1
TRIVQ15
0.5
46
0.8
01
0.6
34
0.6
68
0.5
16
0.5
52
0.4
84
0.4
93
0.4
54
0.5
79
0.5
34
0.5
26
0.4
94
0.5
9
0.6
02
0.5
44
0.5
65
0.4
85
0.5
13
0.5
07
0.3
91
0.4
67
0.4
76 1
TRIVQ16
0.5
88
0.8
62
0.6
83
0.7
19
0.5
56
0.5
94
0.5
2
0.5
31
0.4
89
0.6
24
0.5
75
0.5
66
0.5
32
0.6
35
0.6
48
0.5
86
0.6
08
0.5
22
0.5
52
0.5
46
0.4
21
0.5
03
0.5
13
0.6
9 1
TRIVQ17
0.4
71
0.6
91
0.5
47
0.5
76
0.4
45
0.4
76
0.4
17
0.4
26
0.3
92 0.5
0.4
61
0.4
54
0.4
26
0.5
09
0.5
2
0.4
7
0.4
88
0.4
19
0.4
43
0.4
38
0.3
37
0.4
03
0.4
11
0.5
54
0.5
96 1
IEOQ7
0.8
55
0.5
83
0.4
62
0.6
48
0.3
76
0.4
96
0.3
52
0.3
59
0.3
31
0.4
22
0.3
89
0.3
83
0.3
6
0.5
72
0.5
84
0.5
28
0.5
48
0.4
7
0.4
61
0.4
56
0.3
51
0.4
2
0.4
28
0.4
67
0.5
03
0.4
03 1
IEOQ8
0.8
57
0.5
85
0.4
63
0.6
49
0.3
77
0.4
97
0.3
53
0.3
6
0.3
32
0.4
23
0.3
9
0.3
84
0.3
61
0.5
74
0.5
86
0.5
29
0.5
49
0.4
71
0.4
63
0.4
57
0.3
52
0.4
21
0.4
29
0.4
68
0.5
04
0.4
04
0.7
33 1
IEOQ9
0.9
08
0.6
19
0.4
9
0.6
87
0.3
99
0.5
27
0.3
74
0.3
81
0.3
51
0.4
48
0.4
13
0.4
06
0.3
82
0.6
07
0.6
2
0.5
6
0.5
82
0.4
99
0.4
9
0.4
84
0.3
73
0.4
46
0.4
54
0.4
96
0.5
34
0.4
28
0.7
76
0.7
78 1
IEOQ11
0.6
4
0.4
36
0.3
46
0.4
85
0.2
81
0.3
71
0.2
63
0.2
69
0.2
48
0.3
16
0.2
91
0.2
86
0.2
69
0.4
28
0.4
37
0.3
95
0.4
1
0.3
52
0.3
45
0.3
41
0.2
63
0.3
14
0.3
2
0.3
49
0.3
76
0.3
02
0.5
47
0.5
49
0.5
81 1
304
Appendix 15. Implied Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model)
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IVNCQ30 1.606
IVNCQ31 1.327 1.368
IVNCQ32 1.216 1.145 1.355
IIMCQ25 0.839 0.79 0.724 1.565
IIMCQ26 0.691 0.65 0.596 1.075 1.246
IIMCQ27 0.852 0.802 0.736 1.326 1.092 1.963
IIMCQ28 0.903 0.85 0.779 1.405 1.157 1.427 2.493
IEORQ36 0.756 0.711 0.652 0.894 0.736 0.908 0.962 1.797
IEORQ37 0.831 0.782 0.717 0.982 0.809 0.998 1.057 1.541 2.083
IEORQ38 1.008 0.949 0.87 1.193 0.982 1.212 1.283 1.871 2.057 3.758
IEORQ39 0.817 0.769 0.705 0.967 0.796 0.982 1.04 1.517 1.667 2.024 2.291
IEORQ40 0.503 0.473 0.434 0.595 0.49 0.604 0.64 0.933 1.026 1.246 1.01 1.178
IMPQ41 0.685 0.645 0.591 0.896 0.737 0.91 0.964 1.09 1.199 1.455 1.179 0.726
1.73
1
IMPQ42 0.651 0.613 0.562 0.851 0.701 0.865 0.916 1.036 1.139 1.383 1.121 0.69
1.42
3
1.59
9
IMPQ43 0.5 0.471 0.431 0.654 0.538 0.664 0.703 0.796 0.875 1.062 0.861 0.53
1.09
3
1.03
8
1.58
8
IMPQ44 0.624 0.587 0.539 0.816 0.672 0.829 0.878 0.993 1.092 1.326 1.074 0.661
1.36
4
1.29
6
0.99
5
1.73
4
IMPQ45 0.626 0.589 0.54 0.818 0.674 0.831 0.88 0.996 1.095 1.329 1.077 0.663
1.36
8 1.3
0.99
8
1.24
6
1.67
7
TRIVQ15 0.823 0.774 0.71 0.973 0.801 0.988 1.047 1.062 1.167 1.417 1.149 0.707
0.90
7
0.86
1
0.66
2
0.82
6
0.82
8 1.803
TRIVQ16 0.907 0.853 0.783 1.072 0.883 1.089 1.154 1.17 1.286 1.562 1.266 0.779
0.99
9
0.94
9
0.72
9 0.91
0.91
3 1.274 1.89
TRIVQ17 0.621 0.584 0.536 0.734 0.605 0.746 0.79 0.801 0.881 1.069 0.867 0.533
0.68
4 0.65
0.49
9
0.62
3
0.62
5 0.872 0.962 1.378
IEOQ7 0.495 0.466 0.427 0.585 0.482 0.594 0.629 0.85 0.934 1.135 0.919 0.566
0.67
3
0.63
9
0.49
1
0.61
3
0.61
5 0.695 0.766 0.525
1.2
29
IEOQ8 0.596 0.561 0.515 0.705 0.581 0.717 0.759 1.025 1.127 1.368 1.109 0.682
0.81
1
0.77
1
0.59
2
0.73
9
0.74
1 0.838 0.924 0.633
1.0
84
1.7
78
IEOQ9 0.633 0.596 0.547 0.749 0.617 0.761 0.806 1.089 1.197 1.453 1.178 0.725
0.86
2
0.81
9
0.62
9
0.78
5
0.78
7 0.89 0.981 0.672
1.1
51
1.3
88
1.7
89
IEOQ11 0.39 0.367 0.337 0.461 0.38 0.469 0.497 0.671 0.737 0.895 0.725 0.446
0.53
1
0.50
4
0.38
7
0.48
3
0.48
5 0.548 0.604 0.414
0.7
09
0.8
55
0.9
08
1.36
6
305
Appendix 16. Implied Correlations (Group number 1 - Default model)
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IVNCQ30 1
IVNCQ31 0.895 1
IVNCQ32 0.825 0.841 1
IIMCQ25 0.529 0.54 0.497 1
IIMCQ26 0.488 0.498 0.459 0.77 1
IIMCQ27 0.48 0.49 0.451 0.757 0.698 1
IIMCQ28 0.451 0.46 0.424 0.711 0.656 0.645 1
IEORQ36 0.445 0.454 0.418 0.533 0.492 0.483 0.454 1
IEORQ37 0.454 0.463 0.427 0.544 0.502 0.494 0.464 0.797 1
IEORQ38 0.41 0.419 0.386 0.492 0.454 0.446 0.419 0.72 0.735 1
IEORQ39 0.426 0.435 0.4 0.51 0.471 0.463 0.435 0.748 0.763 0.69 1
IEORQ40 0.366 0.373 0.344 0.438 0.404 0.397 0.373 0.642 0.655 0.592 0.615 1
IMPQ41 0.411 0.419 0.386 0.544 0.502 0.494 0.464 0.618 0.631 0.571 0.592 0.508 1
IMPQ42 0.406 0.414 0.382 0.538 0.496 0.488 0.459 0.611 0.624 0.564 0.585 0.502
0.85
5 1
IMPQ43 0.313 0.319 0.294 0.415 0.383 0.376 0.353 0.471 0.481 0.435 0.451 0.387
0.65
9
0.65
2 1
IMPQ44 0.374 0.381 0.351 0.495 0.457 0.449 0.422 0.563 0.575 0.519 0.539 0.463
0.78
7
0.77
8 0.6 1
IMPQ45 0.381 0.389 0.358 0.505 0.466 0.458 0.431 0.574 0.586 0.529 0.55 0.472
0.80
3
0.79
4
0.61
2
0.73
1 1
TRIVQ15 0.484 0.493 0.454 0.579 0.534 0.526 0.494 0.59 0.602 0.544 0.565 0.485
0.51
3
0.50
7
0.39
1
0.46
7
0.47
6 1
TRIVQ16 0.52 0.531 0.489 0.624 0.575 0.566 0.532 0.635 0.648 0.586 0.608 0.522
0.55
2
0.54
6
0.42
1
0.50
3
0.51
3 0.69 1
TRIVQ17 0.417 0.426 0.392 0.5 0.461 0.454 0.426 0.509 0.52 0.47 0.488 0.419
0.44
3
0.43
8
0.33
7
0.40
3
0.41
1
0.55
4 0.596 1
IEOQ7 0.352 0.359 0.331 0.422 0.389 0.383 0.36 0.572 0.584 0.528 0.548 0.47
0.46
1
0.45
6
0.35
1 0.42
0.42
8
0.46
7 0.503
0.40
3 1
IEOQ8 0.353 0.36 0.332 0.423 0.39 0.384 0.361 0.574 0.586 0.529 0.549 0.471
0.46
3
0.45
7
0.35
2
0.42
1
0.42
9
0.46
8 0.504
0.40
4
0.7
33 1
IEOQ9 0.374 0.381 0.351 0.448 0.413 0.406 0.382 0.607 0.62 0.56 0.582 0.499 0.49
0.48
4
0.37
3
0.44
6
0.45
4
0.49
6 0.534
0.42
8
0.7
76
0.7
78 1
IEOQ11 0.263 0.269 0.248 0.316 0.291 0.286 0.269 0.428 0.437 0.395 0.41 0.352
0.34
5
0.34
1
0.26
3
0.31
4 0.32
0.34
9 0.376
0.30
2
0.5
47
0.5
49
0.5
81 1
306
Appendix 17. Residual Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model)
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IVNCQ30 0
IVNCQ31
-
0.003 0
IVNCQ32
-
0.015
0.01
5 0
IIMCQ25
0.07
5
-
0.019
-
0.041 0
IIMCQ26
-
0.075
-
0.115
-
0.162
0.0
41 0
IIMCQ27
0.24
5
0.14
7
0.11
5
-
0.006
-
0.056 0
IIMCQ28
0.02
8
-
0.063
-
0.098
-
0.032 0.04
-
0.046 0
IEORQ36
0.17
7
0.05
1
0.06
8
0.0
16
-
0.07
0.2
09
0.13
6 0
IEORQ37
0.12
3
-
0.06 -0.1
-
0.06
-
0.019
0.1
36
0.25
5
0.01
9 0
IEORQ38
0.07
4
-
0.133
-
0.15
-
0.012
-
0.019
0.2
69
0.44
3
-
0.093
0.06
3 0
IEORQ39
-
0.013
-
0.21
-
0.132
-
0.008 0.02
0.0
81
0.27
6
-
0.081
0.01
6
0.20
9 0
IEORQ40
0.09
2
0.02
3
0.02
9
-
0.039
0.00
1
0.1
62
-
0.008
0.02
8
-
0.052
-
0.062
0.04
7 0
IMPQ41
0.06
2
-
0.101
-
0.095
-
0.04
-
0.028
0.0
82
0.12
1
0.07
1
-
0.006
0.03
7
-
0.04
0.01
2
0.0
07
IMPQ42
0.06
6
-
0.097
-
0.094
0.0
13
0.01
5
0.1
14
0.20
8
0.05
7
0.01
3
0.09
3
0.02
1
-
0.009
0.0
49
0.0
06
IMPQ43
-
0.005
-
0.147
-
0.06
-
0.078
-
0.127
-
0.078
-
0.049
-
0.098
-
0.175
-
0.165
-
0.141
-
0.117
-
0.041
0.0
06
0.0
04
IMPQ44
0.08
3
-
0.015
-
0.008
0.0
29
0.05
8
0.0
28
0.12
8
0.00
9
0.00
1
0.01
5
-
0.044
-
0.07
-
0.053
-
0.042
0.1
07
0.0
06
IMPQ45
-
0.029
-
0.127
-
0.112
-
0.058
-
0.045
0.0
16
0.05
6
0.01
4
-
0.042
-
0.064
-
0.121
-
0.007
-
0.006
-
0.06
0.0
82
0.1
61
0.0
06
TRIVQ15
0.17
5
0.03
6
0.01
6
0.0
37
-
0.073
0.1
79
0.16
5
-
0.054
-
0.093
-
0.068
-
0.119
-
0.094
0.1
08
0.0
96
-
0.107
0.0
04
0.0
39 0
TRIVQ16
0.01
6
-
0.078
-
0.099
-
0.136
-
0.054
0.0
11
0.04
4
0.05
6
0.08
2
0.04
6 0.05
0.03
8
0.0
14
-
0.006
-
0.253
0.0
05
-
0.054
0.0
11 0
TRIVQ17
0.04
9
-
0.042
-
0.01
0.0
25
-
0.033
0.1
42
0.00
4
-
0.005
-
0.141
-
0.054
-
0.084 0.05
0.0
13
0.0
97
-
0.089
0.0
26
-
0.067
0.0
04
0.0
02 0
IEOQ7
0.09
9
-
0.016
-
0.024
-
0.059
-
0.114
0.1
4
-
0.043
0.10
8
-
0.03
-
0.231
-
0.045
0.09
6
0.1
32
0.0
88
0.0
13
0.0
69
0.0
76
-
0.063
0.0
22
0.0
92 0
IEOQ8
0.08
9
-
0.027
0.00
4
-
0.163
-
0.232
0.0
42
-
0.123
0.05
4
-
0.144
-
0.29
-
0.053
0.04
7
0.0
75
0.0
75
0.0
42
0.0
7
0.0
11
-
0.105
-
0.03
0.1
48
0.0
42 0
IEOQ9
0.16
9
-
0.015 0.04 -0.1
-
0.115
0.0
88
-
0.041 0.06
-
0.024
-
0.228
-
0.023
0.05
2
0.0
94
0.0
67
0.0
65
0.1
54
0.0
82
-
0.099
0.0
78
0.0
49
-
0.024
0.0
13 0
IEOQ11
0.14
4
0.06
4
0.04
7
-
0.006
-
0.049
0.1
14
0.15
3
0.22
9
0.12
4
0.02
3 0.06
0.15
3
0.0
78
0.0
66
0.0
12
0.0
48
0.0
65
-
0.044
0.1
37
0.0
63
-
0.019
-
0.111
0.0
43 0
307
Appendix 18. Standardised Residual Covariances (Group number 1 - Default model)
IVN
CQ
30
IVN
CQ
31
IVN
CQ
32
IIM
CQ
25
IIM
CQ
26
IIM
CQ
27
IIM
CQ
28
IEO
RQ
36
IEO
RQ
37
IEO
RQ
38
IEO
RQ
39
IEO
RQ
40
IMP
Q41
IMP
Q42
IMP
Q43
IMP
Q44
IMP
Q45
TR
IVQ
15
TR
IVQ
16
TR
IVQ
17
IEO
Q7
IEO
Q8
IEO
Q9
IEO
Q11
IVNCQ30 0
IVNCQ31
-
0.021 0
IVNCQ32
-
0.113
0.12
1 0
IIMCQ25
0.60
3
-
0.16
-
0.364 0
IIMCQ26
-
0.684
-
1.131
-
1.626
0.3
38 0
IIMCQ27
1.79
3 1.16
0.92
7
-
0.038
-
0.42 0
IIMCQ28
0.18
5
-
0.449
-
0.704
-
0.189
0.27
5
-
0.252 0
IEORQ36
1.36
6 0.43
0.57
9
0.1
18
-
0.605
1.4
4
0.84
2 0
IEORQ37
0.87
8
-
0.466
-
0.789
-
0.42
-
0.154
0.8
65
1.46
2
0.10
9 0
IEORQ38 0.4
-
0.781
-
0.89
-
0.063
-
0.117 1.3
1.92
2
-
0.416
0.26
3 0
IEORQ39
-
0.091
-
1.563
-
0.999
-
0.057
0.15
3 0.5
1.52
1
-
0.462
0.08
4
0.84
4 0
IEORQ40
0.90
1
0.24
3
0.31
1
-
0.382
0.01
1
1.4
21
-
0.066
0.23
4
-
0.396
-
0.364
0.35
3 0
IMPQ41
0.49
6
-
0.87
-
0.833
-
0.307
-
0.244
0.5
74
0.76
1
0.49
4
-
0.036
0.18
1
-
0.25
0.10
7
0.0
41
IMPQ42
0.54
7
-
0.868
-
0.862
0.1
08
0.13
7
0.8
29
1.36
5
0.40
9
0.08
5
0.47
3
0.13
8
-
0.082
0.3
24
0.0
4
IMPQ43
-
0.046
-
1.368
-
0.565
-
0.66
-
1.215
-
0.596
-
0.334
-
0.755
-
1.245
-
0.892
-
0.97
-
1.147
-
0.295
0.0
48
0.0
24
IMPQ44
0.67
1
-
0.132
-
0.073
0.2
26
0.51
7
0.1
98
0.81
6
0.06
1
0.00
6
0.07
3
-
0.281
-
0.641
-
0.343
-
0.285
0.7
99
0.0
34
IMPQ45
-
0.239
-
1.127
-
1.009
-
0.462
-
0.408
0.1
18
0.36
4 0.1
-
0.28
-
0.325
-
0.778
-
0.068
-
0.042
-
0.414
0.6
14
1.0
99
0.0
35
TRIVQ15
1.33
1
0.29
3
0.13
7
0.2
77
-
0.621
1.2
14
1.00
5
-
0.374
-
0.594
-
0.33
-
0.735
-
0.832
0.7
85
0.7
23
-
0.849
0.0
29
0.2
92 0
TRIVQ16
0.11
6
-
0.617
-
0.797
-
0.968
-
0.436
0.0
71
0.25
6
0.37
1
0.49
8
0.21
7
0.29
5
0.32
1
0.1
01
-
0.041
-
1.936
0.0
38
-
0.388
0.0
7 0
TRIVQ17
0.43
8
-
0.407
-
0.099
0.2
15
-
0.331
1.1
35
0.03
1
-
0.039
-
1.06
-
0.311
-
0.612
0.52
3
0.1
08
0.8
59
-
0.819
0.2
23
-
0.589
0.0
3
0.0
13 0
IEOQ7
0.95
4
-
0.169
-
0.256
-
0.562
-
1.23
1.2
11
-
0.336
0.90
4
-
0.236
-
1.37
-
0.341
1.03
6
1.1
79
0.8
17
0.1
29
0.6
24 0.7
-
0.556
0.1
85
0.9
45 0
IEOQ8
0.71
4
-
0.234
0.03
9
-
1.297
-
2.087
0.3
02
-
0.792 0.38
-
0.93
-
1.426
-
0.331
0.42
4
0.5
62
0.5
8
0.3
36
0.5
3
0.0
87
-
0.762
-
0.213
1.2
63
0.3
31 0
IEOQ9
1.34
4
-
0.126
0.34
8
-
0.789
-
1.027
0.6
29
-
0.262
0.41
1
-
0.15
-
1.103
-
0.144
0.46
3
0.6
91
0.5
1
0.5
22
1.1
47
0.6
23
-
0.709
0.5
41
0.4
16
-
0.186
0.0
83 0
IEOQ11
1.35
6
0.65
2
0.48
6
-
0.058
-
0.514
0.9
63
1.14
9
1.93
1
0.96
6
0.13
3
0.45
5
1.63
4
0.6
87
0.6
1
0.1
17
0.4
26
0.5
84
-
0.377
1.1
46
0.6
31
-
0.186
-
0.895
0.3
39 0
Recommended